Avocent Switch DSView 3 User Manual

DSView® 3  
Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSView® 3  
Management Software  
Version 3.5  
Installer/User Guide  
Avocent, the Avocent logo, The Power of Being There, DSView, DSR,  
MergePoint, AlterPath, AutoView, OutLook, OSCAR, AVWorks,  
LANDesk, Dambrackas Video Compression and Cyclades are registered  
trademarks of Avocent Corporation or its affiliates. All other marks are  
the property of their respective owners.  
© 2007 Avocent Corporation. All rights reserved. 590-395-501J  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iii  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
®
Managing ActiveX controls....................................................................................................40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
viii  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
x
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xiv  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xv  
LIST OF FIGURES  
List of Figures  
Figure 18.2: Manual Video Adjust Dialog Box.............................................................................241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
xvi  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xvii  
LIST OF TABLES  
List of Tables  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
xviii  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xx  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
CHAPTER  
Product Overview  
1
®
The DSView 3 management software version 3.5 is a secure, web browser-based, centralized  
enterprise management solution that allows users to remotely access, manage, monitor and control  
target devices through Avocent managed appliances. A session may be launched to a target device  
with a single point of access.  
Features and Benefits  
Network rebooting and troubleshooting  
The DSView 3 software uses industry standard IP connections so that you can easily troubleshoot a  
server, or even reboot it, from the Network Operations Center (NOC), from your desk or from any  
location in the world. With the DSView 3 software, you can access all of your data center devices  
from a single screen - making complex network access and control remarkably easy. Using out-of-  
band management, the software can be used to reach and restart servers or other devices that are not  
functioning or responding to in-band commands, regardless of the state of the equipment’s  
operating system.  
Web-based access and control  
The DSView 3 management software provides secure “point-and-click” browser-based access to  
control virtually any data center device using managed appliances from DSView 3 software clients  
located anywhere in the world.  
The DSView 3 software supports the following browsers:  
®
Microsoft Internet Explorer version 6.0 SP1 and later  
Mozilla version 1.7.3 and later  
®
®
Firefox version 1.0 and later; version 1.5 or later is required for Macintosh  
operating systems  
®
Netscape version 7.2 and later  
It is recommended that the browser be kept up to date with the latest version.  
NOTE: The Macintosh Safari browser is not supported by DSView 3 software. On supported Macintosh system  
clients, you must use Firefox version 1.5 or later.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Secure authentication and communication  
Secure Socket Layer (SSL) encryption may be used to encrypt data traveling within the DSView 3  
software system. Users may be authenticated through internal or external services such as LDAP,  
Active Directory, NT Domain, TACACS+, RADIUS and RSA SecurID.  
Unit and user management  
The DSView 3 management software provides centralized network access, control and security for  
managed appliances. A DSView 3 software administrator may add, remove, delete and change  
settings for managed appliances and target devices, including assigning permissions and per-device  
contact information, which are stored on the DSView 3 server. A DSView 3 software administrator  
may also assign unique permissions which allow individual users or a group of users access to units  
or groups of units.  
Proxy server access  
The proxy server feature allows keyboard, video and mouse (KVM) and serial sessions to be  
proxied through the DSView 3 server. When a session is initiated with a target device, the viewer  
communicates using the Avocent Proxy Protocol (APP) and the DSView 3 server makes a direct  
connection to the appliance.  
Virtual media  
On supported KVM switches, a virtual media capable IQ module and the virtual media feature  
allow the client workstation user to load files onto USB2-compatible target devices when the usual  
network resources are unavailable.  
Mapping physical drives or image files on the client system as virtual drives on the target device  
can accommodate critical tasks required on the target device, such as operating system installation  
or recovery, BIOS updating and configuration backups.  
System Components  
The DSView 3 software system contains the following components.  
DSView 3 management software  
The DSView 3 software resides on the DSView 3 server (host or hub computer) and provides a web  
gateway and services for managing units (appliances and target devices) using a web browser. The  
gateway allows for IP-based video, serial management, Telnet Viewer, third party Telnet viewer,  
web browser and other supported session types.  
Users may connect to the DSView 3 server from DSView 3 software clients and use the DSView 3  
Explorer windows to communicate with the system.  
DSView 3 server  
The DSView 3 server contains the DSView 3 management software. The server provides a  
centralized database for storing configuration, user, unit and system information. It also provides  
services for authentication, access control, logging events, monitoring and license management.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 1: Product Overview  
3
You may configure one or more spoke (backup) servers in addition to the hub server.  
The hub server is responsible for maintaining the master copy of the database in a DSView 3  
software system. Only one server in a DSView 3 software system may be configured as the  
hub server.  
Spoke servers perform database replication with the hub server. The hub server acts as the  
coordinator for database replication between itself and all of the other spoke servers in a DSView 3  
software system. A hub server and a spoke server both offer the same DSView 3 software  
functionality to a user. The distinction of hub or spoke refers only to the database replication role  
that the server plays and not with the functionality that the server provides. Adding one or more  
spoke servers to a DSView 3 software system provides redundancy and the ability to distribute  
DSView 3 software functionality across multiple sites.  
After the hub server and optional spoke server(s) are configured, you may create and configure the  
type of access levels for users within your network environment. You may also set up event logs to  
record full details of user access and other events.  
DSView 3 software client  
A DSView 3 software client is a computer with a web browser that can access the DSView 3  
management software installed on the DSView 3 server.  
Third party products  
Third party products are not a part of the DSView 3 software, but are supported for use with it.  
External authentication servers - An external authentication server enables the DSView 3 server to  
broker authentication requests from users requesting access to the DSView 3 software system.  
SNMP managers - The SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) manager monitors the  
managed appliances and receives SNMP traps from the DSView 3 software on the server. An  
example of an SNMP manager is the HP OpenView product.  
Third party Telnet viewers - A third party Telnet viewer may be used for serial sessions instead of  
the DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer.  
Third party session software - Third party software such as RDP or VNC, when properly installed  
and configured on the target device, may be enabled for use within the DSView 3 software for  
initiating sessions with the target device.  
NOTE: RDP is only available on supported Windows system clients.  
Partner products  
Environmental monitoring with Uptime Devices  
DSView 3 management software can help you access Uptime Devices SensorHub environmental  
monitoring equipment so you can quickly detect environmental conditions (equipment to track  
temperature, humidity, airflow, water, voltage and contact closures) that could adversely affect  
operation of servers and other network devices. Visit www.uptimedevices.com for  
ordering information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Proactive Network Security with NetClarity Auditor Enterprise  
Integrate NetClarity Auditor Enterprise with DSView 3 software and manage one or more Auditor  
appliances to alert, block and correct critical IT security and compliance problems in your data  
center and throughout your entire enterprise network. Visit www.netclarity.net for  
ordering information.  
®
Avocent DSView 3 Connector for HP Software  
The DSView 3 Connector for HP Software extends the capabilities of HP Software Network Node  
Manager (NNM) and Operations for Windows (OVOW). Seamless access and control allows  
critical management functions for dispersed IT environments. Out of band connectivity offers  
solutions for lights out data centers and ensures quick and efficient troubleshooting and repair from  
the HP console.  
Supported Units  
For management functions, the DSView 3 software client uses HTTPS (Hypertext Transfer  
Protocol with SSL encryption) to send a request to the DSView 3 server, which then sends a  
command to the managed appliance. The appliance then performs the requested function.  
The DSView 3 software supports the managed appliances listed in this section. Other appliances  
may be supported by plug-ins; see the Avocent web site, www.avocent.com, for a list of plug-ins  
that may currently ship with the DSView 3 software and/or that can be added to the DSView 3  
software. See Plug-ins on page 319 for information about adding and managing plug-ins in the  
DSView 3 software system.  
®
Cyclades ACS advanced console server  
ACS advanced console servers allow users to access serially attached devices over a standard TCP/  
IP connection using the Avocent Telnet Viewer, a third party Telnet viewer or a Secure Shell (SSH)  
client. These serial sessions can be shared among multiple users across multiple DSView 3 servers.  
For more information, see the ACS console server plug-in documentation.  
DSView 3 Mobile software  
DSView 3 Mobile software plug-in extends DSView 3 data center solutions to enable management  
of Windows servers from a handheld device. Licenses may be required; see your Avocent  
representative or www.avocent.com for more information.  
®
LANDesk Server Manager  
The DSView 3 management software plug-in for LANDesk Server Manager allows you to access  
the LANDesk Server Manager and its target devices from within the DSView 3 software. This  
integrated system provides complete life cycle and systems management for multiplatform server  
infrastructures. Use the browser-based software to manage server performance and availability, and  
launch sessions to target devices from a single point of access.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 1: Product Overview  
5
LANDesk Server Manager supports rack-mounted and blade servers with low-impact services that  
let users choose the level of management coverage – from device discovery to extended  
performance analysis, security and configuration control. It enables enterprises to take inventory,  
provision, patch, monitor and instantly assess server health and ensure optimum availability.  
®
DSR switches  
DSR switches allow KVM signals to be transmitted over a standard TCP/IP network connection.  
Some DSR switches may be connected using a modem, which provides benefits for branch offices  
such as low cost and dial-up performance.  
The DSView 3 software supports the following DSR switch models:  
800, 1010, 1020*, 1021*, 1022*, 1024*, 1030*, 1031*, 1161, 2010, 2020*, 2030*, 2035*,  
2161, 4010, 4020*, 4030*, 4160, 8020*, 8030*, 8035*  
*These models contain a dedicated serial port for connecting an external modem for use with  
the DSR Remote Operations software.  
For DSR switches, a target device is first attached to an IQ module, which is then attached to a DSR  
switch. DSView 3 software clients communicate with target device ports using a Video Viewer  
connection between the client and the managed appliance.  
The DSR switches allow the cascading of legacy analog KVM switches from DSR switch ports,  
which may be managed in a DSView 3 software system. Certain DSR switch models also allow the  
cascading of another switch. For more information, see the installer/user guide for your  
DSR switch.  
NOTE: PEM cascade devices are not supported.  
®
MergePoint 52xx service processor (SP) manager  
The MergePoint 52xx service processor manager is a secure, centralized enterprise management  
solution for target devices equipped with IPMI, HP iLO and Dell DRAC service processors. You  
can use the DSView 3 software to access, monitor and control the MergePoint 52xx SP manager  
and attached target devices.  
The MergePoint 52xx SP manager provides a standardized interface independent of the  
management protocols used to manage each target device. Management operations can be  
performed either by using commands or scripts over a Telnet or SSH version 2 session or by using  
the appliance’s web interface from a standard web browser.  
For more information, see the MergePoint 52xx appliance plug-in documentation.  
Cyclades OnSite branch office appliance  
OnSite branch office appliances may be used to access multiple traditional or headless servers,  
networking devices, infrastructure components or any other device with a serial console or KVM  
port. You can use the DSView 3 software to access, monitor and control the OnSite appliance and  
attached target devices. For more information, see the OnSite appliance plug-in documentation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
®
VMware environments  
The DSView 3 software plug-in for Virtualization allows you to access and control VMware  
VirtualCenters, ESX Servers and virtual machines from the DSView 3 software. You can launch a  
Virtual Network Computing (VNC), Remote Desktop or VMware viewer session to a virtual  
machine from a single point of access. For more information, see the Virtualization plug-in  
documentation. Licenses may be required; see your Avocent representative or www.avocent.com  
for more information.  
Blade chassis  
The DSView 3 software plug-in for Blade Chassis allows you to access multi-vendor blade chassis  
and blades from the DSView 3 software. You can launch a KVM session to any managed blade  
from a single point of access. For a list of supported blade chassis and other information, see the  
Blade Chassis plug-in documentation.  
Generic appliances  
Generic appliances manage data center devices such as routers. These devices may be managed  
within a DSView 3 software system by launching a standard web browser to the device URL or by  
opening a Telnet session.  
Embedded units  
Using the DSView 3 software, you may add/delete, configure/display properties, and launch video  
sessions to the following versions of third party embedded units:  
®
IBM ASM (Advanced System Management) RSA II (Remote Supervisor Adapter II) -  
Version 5, Build GRE132AUS  
DRAC 4 (Dell™ Remote Access Controller) - Version 1.0, Build 06.14  
HP iLO (Integrated Lights-Out) - Version 1.20  
NEC IPF (Itanium Processor Family) - Version 0.5.1.20  
For management functions (other than launching video sessions) that are not performed by the  
DSView 3 software, see the documentation for the unit.  
Legacy units  
The following legacy units are supported in the DSView 3 software.  
DSI5100 IPMI proxy appliances  
EVR1500 environmental monitors  
DS1800 digital switches  
®
AutoView 200-4, 200-8, 400-4, 400-8, 416, 424 and 2000-AM switches (these switches must  
be Flash upgraded to be added to a DSView 3 software system)  
®
OutLook 140ES, 180ES, 280ES, 1160ES, 2160ES and 4160ES switches  
Cyclades KVM/net KVM over IP switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1: Product Overview  
7
Cyclades KVM/net Plus KVM over IP switches  
Cyclades TS appliances  
CCM console management appliances  
CPS810 and 1610 serial over IP network appliances  
Target devices  
Target devices encompass a wide range of data center components such as servers and routers that  
a DSView 3 software administrator may manage virtually through the DSView 3 software system.  
A target device is added automatically to your DSView 3 software system when the supported  
managed appliance is added. A target device may also be added individually.  
Power devices  
A power device is a type of target device that can be cascaded from a managed appliance.  
When a DSView 3 software client sends a power control request to a target device, an HTTPS  
request is sent to the DSView 3 server, which then sends a command to the managed appliance.  
The command is converted and serially sent to the power device. The power device then performs  
the requested action (for example, turning a power outlet on or off).  
The DSView 3 software supports the following power devices:  
Avocent SPC power control devices  
Server Technologies Sentry Switched CDU CW-8H1, CW-8H2, CW-16V1, CW-16V2,  
CW-24V2, CW-24V3, CW-32VD1 and CW-32VD2 (supported models may change; contact  
Avocent Technical Support for current information)  
®
®
Cyclades Power Distribution Units (AlterPath PM devices)  
All of the above power devices are supported on DSR switches that contain one or more SPC ports.  
Avocent and Server Technologies power devices are also supported on CCM and CPS appliances.  
System Configuration  
Figure 1.1 illustrates an example system configuration using the DSView 3 management software.  
For information about the TCP ports that the DSView 3 software uses, see TCP and UDP Ports on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
8
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4
3
2
5
1
6
7
11  
10  
13  
19  
8
9
12  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
20  
21  
22  
Figure 1.1: Example System Configuration  
Table 1.1: DSView 3 Software System Configuration Descriptions  
Number Description Number Description  
1
DSView 3 Software Client  
Hub DSView 3 Software Server  
12  
13  
Power Device  
2
Generic Appliance  
VMware VirtualCenter  
Target Device  
3
Spoke DSView 3 Software Servers (Optional) 14  
4
External Authentication Servers (Optional)  
SNMP Manager (Optional)  
TCP/IP  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
5
IQ Module  
6
Cascade Switch  
Target Devices  
7
Replication  
8
ACS Advanced Console Server  
Power Device  
MergePoint 5200 Service Processor Manager  
VMware ESX Server  
9
10  
11  
DSR Switch  
VMware Virtual Machines  
Blade Chassis  
®
OSCAR Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9
CHAPTER  
Installation  
2
This chapter describes the following installation sequence:  
What you should do before installing the DSView 3 software  
Installing the DSView 3 software  
Configuring the DSView 3 software, plus considerations when upgrading  
Running the DSView 3 software, that is, start a client session  
Final sections describe how to change your password, uninstall the software, end a DSView 3  
software session and install Java.  
About Installation  
When the DSView 3 management software is installed, the DSView 3 software database and a hub  
server are also installed on the dedicated server.  
The DSView 3 software may be installed on a computer containing an existing DSView 2.x  
software authentication server without causing any interference with the operation of the DSView  
2.x software system. The DSView 2.x software authentication server and the DSView 3 software  
may run on the same dedicated server at the same time.  
Rebooting the dedicated server is not required prior to using the DSView 3 software.  
Once the DSView 3 software is installed and you have configured the hub server, users may log in  
at another computer as a DSView 3 software client, using a supported web browser.  
You may also install the DSView 3 software on additional computers and configure them as spoke  
NOTE: A license key permits the operation of the DSView 3 software on the dedicated server. The license key  
also specifies the number of clients that may use the software and the number of spoke servers allowed on a  
Minimum requirements for the DSView 3 software  
The following are the minimum requirements for installing the DSView 3 software on a dedicated  
hub server or a computer that will function as a DSView 3 software spoke server:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
10  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
For supported Windows and Linux systems: 2 GHz Pentium or equivalent processor  
For supported Solaris systems: 1 GHz UltraSparc III processor  
1 GB of RAM - additional memory may be needed, depending on the number of plug-ins  
installed and appliances supported  
100BaseT NIC (1GByte LAN recommended)  
10 GB of free disk space - additional disk space may be required for data logging and plug-ins  
One of the following operating systems:  
®
Windows 2000 Server or Advanced Server with the latest service package  
Windows Server 2003 Standard, Enterprise and Web Edition  
Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2 or later  
Windows Vista Ultimate or Business  
®
Red Hat Enterprise Linux, Version 4 (AS, ES and WS products)  
Red Hat Enterprise Linux, Version 5  
®
Sun Solaris SPARC 9 and 10  
®
®
Novell SUSE Linux (x86) Enterprise Server 9 or 10  
Before installing and configuring the DSView 3 software  
Before installing the DSView 3 management software, install the managed appliance hardware.  
If the computer will be a hub server, you will need the license key obtained from Avocent and  
provide a username and password to use for initial log in.  
If the computer will be a spoke server, you will need to identify the associated hub server and  
provide the name/password of the hub server’s DSView 3 software administrator.  
To prevent potential mouse conflicts, you may configure certain settings on each server connected  
to a KVM switch or serial console appliance. For details, see the Mouse and Pointer Settings  
Technical Brief, which is available on the DSView 3 software DVD and on the Avocent web site.  
Installing the DSView 3 Software  
The DSView 3 management software may be installed using the DSView 3 software DVD or by  
downloading the software in a self-extracting .zip file from the Avocent web site.  
NOTE: If you are upgrading the DSView 3 software from a previous version, it is strongly recommended that you  
perform a database synchronization between the hub and spoke servers; see Replication on page 71. You  
should also perform a backup of the hub server prior to upgrading the DSView 3 software; see Backing up and  
Restoring Hub Servers Manually on page 65. Failure to perform synchronization and backup may have  
detrimental effects. A backup should be performed both before the upgrade and immediately following  
the upgrade.  
To install the DSView 3 software on a supported Windows system:  
1. Log on to the dedicated server as Administrator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 2: Installation  
11  
2. To install from a DVD:  
a. Insert the DSView 3 software DVD. An autorun file will bring up a menu of  
installation options.  
b. Click Install DSView 3 Software.  
-or-  
If autorun is not enabled, type <drive:>\DSView\win32\setup.exe, where <drive:> is the  
letter of your DVD drive.  
A dialog box will indicate that the server will be verified to ensure it meets the minimum  
requirements for installing the DSView 3 software.  
To install from a downloaded file:  
a. Using your web browser, download the DSView 3 software from the Avocent web site.  
Go to www.avocent.com and click the Support link. On the Technical Support page, click  
the Product Upgrades link, then select DS Software Upgrades.  
b. Double-click on the downloaded installation package (setup.exe). A dialog box will  
indicate that the server will be verified to ensure it meets the minimum requirements for  
installing the DSView 3 management software.  
3. If the current or an earlier version of the DSView 3 software is already installed, the Installed  
Product Found: Same Version message box will appear. Click OK to reinstall the DSView 3  
software or Cancel to exit setup.  
4. The Check for an UPDATED version window will open. (If the DSView 3 software is already  
installed on the dedicated server, a message box will display. Click OK to close the  
message box.)  
a. Click Next to reinstall the software, or click Cancel to stop the reinstallation.  
b. Click Check for UPDATES and then click Next to check the Avocent web site for the most  
recent DSView 3 software installation package. Go to step 5.  
-or-  
Click Next to install the DVD or downloaded version of the DSView 3 software. Go to  
step 6.  
5. If a newer version of the DSView 3 software is found, an Update Available message box  
will appear.  
a. Click OK to download the latest DSView 3 software installation package. The installation  
will be cancelled and the server’s default web browser will launch and open in the Product  
Upgrades and Options page of the Avocent web site.  
-or-  
Click Cancel to resume installation of the older version of the DSView 3 software. Go to  
step 6.  
b. Type your email address and password, and then click Submit to log in to the web site.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
c. Download the DSView 3 software installation package, log out and close the web  
browser. Return to step 2.  
6. The Introduction window will open. Click Next.  
7. The License Agreement window will open.  
If you accept the terms, click I accept the terms of the License Agreement and then click  
Next. Go to step 8.  
If you do not accept the terms, click I do NOT accept the terms of the License Agreement.  
A License Agreement Warning message box will appear.  
If you click Quit, the installation will exit without installing the DSView 3 software.  
If you click Resume, you will be returned to the License Agreement window.  
The DSView 3 software license agreement may also be viewed from the User Login window  
by clicking the Avocent DSView 3 End User License Agreement link. The agreement will  
appear in a separate web browser window.  
8. If the default TCP port used by the dedicated server hosting the DSView 3 software (TCP port  
443) is not available, the Define Web Application Server TCP port window will open. Type the  
port you want to use in the TCP port # field, then click Next. (Clicking Cancel exits the  
Checking for an Updated version installation program.)  
9. If the default TCP port used by the Avocent proxy server (TCP port 1078) is not available, the  
Define TD (target device) Session Viewer Proxy TCP port window will open. Type the port  
you want to use in the TCP port # field, then click Next.  
10. If the default ports used by the SSH server and the Syslog server for data logging are not  
available, appropriate windows will open. Type the port you want to use, then click Next.  
11. The Choose Destination Location window will open.  
a. Click Choose and use the Browse for Folder dialog box to select a directory in which to  
install the DSView 3 software.  
-or-  
Click Restore Default Folder to restore the installation directory to the default  
(C:\Program Files\Avocent DSView 3).  
b. Click Install.  
The Installing... window will open and display the progress of the installation. The software  
will be installed in the specified folder, a Start - Programs - DSView 3 shortcut menu will be  
generated and the DSView 3 software service startup will be verified.  
If a previous version of the DSView 3 software already exists on the dedicated server, message  
boxes may appear, prompting you to confirm overwriting existing files. Click Yes to All.  
12. When the software has finished installing, the Successful Service Startup message box will  
appear. Click Continue.  
13. The Installation Complete window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2: Installation  
13  
To begin configuration of the DSView 3 software, click Done; see Configuring the  
DSView 3 Software on page 13. A Security Alert dialog box will appear containing certifi-  
cate information and a warning that the generator of the certificate is not trusted. This  
occurs because the DSView 3 server certificate created when the server is installed is a  
self-signed certificate. You may either import the certificate into the DSView 3 software  
client web browser (choosing to trust the certificate) or obtain a server certificate from a  
Certificate Authority (CA) trusted by the web browser.  
To configure the DSView 3 software at a later time, click X (Cancel) in the top right corner  
of the window.  
To install the DSView 3 software on a supported Linux or Solaris system:  
1. Log in to the server as root.  
2. Insert the DSView 3 software DVD into your DVD drive. If AutoMount is supported and  
enabled, open a command window and continue with step 3.  
If your system does not support AutoMount, issue the following command to mount the DVD  
volume: mount <device> <mount point>, where <device> and <mount point> are the names  
of your server’s DVD Linux or Solaris device and mount point directory, respectively.  
For example, to mount the first IDE cdrom on /media/cdrom, enter the command:  
mount /dev/cdrom /media/cdrom  
3. Enter the following command to access the readme file:  
less /<mount point>/DSView/readme  
For example, the following command accesses the readme file on the /media/cdrom  
mount point.  
less /media/cdrom/DSView/readme  
4. Follow the instructions in the readme file.  
Configuring the DSView 3 Software  
After the DSView 3 software has been installed, it must be configured using a web browser.  
During configuration, you specify whether the computer will be a hub server or a spoke server. If  
this is your first DSView 3 server installation, hub should be selected in the Select DSView Server  
Role window. The hub server should be installed before any spoke servers are added.  
What you will need  
If the computer will be a hub server, you will need the license key obtained from Avocent and  
provide a username and password to use for initial log in.  
If the computer will be a spoke server, you will need to identify the associated hub server and  
provide the name/password of the hub server’s DSView 3 software administrator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
14  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To configure the DSView 3 software:  
1. If you are configuring the DSView 3 software during the installation process, you have already  
clicked Done in the Launch Default Browser window.  
If you quit after installing the DSView 3 software installation process (by closing the window),  
select Start - Programs - Avocent DSView 3 - DSView Software.  
2. A security alert box will appear containing certificate information. See Certificates on page 43.  
The DSView 3 Explorer will open with the Welcome page of the DSView Server  
Configuration Wizard. Click Next.  
3. The Select DSView Server Role window opens.  
Click Hub to assign the dedicated server as the hub server, then click Next. Go to step 3.  
Click Spoke to assign the dedicated server as a spoke server, then click Next. Go to step 8.  
4. The Type in Master License Key window opens. Type the Avocent-provided license key for  
the DSView 3 software hub server, then click Next. (DSView 3 software license keys prior to  
version 3.0 are not valid.)  
If you did not receive a license key, click the http://www.avocent.com/activation link to obtain  
a license key.  
If the entered license is already in use on another server, a license violation will occur when  
you log in, and you must configure the server as a spoke server.  
5. The Type in Initial Administrator Account window opens. Type a username, a password and  
confirm the password of the user to whom you wish to give administrator privileges.  
Usernames are case sensitive and may contain up to 64 characters. Click Next.  
6. A Request in Progress message will appear. The license key will be installed and a DSView 3  
software administrator account will be created. The built-in user groups will also be created.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open when configuration is completed. Click Finish.  
8. The User Login window will open in the DSView 3 Explorer.  
You may now log in using the username and password specified during configuration.  
If you chose to configure the server as a spoke server in the Select DSView Server Role window or  
if you entered a duplicate software license key in the Type in Master License Key window,  
continue with the following steps.  
NOTE: The DSView 3 software versions of the spoke server and the hub server must match in order to register  
the spoke server. For example, you may not register a spoke server running DSView 3 software version 3.0 with  
a hub server running DSView 3 software version 3.2.  
9. The Type in Hub Server Address and Port window will open. Type the address of the DSView  
3 software hub server using standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or type the DNS name in  
the Address field. Click Next.  
10. The Accept DSView Server Certificate window will open. Click Next to accept the certificate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2: Installation  
15  
11. The Type in Hub Administrator Credentials window will open. Type a valid username and  
password for a user with DSView 3 software administrator privileges on the DSView 3  
software hub server. Click Next.  
12. The Registering Spoke Server window will open with the message Request In Progress Please  
Wait. The configuration of the spoke server will be saved to the database of the hub server and  
the spoke server’s certificates will be installed on the hub server.  
13. The Completed Successful window will open when the spoke server has been added.  
Click Finish.  
Upgrading the DSView 3 software  
When upgrading to a newer version of the DSView 3 software, it is recommended that all DSView  
3 servers are upgraded at the same time. The DSView 3 software hub server should be upgraded  
first, followed by each spoke server.  
Before upgrading, a replication should be performed (see Replication on page 71), then a backup  
immediately before and after upgrading the DSView 3 software (see Backing up and Restoring Hub  
The firmware for the appliances may also need to be upgraded in order to support new functionality  
in the DSView 3 software version. The DSView 3 software should work with the existing firmware  
revisions, but in cases where new functionality is not supported until the firmware is upgraded, the  
DSView 3 software will indicate this in the GUI.  
Running the DSView 3 Software  
DSView 3 software clients access the DSView 3 management software host using a supported web  
browser. Any software required by the client, such as applets and the Java Runtime Environment  
(JRE), will be automatically installed by the DSView 3 server host.  
The DSView 3 software uses Secure Sockets Layers (SSL) encryption to send data between the  
DSView 3 software host and the web browser on the client to ensure data integrity and privacy.  
When a user attempts to log in to a DSView 3 software client session, the authentication service  
configured in the DSView 3 software by the DSView 3 software administrator verifies the  
credentials of the user. Security alerts related to the certificates on the DSView 3 software host may  
Minimum client requirements  
The following are the minimum requirements for a DSView 3 software client:  
1 GHz Pentium or equivalent processor  
512 MB of RAM  
10 or 100BaseT NIC (100 recommended)  
XGA video with graphics accelerator  
Desktop size setting of at least 800 x 600  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
16  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Color palette of at least 256 colors  
One of the following operating systems:  
Windows 2000 Workstation, Server or Advanced Server with the latest service package  
Windows XP Home Edition or Professional  
Windows 2003 Server Standard, Enterprise or Web Edition  
Windows Vista Ultimate or Business  
Red Hat Enterprise Linux, Version 4 (AS, ES and WS products)  
Red Hat Enterprise Linux, Version 5  
Sun Solaris SPARC 9 and 10  
Novell SUSE Linux (x86) Enterprise Server 9 or 10  
Macintosh OS X version 10.4 and later  
One of the following browsers:  
Internet Explorer 6.0 SP1 or later web browser (Windows operating systems only)  
Mozilla version 1.7.3 and later  
Firefox version 1.0 and later; version 1.5 or later is required for Macintosh  
operating systems  
Netscape version 7.2 and later  
If you are using Mozilla, Firefox or Netscape, the Video Viewer and the Telnet Viewer clients  
require Java; see Java Installation on page 18.  
Opening a client session  
Before opening a client session  
Enable cookies and JavaScript on the client’s web browser.  
Configure the web browser. If you are using Internet Explorer, see Internet Explorer Consider-  
To open a client session:  
NOTE: If DSView 3 Software Client Certificate Authentication or DSView 3 Software Client Integrated Windows  
Authentication is being used, the user will not be required to log in. See Certificates on page 43.  
1. From the DSView 3 software client web browser, enter the URL of the server host in the  
address bar in the format:  
https://<servername>/dsview  
In this case, <servername> is the DNS name of the host system, or the IP address in standard  
dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
NOTE: To avoid multiple security warnings, enter the DNS name.  
-or-  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Installation  
17  
If you are opening the session on the DSView 3 server, you may select Start - Programs -  
Avocent DSView 3 - DSView Software.  
2. Accept all security alerts that may appear as the client computer connects to the DSView 3  
server. The DSView 3 Explorer User Login window will open.  
If an RSA SecurID external authentication service has been added to the DSView 3 software,  
see RSA SecurID login below for the login procedure.  
3. Type a valid username and password in the fields provided.  
Depending on the settings specified by the administrator, you may be required to change your  
password before being allowed to complete the login process. See Adding User Accounts on  
4. Click Login. The window that appears depends on the rights assigned to the DSView 3 user  
that is logging in.  
If the client machine uses an onboard video controller and experiences video problems, be sure the  
BIOS is updated to the latest version.  
RSA SecurID login  
When an RSA SecurID external authentication service has been added to the DSView 3 software,  
the login credentials include a username and a passcode. The passcode includes a PIN and an RSA  
SecurID tokencode. The login request is sent to the RSA Authentication Manager. Depending on  
the user configuration and state on the RSA Authentication Manager, the user may be prompted for  
a second successive tokencode.  
The user configuration also specifies how the 4-6 digit PIN will be generated:  
User defined - the user must enter a PIN  
System generated - the user cannot enter a PIN; it must be generated by the RSA server  
User selectable - the user may choose to enter a PIN or allow the RSA server to generate it  
If a PIN has not yet been assigned to the user or if security policy requires a PIN change, the user  
will be prompted accordingly. If the RSA server generates the PIN, the user will be given a brief  
interval to memorize it.  
Regaining access  
If access to a DSView 3 software system is lost, see Regaining Access to the DSView 3 Software on  
Uninstalling the DSView 3 Software  
To uninstall the DSView 3 software on a supported Windows system:  
1. Select Start - Settings - Control Panel. The Control Panel will appear.  
2. From the Control Panel, click Add/Remove Programs. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box  
will appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
18  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. Select Avocent DSView 3 and then click Change/Remove. The Uninstall Avocent DSView  
window will open.  
4. Click Uninstall.  
To uninstall the DSView 3 software on a supported Linux or Solaris system:  
1. Log in to the server as root.  
2. Insert the DSView 3 software DVD into your DVD drive. If AutoMount is supported and  
enabled, open a command window and continue with step 3.  
-or-  
If your system does not support AutoMount, issue the following command to mount the  
DVD volume: mount <device> <mount point>, where <device> and <mount point> are the  
names of your server’s DVD Linux or Solaris device and mount point directory, respectively.  
For example, to mount a DVD which is the second IDE unit on /media/cdrom, enter the  
command:  
mount /dev/cdrom /media/cdrom  
3. Enter the following command to access the readme file.  
less /media/cdrom/DSView/readme  
Follow the instructions in the readme file.  
Closing a DSView 3 Software Session  
Files are copied to DSView 3 software clients when you log in to the DSView 3 software. When  
using Internet Explorer, temporary files may be removed by selecting the Delete Temporary  
Internet Files command and active web components may be uninstalled by selecting the Remove  
Objects command. See the Internet Explorer documentation for more information.  
To close a DSView 3 software session:  
From the DSView 3 Explorer, click LOGOUT or the logout icon.  
Java Installation  
On non-Windows clients, the Video Viewer, Telnet and VNC Viewers require Java version 1.5.  
The Telnet/SSH applet may work with other versions; the Video Viewer requires that version.  
On Windows clients, Java is required to run the Avocent Telnet/SSH Viewer. If the Win32 PuTTY  
Telnet/SSH Viewer is selected in the user’s profile, then Java is not required on the client. On a  
Windows client, it is recommended that the JRE (Java Runtime Environment) be installed in the  
C:\Program Files\ location. If your system automatically installs programs in another location, you  
may not be able to launch the Video Viewer. In this case, you can configure Java to find the JRE.  
To configure Java to find the JRE:  
1. Access the Java Control Panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: Installation  
19  
2. Select the Java tab.  
3. In the Java Application Runtime Settings panel, click View.  
4. Change the path to the installed JRE.  
5. Click OK.  
For Windows, Linux and Solaris operating systems, the DSView 3 software client automatically  
downloads and installs the JRE the first time it is needed. For Macintosh operating systems, you  
must update Java and install the JRE using the Macintosh software updates. Refer to the Macintosh  
operating system documentation for more information.  
To install the JRE on a Windows client:  
1. In a DSView 3 software Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98),  
click an Action link.  
2. A window will open, containing a link for downloading the JRE installer. Download the JRE  
installer, then close all browser windows.  
3. Click on the JRE icon to launch the installer.  
4. Restart the browser, and click an Action link.  
To install the JRE on a Linux or Solaris client:  
NOTE: Only one version of the JRE can be installed in the browser for DSView 3 software support. Depending  
on your system’s configuration, you may have to log in as the root user to install the JRE. Contact your system  
administrator if you need help with installing software as the root user.  
1. In a DSView 3 software Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98),  
click an Action link.  
2. A window will open, containing a link for downloading the JRE installer. Download the JRE  
installer, then close all browser windows.  
3. Run the installer.  
4. Restart the browser, and click an Action link.  
Installing the DSR Remote Operations Software  
NOTE: Installing and using the DSR Remote Operations software is optional.  
If your DSView 3 software system includes DSR1021, 1022, 1024, 1020, 1030, 1031, 2020, 2030,  
2035, 4020, 4030, 8020, 8030 or 8035 switches, you may use the DSR Remote Operations software  
for switch access using a dial-up point to point protocol (PPP) modem connection when an Ethernet  
connection is unavailable.  
See DSR Remote Operations Software on page 334 for information about installing and using the  
DSR Remote Operations software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
20  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
CHAPTER  
DSView 3 Explorer Windows  
3
When a user has been logged in and authenticated, the Avocent DSView 3 Explorer window opens.  
From the DSView 3 Explorer window, you may view, access and manage units.  
1
2
3
4
5
Figure 3.1: Example Avocent DSView 3 Explorer Window Areas  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
22  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 3.1: DSView 3 Explorer Window Area Descriptions  
Number Description  
Top option bar - Use the top option bar to bookmark a DSView 3 software window, refresh a  
1
window display, print a page, log out of a software session or access online help. The name of the  
logged in user appears on the left side of the top option bar.  
Tab bar - Use the tab bar to display and manage units, user accounts, reports, system settings and  
session profiles.  
2
3
4
5
Top navigation bar - The selections in the top navigation bar vary, depending on the active tab in  
the tab bar. Topics relevant to each selection display in the side navigation bar.  
Side navigation bar - Use the side navigation bar to select system information to display or edit in  
the content area. The side navigation bar contains arrows that affect its display.  
Content area - The information specified by the tab bar, top navigation bar and side navigation bar  
selections is displayed and changed in the content area.  
Accessing Target Devices  
Target devices (TDs) that may be accessed system-wide are displayed in a Units View window.  
You may initiate a session with a target device from a Units View window by clicking the link in  
the Action column. See Units View Windows on page 95.  
You may also initiate a session with a target device from a Unit Overview window. See Unit  
For information about controlling the power of target devices attached to power devices, see Power  
Using the Side Navigation Bar  
The side navigation bar is used to display windows that specify settings or perform operations. The  
contents of the side navigation bar varies, depending on the tab and top navigation bar selections  
and the window that is displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: DSView 3 Explorer Windows  
23  
2 1  
3
4
Unit Views  
Target Devices  
Appliances  
All  
ACS48  
DSR1031  
DSR8035  
Recently Accessed  
Active Sessions  
.
.
.
Figure 3.2: Example Side Navigation Bar  
Table 3.2: Side Navigation Bar Descriptions  
Number Arrow  
1
Description  
Expand All Nodes - Click this arrow in the upper right corner to expand all nodes and  
display additional links.  
Collapse All Nodes - Click this arrow in the upper right corner to collapse all nodes  
and their links.  
2
3
Collapse Node - Click this arrow to collapse an opened tree branch and its links.  
Expand Node - Click this arrow to expand a closed tree branch and display its links.  
4
You may choose whether an expanded node will collapse when another Expand Node arrow is  
Clicking on a link that does not contain an arrow will display its corresponding window. Some  
windows contain additional links, which may display another window and a side navigation bar  
with different content.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
24  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Using Windows  
Sorting information in a window  
The order of rows in a list may be changed by clicking the heading of one of the displayed columns.  
When you click a column heading, the order of the list rows will change to alphabetically  
ascending, based on that column. If you click the column heading a second time, the order will  
change to an alphabetically descending order. An up arrow indicates ascending order and a down  
arrow indicates descending order.  
If you are using the topology feature in a Units View window, see Topology view on page 96 for  
sorting criteria.  
Filtering information in a window  
Some DSView 3 software windows allow you to filter list information by providing a text string  
that will be used to retrieve matching items. Filtering is useful if you have many target devices or  
other items that extend over many pages. Windows that allow filtering contain a text field and a  
Filter button in the content area, as shown in Figure 3.1 on page 21.  
Filtering is performed over the entire list of items, not just those displayed in the current window,  
and can provide a shorter, more exact list of items. When filtering is performed, the text in every  
row and column in the window is searched for the specified text string. For example, you may wish  
to perform filtering to list only DSR1031 switches in the Name column, target devices with KVM  
connections in the Action column, ACS console servers that are idle in the Status column and  
so on.  
When the topology feature is enabled in a Units View window, both parent and child units will  
display in the filtered view. For example, if you filter for a child named target device 1 that is  
attached to a DSR1031 switch, target device 1 will appear below the DSR1031 switch in the  
filtered view.  
When filtering, you may use an asterisk (*) before and/or after text strings as a wildcard. For  
example, typing emailserver* and clicking Filter will display items with emailserver at the  
beginning (such as emailserver, emailserverbackup). Typing *emailserver* and clicking Filter will  
display items containing emailserver in any part of the name (such as emailserver,  
emailserverstore, tdemailserver, tdemailserver1).  
Table 3.3 lists the ways you may specify text strings for filtering.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: DSView 3 Explorer Windows  
25  
Table 3.3: Filter Text Strings  
Typed in the Filter Field  
Results  
Entering a string displays a filtered list of items that contain the ‘word’ (that is, it  
will find matching strings that are followed by anything other than a letter or  
number). For example, typing email will list any items that contain the string  
email, followed by a space or punctuation mark.  
<String>  
If you enter multiple words separated by spaces but without logical operators,  
OR is assumed, and each word is treated separately. For example, typing email  
server will display items containing email or server.  
Surrounding the string with quotation marks displays a filtered list of items  
containing the exact string, including spacing and punctuation. For example,  
typing “email server” will display items that contain email server. The DSView  
3 software will provide a closing quotation mark if it is omitted.  
“<String>”  
Using the AND logical operator displays the items that contain both strings. For  
example, typing email and server will display items named email-server-3,  
email-server-2, server email and so on.  
<String1> AND <String2>  
<String1> OR <String2>  
Using the OR logical operator displays the items that contain at least one of the  
strings. For example, typing email or server will find any items that contain the  
string email or the string server.  
Parentheses may be used to override the default (left to right) order of  
precedence during evaluation of a filter string.  
For example, searching for email and server or service would be the  
equivalent of ((email and server) or service), which may not be the intended  
search. The user may choose instead to change the order of precedence by  
grouping the search terms with parentheses, such as (email) and (server  
or service).  
(<String>)  
Preceding the string with NOT displays all items that do not contain the string.  
For example, typing not email will display all items except those containing  
email (email, email server, email-server-1 and so on will not display).  
NOT <String>  
To filter the list in a window:  
1. In a window containing a Filter field, type a text string in the field. Searches are not  
case sensitive.  
2. Click Filter. A filtered list of the information in the window will be displayed.  
3. Click Clear to return to a non-filtered list.  
Saving information in a window  
When you change information in a window, you must click Save in order to apply the changes. By  
default, a message box will appear if you click Close or try to exit the window by clicking a link in  
the top bar, top navigation bar or side navigation bar without first clicking Save.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
26  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Clicking OK in the message box will exit the current window without saving the changes. If you  
want to save the changes you have made, click Cancel in the message box, then click Save in  
the window.  
You may choose whether you will be reminded to save changes made in windows before exiting  
Using the Customize link in windows  
Windows that contain a Customize link allow you to change the following information:  
The number of items displayed per page in the window  
Which columns of information are displayed in Units View windows  
Showing units that have been hidden in Units View windows  
The items available for customizing and methods for changing them will vary, depending on the  
window being customized. Although the items that appear in windows may vary, the items that do  
appear are modified identically regardless of the window in which you clicked the Customize link.  
DSView 3 software administrators may also configure the default display for customizable  
windows, that is, which columns will be displayed and how many items will be displayed per page  
by default. The default values will be used by all new users and by existing users who have not  
already customized their views.  
To customize a window using the Customize link:  
1. In a window containing a Customize link in the upper right corner, click the link. A View  
Customization window will open.  
2. Add, remove or move fields in the window display:  
To add one or more fields to the window display, select the fields in the Available Fields  
list, then click Add. The fields will be moved to the Fields to Show list.  
To remove one or more fields from the window display, select the fields in the Fields to  
Show list, then click Remove. The fields will be moved to the Available Fields list.  
To change the order that fields display from left to right in the window, select one or more  
fields in the Fields to Show list. Use the up or down arrow to change its order in the list.  
3. To specify the number of items that appear in a window, use the arrow keys in the Items per  
Page field to select a number or type a number (1-2000). In Units View windows that have the  
topology view enabled, the number of items per page includes children, even if the display is  
collapsed and the children are not visible.  
4. To show hidden items in a Units View window (see Showing and hiding units on page 98).  
a. Check the Show hidden items checkbox.  
b. Select Visibility from the Available Fields column, and then click Add. Visibility will  
move to the Fields to Show list.  
5. To show group descendants in windows that display unit groups (see Unit group hierarchy on  
page 194), click the Show group descendants checkbox.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: DSView 3 Explorer Windows  
27  
6. To expand a topology view automatically in a Units View window (see Topology view on  
page 96), click the Expand View Automatically checkbox.  
7. To set the Fields to Show and List Items as the default, click Set as Default. This button will  
appear only if you are a DSView 3 software administrator. You will be prompted to confirm  
setting these values as the default. Confirm or cancel.  
8. Click Save and then click Finish. The window being customized will open with the changes.  
Displaying pages  
Multiple page windows contain navigation buttons which may be used to quickly move  
among pages.  
Table 3.4: DSView 3 Explorer Page Navigation Buttons  
Button  
|<  
Description  
First Page - Navigates to the beginning of a list displayed in a window.  
Previous Page - Navigates to the previous page of a list displayed in a window.  
Next Page - Navigates to the next page of a list displayed in a window.  
Last Page - Navigates to the end of a list displayed in a window.  
<<  
>>  
>|  
The page navigation buttons are enabled only if there are enough pages available to make  
them necessary.  
The number of items that display in a window page is specified by using the Customize link (see  
Using the Customize link in windows on page 26). If a page’s content cannot fit vertically and/or  
horizontally in the window, scroll bars will appear. The current page and total number of pages  
appear in the top left corner of the window.  
Many operations allow you to select all items on a page by enabling a checkbox located to the left  
of the column headings in the window. Enabling this checkbox selects all the items listed on a page  
(whether or not the entire page is visible). However, for multi-page displays, items listed on other  
pages will not be included in the selection.  
The only time you can select all items on all pages of a multipage display in one step is when you  
are setting access rights from a Units View windows. For this operation, if you click Rights in a  
Units View window with no units selected, all units on all pages will be affected by the operation.  
Bookmarking a window  
Many windows contain a bookmark icon and text in the top option bar. Bookmarking a window  
will add a link to the window in the Favorites menu. You may select the link at any time to quickly  
access the bookmarked window.  
If you bookmark a window and information related to the window changes, this new information  
will appear in the window when you next display the bookmarked window. For example, if you  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
28  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
bookmark the Recently Accessed window and then access other units, the bookmarked window  
will contain these other units the next time you display the bookmarked page.  
If you click BOOKMARK or the bookmark icon after the DSView 3 server session has timed out,  
the User Login window will open and you must log in again. After you log in, you will be  
redirected to the bookmarked page.  
To bookmark a window:  
1. In the top option bar, click BOOKMARK or the bookmark icon. The Add Favorite dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Optionally, type a name for the window. You may also click Create in to create or specify a  
folder in which to place the window.  
3. Click OK to close the Add Favorite dialog box.  
Printing a window  
All windows contain a print icon and text in the top option bar. When you print a window, all the  
information on the page is printed, not just the visible portion.  
To print a window:  
1. In the top option bar, click PRINT or the print icon. The Print dialog box will appear.  
2. Specify options to use, then click Print to print the window and close the Print dialog box.  
Refreshing a window  
A window may be refreshed at any time by clicking REFRESH or the refresh icon in the top  
option bar.  
By default, status information automatically refreshes every 30 seconds. This interval may be  
changed or disabled. See Changing user options on page 33.  
Using keyboard commands  
In addition to using a mouse, certain keyboard commands may be used to select and change items  
in windows.  
Table 3.5: General Keyboard Commands  
Key  
Description  
Tab  
Transfers focus to the next control in the window, including the calendar  
Transfers focus to the previous HTML control  
Shift-Tab  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 3: DSView 3 Explorer Windows  
29  
Table 3.6 lists the keyboard commands that may be used when a calendar is enabled and has focus.  
Table 3.6: Calendar Keyboard Commands  
Key  
Description  
Enter or Space  
Esc  
Displays or closes the calendar.  
Closes the calendar.  
Page Up  
Page Down  
Decrements the month by one month and selects the first day of the month.  
Increases the month by one month and selects the first day of the month.  
Increments the day by one day. If the last day of the month is selected and the Right  
Arrow key is pressed, the month is incremented to the next month.  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Decrements the day by one day. If the first day of the month is selected and the Left  
Arrow key is pressed, the month is decremented to the previous month.  
Decrements the weekday by one week. If the first weekday type of the month is selected  
and the Up Arrow key is pressed, the month is decremented to the previous month.  
Increments the weekday by one week. If the last weekday type of the month is selected  
and the Down Arrow key is pressed, the month is incremented to the next month.  
Down Arrow  
Table 3.7 lists the keyboard commands that may be used when a spinner is enabled and has focus.  
Table 3.7: Spinner Keyboard Commands  
Key  
Description  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Increments the spinner number by one  
Decrements the spinner number by one  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
30  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31  
CHAPTER  
Basic Operations  
4
This chapter describes basic operations and settings, including global system properties, profiles,  
built-in user groups and preemption levels.  
DSView 3 Help  
NOTE: The DSView 3 Help section only applies to DSView 3 software versions 3.5 or later.  
The DSView 3 help is hosted on the Avocent web site. If you do not have continuous access to the  
Internet, you may wish to install the help on the local DSView 3 server.  
NOTE: Help for DSView 3 software plug-ins is automatically installed on your local server and is not available  
from the Avocent web site.  
Configuring the DSView 3 help location  
DSView 3 administrators can change the DSView 3 help location at any time. Help is configured  
independently for each DSView 3 hub and spoke server.  
To configure the DSView 3 help location:  
1. Click the System tab, then click DSView 3 Server.  
2. Click Properties - Help Configuration in the side navigation bar.  
3. Specify the location of the help that will be accessed each time Help - DSView 3 Management  
Software Help is clicked.  
Select View help from the Avocent web site to access the latest help for your DSView 3  
software version from the Avocent web site (Internet connection required).  
-or-  
Select View help from this DSView 3 server help location to access the downloaded help from  
your local server. Complete the following procedure for Installing DSView 3 help on a local  
server.  
4. Click Save.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
32  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
NOTE: If your DSView 3 software version is several versions prior to the current version, the help may not be  
available on the Avocent web site. In this case, when you access the help from the web, you are prompted to  
save a .zip file of the help to the local device. Complete the Installing DSView 3 help on a local server procedure.  
Installing DSView 3 help on a local server  
You can automatically download the help from the Avocent web site using the DSView 3 software,  
or you can visit www.avocent.com/dsview3help to browse for the appropriate version and save a  
.zip file of the help to local media.  
To download or update DSView 3 help on the local server:  
1. Click the System tab, then click DSView 3 Server.  
2. Click Properties - Help Configuration in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click the Download Latest Help button.  
4. The DSView 3 Help Download Wizard opens. Click Next.  
5. Select From the Avocent web site to download the latest help for your DSView 3 software  
version from the Avocent web site.  
-or-  
Select From a local device to retrieve the help from local media. To specify the location, click  
Browse or type the path in the field.  
6. Click Next.  
7. The Completed Successful window opens. Click Finish.  
NOTE: If you reinstall or upgrade the DSView 3 software, the DSView 3 help location is reset to From the  
Avocent web site. Complete the Installing DSView 3 help on a local server procedure if you want to access the  
help from the local server.  
Global System Properties  
Global system properties affect all DSView 3 servers in the system. That is, when global system  
properties are changed on a DSView 3 server, the next replication operation will apply those  
changes to all other DSView 3 servers in the system; see Replication on page 71.  
Global system properties include:  
Video session properties - see Video Viewer session properties on page 227  
Legal notice - see Legal Notice on page 32  
Legal Notice  
You may enable or disable the display of a legal caption and disclaimer prior to users logging in to  
the DSView 3 software. When enabled, the legal disclaimer is displayed every time a user logs in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
33  
The legal notice feature affects all DSView 3 servers in the system after replication; see Replication  
Only DSView 3 software administrators may configure the legal notice.  
To enable or disable and configure the legal notice:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Legal Notice in the side navigation bar. The DSView 3 System Logon Legal Notice  
window will open.  
4. To enable the legal notice display:  
a. Check the Enable Legal Notice checkbox.  
b. Enter up to 80 characters in the Caption field. This is a required field.  
c. Enter up to 512 characters in the Text field. Carriage returns may be used to separate lines.  
This is a required field.  
d. Click Save.  
5. To disable the legal notice display, uncheck the Enable Legal Notice checkbox and then  
click Save.  
Profiles  
Profile information contains features and tasks that may affect actions when using the DSView 3  
software. These include:  
User options  
Color scheme  
Changing a password  
Choice of serial session application  
Specifying a user certificate  
Specifying a user SSH key  
NOTE: You may also set up KVM session profiles for use with the Video Viewer; see KVM Session Profiles on  
Changing user options  
To change user options:  
1. Click the Profile tab. The Options window will open.  
2. In the Navigation Tree Behavior area, select one option:  
If you select Automatically collapse navigation tree nodes, a currently-expanded tree node  
will be collapsed when you select another tree node.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
34  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If you select Preserve navigation tree state, a currently-expanded tree node will remain  
expanded when you select another tree node.  
If you select Automatically fully expand navigation tree nodes, all tree nodes will be  
expanded. This is equivalent to clicking the Expand All Nodes arrow in the side navigation  
3. Enable or disable prompts when leaving pages with unsaved changes:  
Check Skip prompt when leaving pages with unsaved changes, if you do not want a  
message box to prompt you to save modified information when you leave a window.  
Uncheck Skip prompt when leaving pages with unsaved changes if you want a message  
box to prompt you to save modified information when you leave a window.  
4. Select a refresh rate or Never. By default, windows automatically refresh every 30 seconds. If  
you select Never, windows will only be refreshed when you click the REFRESH icon or text in  
the top option bar.  
5. Enable or disable the display of welcome pages when wizards are launched in the Skip  
Welcome Pages in Wizards checkbox.  
6. Click Save.  
Changing the color scheme  
When the color scheme is changed, it is changed only for the logged in user.  
To change the color scheme:  
1. Click the Profile tab.  
2. Click Preferences in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Color Scheme in the side navigation bar. The Color Scheme window will open.  
4. Click a color scheme to use. If the System Colors scheme is selected, the DSView 3 Explorer  
window will match the user’s desktop color scheme.  
5. Click Save. The color scheme will be applied to the DSView 3 Explorer window.  
Changing your password  
When the DSView 3 software internal authentication service is used, user accounts will indicate if  
users are allowed to change their password; see User account restrictions and expiration settings  
By default, passwords must contain at least three characters and will never expire. A different  
minimum character length and an expiration date may be configured; see DSView 3 software  
To change your password:  
1. Click the Profile tab.  
2. Click Preferences in the top navigation bar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
35  
3. Click Change Password in the side navigation bar. The Change Password window will open.  
4. Type your current password.  
5. Type and confirm the new password.  
6. Click Save.  
Choosing the serial session application  
You may specify the application to be used for serial sessions to target devices.  
DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer (Avocent Session Viewer)  
Win32 PuTTY Telnet/SSH application  
Third party application  
NOTE: If you use a third party Telnet application, the first time you attempt to launch a session, you will be  
prompted to confirm the use of that application. If you do not confirm the use of that application, the session will  
not be launched.  
NOTE: Only the DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer is supported on Macintosh system clients.  
To specify the serial session application:  
1. Click the Profile tab.  
2. Click Applications in the side navigation bar.  
3. Check the checkbox for the application you want to use for serial sessions.  
4. If you check 3rd Party Application, enter the path and executable name of the application  
(maximum 256 characters) in the Serial Application field.  
Specify any of the following parameters (up to 128 characters) in the Command Line  
Arguments field. When the serial session is launched, the actual values will be substituted.  
%ADDRESS% - The IP address will be substituted.  
%PORT% - The port number will be substituted.  
%TNAME% - The target name will be substituted.  
If the third party application does not automatically launch a command window, check the  
Launch in Command Window checkbox.  
5. Click Save.  
Specifying a user certificate  
This property may be changed only for internal authentication users. See DSView 3 software  
A user may specify a certificate if the administrator has allowed it; see the procedure below. If the  
system certificate policy is enabled for user certificates (see System certificate policy and trust  
store on page 44), the user certificate used at login must meet the policy requirements.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
36  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
As an alternative, the administrator may specify the certificate in the user account properties. See  
To enable user settable certificates:  
NOTE: Only DSView 3 software administrators may access this procedure.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click User Credential Properties in the side navigation bar.  
3. Check the Allow user to set own certificate checkbox.  
4. Click Save.  
To specify a user certificate:  
NOTE: A user may access this procedure only if a DSView 3 software administrator has allowed it.  
1. Click the Profile tab. Preferences will automatically be selected in the top navigation bar.  
2. Click Credentials in the side navigation bar, then click Certificate.  
3. Type the path and name of the certificate or browse to the certificate location.  
4. Click Save. An updated Certificate window will open.  
Specifying an SSH key  
A user may specify an SSH key if the administrator has allowed it.  
As an alternative to this method, the administrator may specify the SSH key in the user account  
To enable user settable SSH keys:  
NOTE: Only DSView 3 software administrators may access this procedure.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click User Credential Properties in the side navigation bar.  
3. Check the Allow user to set own SSH key checkbox.  
4. Click Save.  
To specify an SSH key:  
NOTE: A user may access this procedure only if a DSView 3 software administrator has enabled it.  
1. Click the Profile tab. Preferences will automatically be selected in the top navigation bar.  
2. Click Credentials in the side navigation bar, then select SSH Key.  
3. Type the 1-256 character name of the file containing the public SSH key that was generated by  
a third party key generator or browse to the file location.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
37  
4. Click Save. An updated SSH Key window will open. The SSH key file will be uploaded to the  
DSView 3 server for use in authenticating the user.  
Enabling user credential caching  
User credential caching provides a single sign-on method for accessing units supported by certain  
plug-ins. If enabled, the credentials used to log in to the DSView 3 software are maintained in a  
secure internal cache. A supported plug-in, such as the Virtualization plug-in, can retrieve these  
credentials to log in to connected units.  
To enable user credential caching:  
NOTE: Only DSView 3 software administrators may access this procedure.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click User Credential Properties in the side navigation bar.  
3. Check the Enable credential caching checkbox.  
4. Click Save.  
Any currently logged in users must log out and log in again for their credentials to be cached.  
Built-in User Groups  
When a user account is added to the DSView 3 software system, the user may be assigned to any of  
the following built-in user groups:  
DSView 3 software administrators  
Appliance administrators  
User administrators  
Auditors  
Users  
Table 4.1 lists the operations allowed for the built-in user groups.  
Table 4.1: Built-In User Group Allowed Operations  
Built-In User Group  
Operation  
Configure DSView 3 software system-level settings  
Add, change, import and delete DSView 3 software  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
38  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 4.1: Built-In User Group Allowed Operations (Continued)  
Built-In User Group  
Operation  
Backup and restore the DSView 3 software database  
Register a spoke server  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Add, change and delete units  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Add, change and delete unit groups  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Configure access rights  
Add, change and delete sites, departments and locations  
Add, change and delete external authentication services  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Add, change, delete user accounts and user-defined  
user groups  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
All event-related operation  
Change your own password  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
In addition to the built-in user groups, the DSView 3 software supports user-defined user groups;  
Preemption Levels  
The preemption level of users determines whether they may interrupt or disconnect another user’s  
serial or video (KVM) session with a target device. This also applies to virtual media sessions,  
which are initiated from the Video Viewer.  
DSView 3 software administrators and user administrators may specify the preemption level for  
user accounts or user-defined user groups when an account or group is created. The preemption  
By default, the preemption level used by the DSView 3 management software (the effective user  
preemption level) is the highest level of all of the user groups to which the user belongs.  
Preemption levels range from 1-4, with 4 being the highest level. For example, a user or a user  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
39  
group with a preemption level of 4 may preempt other level 4 users or user groups, as well as those  
with a level 1, 2 or 3 setting.  
Table 4.2: User and User Group Preemption Levels  
Preemption Level Description  
The default preemption level for a new local user of a KVM switch or serial  
console appliance.  
4
The default preemption level for the DSView 3 software administrator and appliance  
administrator user groups.  
3
2
1
The default preemption level for the user administrator user group.  
The default preemption level for the users and auditors groups.  
The preemption levels may be used in the following ways:  
User preemption level - This is the preemption level assigned to a user by a DSView 3 software  
administrator or user administrator. If this value is larger than the highest preemption level of  
the user group to which the user belongs, the value will be used as the effective user  
preemption level.  
Group preemption level - This is the preemption level assigned to user groups to which the  
user belongs. If the user is assigned to multiple user groups with different preemption levels,  
this will be the preemption level of the user group with the highest level. For example, if a user  
belongs to the administrators (level 3) and auditors (level 1) user groups, this value will be  
defined as 3. If this value is larger than the highest preemption level of the user, the value will  
be used as the effective user preemption level.  
Effective user preemption level - This is the largest value between the user and group  
preemption level, and is the actual preemption level that will be recognized by the DSView 3  
software when the user attempts to preempt another user’s session. For example, if user  
belongs to the auditors group (level 1) but is assigned a user preemption level of 4, the user  
will have an effective user preemption level of 4. Although a member of the auditors group,  
this user would also be able to preempt the session of a user belonging to the administrators or  
appliance administrators user groups.  
An administrator or user administrator may also specify an OSCAR graphical user interface  
preemption level that is applied to users accessing target devices through the OSCAR interface. See  
Internet Explorer Considerations  
When the Internet Explorer web browser is used, specific settings are required to enable the  
DSView 3 software to operate correctly.  
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) certificates - Used for secure authentication between the DSView  
3 software client and DSView 3 software hub server; see Certificates on page 43.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
40  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
ActiveX controls - Used to display Telnet application, serial and KVM sessions.  
Security Zones - Used to control the actions that may be performed within Internet Explorer.  
For example, the operation of JavaScript, which is used by the DSView 3 software, is  
dependent on security zone settings.  
Advanced Internet options - Used for miscellaneous settings that enhance the use of the  
DSView 3 software.  
Managing ActiveX® controls  
The DSView 3 software uses ActiveX controls to provide interactive content for viewers. (The  
Avocent Telnet Viewer uses Java; see Java Installation on page 18 for information.)  
The functionality of the ActiveX controls is determined by the settings for the security zone being  
used by the DSView 3 software. See Security zones on page 41.  
Administrators may prevent users from installing software on their computers. In this case, the  
Windows domain administrators may choose to “push” an MSI installer using a Group Policy. This  
will silently install the Avocent Session Viewers without requiring the user to install the software  
themselves. This will install only the viewers for Internet Explorer. The MSI file is located on the  
DSView 3 software DVD and in the webapp/applets directory on the DSView 3 server.  
Use the following procedures if you are permitted to install software.  
To download an ActiveX control on a DSView 3 software hub server using Windows  
(all operating systems except Windows XP with Service Pack 2):  
1. In a Units View window that contains target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the link in the Action field or select an alternate action, if available.  
You can also access a Unit Overview window for a target device and click the icon or link for  
the session type.  
If this is the first time the ActiveX control has been requested by the DSView 3 software, an  
Avocent Session Viewer message box will appear, followed by a Security Warning dialog box.  
2. Select Always trust content from Avocent Huntsville Corporation.  
3. Click Yes to download the ActiveX control. When the control has been downloaded, a KVM  
session will start in a Video Viewer window or a serial session will start in a Telnet Viewer  
window, depending on the supported action for the managed appliance.  
If the required ActiveX control could not be loaded, a red X will appear in the Avocent Session  
Viewer message box. The ActiveX control may fail to load for one of the following reasons:  
The user did not select Always trust content from Avocent Huntsville Corporation.  
The DSView 3 software client security zone settings are not correct.  
The ActiveX control failed to properly install.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
41  
To download an ActiveX control on a DSView 3 software hub server using Windows  
XP with Service Pack 2:  
1. In a Units View window that contains target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the link in the Action field or select an alternate action, if available.  
You can also access a Unit Overview window for a target device and click the icon or link for  
If this is the first time the ActiveX control has been requested by the DSView 3 software, an  
Avocent Session Viewer message box will appear.  
2. Click in the top yellow bar. A pop-up menu will appear. Click Install. A Security Warning  
dialog box will appear.  
3. Click Install to install the ActiveX control.  
Security zones  
Internet Explorer restricts actions performed by the web browser, based on the security zone  
membership of the web site being accessed. Each security zone typically has its own security  
restrictions. The following four security zones are available in Internet Explorer:  
Trusted Sites - Web sites contained in the list of trusted sites.  
Restricted Sites - Web sites contained in the list of restricted sites.  
Local Intranet - Web sites accessed using a host name (for example, https://sun-e2-callisto).  
Internet - All other web sites, including those accessed using standard dot notation (for  
example, https://10.0.0.1).  
By default, the DSView 3 software operates correctly in the Internet, Local Intranet and Trusted  
Sites security zones when accessing a hub server.  
NOTE: A DSView 3 software hub server installed on a PC running the Windows 2003 Server will not operate  
correctly in the Internet security zone.  
The current security zone appears in the lower right corner of the DSView 3 Explorer window.  
To ensure that the DSView 3 software works correctly in security zones:  
Specify settings for the Local Intranet and Internet security zones. When a DSView 3 software  
client accesses a hub server using a host name (for example, https://avocent), the Local Intranet  
security zone will be used. When a client accesses a hub server using a web address with periods  
(for example, https://www.avocent.com), the Internet security zone will be used.  
-or-  
Add the DSView 3 software hub server to the Trusted Sites list. The DSView 3 software client will  
always connect to the hub server using the Trusted Sites security zone. The Trusted Sites zone  
contains very low security settings and ensures successful communication between the client and  
the hub server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To display or change the restrictions of a security zone:  
1. In Internet Explorer, select Tools - Internet Options. The Internet Options dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Click the Security tab.  
3. Select the security zone you wish to view.  
4. Click Custom Level. The Security Settings dialog box will appear.  
5. Ensure that the following security settings are set to Enabled or Prompt. The Active Scripting  
setting should be set to Enabled.  
Download Signed ActiveX Controls  
Run ActiveX Controls and Plug-Ins  
Launching Programs and Files in an IFRAME  
Active Scripting  
6. Click OK to save the settings and close the Security Settings dialog box.  
7. Click OK to close the Internet Options dialog box.  
To add a hub server to the Trusted Sites list:  
NOTE: If Trusted Sites security zone settings have been modified from their defaults, ensure that the correct  
settings required for the DSView 3 software are specified, as indicated above.  
1. In Internet Explorer, select Tools - Internet Options. The Internet Options dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Click the Security tab.  
3. Click Trusted Sites, then click Sites. The Trusted Sites dialog box will appear.  
4. Type the web site address, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), for the DSView 3  
software hub server (for example, https://10.0.0.1).  
5. Click Add. The web site address will appear in the web sites list box.  
6. Ensure that Require server verification (https:) for all sites in this zone is selected.  
7. Click OK to save the settings and close the Trusted Sites dialog box.  
8. Click OK to close the Internet Options dialog box.  
Advanced Internet options  
Internet Explorer contains advanced settings that may be specified to enhance use of the DSView 3  
software. Changing these settings is not required, but is recommended for optimum results.  
To specify advanced Internet options for the DSView 3 software:  
1. In Internet Explorer, select Tools - Internet Options. The Internet Options dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Click the Advanced tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
43  
3. Select the following settings:  
Always send URLs as UTF-8  
Disable script debugging  
Play animations in web pages  
Show pictures  
Print background colors and images  
Use SSL 2.0  
Use SSL 3.0  
4. Select Enable Integrated Windows Authentication if the DSView 3 software is using Integrated  
Windows Authentication. See Integrated Windows Authentication on page 46.  
5. Uncheck the following settings:  
Always expand ALT text for images  
Display a notification about every script error  
6. Click OK to save the settings and close the dialog box.  
Certificates  
The DSView 3 software system uses certificates to provide secure transactions between  
components and to uniquely identify components in the system.  
System certificate  
The DSView 3 software system generates and manages a system certificate. The system certificate  
may be exported to a local directory - the certificate’s public key may then be used to validate the  
To view or export the system certificate:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. In the side navigation bar, click X.509 Certificates, and then click System Certificate. The  
System Certificate window will open.  
4. To export the system certificate in PEM format to a local directory, click Export Certificate. A  
pop-up window will open. The content of this window is browser-dependent, but it will usually  
prompt you to confirm the export operation. Confirm or cancel.  
Server certificates  
A DSView 3 server certificate:  
Uniquely identifies the DSView 3 server to DSView 3 software clients connecting to the server  
using web browsers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
44  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Uniquely identifies the DSView 3 server to other DSView 3 servers in the system and provides  
for secure transactions between them  
Provides for secure transactions between DSView 3 software clients and the DSView 3  
software server  
A Security Alert dialog box may appear if there are server certificate issues. See Server certificates  
on page 57 for information about certificate alerts and updating server certificates.  
Client certificates  
DSView 3 software client certificates (also known as user certificates) are used to authenticate  
client users during login when the DSView 3 software internal authentication service is configured  
in their user accounts. See Adding User Accounts on page 203.  
To use DSView 3 software client certificates for authentication, a DSView 3 software administrator  
must first enable certificate authentication; see Client session information on page 62. Once this is  
enabled, the DSView 3 server will prompt the client web browser to send its user certificates.  
The DSView 3 software client certificate must first be loaded into the client web browser and be  
associated with a user account. There are two ways to do this:  
The certificate location can be specified in a user account - see User certificates on page 207  
The DSView 3 software administrator may enable user-settable certificates, then the user may  
specify the certificate location - see Specifying a user certificate on page 35  
If the system certificate policy (see below) is enabled for user certificates, the certificate used at  
login must meet the policy requirements.  
Managed appliance certificates  
Certificates are also used for authenticating and authorizing managed appliance sessions when a  
managed appliance is added in secure mode. See Adding Units on page 107.  
System certificate policy and trust store  
DSView 3 software administrators may configure the certificate policy by enabling/disabling  
settings. The trust store contains a list of all trusted certificate authorities known to the DSView 3  
software. You may add, remove or modify the location of trust store entries.  
To configure certificate policy settings:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click X.509 Certificates in the side navigation bar. The System Certificate Policy window  
will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
45  
4. Enable/disable checkboxes or select values as indicated for each setting.  
Table 4.3: System Certificate Policy  
Feature  
Value when enabled  
Chain Building  
Permits the DSView 3 software to use the AIA certificate extension to  
locate a certificate’s issuer.  
Authority Info Access (AIA)  
Maximum allowable number of certificates (inclusive) between the leaf  
certificate and a trusted certificate. Valid range is 1-16.  
Max chain length  
Chain Validation  
Partial chains  
Allows partial chains. (If disabled, partial chains will be considered  
invalid, even if the chain contains a trusted certificate.)  
A certificate may be used only for the reasons dictated in the  
certificate. For example, a certificate must be flagged as CA  
(Certificate Authority) to be considered a valid certificate issuer.  
Usage flags  
The current date and time on the server must be within the window on  
each certificate in the chain.  
Validity period  
Verify signatures  
The signatures within the certificate chain are checked for validity.  
Certificate Revocation Lists (CRL)  
If CRLs are available, they are checked to determine a certificate’s  
revocation status.  
CRL checks  
Distribution points  
CRLs may be located using the distribution point certificate extension.  
The DSView 3 software will reject a certificate chain if a CRL is  
specified (either in the certificate or the DSView 3 trust store) and it  
cannot be read or is invalid.  
Reject on error  
Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)  
Name verification  
Outbound SSL connections will verify server names.  
The server names may match the certificate common name or one of  
the subject alternative names.  
Subject alternative names  
User Certificates  
User certificates presented to the DSView 3 software are verified using  
the System Trust Store.  
Verify using trust store  
5. Click Save.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
46  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To display and manage the trust store:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. In the side navigation bar, click X.509 Certificates, and then click Trust Store. The System  
Trust Store window will open, listing all trusted certificate authorities known to the DSView 3  
software. By default, the list contains the standard CAs from Java.  
4. To view or change information about a certificate, click on its name. The System Trust Store  
Entry window will open. You may change the CRL Location, which indicates where the CRL  
should be obtained for that CA. If you change the location, click Save. Then click Close.  
5. To delete one or more certificates:  
a. Click the checkbox to the left of the certificate name. To delete all certificates on the page,  
click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
b. Click Delete.  
c. You are prompted to confirm the deletion. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
6. To add a certificate:  
a. Click Add. The New System Trust Store Entry window will open.  
b. In the Certificate File field, enter the name of the file containing the X.509 certificate to  
upload into the trust store. The file may be binary or Base64 encoded.  
c. In the CRL Location field, you may enter the location of the CRL for the uploaded  
certificate (maximum 256 characters). The supported protocols are http://and ldap://.  
d. Click Add.  
Integrated Windows Authentication  
The DSView 3 management software allows DSView 3 software clients to authenticate against  
Microsoft Windows NT domain and Microsoft Active Directory external authentication servers  
using Integrated Windows Authentication. This feature allows Single Sign-On (SSO) and is  
disabled by default.  
NOTE: Integrated Windows Authentication cannot be used if the DSView 3 server name contains periods (.).  
To use Integrated Windows Authentication for authentication, a DSView 3 software administrator  
Firewalls  
In a typical network configuration, as shown in Figure 4.1, the DSView 3 software client is located  
outside of the firewall and the DSView 3 server and managed appliances reside inside the firewall.  
In this case, the firewall must be configured to allow two TCP/IP ports inside the firewall.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
47  
One TCP port (default=443) is used for the HTTPS web browser connection between the DSView  
3 software client and the DSView 3 server. The other TCP port (default=1078) is used for the  
Avocent Proxy Protocol to tunnel video and Telnet traffic. Both ports are configurable.  
If you are using the DSView 3 management software through a firewall, we recommend  
the following:  
Place the DSView 3 server and all managed appliances within the same firewall Demilitarized  
Zone (DMZ). If the managed appliances are not in the same DMZ with the DSView 3 server,  
you must configure the firewall so all data may pass between the zones using TCP/IP ports 22  
(SSH), 3211, 2068, 8192 and 3871. You must also configure the User Datagram Protocol  
(UDP) port 3211 so it may pass through the firewall for initial network discovery of appliances  
that do not have an IP address.  
5
2
3
6
4
1
7
8
Figure 4.1: Typical DSView 3 Software System Firewall Configuration  
Table 4.4: Typical DSView 3 Software System Firewall Configuration Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
DSView 3 Software Client  
HTTPS  
Number  
Description  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
DSView 3 Server  
Proxy  
Proxy  
KVM Switch or Serial Console Appliance  
Target Devices  
Firewall  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
48  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
VPNs  
A Virtual Private Network (VPN) is a secure network that uses public infrastructure and typically  
includes several Wide Area Network (WAN) components that may impact performance of  
the VPN.  
Typically, two sites are connected in a VPN network using WANs and a router. This setup provides  
a secure network between the two sites, but processing is slow.  
Several factors related to the network setup, including the DSView 3 software database replication  
schedule and methods of device access, can affect the speed of a multi-site VPN network. The  
trade-off must be made based on the network setup.  
Frequent replication of the DSView 3 software database will increase WAN/VPN traffic but  
provide steady data reception at the local sites. Infrequent database replication made at the various  
sites decreases the WAN/VPN traffic but delays the reception of changes at the local site.  
In addition, the methods used to access devices affects network speed. VPN access of a managed  
appliance is always slower than local access.  
The DSView 3 management software supports VPNs that provide full transparency for IP  
addresses, as well as ports between sites and many VPNs that perform network address translation  
(NAT) between sites. For example, the VPN in Figure 4.2 could use NAT if Site A and Site B are  
separate companies that merged but have not resolved their IP addresses. See NAT Devices on  
5
6
2
9
1
7
3
10  
8
4
11  
Figure 4.2: DSView 3 Software System on a VPN  
Table 4.5: DSView 3 Software System on a VPN Descriptions  
Number  
1
Description  
Number  
7
Description  
DSView 3 Software Client  
Replication  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
49  
Table 4.5: DSView 3 Software System on a VPN Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
Firewall  
Number  
Description  
2
3
4
5
6
8
VPN  
Site A  
9
DSView 3 Software Client  
Site B  
Target Devices  
Hub Server  
Spoke Server  
10  
11  
Target Devices  
NAT Devices  
NAT devices enable a company to use more internal IP addresses than they have assigned to  
managed appliances. The IP addresses are not exposed outside of the NAT device.  
NAT devices are typically used with a DSL broadband router. A DSView 3 software client is  
connected to the NAT device, as shown in Figure 1.6, which then connects to the corporate  
network using a VPN.  
8
2
5
6
7
9
1
3
10  
11  
4
Figure 4.3: Single NAT Configuration (Client Only)  
Table 4.6: Single NAT Configuration (Client Only) Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
Number  
Description  
Firewall  
1
2
3
4
5
6
DSView 3 Software Client  
7
Private  
NAT Device  
Client  
8
Private  
9
DSView 3 Server  
Managed Appliance  
Corporate  
10  
11  
Public  
VPN  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
50  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Another scenario, shown in Figure 4.4 on page 50, is when the corporate site also uses a NAT  
device to save IP addresses (double-NAT). Since the DSView 3 software client is trying to access a  
private resource inside the corporate site, the TCP/IP ports used for HTTPS and the proxy server  
must be configured to be exposed on the corporate NAT device.  
7
2
8
5
6
9
1
3
10  
11  
4
Figure 4.4: Double-NAT Configuration (Client and Corporate)  
Table 4.7: Double-NAT Configuration (Client and Corporate) Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
Number  
Description  
NAT Device  
Private  
1
2
3
4
5
6
DSView 3 Software Client  
7
Private  
NAT Device  
Client  
8
9
DSView 3 Software Server  
Managed Appliance  
Corporate  
10  
11  
Public  
VPN  
NOTE: NAT devices may not be connected between the DSView 3 server and any managed appliances.  
Licenses  
License keys permit the operation of the DSView 3 management software on the hub server. They  
also specify the number of:  
clients that may use the software  
spoke servers allowed on a system  
third party power devices that may be added  
plug-in license IDs  
data logging sessions that can be enabled concurrently  
NetClarity Auditor appliances that can be managed  
virtual machines that can be managed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
51  
A demonstration (demo) license key may also be used for a trial period. When the trial elapses,  
login attempts will fail. A demo license key may be replaced with another demo license key or a  
permanent license. If additional license keys are added during the trial and the demo key expires,  
the add-on keys will have to be re-entered when a new license key is installed.  
Contact Avocent for information about obtaining licenses.  
To display license information:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Licenses in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Summary in the side navigation bar. The License Summary window will open. Table 4.8  
describes the window fields.  
Table 4.8: License Summary Fields  
Section  
Field  
Description  
Installation Key or  
Demo Install Key  
Serial number encoded in the license key for the DSView 3  
software hub.  
Serial Number  
Total number of licenses for concurrent DSView 3 software  
sessions. Unlimited indicates there are no restrictions on the  
number of concurrent DSView 3 software sessions.  
Licensed  
Number of licenses for DSView 3 client sessions currently in use.  
This value is incremented each time someone logs into the  
DSView 3 software; it is decremented when someone logs out or  
their session times out.  
If a user opens any number of SSH Passthrough sessions, an  
additional client session license is used and value is incremented.  
Once the user closes all SSH Passthrough sessions, the license is  
freed and value is decremented.  
Client Sessions  
Currently in Use  
Total number of licenses for backup (spoke) DSView 3  
software servers.  
Licensed  
Backup Servers  
Currently in Use Number of licenses for backup DSView 3 servers currently in use.  
Total number of licenses for third party power devices. Unlimited  
Licensed  
indicates there are no restrictions on the number of power devices  
that can be added.  
Third Party Power  
Devices  
Currently In Use Number of licenses for third party power devices currently in use.  
Licensed Total number of license IDs for plug-ins.  
Currently In Use Number of license IDs for plug-ins currently in use.  
Plug-ins  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
52  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 4.8: License Summary Fields (Continued)  
Section  
Field  
Description  
Total number of data logging sessions that can be enabled  
simultaneously. Unlimited indicates there are no restrictions on the  
number of data logging sessions that can be enabled.  
Licensed  
Data Logging Sessions  
Currently in Use Number of data logging sessions currently enabled.  
Total number of Auditor appliances licensed to be added as  
managed appliances.  
Licensed  
Auditor Appliances  
Currently in Use Number of Auditor appliance licenses currently enabled.  
Total number of virtual machines licensed to be added as  
target devices.  
Licensed  
Number of licensed virtual machines currently added in the  
DSView 3 software.  
Virtualization  
Currently in Use NOTE: You can also manage virtualization licenses from the  
License Manager window. See the DSView 3 Software Plug-in for  
Virtualization help for more information.  
To display license keys:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Licenses in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click License Keys in the side navigation bar. The License Keys window will open and list  
each installed license key and a description of the key. One of the following descriptions will  
display beside each key:  
Adds <number> Backup Server(s) - Adds <N> backup (spoke) DSView 3  
software servers.  
Adds <number> Backup Server(s) and Unlimited Client Sessions - Combines the keys for  
Adds <N> Backup Server(s) and Client Session Site License.  
Adds <number> Client Session(s) - Adds <N> concurrent DSView 3 software client  
sessions across all DSView 3 servers.  
Client Session Site License - Increases the number of concurrent DSView 3 software  
client sessions to unlimited.  
Installation Key - Enables first use of the DSView 3 software and sets the initial number of  
backup DSView 3 servers and concurrent DSView 3 software clients.  
Demo License Key - Enables first use of the DSView 3 software for a certain period  
of time.  
Third Party Power Devices Site License - Increases the number of third party power  
devices that can be added to unlimited.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4: Basic Operations  
53  
Add <number> Third Party Power Devices - Increases the number of third party  
power devices.  
Plug-in Id <number> License Key - Enables use of a plug-in for a specific appliance type.  
Adds <N> Data Logging Sessions - Adds <N> concurrent data logging sessions to  
be enabled.  
Data Logging Session Site License - Increases the number of concurrent data logging  
sessions that may be enabled to unlimited.  
To add a new license key:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Licenses in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click License Keys in the side navigation bar. The License Keys window will open.  
4. Click Add. The Add License Key window will open.  
5. If you did not receive a license key, click the http://www.avocent.com/activation link to obtain  
a license key.  
6. Type a valid new add-on license key in the License Key field. (License keys from a DSView  
software release prior to version 3.0 are not valid.)  
7. Click Save. The License Keys window opens, containing a new row with the new license key.  
ISV Partners  
The Avocent Independent Software Vendors (ISV) partners program supports configuring and  
launching a browser from within the DSView 3 software to the console of the Ipswitch  
WhatsUp Professional.  
Only members of the DSView 3 administrators user group may configure ISV partner URLs.  
See the Avocent web site for more information about the ISV partners program.  
To add or change the partner URLs:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Partners in the top navigation bar.  
3. If partner URLs have not already been configured, click Properties in the side navigation bar.  
4. The Partner Properties window will open. Enter the URLs for launching a browser to the  
partner product. Separate multiple URLs with a line break. The maximum length in each field  
is 512 characters.  
5. Click Save. A button icon and link will appear for each configured URL on the Partner  
Tools page.  
To launch a browser session to a partner URL:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Partners in the top navigation bar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
54  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. The Partner Tools window will open. (This window exists only if at least one URL has been  
defined in the Partner Properties window.)  
4. Click on the button or link to launch the browser window to the specified URL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
CHAPTER  
DSView 3 Servers  
5
This chapter describes how to configure DSView 3 server properties, backup and restore hub  
servers and manage spoke servers.  
Server Properties  
Table 5.1 lists the DSView 3 server properties.  
Table 5.1: Server Properties  
Property  
Description  
Identity  
Name of the DSView 3 server and the server’s role (hub or spoke).  
IP address (*) and port used by clients to access the server using the HTTPS (SSL)  
protocol. You may change the port number used for the HTTPS connection.  
NOTE: When the DSView 3 server is running on a Linux system, the IP address field may  
contain the loopback address. If this is not desired, edit the /etc/hosts file on the Linux  
system. Add a new line above the line that defines the loopback address. The new line  
should contain the IP address, followed by the host name. For example, the following new  
line adds the IP address 172.30.20.206 for the host name sun-jcv-fc3.avocent.com, above  
the existing line that defines the loopback address (127.0.0.1).  
Network  
172.30.20.206  
127.0.0.1  
sun-jcv-fc3.avocent.com  
localhost.localdomain sun-jcv-fc3.avocent.com localhost sun-jcv-fc3  
Certificate  
DSView 3 server certificate presented to DSView 3 software client web browsers.  
When the Avocent proxy server is used, DSView 3 software client KVM and serial session  
requests are sent through the DSView 3 server rather than directly to the KVM switch or  
serial console appliance, which prevents the exposure of the internal address of the  
managed appliance. You may change the proxy server configuration.  
Proxy Server  
SSH Server  
NOTE: EVR1500 environmental monitor, DSI5100 IPMI and generic appliance sessions  
are not sent through the DSView 3 server, even when the proxy is enabled.  
Enables/disables the SSH server and specifies the port it uses.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
56  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 5.1: Server Properties (Continued)  
Property  
Description  
The DSView 3 server polls KVM switches or serial console appliances to determine if they  
are responding. If the managed appliance does not respond, the DSView 3 server sends an  
SNMP Loss Of Communication (LCM) trap or alert to the external SNMP manager. When  
the DSView 3 server detects that the appliance is once again communicating, a Regained  
Communication (RCM) trap is sent from the DSView 3 software server.  
When a response change occurs during communication between the DSView 3 server and  
a managed appliance, the DSView 3 software writes the event to the event log and sends  
an SNMP trap to the configured trap destinations.  
Trap  
Destinations  
Trap destinations may also be specified by clicking on a managed appliance and changing  
the SNMP appliance settings.  
DSView Client  
Sessions  
Settings for inactivity time-out, Single Sign-On (SSO) for the session or restrictions to use  
specific IP addresses to start the sessions.  
DSView Modem Settings for dial-up sessions, including inactivity time-out, time to wait for a connection and  
Session  
dial-back number.  
IP address of the SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol) server that is used by the DSView  
3 software to send email notifications.  
Email  
Enables/disables unit status polling for the DSView 3 server, and specifies the delay  
between polling cycles and the number of managed appliances that will be  
concurrently polled.  
Unit Status  
Polling  
Spoke Servers  
Data Logging  
Enables you to manage the DSView 3 software spoke servers in your system.  
Settings for data log file location, archiving and Syslog server.  
To display server properties:  
Click the System tab. DSView Server will automatically be selected in the top navigation bar and  
Identity will automatically be selected in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Identity  
Properties window will open. The top of the side navigation bar will indicate the name of the  
DSView 3 software server.  
To change server network properties:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Network in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Network Properties window  
will open.  
3. Type a new DSView 3 server port number in the HTTPS Port field.  
If the default value (443) is modified, the port number in the URL must be specified when  
accessing the DSView 3 software. For example, if the IP address of the hub server is 10.0.0.1  
and the port number is changed to 444, https://10.0.0.1:444/dsview must be typed in the  
Address field of the web browser to access the DSView 3 software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
57  
The selected port must be available on the DSView 3 server. If DSView 3 software clients are  
located on an external connection, the specified port must be open on the firewall.  
4. Click Save. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
A web browser error message will appear when Save is clicked. This error message is a normal  
occurrence. To reestablish connection to the DSView 3 software, you must reconnect to the  
hub server by typing the URL with the new port number. For example, if you changed the port  
number to 334 for a hub server with an IP address of 10.0.0.1, type https://10.0.0.1:334/  
dsview to access the DSView 3 management software.  
5. Confirm or cancel the change.  
Server certificates  
DSView 3 software administrators manage server certificates. See Certificates on page 43 for a  
description of certificate types and procedures to manage certificate policy and the system trust  
store.  
Security alerts  
The DSView 3 software uses SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) to securely communicate between the  
DSView 3 software hub server and DSView 3 software clients. SSL provides secure authentication  
using certificates, which is data that identifies the PC with which communication will occur. A  
certificate is typically verified by another certificate from a trusted certificate authority.  
When the DSView 3 software is initially installed, it generates a self-signed certificate for use with  
DSView 3 software clients. To replace this, a DSView 3 software administrator may create a  
Certificate Signing Request (CSR) to submit to a trusted third party Certificate Authority (CA) for  
signature. The administrator may then replace the generated certificate with the new one. If the  
generated certificate is not replaced, the web browser will prompt a user whether to trust the  
generated certificate when a DSView 3 software client session is started.  
Three tests are performed on a certificate each time a DSView 3 software client connects to the  
DSView 3 software hub server:  
Does the client web browser trust the certificate issuer?  
Has the certificate expired?  
Does the name on the DSView 3 server certificate match the name the DSView 3 software  
client used to access the DSView 3 server?  
A Security Alert dialog box will appear if the answer to any of the three questions is No. To prevent  
the Security Alert message box from appearing when you connect to a the DSView 3 software hub  
server, all three questions must be answered Yes. When a Security Alert dialog box appears, you  
have the following choices:  
If you click Yes, a connection will be made with the DSView 3 software hub server and the  
DSView 3 software login window will appear, but the Security Alert dialog box will continue  
to appear each time you connect to the hub server.  
If you click No, a connection will not be made with the DSView 3 software hub server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
58  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If you click View Certificate, you may install the certificate; see below.  
To correct certificate security alerts for client and hub server connections:  
1. From the DSView 3 software client, open a client session; see Opening a client session on  
page 16. The Security Alert dialog box will appear.  
2. Click View Certificate. The Certificate dialog box will appear.  
3. Click Install Certificate. See the Internet Explorer documentation for more information.  
4. Once the certificate is installed, ensure that the time setting on the DSView 3 software client  
PC is within the Valid from...to... dates and that the Issued to and Issued by fields  
exactly match.  
Invalid to...from dates typically occur when the DSView 3 software is installed on a server that  
is set to an invalid time. When a DSView 3 software client that is set to a valid time connects to  
the DSView 3 server that is set to an invalid time, the following warning will appear in the  
Security Alert dialog box: “The security certificate date is invalid.”  
Serial session security alerts  
The Serial Session Viewer, which is used during a serial session, is a Java-based applet. Three  
certificate tests are performed by Java when the DSView 3 software connects to a serial device:  
Does the serial device trust the certificate issuer?  
Has the certificate expired?  
Does the name on the serial device certificate match the name of the DSView 3 software hub  
server certificate?  
A warning dialog box will appear if the answer to all three questions is No. To prevent this warning  
dialog box from appearing when you connect to a serial device, all three questions must be  
answered Yes.  
To correct certificate security alerts when connecting to a serial session:  
1. In a Units View window that contains serial console appliance target devices (see Accessing  
Units View windows on page 98), click the Serial Session link in the Action field.  
You can also access a Unit Overview window for a target device and click the Serial Session  
icon or link for the session type (see Unit Overview Windows on page 104).  
2. If the certificate is trusted and has not expired, but there is a mismatch of the name on the  
DSView 3 software client certificate and the name on the DSView 3 software hub server  
certificate, a Warning - HTTPS dialog box will appear. Contact the issuer of your certificate.  
3. When a Warning - Security dialog box appears, you have the following choices:  
If you click Yes, a connection will be made with the appliance and the viewer will open,  
but the warning dialog box will continue to appear each time you connect to the serial  
console appliance.  
If you click No, a connection will not be made with the serial console appliance.  
If you click Always, the certificate will be added to the Java certificate store.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
59  
To create a CSR:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Certificate in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Certificate Properties window  
will open.  
3. Click Get CSR. A File Download dialog box will appear.  
4. Click Open. The CSR is downloaded and displays in the configured text editor.  
-or-  
Click Save. The Save As dialog box will appear. Select a directory and filename and click Save  
to save the CSR.  
5. Submit the CSR generated request to a CA to obtain a signed server certificate.  
6. Update the DSView 3 server to use the certificate created by the CA.  
To update certificate information on the DSView 3 server:  
NOTE: You may also update a spoke server certificate on a hub server and update a hub server certificate on a  
spoke server; see Managing hub and spoke server certificates on page 60.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Certificate in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Certificate Properties window  
will appear.  
3. Click Update. The Update DSView Server Certificate Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Operation to Perform window will open.  
Select Create a new self-signed SSL server certificate to create a minimal security SSL  
certificate without incurring the costs and overhead involved with a Certificate Authority  
(CA). Click Next, then go to step 5.  
Select Import a signed SSL server certificate to import a more secure SSL certificate that  
has been approved (perhaps by a CA). The public key of the imported certificate must  
match the public key in the certificate that the DSView 3 server is currently using. This  
requires that both certificates be made on the same DSView 3 server. Click Next, then go  
to step 6.  
5. The Type in Certificate Information window will open.  
a. Type the name of the computer that will serve as the DSView 3 server on your intranet in  
the Common Name field. If the DSView 3 server is outside the intranet, type the server’s  
full domain name in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
b. Type the name of the organization (or country).  
c. Type the name of the organizational division or name under which the organization is  
doing business.  
d. Type the complete city or location name. The City or Location field is required for  
organizations registered only at the local level.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
60  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
e. Type the complete name of the state or province where the organization is located.  
f. Type the two-character ISO country code for the country where the organization  
is located.  
g. Click Next. Go to step 7.  
6. The Select Certificate to Import window will open.  
a. Type the full directory and filename for the SSL certificate file you wish to import to the  
DSView 3 server or browse to the file location.  
The name of the SSL certificate file must be entered in case sensitive text if your operating  
system supports case sensitive filenames.  
Imported certificates must have been generated from a CSR created on the same DSView  
3 server to which you are importing the certificate.  
b. Click Next.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open.  
8. Click Finish. The DSView Server Certificate Properties window will open, containing updated  
certificate information.  
Managing hub and spoke server certificates  
When a spoke server is registered with a hub server, a certificate trust relationship is established  
between the two servers. Certificate information must match on the hub server and the spoke  
servers for communication to take place between the servers. If the spoke server certificate is  
subsequently changed, a certificate mismatch will occur.  
To update the certificate of a spoke server on the hub server:  
NOTE: Certificates may only be viewed by DSView 3 software administrators and user administrators.  
1. On the hub server, click the System tab. DSView Server will automatically be selected in the top  
navigation bar and the name of the DSView 3 software hub server will appear at the top of the  
side navigation bar.  
2. Click Spoke Servers in the side navigation bar. The Spoke Servers window will open.  
3. In the Spoke Servers window, click Certificate. The Spoke Server Certificate window will  
open including information about the spoke server certificate (Actual Certificate) and the  
certificate registered for this spoke server on the hub server (Registered Certificate).  
4. The window displays the certificate on the spoke server and the certificate registered on the  
hub server.  
If the DSView 3 management software cannot obtain the certificate information from the  
spoke server, a message will appear at the bottom of the DSView Server Certificate - Spoke  
Server window. The message states: Remote server is not responding. Information displayed  
may not match remote side.  
If the certificate information does not match, go to step 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
61  
If the certificate information matches, go to step 6.  
5. Click Update. The spoke server certificate information will be updated on the hub server.  
6. Click Close. The Spoke Servers window will open.  
To update the certificate of a hub server on a spoke server:  
1. On the spoke server, click the System tab. DSView Server will automatically be selected in the  
top navigation bar and the name of the spoke server will appear at the top of the side  
navigation bar.  
2. Click Hub Server in the side navigation bar. The Hub Server window will open.  
3. In the Hub Server window, click Certificate. The Hub Server Certificate window will open  
including information about the spoke server certificate (Actual Certificate) and the certificate  
registered for this spoke server on the hub server (Registered Certificate).  
If the DSView 3 software cannot obtain the certificate information from the hub server, a  
message will appear at the bottom of the DSView Server Certificate - Hub Server window. The  
message states: Remote server is not responding. Information displayed may not match  
remote side.  
If the certificate information does not match, go to step 4.  
4. Click Update. The hub server certificate information will be updated on the spoke server.  
Proxy servers  
Proxy servers are valid on supported KVM switches or serial console appliances.  
To specify a proxy server:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Proxy Server in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Proxy Properties window  
will open.  
a. Type a new port number to use for DSView 3 software client communication with the  
Avocent proxy to the logged in DSView 3 server.  
If DSView 3 software clients are located on an external connection, the specified TCP/IP  
proxy port must be opened on your firewall.  
b. Select the type of Proxy Invocation:  
Click Disable the proxy server to allow all internal and external DSView 3 software  
clients to communicate directly with the managed appliances. (This is the default.)  
Click Use the proxy server for all KVM, serial and virtual media sessions to enable all  
DSView 3 clients to communicate with the managed appliances using the DSView 3  
software proxy server.  
Click Use the proxy server only for clients not on the same network as this DSView  
Server to enable all external and internal clients on a different network than the  
current DSView 3 server to communicate with the managed appliances using the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
62  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
DSView 3 proxy server. All other external and internal clients will communicate  
directly with the managed appliances.  
Click Use the proxy server only for clients connecting with the following addresses to  
enable only DSView 3 software clients with IP addresses entered in the Address List  
to communicate with the managed appliances using the DSView 3 proxy server. All  
other clients communicate directly with the managed appliances.  
NOTE: Changing the Proxy Port or Proxy Invocation setting will disconnect active DSView 3 software  
client sessions.  
3. Click Save. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
4. Confirm or cancel the action.  
Server trap destinations  
To specify trap destinations:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Trap Destinations in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Trap Destinations  
window will open.  
3. In each address field, type the IP addresses in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or the  
domain name for the computer that handles traps. Up to four computers may be specified.  
4. Click Save to store the trap information in the DSView 3 software database on the host.  
Client session information  
To specify client session information:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Client Sessions in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Client Session  
Properties window will open.  
a. Use the arrows to specify a time-out value (from 5-60 minutes) for inactivity of a DSView  
3 user client session. The default is 15 minutes. When the time-out value has been  
exceeded, the session will end and the user must log in again.  
b. Check the Enable certificate authentication checkbox to allow the DSView 3 software to  
automatically log in internal users if the user certificate (X.509 digital ID) installed in the  
DSView 3 software client web browser matches the certificate configured for the user.  
Certificates for users may be modified. See User certificates on page 207.  
Web browser settings may need to be modified to allow users to automatically log in using  
certificates; see your web browser documentation.  
-or-  
®
Check the Enable Integrated Windows Authentication checkbox to automatically log a  
user into the DSView 3 software using the user’s NT domain or Active Directory  
credentials and Integrated Windows Authentication.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
63  
Web browser settings may need to be modified to allow users to automatically log in using  
Integrated Windows Authentication; see your web browser documentation.  
c. To enable only DSView 3 software clients with IP addresses entered in the Address List to  
communicate with managed appliances, check the Restrict by address range checkbox. To  
disable address restrictions for logging into the DSView 3 software, uncheck  
this checkbox.  
3. Click Save to store client session information in the DSView 3 software database on the host.  
DSView 3 software modem sessions  
For more information about modem sessions, see Active modem sessions on page 161.  
NOTE: Modem sessions are available on supported ACS console servers.  
To specify modem session properties:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Modem Sessions in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Modem Session  
Properties window will open.  
3. Specify the following Session Timeout properties:  
a. Inactive dial-up session timeout - in the drop-down menu, specify the number of seconds  
in the range of 60-3600 after which the session will be terminated. The default value is  
120 seconds.  
b. Dial-up connection attempt timeout - in the drop-down menu, specify the number of  
seconds in the range of 60-600 after which the attempt will be terminated. The default  
value is 120 seconds.  
c. Dial-back connection attempt timeout - in the drop-down menu, specify the number of  
seconds in the range of 60-600 after which the modem will be removed from listening  
mode. The default value is 120 seconds.  
4. Specify the following Dial Up settings:  
a. In the Server Prefix field, type the dial-up prefix for the DSView 3 server to obtain an  
outside line. This prefix will be added to the unit phone number.  
b. Enter the IP address range to be used in dial-up connections in the From address and To  
address fields.  
5. Specify the following Dial Back Settings:  
a. In the Analog phone number field, type the analog phone number for the appliance to  
dial-back to the DSView 3 server. This number will be stored in the DSView 3 software  
database and automatically updated on the ACS console server.  
b. In the Analog on hook time field, specify the on hook interval in the range of 0-25  
seconds. The default value is 4 seconds. The on hook interval is the amount of time after  
the initial dial-up connection is dropped before the modems on the DSView 3 server will  
receive incoming calls.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
64  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
c. Use the ISDN controller map field to define the map of Multiple Subscriber Numbers  
(MSNs) to ISDN channels. Enter the controller map definition for each port sequentially  
on a separate row in the text field. Use the following format:  
<port number>:<MSN1>,<MSN2>  
For example, if an Eicon card has one port, and MSN 21 is assigned to ISDN channel 1 on  
port 1, and MSN 22 is assigned to ISDN channel 2 on port 1, the text in the ISDN  
controller map field would be:  
1:21,22  
A controller map definition must be provided for each ISDN dial-back phone number.  
d. In the ISDN phone number field, enter the Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)  
phone number for the appliance to dial-back to the DSView 3 server. You may enter  
multiple dial-back phone numbers each separated by a comma. The number(s) will be  
stored in the DSView 3 software database and automatically updated on the ACS  
console server.  
e. In the ISDN on hook time field, specify the on hook interval in the range of 2-10 seconds.  
The default value is 2 seconds. The on hook interval is the amount of time after the initial  
dial-up connection is dropped before the modems on the DSView 3 server will receive  
incoming calls.  
NOTE: If your DSView 3 server is on Windows, the ACS console server username and password must be  
configured as a user in Windows before a dial-back connection can be established.  
6. Click Save.  
Email  
To specify email properties:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Email in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Email Server Properties window  
will open.  
3. Type a new address for the SMTP server that sends email notifications as a domain name or an  
IP address in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
4. If your SMTP server requires login credentials, select Login required to access SMTP server  
and type a username and password, then confirm the password.  
5. Click Save to store DSView 3 software email property information in the DSView 3 software  
database on the host.  
Unit status polling  
To use unit status polling:  
1. Click the System tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
65  
2. Click Unit Status Polling in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Unit Status Polling  
Properties window will open.  
3. Select Enable unit status polling.  
4. Type the number of seconds to wait between polling cycles (from 30-999 seconds). The default  
is 900 seconds (15 minutes). A smaller value results in greater accuracy.  
5. Type the number of managed appliances that may simultaneously be polled to obtain status  
information (from 1-25 units). The default is 5. A larger number results in faster speed.  
6. Click Save to store unit status information in the DSView 3 software database on the host.  
Backing up and Restoring Hub Servers Manually  
NOTE: You may only restore a DSView 3 software hub server with a backup archive made using an identical  
DSView 3 software version. For example, you may not restore a hub server running DSView 3 software version  
3.2 using a backup archive made with DSView 3 software version 3.1.  
You may manually create a backup of your hub server. Two methods are available:  
From a command line in an MS-DOS window. This method may be used for DSView 3  
software hub servers on supported Windows or Linux systems.  
Using the Backup and Restore Utility delivered with the DSView 3 software. The backup is  
saved as a .zip file containing the files needed to restore the DSView 3 management software.  
This method may be used for DSView 3 software hub servers on supported Windows  
systems only.  
Client sessions will be temporarily disconnected during a manual backup. The sessions will be  
automatically reconnected when the backup is completed.  
Hub server backups may also be automatically created as a task within the DSView 3 software. If  
you use the Backup DSView database and system files task, client sessions will not be temporarily  
Manual backup and restore procedures require DSView 3 software administrator privileges.  
To manually backup or restore a hub server using a command line on a supported  
Windows system:  
1. In the Start menu on your desktop, select Start - Programs - Accessories - Command Prompt.  
A command prompt window will open.  
2. Change directories to the directory in which the DSView 3 software is installed (typically  
C:\Program Files\Avocent DSView 3\bin).  
3. Enter DSViewBackupRestore to display the DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box.  
Follow the directions in To manually back up a hub server using the Backup and Restore  
Utility dialog box to back up the hub server using the dialog box or To manually restore a hub  
server using the Backup and Restore Utility dialog box to restore the hub server using the  
dialog box. (These procedures are described later in this section.)  
-or-  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
66  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To backup the DSView 3 software hub server, enter DSViewBackupRestore -backup  
-archive “<archive name>” -passwd <password>.  
-or-  
To restore the DSView 3 software hub server, enter DSViewBackupRestore -restore -archive  
“<archive name>” -passwd <password>.  
“<archive name>” - Name of the archive, which must be enclosed by quotation marks (for  
example, “myarchive”). The -archive option and an archive name are required.  
<password> - A password that encrypts the archive. The password is optional when  
creating a backup. If a password is specified when creating the backup, it will be required  
when restoring the backup.  
To display help information, type DSViewBackupRestore -h or  
DSViewBackupRestore -help.  
For example, entering the following in a command prompt window will create a backup named  
db.zip with the password test.  
DSViewBackupRestore.exe -backup -archive “db.zip” -passwd test  
Entering the following in a command prompt window will restore a backup named db.zip with the  
password test.  
DSViewBackupRestore.exe -restore -archive “db.zip” -passwd test  
To manually backup or restore a hub server using a command line on a supported  
Linux or Solaris system:  
1. Access the command prompt on your system.  
2. Change directories to the directory where the DSView 3 software is installed, which is  
typically /usr/local/dsviewserver/bin.  
3. To backup the DSView 3 software hub server, enter DSViewBackupRestore.sh -backup  
-archive <archive name> -passwd <password> -overwrite.  
4. To restore the DSView 3 software hub server, enter DSViewBackupRestore.sh -restore  
-archive <archive name> -passwd <password>.  
<archive name> - Name of the archive. The -archive option and an archive name  
are required.  
<password> - A password that encrypts the archive. The password is optional when  
creating a backup. If a password is specified when creating the backup, it will be required  
when restoring the backup.  
-overwrite - Enables overwriting of an existing archive during backup. If this parameter is  
omitted, no overwriting will occur.  
To display help information, type DSViewBackupRestore.sh -help.  
For example, entering the following in a command prompt window will create a backup named  
dbasebackup.zip with the password test1.  
DSViewBackupRestore.sh backup -archive dbasebackup.zip -passwd test1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
67  
Entering the following in a command prompt window will restore a backup named  
dbasebackup.zip with the password test1.  
DSViewBackupRestore.sh restore -archive dbasebackup.zip -passwd test1  
To manually back up a hub server using the Backup and Restore Utility dialog box  
on a supported Windows system:  
1. In the Start menu on your desktop, select Start - Programs - Avocent DSView 3 - Backup and  
Restore Utility. The DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box will appear.  
2. Click Backup Database to a file.  
3. To password-protect the backup file, click Enabled and type a password in the Password field.  
4. Click Browse and use the Save As dialog box to specify a directory and name for the backup  
file. Click Save when you are finished.  
5. Click Backup. The DSView 3 software system backup files are saved.  
6. Click Close to close the DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box.  
To manually restore a hub server using the Backup and Restore Utility on a  
supported Windows system:  
1. In the Start menu on your desktop, select Start - Programs - Avocent DSView 3 - Backup and  
Restore Utility. The DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box will appear.  
2. From the DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box, click Restore the database from a file.  
3. If the backup file is password-protected, click Enabled and type its password in the  
Password field.  
4. Click Browse and use the Save As dialog box to find the backup file.  
5. Click Restore. The DSView 3 software system is restored from the backup files.  
6. Click Close to close the DSView 3 Backup/Restore Utility dialog box.  
Spoke Servers  
Information on the hub server is replicated on one or more spoke servers. Information about each  
spoke server, such as IP address, port number and certificate, is stored in the hub server’s database.  
You may specify up to 15 computers as spoke servers. Contact Avocent for information about  
spoke server licenses. To install licenses, see Licenses on page 50.  
NOTE: The DSView 3 management software versions of the spoke server and hub server must match in order to  
register a spoke server. For example, you may not register a spoke server running DSView 3 software version  
3.1 with a hub server running DSView 3 software version 3.2.  
A spoke server may be created by:  
Specifying a spoke server when installing the DSView 3 software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
68  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Converting a hub server to a spoke server by registering it as a spoke to another DSView 3  
software hub server. The DSView 3 software system data on the hub server being converted  
will be lost and the converted hub server will replicate the data of the new specified hub server.  
You may also change the properties of a spoke server or remove spoke servers from your system.  
To display a list of spoke servers:  
NOTE: The Spoke Servers window is only available on the hub server.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar. The side navigation bar will include the name  
of the server to which you are logged in.  
3. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, and then click Spoke Servers. The Spoke Servers  
window will open.  
You may change the fields that display by using the Customize link. See Using the Customize  
Each spoke server in the list includes status.  
Table 5.2: DSView 3 Software Spoke Server Status  
Status  
Cause  
Normal operation. The hub and spoke servers are communicating with each other  
using HTTPS.  
Responding  
The hub and spoke servers cannot communicate with each other using HTTPS. This  
typically indicates a network communication error. Ensure that network connectivity is  
occurring between the two servers.  
Not responding  
Hub/Spoke Versions  
Not Compatible  
The versions of DSView 3 software on the hub and spoke servers are not compatible.  
Certificates on the hub server and spoke servers do not match. See Managing hub and  
spoke server certificates on page 60 for information about updating the server  
certificates so that they will match.  
Certificates Do Not  
Match  
A server responded, but it is not compatible with the DSView 3 software. This typically  
occurs when communication is attempted with a server that does not contain the  
software, or if either server contains an older version of the software. Ensure that both  
servers are running the same DSView 3 software version.  
Invalid Server or  
Versions Not  
Compatible  
To add a spoke server:  
1. Install the DSView 3 software on the computer that will be used as a spoke server. See  
2. Configure the computer as a spoke server. See Configuring the DSView 3 Software on page 13.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
69  
To register a hub server as a spoke server:  
Only DSView 3 software administrators may access this procedure.  
NOTE: When registering a hub server as a spoke server on another DSView 3 software system, the information  
on the hub server being registered will be lost. Its database will be updated to match the new hub server to which  
it is being registered.  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar. The side navigation bar will include the name  
of the server to which you are logged in.  
3. Select Tools in the side navigation bar. The DSView Server Tools window will open.  
4. Click the Register as Spoke Server icon or text. The Register Spoke Server Wizard will appear.  
Click Next.  
5. The Type in Hub DSView Server Address window will open.  
a. Type the IP address of the hub server in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or the  
domain name of the hub server.  
b. Type the port number for the hub server.  
If the default hub server port value (443) is modified, you must specify it when registering  
a spoke server so that register requests will be sent to the correct port on the hub server.  
For example, if the IP address of the hub server is 10.0.0.1 and the port number is changed  
to 444, type https://10.0.0.1:444/dsview in the Address field of the Register Spoke  
Server Wizard.  
c. Click Next.  
6. The Operation in Progress window will open briefly, followed by the Accept Hub DSView  
Server Certificate window. Click Next.  
7. The Type in Hub DSView Server Administrator Credentials window will open. Click Next.  
8. Type the name of a user with DSView 3 software administrator privileges on the hub server.  
Type a password for the user. Click Next.  
9. The Operation In Progress window will open. The configuration of the spoke server will be  
saved to the database of the hub server and the spoke server’s certificates will be installed on  
the hub server.  
10. The Completed Successful window will open when the spoke server has been added.  
11. Click Finish.  
To change spoke server network properties:  
NOTE: Spoke server network settings may need to be changed by DSView 3 software administrators when  
network settings are changed and the the hub server did not automatically detect the changes. When changing  
the network settings, ensure that a port mismatch does not occur between the hub server and the spoke server.  
1. On the hub server, click the System tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
70  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar. The side navigation bar will include the name  
of the server to which you are logged in.  
3. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, and then click Spoke Servers. The Spoke Servers  
window will open.  
4. Click on the name of the spoke server whose network properties you wish to change. The  
Spoke Server Network Properties window will open.  
5. Change any of the following network settings:  
Type a new computer name to use as the spoke server.  
Type a new address in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) for the spoke server.  
Type a new port number for the spoke server.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Spoke Servers window will open.  
To delete a spoke server:  
1. On the hub server, click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar. The side navigation bar will include the name  
of the server to which you are logged in.  
3. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, and then click Spoke Servers. The Spoke Servers  
window will open.  
4. Click the checkbox to the left of the spoke servers you wish to delete. To delete all spoke  
servers, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
5. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
6. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
NOTE: When a spoke server is deleted, it is no longer allowed to communicate with the hub server. Only spoke  
servers that are no longer active should be deleted. If a spoke server is still active, it may be re-registered using  
the Register Spoke Server wizard.  
Promoting spoke servers  
Promoting a spoke server to be a hub server is usually done only if the current hub server is no  
longer operational and will not be brought back into service. (For less severe problems with a hub  
server, the backup and restore operations can be used.)  
If a spoke server must be promoted, be sure to run the replication task, if possible (see Replication  
on page 71) on all other spoke servers, then on the spoke server being promoted, immediately  
before the promotion. This will prevent loss of data from the other spoke servers.  
(After the promotion of a spoke server to a hub, if the server that was originally the hub becomes  
operational again, it will have to register as a spoke server, since a system can have only one  
hub server.)  
To promote a spoke server to be a hub server:  
1. On the spoke server, click the System tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: DSView 3 Servers  
71  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click Promote to hub server. The Promote Hub Server Wizard will appear.  
4. Follow the prompts and heed the cautionary warnings in the wizard. The spoke server on  
which the wizard is running will become the hub server, and the other spoke servers will be  
advised of the changed configuration.  
Replication  
Replication is a task that synchronizes the hub and spoke server databases. By default, replication  
runs every 12 hours on each spoke server. A spoke server’s first replication occurs automatically  
when the spoke server is added to the DSView 3 software system. You may change the interval that  
the replication task runs on each spoke server, or you may initiate an immediate replication.  
During replication, the spoke server sends all of its database changes since the last replication to the  
hub server. The hub server then incorporates those changes and sends all of its database changes  
since the last replication to the spoke server (excluding the changes that spoke server just sent to the  
hub server).  
If an item is added on a spoke server, and another item with the same name (but perhaps with  
different configuration parameters) is added on the hub server, then after replication, both items  
will appear on both the hub and spoke servers, with a tilde (~) and a number added to one of the  
names. The administrator should handle the issue appropriately - in some cases, the duplicate item  
may need to be renamed; in others, the duplicate item should be deleted.  
When different changes are made to one existing item, two outcomes are possible. For example,  
assume an item is added and configured on the hub server and is then replicated to the spoke server.  
Later, an administrator changes something about the item on the spoke server. Another  
administrator then changes something about the item on the hub server. When the replication task  
runs, two things may happen.  
In a few instances where no conflict occurs, both changes will be incorporated and replicated. For  
example, if the hub server’s administrator adds username JaneDoe to the existing user-defined user  
group Accounting and the spoke server’s administrator adds username JohnDoe to the Accounting  
user group, both names will be added and replicated.  
In most other instances where the changes are mutually exclusive or some other conflict occurs, the  
most recent change will be the only change accepted and replicated. For example, if the hub  
server’s administrator associates a unit with the Miami site, and the spoke server’s administrator  
associates the same unit with the Chicago site, the change that was made closest to the time of  
replication (that is, the most recent change) will be accepted and replicated.  
This emphasizes the importance of ensuring the hub and spoke servers’ clocks are synchronized.  
The exception to the last-change rule is when one of the actions deletes an item - in that case, the  
deletion is accepted and replicated, regardless of timing. For example, if a unit was deleted on the  
hub server, and then the contact information for the same unit was changed on the spoke server a  
minute later, the unit will be deleted when the replication task is run.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
72  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
On a spoke server, you may enable a replication task property that forces the spoke server to  
retrieve a snapshot of the hub database rather than synchronizing changes back and forth. The  
snapshot is a copy of the hub at the time of the operation. This feature is not normally used; it is  
intended to help recover a system when replication has failed.  
To display replication results and/or change the replication schedule for a  
spoke server:  
1. On the spoke server, click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Select the Database Replication task. The Task Results - Database Replication window will  
open. This window contains the results of the most recent replication.  
4. To display or change the replication schedule, click Schedule in the side navigation bar. The  
Task Schedule - Database Replication window will open.  
By default, the replication task runs every 12 hours. You may change the schedule type, start  
time, date and interval.  
5. To force the spoke server to retrieve a snapshot of the hub database rather than synchronizing  
changes, click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click the Perform a hub database  
snapshot the next time this task executes checkbox. This setting will be reset to unchecked after  
the operation completes.  
6. If you made any changes, click Save and then Close.  
You may also display the replication schedule from the hub server, but you cannot change it.  
To initiate an immediate replication on a spoke server:  
1. On the spoke server, click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Check the checkbox to the left of the Database Replication task and then click Run Now.  
To display the replication schedule for a spoke server from the hub server:  
1. On the hub server, click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar.  
3. Select the Database Replication task for the spoke server you wish to view. The Task Schedule  
- Database Replication window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
73  
CHAPTER  
Authentication Services  
6
Users must be authenticated before they may access or perform any tasks in the DSView 3  
management software system.  
When users log in, they will be prompted for a username and password. The DSView 3 software  
will look up the login, determine the authentication service to use and forward the login credentials  
to the appropriate authentication service for verification. All authentication is performed over an  
HTTPS (SSL) encrypted link.  
Some web browsers may store password information; see your web browser documentation.  
Supported Authentication Services  
The DSView 3 software is delivered with the DSView internal authentication service, which  
verifies a log in and password against user account information stored in the database on the  
DSView 3 software server.  
The DSView 3 software also supports the following external authentication services:  
®
Microsoft Active Directory *  
®
®
IBM SecureWay Directory Server *  
®
Novell LDAP Services *  
Sun Solaris R9 LDAP Directory Server *  
Sun ONE™ LDAP Directory Server *  
Microsoft Windows NT domain  
®
Cisco Secure ACS 3.3 for Windows 2000/2003 server  
Microsoft IAS for Windows 2000/2003 server  
FreeRADIUS for Red Hat RHL3  
Cisco Secure ACS 3.3 for Windows 2000/2003 server  
®
RSA SecurID  
* Uses LDAP V3  
If the DSView 3 server is configured for external authentication, login requests are re-directed to  
the configured external authentication server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
74  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The DSView 3 software obtains external group membership and external user information when a  
user logs in. If a user’s group membership changes or the user is deleted externally, the DSView 3  
software will not see these changes until the next time the user logs in.  
You may schedule a task that will automatically verify LDAP, Active Directory and NT external  
authentication servers to ensure that accounts are still valid; see Task: Validating user accounts on  
Authentication services may be managed only by DSView 3 software administrators and  
user administrators.  
To display configured authentication services:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
The User Authentication Services window may be customized by using the Customize link. See  
To remove authentication services:  
NOTE: The internal authentication service cannot be removed.  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Check the checkbox to the left of the authentication service(s) to delete. To delete all external  
authentication services on the page, check the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of  
the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
DSView 3 software internal authentication service  
To change the DSView 3 internal authentication service account policies:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click DSView Internal. The side navigation bar will change to include DSView Internal at the  
top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Account Policies. The Authentication Service User Account Policies - DSView Internal  
window will open.  
5. Specify the password policies for the authentication service:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
75  
a. Type a number (from 1-64) in the Minimum Password Length field, or click the arrows to  
select a number.  
b. Check the Passwords Expire checkbox to require a user to change the password after a  
certain number of days. Specify a number (from 1-365) in the Maximum Expiration (days)  
field, or select a number.  
c. Select Passwords must contain both alpha and numeric characters if new passwords must  
contain at least one letter and one number.  
d. Select Passwords must contain both lower and upper case characters if new passwords  
must contain at least one uppercase and one lowercase letter.  
6. Specify the lockout policy for the authentication service:  
To assign a specific number of user login attempts, check the Lockout users after invalid login  
attempts checkbox, then continue with step a.  
If you leave this checkbox unchecked, unlimited user login attempts will be allowed. Skip to  
the last step.  
a. Type the number of allowable user login failures (from 1-25) in the Maximum Login  
Failures field, or select it from the menu.  
b. To permit user logins after a certain period of time, check the Automatically unlock users  
after the lockout period checkbox. Specify the lockout period (in minutes) by typing a  
number from 1-1,440 in the Maximum Lockout Period (minutes) field, or choose a value  
from the menu (1,440 minutes is equivalent to 24 hours).  
If you leave this checkbox unchecked, locked user accounts must be manually unlocked  
by a DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services window will open.  
To change custom field labels for user accounts that use internal authentication:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click DSView Internal. The side navigation bar will change to include DSView Internal at the  
top and, below the name, information you may define.  
4. Click Custom Field Labels in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service User  
Account Custom Field Labels - DSView Internal window will open.  
5. Type the text that you wish to appear in each of the six custom field labels.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services window will open.  
By default, the custom field labels do not display in the User Accounts - All window, but they may  
be added to the display (or added to the default display by an administrator), using the Customize  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
76  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Active directory external authentication service  
To add an Active Directory external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. Type a name for the external authentication service.  
b. Select Active Directory from the menu.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Specify Active Directory Connection Settings window will open.  
a. Type the Active Directory domain name for the domain you wish to add in the AD  
Domain Name field.  
b. In the User Container field, specify the name of the container to search for user accounts.  
This will limit the search scope to that container. The name may be entered in several  
forms, optionally including a sub-domain. Valid forms are explained below by example.  
Assume an Active Directory domain name of “sunrise.mycompany.com” with users in  
subfolder “sun/myusers.” The User Container field may be entered as:  
Example 1 (no sub-domain): “sun.myusers”  
Example 2 (no sub-domain): “ou=myusers,ou=sun”  
If users are contained in a sub-domain such as “mktg.sunrise.mycompany.com”, valid  
forms are:  
Example 1 (with sub-domain): “mktg.sunrise.mycompany.com/sun/myusers”  
Example 2 (with sub-domain and no container specified):  
“mktg.sunrise.mycompany.com/”  
Example 3 (with sub-domain):  
“ou=myusers,ou=sun,dc=mktg,dc=sunrise,dc=mycompany,dc=com”  
c. In the Group Container field, specify the name of the container to search for user groups.  
This will limit the search scope to that container. The name may be entered in several  
forms, optionally including a sub-domain. Valid forms are explained in step 5b above.  
d. In the Username Type menu, select the type of username. Each choice in the menu  
contains an example.  
A Full Windows 2000 username is specified as username@domain.  
A Partial Windows 2000 username is specified as username.  
A Full Pre-Windows 2000 username is specified as domain\username.  
A Partial Pre-Windows 2000 username is specified as username.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
77  
This option may only be configured for new authentication servers; it cannot be modified.  
Existing authentication servers are set to the Partial Windows 2000 Username type  
for compatibility.  
e. Specify a Secure Socket Layer (SSL) encryption mode:  
Click Do Not Use SSL to have authentication performed using unencrypted clear text  
instead of SSL encryption. This method is the least secure.  
Click Use SSL in Trust All Mode to use SSL encryption for data transmission. All  
server certificates will be trusted and automatically accepted by the DSView 3  
software for transmitting data. This SSL method provides medium security.  
This encryption mode is not recommended for wide area networks (WANs).  
Click Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode to use SSL encryption for data  
transmission. The DSView 3 management software will approve the server and then  
the certificate before transmitting data. This SSL method provides maximum security.  
f. Click Use Kerberos for User Authentication to use the Kerberos protocol for  
authentication requests, including the browsing. If enabled, you must use DES encryption  
types for this account. If an account was created prior to Active Directory, the user’s  
password must be changed after this setting is changed. In addition, the Active Directory  
server addresses must be resolvable to their host names via DNS.  
When this is not checked, the LDAP protocol will be used.  
g. Click Enable Chasing of Referrals to allow the Active Directory server to refer DSView 3  
software clients to additional directory servers.  
h. Click Use an Active Directory Global Catalog to have the AD service access the global  
catalog for the specified domain name.  
i. Click Next.  
If you selected Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode, go to step 6.  
If you selected Do Not Use SSL or Use SSL in Trust All Mode, go to step 8.  
6. The DSView 3 server will try to find a server that has a trusted certificate chain (see System  
certificate policy and trust store on page 44). If no trusted certificate chain is found, then the  
Accept Certificate window will open and list all servers that belong to the domain. It will also  
list the reasons for rejection of the certificate chain.  
7. Click Next to accept the certificate.  
8. The Select Browsing Method window will open.  
Click Browse Anonymously to browse users on the external Active Directory  
authentication server.  
-or-  
Click Browse with user credentials to browse users on the external Active Directory  
authentication based on credentials configured on the server. If this option is selected, do  
the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
78  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
a. Type the username for an Active Directory account that has browse rights in the User  
Name field. The login ID must be entered in case sensitive text if the Active Directory  
server is set up to use Kerberos. When using Kerberos, the browse account cannot be  
specified in the Full Pre-Windows 2000 Username form (domain\username). If the  
username is in a sub-domain of the Active Directory domain (specified in step 3a), then  
the username should be specified as <username>@<subdomain>.  
b. Type the password for an Active Directory account that has browse rights in the  
Password field.  
c. Click Next.  
9. The Establish Connection with Authentication Service window will open briefly. If the  
external authentication service is added successfully, the Completed Successful window  
will open.  
10. Click Finish. The User Authentication Services window will open with the new service listed.  
To change settings for the Active Directory external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the Active Directory (AD) service. The side navigation bar will change to  
include the name of the AD service at the top and, below the name, the information you may  
define.  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings -  
AD window will open.  
5. Type a name in the Service Name field to change the name of the service that appears in the  
Name column of the User Authentication Services window.  
6. Type the domain name of the Active Directory service in the AD Domain Name field.  
7. In the User Container field, specify the name of the container to search for user accounts. This  
will limit the search scope to that container. The name may be entered in several forms,  
optionally including a sub-domain. See To add an Active Directory external authentication  
service: on page 76 for an explanation of the valid forms.  
8. In the Group Container field, specify the name of the container to search for user groups. This  
will limit the search scope to that container. The name may be entered in several forms,  
optionally including a sub-domain. See To add an Active Directory external authentication  
service: on page 76 for an explanation of the valid forms.  
9. Specify a Secure Socket Layer (SSL) Encryption mode:  
Click Do Not Use SSL to have authentication performed using unencrypted clear text  
instead of SSL encryption. This method is the least secure.  
Click Use SSL in Trust All Mode to use SSL encryption for data transmission. All server  
certificates will be trusted and automatically accepted by the DSView 3 software for  
transmitting data. This SSL method provides medium security.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
79  
This encryption mode is not recommended for wide area networks (WANs).  
Click Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode to use SSL encryption for data  
transmission. The DSView 3 software will approve the server and then the certificate  
before transmitting data. This SSL method provides maximum security.  
10. Click Use an Active Directory Global Catalog to have the AD service access the global catalog  
for the specified domain name.  
11. Click Use Kerberos for User Authentication to use the Kerberos protocol for authentication  
requests, including the browsing. If enabled, you must use DES encryption types for this  
account. If an account was created prior to Active Directory, the user’s password must be  
changed after this setting is changed. In addition, the Active Directory server addresses must  
be resolvable to their host names via DNS.  
When this is not checked, the LDAP protocol will be used.  
12. Click Save to save your changes.  
If you selected Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode, the Certificates heading will  
appear in the side navigation bar. Go to step 13.  
If you selected Do Not Use SSL or Use SSL in Trust All Mode, go to step 16.  
13. Click Certificates. The Authentication Service Certificate Management - AD window opens  
and list all servers in that domain. A status of Trusted indicates the certificate is trusted, based  
on the certificate policy (see System certificate policy and trust store on page 44); Untrusted  
indicates the certificate cannot be trusted.  
14. To register certificates:  
a. To select one or more certificates, click the checkbox to the left of the server IP addresses.  
To select all certificates on the page, click the checkbox to the left of the IP  
Address heading.  
b. Click Register above the IP Address list to register the certificates. The Accept SSL  
Certificate window will open.  
c. Click Save to store the certificate values to the DSView 3 software database on the host or  
click Close if you do not wish to save the certificate values.  
The Authentication Service Certificate Management window will open if only one  
certificate was selected. If more than one certificate was selected, each will appear in  
order in subsequent Accept SSL Certificate windows.  
15. To unregister certificates:  
a. To select one or more certificates, click the checkbox to the left of the server IP addresses.  
To unregister all certificates, click the checkbox to the left of the IP Address heading.  
b. Click Unregister to unregister the certificates.  
c. A confirmation message box will appear. Confirm or cancel the operation.  
16. Click Close. The User Authentication Services window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
80  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To change user browsing settings for the Active Directory external authentication  
service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the AD service. The side navigation bar will change to include the name of  
the AD service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. From the side navigation bar, click User Browsing. The Authentication Service User Browsing  
- AD window will open.  
5. Click Browse Anonymously to browse users on the external Active Directory  
authentication server.  
-or-  
Click Browse with User Credentials to browse users on the external Active Directory  
authentication based on credentials configured on the server. If this option is selected, do  
the following:  
a. Type the username for an Active Directory account that has browse rights in the User  
Name field. The log in ID must be entered in case sensitive text if the Active Directory  
server is set up to use Kerberos.  
b. Type the password for an Active Directory account that has browse rights in the  
Password field.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
Windows NT external authentication service  
To add a Windows NT external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. Type a name for the external authentication service.  
b. Select Windows NT Domain from the menu.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Specify Windows NT Connection Settings window will open. Type the Windows NT  
domain name you wish to add in the Domain Name field, and then click Next.  
6. The Select Browsing Method window will open.  
Click Browse Anonymously to browse users on the external Windows NT  
authentication server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
81  
-or-  
Click Browse with user credentials to browse users on the external Windows NT  
authentication based on credentials configured on the server. If this option is selected, do  
the following:  
a. Type the username for a Windows NT account that has browse rights in the User  
Name field.  
b. Type the password for a Windows NT account that has browse rights in the  
Password field.  
c. Click Next.  
7. The Establish Connection with Authentication Service window will briefly appear. If the  
external authentication service is added successfully, the Completed Successful window  
will open.  
8. Click Finish. The User Authentication Services window will open with the new service listed.  
To change connection settings for the Windows NT external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the Windows NT service. The side navigation bar will change to include the  
name of the service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings -  
NT window will open.  
5. Type a name in the Service Name field to change the name of the service that appears in the  
Name column of the User Authentication Services window.  
6. Type the name of the Windows NT domain in the Domain Name field.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services window will open.  
To change user browsing settings for Windows NT external  
authentication services:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the Windows NT service. The side navigation bar will change to include the  
name of the Windows NT service at the top and, below the name, the information you  
may define.  
4. Click User Browsing in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service User Browsing -  
NT window will open.  
5. Click Browse Anonymously to anonymously browse users on the external Windows NT  
authentication server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
82  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
-or-  
Click Browse with User Credentials to browse users on the external Windows NT  
authentication based on credentials configured. If this option is selected, do the following:  
a. Type the username for an NT domain account that has browse rights in the User  
Name field.  
b. Type the password for an NT domain account that has browse rights in the Password field.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
LDAP external authentication service  
To add an LDAP external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. Type a name for the external authentication service.  
b. Select LDAP from the Type menu.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Specify LDAP Connection Settings window will open.  
a. Type the address of the LDAP host in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or type the  
DNS host name in the Host Address field.  
b. Type the number of the port for connecting to the LDAP host in the Port Number field.  
c. Specify an SSL encryption mode:  
Click Do Not Use SSL to have authentication performed using unencrypted clear text  
instead of SSL encryption. This method is the least secure and automatically sets the  
Port Number field to a default port number of 389.  
Click Use SSL in Trust All Mode to use SSL encryption for data transmission. All  
server certificates will be trusted and automatically accepted by the DSView 3  
software for transmitting data. This SSL method provides medium security and  
automatically sets the Port Number field to a default port number of 636.  
This encryption mode is not recommended for wide area networks (WANs).  
Click Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode to use SSL encryption for data  
transmission. The DSView 3 software will approve the server and then the certificate  
before transmitting data. This SSL method provides maximum security and  
automatically sets the Port Number field to a default port number of 636.  
d. Click Enable Chasing of Referrals if you wish to allow the LDAP server to refer DSView  
3 software clients to additional directory servers.  
e. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
83  
If you selected Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode, go to step 6.  
If you selected Do Not Use SSL or Use SSL in Trust All Mode, go to step 10.  
6. The DSView 3 server will try to find a server that has a trusted certificate chain (see System  
certificate policy and trust store on page 44). If no trusted certificate chain is found, then the  
Accept Certificate window will open and list all servers that belong to the domain. It will also  
list the reasons for rejection of the certificate chain.  
7. Click Next to accept the certificate.  
8. The Specify LDAP User Schema window will open.  
a. Type the Base distinguished name (DN) from which to begin searches. This is a required  
field unless the Directory Service has been configured to allow anonymous search. Each  
Search DN value must be separated by a comma.  
b. Type the key attribute. The default value is common name (cn).  
c. Type the object class. The default value is person.  
d. Type the full name attribute. The default value is surname (sn).  
e. Click Next.  
9. The Specify LDAP Group Schema window will open.  
a. Type the Base distinguished name (DN) from which to begin searches. This is a required  
field unless the Directory Service has been configured to allow anonymous search. Each  
Search DN value must be separated by a comma.  
b. Type the object class. The default value is group.  
c. Type the member attribute. The default value is member.  
d. Type the username member attribute (only the username, not the full LDAP object DN).  
The user’s group membership will be located using this attribute in addition to the  
member attribute. This attribute is primarily used with NIS-like schemas.  
e. Click Next.  
10. The Select Browsing Method window will open.  
Click Browse Anonymously to browse users on the external LDAP authentication server.  
-or-  
Click Browse with user credentials to browse users on the external LDAP authentication based  
on credentials configured on the server. If this option is selected, do the following:  
a. Type a log in ID in the User Name field, in one of two forms: a fully qualified  
distinguished name or the username of an account in the base user DN.  
b. Type the password for the LDAP user account in the Password field.  
c. Click Next.  
11. The Establish Connection with Authentication Service window will open briefly. If the  
external authentication service is added successfully, the Completed Successful window  
will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
84  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
12. Click Finish. The User Authentication Services window will open with the new service listed.  
To change connection settings for the LDAP external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the LDAP service. The side navigation bar will change to include the name  
of the LDAP service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings -  
LDAP window will open.  
5. Type a name in the Service Name field to change the name of the service that appears in the  
Name column of the User Authentication Services window.  
6. Type the address of the LDAP host, in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the Host  
Address field.  
7. Type the number of the port you wish to use for connecting to the LDAP host in the Port  
Number field.  
8. Specify a Secure Socket Layer (SSL) Encryption mode:  
Click Do Not Use SSL to have authentication performed using unencrypted clear text  
instead of SSL encryption. This method is the least secure and automatically sets the Port  
Number field to a default port number of 389.  
Click Use SSL in Trust All Mode to use SSL encryption for data transmission. All server  
certificates will be trusted and automatically accepted by the DSView 3 software for  
transmitting data. This SSL method provides medium security and automatically sets the  
Port Number field to a default port number of 636.  
This encryption mode is not recommended for wide area networks (WANs).  
Click Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode to use SSL encryption for data  
transmission. The DSView 3 software will approve the server and then the certificate  
before transmitting data. This SSL method provides maximum security and automatically  
sets the Port Number field to a default port number of 636.  
9. Click Save to save your changes.  
If you selected Use SSL in Certificate-based Trust Mode, the Certificates heading will appear  
in the side navigation bar. Go to step 8.  
If you selected Do Not Use SSL or Use SSL in Trust All Mode, go to step 15.  
10. Click Certificates. The Authentication Service Certificate Management - LDAP window will  
open and list all servers that belong to the domain. A status of Trusted indicates the certificate  
is trusted, based on the certificate policy (see System certificate policy and trust store on  
page 44); Untrusted indicates the certificate cannot be trusted.  
11. To register certificates, click the checkbox to the left of the server IP address(es). To select all  
server IP addresses on the page, click the checkbox to the left of the IP Address heading.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
85  
12. Click Register to register the certificates. The Accept SSL Certificate window will appear.  
13. Click Save to store the certificate values to the DSView 3 software database on the host.  
The Certificate Management window will open if only one certificate was selected. If more  
than one certificate was selected, each will appear in order in subsequent Accept SSL  
Certificate windows.  
14. To unregister one or more certificates, check the checkbox to the left of the server IP  
address(es). To select all server IP addresses on the page, click the checkbox to the left of the  
IP Address heading.  
15. Click Unregister to unregister the certificates.  
16. A confirmation message box will appear. Confirm or cancel the operation.  
17. Click Close. The User Authentication Services window will open.  
To change user schema settings for the LDAP external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the LDAP service. The side navigation bar will change to include the name  
of the LDAP service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Schema in the side navigation bar. Users will automatically be selected and the  
Authentication Service User Schema - LDAP window will open.  
5. Type the Base distinguished name (DN) from which to begin searches. This is a required field  
unless the Directory Service has been configured to allow anonymous search. Each Search DN  
value must be separated by a comma.  
6. Type the key attribute. The default value is common name (cn).  
7. Type the object class. The default value is person.  
8. Type the full name attribute for the user. The default value is surname (sn).  
9. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
To change group schema settings for the LDAP external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the LDAP service. The side navigation bar will change to include the name  
of the LDAP service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Schema in the side navigation bar, and then click Groups. The Authentication Service  
Group Schema - LDAP window will open.  
5. Type the Base distinguished name (DN) from which to begin searches. This is a required field  
unless the Directory Service has been configured to allow anonymous search.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
86  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
6. Type the object class. The default value is groupOfNames.  
7. Type the members attribute. The default value is member.  
8. Type the username member attribute (only the username, not the full LDAP object DN). The  
user’s group membership will be located using this attribute in addition to the member  
attribute. This attribute is primarily used with NIS-like schemas.  
9. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
To change user browsing settings for the LDAP external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the LDAP service. The side navigation bar will change to include the name  
of the LDAP service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click User Browsing in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service User Browsing -  
LDAP window will open.  
5. Click Browse Anonymously to browse users on the external LDAP authentication server.  
-or-  
Click Browse with User Credentials to browse users on the external LDAP authentication  
based on credentials configured on the server. If this option is selected, do the following:  
a. Type a log in ID in the User Name field, in one of two forms: a fully qualified  
distinguished name or the username of an account in the base user DN.  
b. Type the password for the LDAP user account in the Password field.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
RADIUS external authentication service  
To add a RADIUS external authentication service:  
1. On the RADIUS server that will be used as an external authentication service, add the DSView  
3 server as a RADIUS client. Make a note of the configured shared secret and the available  
authentication type(s) on the RADIUS server.  
2. From the DSView 3 Explorer, Click the Users tab.  
3. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
4. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
5. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. Type a 1-64 character name for the RADIUS authentication service.  
b. Select RADIUS from the Type menu.  
c. Click Next.  
6. The Specify RADIUS Connection Settings window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
87  
a. Type the address of the RADIUS host in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or type  
the DNS host name in the Server Address field.  
b. Type the number of the port (from 1-65535) for connecting to the RADIUS host in the  
Port Number field. The default is port 1812.  
c. Click Next.  
7. The Establish Connection with Authentication Service window will open briefly. If the  
external authentication service is contacted successfully, the Specify RADIUS Authentication  
Settings window will open.  
a. Select the authentication type from the Authentication Type menu. Make sure it is one of  
the available authentication types noted in step 1.  
PAP - Password Authentication Protocol  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (default)  
MS-CHAP - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
MS-CHAP v2 - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol Version 2  
b. In the Shared Secret field, type the shared secret (that was configured on the RADIUS  
server in step 1), which is a password protected field. Microsoft’s implementation allows  
up to 128 ASCII characters for the shared secret; other servers may have a different limit.  
c. Re-enter the shared secret in the Confirm Shared Secret field.  
d. Click Next.  
8. If the external authentication service is added successfully, the Completed Successful window  
will open.  
9. Click Finish. The User Authentication Services window will open with the new service listed.  
To change settings for the RADIUS external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the RADIUS service. The side navigation bar will change to include the  
name of the RADIUS service at the top and, below the name, the information you may define.  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings -  
RADIUS window will open.  
a. Type a 1-64 character name for the RADIUS authentication service.  
b. Type the address of the RADIUS host in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or type  
the DNS host name in the Server Address field.  
c. Type the number of the port (from 1-65535) for connecting to the RADIUS host in the  
Port Number field. The default is port 1812.  
d. Click Save.  
5. To change the authentication type and/or shared secret, click Settings in the side navigation bar.  
The Authentication Service Authentication Settings - RADIUS window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
88  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
a. Select the authentication type from the Authentication Type menu.  
PAP - Password Authentication Protocol  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (default)  
MS-CHAP - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
MS-CHAP v2 - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol Version 2  
b. In the Shared Secret field, type the shared secret, which is a password protected field.  
Microsoft’s implementation allows up to 128 ASCII characters for the shared secret; other  
servers may have a different limit.  
c. Re-enter the shared secret in the Confirm Shared Secret field.  
d. Click Save.  
6. Click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
TACACS+ external authentication service  
DSView 3 software supports TACACS+ external authentication. Once the TACACS+  
authentication service is added, you may map TACACS+ users to the DSView 3 software database  
by using the Add User Account wizard. The username added in the DSView 3 software should  
match the username configured in the TACACS+ server. For more information about adding users,  
You may choose to associate users with internal DSView 3 software groups to control group level  
access rights. Or, you may choose to map users to external TACACS+ groups and control group  
level access rights using the TACACS+ service. There are two types of external TACACS+ groups  
that can be used: the TACACS+ standard privilege level attribute, or a custom group name  
attribute. To map users to external TACACS+ groups, use the DSView 3 software Add User Group  
wizard and specify the group type. For more information, see Adding User-defined User Groups on  
To add a TACACS+ external authentication service:  
1. On the TACACS+ server that will be used as an external authentication service, add the  
DSView 3 server as a TACACS+ client. Make a note of the configured shared secret and the  
available authentication type(s) on the TACACS+ server.  
2. From the DSView 3 Explorer, Click the Users tab.  
3. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
4. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
5. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. Type a 1-64 character name for the TACACS+ authentication service.  
b. Select TACACS+ from the Type menu.  
c. Click Next.  
6. The Specify TACACS+ Connection Settings window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
89  
a. Type the address of the TACACS+ host or type the DNS host name in the Server  
Address field.  
b. Type the number of the port (from 1-65535) connecting to the TACACS+ host in the Port  
Number field. The default port is 49.  
c. Click Next.  
7. The Establish Connection with Authentication Service window will open briefly. If the  
external authentication service is contacted successfully, the Specify TACACS+  
Authentication Settings window will open.  
a. Select the authentication type from the Authentication Type menu. Make sure it is one of  
the available authentication types noted in step 1.  
PAP - Password Authentication Protocol  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (default)  
MS-CHAP - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
b. In the Shared Secret field, type the shared secret (configured on the TACACS+ server in  
step 1), which is a password protected field. (For the shared secret, Microsoft’s  
implementation allows up to 128 ASCII characters and CISCO’s implemetation allows up  
to 32 ASCII characters; other servers may have a different limit.)  
NOTE: If you change the authentication type, you will be required to enter the shared secret.  
c. Re-enter the shared secret in the Confirm Shared Secret field.  
d. Click Next.  
8. The Specify TACACS+ Group Authorization Method window will open.  
a. Click the corresponding radio button to choose one of the following options to manage  
group authorization:  
DSView internal groups: Choose this option if you plan to associate TACACS+ users  
with DSView 3 software internal user groups.  
TACACS+ privilege level attribute: Choose this option if you plan to associate  
TACACS+ users with external TACACS+ groups using the privilege level attribute.  
TACACS+ custom attribute for group names: Choose this option if you plan to  
associate TACACS+ users with external TACACS+ groups using the custom group  
names attribute.  
b. Click Next.  
9. If you selected DSView internal groups and the external authentication service was added  
successfully, the Completed Successful window will open.  
-or-  
If you selected any other option, the Specify TACACS+ Server Group Authorization Settings  
window will open.  
a. In the Service field, type the appropriate TACACS+ service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If you selected the privilege level attribute method in step 8, the default value shell will  
appear in the field by default.  
If you selected the group name custom attribute method in step 8, the default value raccess  
will appear in the field by default.  
b. If the TACACS+ service requires a protocol for authorization requests, type the protocol  
in the Protocol field.  
c. In the Attribute Name field, type the attribute name that the DSView 3 server will receive  
after an authorization request.  
If you selected the privilege level attribute method in step 8, the default value priv-lvl will  
appear by default.  
If you selected the group name custom attribute method in step 8, the default value  
group_name will appear by default.  
NOTE: The Cyclades ACS advanced console server uses the service “raccess” and the attribute “group_name”  
for TACACS+ group implementation.  
10. Click Next. If the external authentication service is added successfully, the Completed  
Successful window will open.  
11. Click Finish. The User Authentication Services window will open with the new service listed.  
To change settings for the TACACS+ external authentication service:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
3. Click the name of the TACACS+ service. The side navigation bar will change to include the  
name of the TACACS+ service at the top and, below the name, the information you  
may define.  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings -  
TACACS+ window will open.  
a. Type a 1-64 character name for the TACACS+ authentication service.  
b. Type the address of the TACACS+ host in dot notation format (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) or type  
the DNS host name in the Server Address field.  
c. Type the number of the port (from 1-65535) for connecting to the TACACS+ host in the  
Port Number field. The default is port 49.  
d. Click Save.  
5. To change the authentication type and/or shared secret, click Settings in the side navigation bar.  
The Authentication Service Authentication Settings - TACACS+ window will open.  
a. Select the authentication type from the Authentication Type menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
91  
PAP - Password Authentication Protocol  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (default)  
MS-CHAP - Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
b. In the Shared Secret field, type the shared secret, which is a password protected field. (For  
the shared secret, Microsoft’s implementation allows up to 128 ASCII characters and  
CISCO’s implemetation allows up to 32 ASCII characters; other servers may have a  
different limit.)  
NOTE: If you change the authentication type, you will be required to enter the shared secret.  
c. Re-enter the shared secret in the Confirm Shared Secret field.  
d. Click Save.  
6. To change the group authorization settings, click Group Authorization in the side  
navigation bar.  
The Method field will display the group authorization method configured when the TACACS+  
authentication service was added. This field cannot be changed.  
a. In the Service field, type the appropriate TACACS+ service.  
If TACACS+ privilege level attribute is the method, the default value is shell.  
If TACACS+ custom attribute for group names is the method, the default value is raccess.  
b. If the TACACS+ service requires a protocol for authorization requests, type the protocol  
in the Protocol field.  
c. In the Attribute Name field, type the attribute name that the DSView 3 server will receive  
after an authorization request.  
If TACACS+ privilege level attribute is the method, the default value is priv-lvl.  
If TACACS+ custom attribute for group names is the method, the default value is  
group_name.  
d. Click Save.  
7. Click Close. The User Authentication Services dialog box will appear.  
RSA SecurID external authentication service  
When an RSA SecurID external authentication service is added, the DSView 3 software obtains  
user authentication information and relays it to the RSA Authentication Manager. The RSA  
Authentication Manager’s validation results are then relayed to the user. The DSView 3 software  
also supports new PIN operations, next tokencode operations, RSA Authentication Manager  
Replica functionality and name locking. The DSView 3 software is the agent type Net OS Agent.  
See RSA SecurID login on page 17 for information about the login process when an RSA SecurID  
external authentication service is used. Consult the RSA Authentication Manager documentation  
for additional details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
92  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
For complete information about what is needed on the RSA server, see the RSA Secured Partner  
Solutions Directory on the RSA web site (rsasecurity.com).  
To add an RSA SecurID external authentication service:  
1. On the RSA server that will be used as an external authentication service, add the DSView 3  
server as an RSA Agent Host.  
2. From the DSView 3 Explorer, Click the Users tab.  
3. Click Authentication Services in the top navigation bar. The User Authentication Services  
window will open.  
4. Click Add. The Add Authentication Service Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
5. The Provide Authentication Service Name and Type window will open.  
a. In the Name field, type a 1-64 character name for the RSA authentication service.  
b. Select RSA SecurID from the Type menu.  
c. Click Next.  
6. The Specify RSA SecurID Connection Settings window will open. Type the 1-512 character  
path to the sdconf.rec file, or browse to the  
Chapter 6: Authentication Services  
93  
4. Click Connection in the side navigation bar. The Authentication Service Connection Settings  
window will open.  
5. To change the name of the service:  
a. Type a 1-64 character name in the Service Name field.  
b. Click Save.  
c. If that is the only change you are entering, click Close. Otherwise, continue with the  
next steps.  
6. To clear the RSA SecurID node secret for one or more DSView 3 servers:  
a. Click the checkbox to the left of the server name. To select all DSView 3 servers on the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of DSView Server at the top of the list.  
b. Click Clear Node Secret. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
c. Confirm or cancel the operation.  
7. To update the RSA configuration files used by one or more DSView 3 servers to communicate  
with the RSA Authentication Manager software:  
a. Click the checkbox to the left of the server name. To select all DSView 3 servers on the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of DSView Server at the top of the list.  
b. Click Update. The Update RSA Configuration File window will open.  
c. To change the sdconf.rec configuration file, enter the path in the sdconf.rec field or  
browse to the location.  
d. To specify the advanced option sdopts.rec file for manual load balancing, enter the path in  
the sdopts.rec field or browse to the location.  
e. Click Save and then click Close.  
The DSView Service may need to be restarted when the RSA configuration is updated  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
94  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
95  
CHAPTER  
Units View Windows  
7
Units View windows display list of units that have been added to the DSView 3 software database.  
A user must have unit view access rights to open Units View windows; see About Access Rights on  
page 129. Also, units will not display if they are hidden; see Showing and hiding units on page 98.  
Each Units View window contains one or more information fields; see Units View windows fields  
Units are displayed in a table format with column headings. Use the checkbox to the left of each  
unit name to select/deselect the unit for an operation. To select all the units on a page, click the  
checkbox at the left of all the column headings at the top of the list - this is usually to the left of the  
Name column. Clicking this Select All checkbox will automatically enable the checkboxes for all  
units on that page. To deselect items that were previously selected, click on the checkbox.  
When you click the checkbox at the top of the list, all units on the current page are selected (or  
deselected if they were previously all selected). If the list of units spans more than one page, units  
on subsequent pages will not be selected. You can specify how many items will appear on a Units  
View page (that is, the number of rows); see Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Types of Units View windows  
There are four types of Units View windows, which are accessed by clicking tabs and side  
navigation bar links. Additional Units View windows, such as Virtualization or Blade Chassis, may  
be added by plug-ins; see the plug-in documentation for more information. For information about  
using the collapse/expand icons in the side navigation bar, see Using the Side Navigation Bar on  
Any Units View window that contains managed appliances may also be viewed using the topology  
feature, which displays a hierarchical structure; see Topology view on page 96.  
All Appliances: The Appliances - All window lists all managed appliances.  
Appliance Type: Appliance Type windows list all managed appliances of a particular type (for  
example, DSR1031 switches). The Appliance Type links in the side navigation bar are listed  
under Appliances - All.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
96  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
An appliance type will only be listed in the side navigation bar if an appliance of that type has  
been added to the DSView 3 software database and the user has access to it. For example, if a  
DSR1021 switch has not been added, that type will not appear in the side navigation bar.  
Target Devices: The Target Devices - All window lists all target devices. If target device types  
have been created, their links in the side navigation bar are listed under Target Devices - All.  
Mixed Views: Mixed view windows may contain managed appliances, target devices or both.  
Several links in the side navigation bar will open mixed view Units View windows.  
Recently Accessed - Units that the user has accessed most recently.  
Groups - Units that have been assigned to a personal or global unit group.  
Sites - Units that have been assigned to a site.  
Departments - Units that have been assigned to a department.  
Locations - Units that have been assigned to a location.  
Custom fields - Units that have been assigned to custom groups. These group names may  
also have custom field labels.  
See Grouping Units beginning on page 187 for information about creating and  
managing groups.  
Topology view  
Units View windows that contain managed appliances support a topology feature that can be  
enabled/disabled. A topology view is a series of parent-child hierarchies. A parent is a managed  
appliance; children can be target devices, cascade switches (with target device children of their  
own) and power control devices (with socket children of their own).  
When the topology feature is enabled in a Units View window that contains appliances, an arrow  
will appear next to each appliance. This arrow can be used to expand (open) an appliance display to  
list all the appliance ports. A Port column will be added next to the Name column. The port value is  
the port number on the appliance (or “SPC” if a power device is attached to an SPC port on a DSR  
switch), the port number on a cascaded switch or the socket number on a cascaded power device  
(for example, A1). By default, the topology view sorts by the Port column. The Port column is  
sorted by type, number and then unit name.  
Expanding and collapsing the display follows the same rules as the side navigation bar. If the arrow  
is pointing right, clicking it causes the children to be displayed (expanding/opening the item). If the  
arrow is pointing down, clicking it causes the children to be hidden (collapsing/closing the item).  
If a port has a cascade switch or power control device attached, the unit name for that port will  
include an arrow that can be used to expand/collapse the display of either all the ports on the  
cascade switch or all the sockets on the power control device.  
Ports on an appliance or a cascade switch that do not have units attached are also listed. The Status  
column will indicate No Device Attached and the Type column will indicate the default valid  
connection type for that port. The Action column will indicate Attach Device; see the procedure in  
this section for how to attach device from this link.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Units View Windows  
97  
If a target device is connected to multiple managed appliances, it will appear multiple times in a  
topology view. If you select one occurrence of an item, all other occurrences are also selected.  
If you expand a display and select one or more child items, collapsing the display will hide those  
children and deselect them.  
The Select All checkbox at the top of the list will only select displayed items on the current page.  
Items that are hidden in a collapsed unit cannot be selected with the Select All checkbox.  
In a topology view, the number of items per page value applies to appliances and children, even if  
the display is collapsed and the children are not visible. You may also specify that the topology  
view expand automatically when the Topology button is clicked. See Using the Customize link in  
If you filter the display (see Filtering information in a window on page 24), and a child matches the  
filter criteria, the parent(s) automatically open. If only an appliance matches the filter criteria, the  
appliance is closed (unless the Expand View Automatically option is enabled).  
To enable or disable a topology view:  
In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click Topology.  
Although you can enable the topology view in all Units View windows, it is only meaningful in  
windows that contain managed appliances (parent units that have children). If you enable topology  
view in a Units View window that contains only target devices, the only change will be the addition  
of the Port column to the display.  
To attach a device from a topology view:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), enable the topology view by clicking Topology.  
2. The Topology checkbox will appear pressed and the Port column will be added to the display.  
3. Click the arrow next to the appliance. If the port is located on a cascade switch, click the arrow  
next to the cascade switch.  
4. In the Action field of the port where you want to attach the target device, click Attach Device.  
The Attach Device Wizard will open. Click Next.  
5. The Select a Method for Attachment window will open.  
To create a new target device and attach it, enable the Create a New Target Device radio  
button, enter a unique name (up to 64 characters) in the Device Name field and then  
click Next.  
To attach a target device that has already been added to the DSView 3 software system,  
enable the Attach to an Existing Target Device radio button, enter the name in the Device  
Name field and then click Next.  
To browse for a target device that has already been added to the DSView 3 software  
system, enable the Browse for an Existing Target Device radio button. The Browse for an  
Existing Target Device window will open, listing all target devices (or the first 2000),  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
98  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
sorted alphabetically. To tailor the list, enter a valid filter string and click Filter. Select a  
target device from the list and then click Next.  
6. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
Accessing Units View windows  
To enable a topology view in a Units View window, click Topology (see Topology view on  
page 96).  
To access Units View windows:  
Click the Units tab.  
To display target devices:  
a. Click Target Devices in the side navigation bar. The Target Devices - All window will  
open. This window lists all target devices in the system.  
b. Click one of the target device type links (if available) in the side navigation bar. Target  
device types are user-defined. If a type has been assigned to a target device, the type name  
will appear under Target Devices in the side navigation bar. For example, if you assign a  
type of “Windows 2000” to three target devices, a Windows 2000 link will appear in the  
side navigation bar. Clicking on the link will display the three target devices, as well as  
any other target devices assigned that type.  
To display managed appliances:  
a. Click Appliances in the side navigation bar. The Appliances - All window will open.  
b. To display an Appliance Type window, click one of the appliance type links in the side  
navigation bar.  
To display a list of units that you have accessed most recently, click Recently Accessed in the  
side navigation bar.  
To display units by groupings (if available), click the link in the side navigation bar.  
Click Sites to open the Units in Sites window.  
Click Departments to open the Units in Departments window.  
Click Locations to open the Units in Locations window.  
Click Custom Field Labels to display the Units in Custom Field window.  
Showing and hiding units  
Hiding turns off the display of units in the window, but does not remove the units from the DSView  
3 software system.  
To hide a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click Customize. The  
Units View Customization window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 7: Units View Windows  
99  
2. Click Visibility in the Available Fields column and then click Add. Visibility will be moved to  
the Fields to Show column.  
3. Enable the Show hidden items checkbox if you wish to display hidden units in the Units View  
Customization window with a transparent icon.  
4. Click Save and then click Close. The window will open, containing the Visibility column. The  
Visibility column will display Hide for each unit.  
5. Click Hide for each unit.  
The display of the selected unit will be turned off in the Units View window if Show hidden  
items was not selected in the Units View Customization window.  
If Show hidden items was selected, the hidden unit will appear with a transparent icon.  
To hide multiple units with one operation:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the units you want to hide from display. To select all units on the page, click the  
checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Hide Units from the drop-down menu.  
To show hidden units:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98) click Customize. The  
Units View Customization window will open.  
2. Click Visibility in the Available Fields column and then click Add. Visibility will be moved to  
the Fields to Show column.  
3. Click Show hidden items.  
4. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open, containing the hidden  
items and the Visibility column. Hidden items will have a transparent icon and the Visibility  
field will contain Show.  
5. Click Show in the Visibility column for the unit(s) you want to display. The unit will be made  
visible, the icon will no longer be transparent and the Visibility field will change to Hide.  
Units View windows fields  
The following fields may appear in Units View windows. You may enable or disable a field’s  
display using the Customize link. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Name in Appliance - Name of the unit as defined in the appliance. Click on the name to display  
or change unit information.  
Name in DSView - Name of the unit as defined in the DSView 3 software database.  
Type - Type of target device or managed appliance model. Managed appliance types cannot be  
changed; to assign a type to a target device, see Unit Overview Windows on page 104.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
100  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Status - Current activity level of a unit. Table 7.1 lists and describes the possible values.  
Table 7.1: Unit Status Values  
Unit type  
Status and Icon  
Icon  
Description  
Any unit  
Idle  
N/A  
The unit is powered up with no connection.  
Any unit  
In Use  
The unit has at least one active connection.  
The status of the unit was reported to the software  
but cannot be obtained for an unknown reason.  
Any unit  
Status Unknown  
No Power  
Target devices  
Target devices  
Target devices  
The target device is powered down.  
The connection path to the target device is blocked  
because a cascade switch is already in use.  
KVM Blocked  
No device attached  
(topology view only)  
N/A  
The port does not have a target device attached.  
The DSView 3 software cannot determine the power  
state of the target device, or the software received a  
mixed power state from the target device. For  
example, if a target device has a KVM connection  
and a power device connection, the software will  
prompt for a power status for both of these  
connections. If both connections do not reply with  
ON or OFF, the power status will display as Partial  
Power.  
Target devices  
Partial Power  
The managed appliance did not provide status  
information. This may occur for multiple reasons,  
such as the appliance is not powered up or it is  
disconnected from the DSView 3 software system.  
Managed  
appliances  
Not Responding  
Action - Type of session that may be initiated. Although a unit may have multiple actions that  
may be performed (for example, you may be able to access a target device using a browser  
session or a Telnet session), only one action will be displayed.  
For example, a target device that is only attached to a serial console appliance will not contain  
a KVM Session link. If a target device has a connection to both a serial console appliance and  
a KVM switch, a KVM Session link will appear.  
As shown in Figure 7.1, other available actions that have been enabled may be accessed by  
clicking the Alternate Actions arrow to the right of the action with the highest precedence.  
Clicking on one of the displayed links will launch the corresponding window type.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 7: Units View Windows  
101  
Action  
Click on the Alternate Actions  
arrow to display a list of all  
available connection methods.  
V
V
KVM Session  
KVM Session  
KVMSession  
V
V
Exclusive KVM Session  
Browser Session  
Click on an action to launch the  
corresponding window.  
Telnet Session  
V
KVM Session  
V
Figure 7.1: Alternate Actions Arrow in a Units View Window  
Table 7.2: Action Links  
Action link  
Displays  
Valid for*  
TDs attached to KVM switch  
channels/ports  
KVM Session  
Video Viewer window  
Video Viewer window (this link only  
appears when Alternate Action arrow  
is selected)  
Exclusive KVM  
Session  
TDs attached to KVM switch  
channels/ports  
Supported versions of IBM ASM RSA II,  
DRAC 4 and NEC IPF embedded units  
Embedded Session  
IPMI Session  
Viewer window  
IPMI Viewer window  
IPMI TDs  
Opens a Telnet session window using  
the configured application  
Serial Session  
Target devices  
EVR1500 environmental monitors,  
generic appliances, standalone TDs  
and TDs attached to serial console  
appliances, HP iLO embedded unit or  
KVM switch ports  
Browser Session  
Web browser  
EVR1500 environmental monitors,  
generic appliances, standalone TDs  
and TDs attached to serial console  
appliances, HP iLO embedded unit or  
KVM switch ports  
Telnet Viewer window or third party  
Telnet view window  
Telnet Session  
Target devices; see Target Device  
<Service Name>  
Service interface  
Appliances and/or TDs supported by  
plug-ins that define this  
connection type.  
<Connection Name> Session interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
102  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 7.2: Action Links (Continued)  
Action link  
Displays  
Valid for*  
* In addition to the units listed in this column, one or more of these connection types may be valid for units  
supported by plug-ins. See the plug-in documentation for details.  
Browser URL - URL that may be used to access a target device, EVR1500 environmental  
monitor or generic appliance. This field will be empty if a URL is not available.  
Custom Field 1-3 - Custom fields assigned to units. If these fields have been defined with new  
names, the defined names will appear instead of Custom Field 1, Custom Field 2 and Custom  
DSView Software Server - Name of the server associated with the units.  
Location - Location assigned to the units. See Site, Department and Location Groups on  
®
Migration Status - Whether units imported from a DSView 2.x database or AlterPath  
Manager software require migration to be operational in the DSView 3 software. See Task:  
Part Number - See Unit Properties on page 125.  
Primary Contact, Primary Contact Phone, Secondary Contact and Secondary Contact Phone -  
Name and phone number of person(s) responsible for a unit. See Unit Properties on page 125.  
Telnet Port - Port number used for a Telnet connection to a target device. See Unit Properties  
Visibility - Whether to display (Show) or not display (Hide) a unit in the Units View windows.  
Multiple unit operations from a Units View window  
From a Units View window, you may delete one or more units (see Deleting Units on page 114) or  
assign access rights for one or more units (see About Access Rights on page 129).  
You may also use the Operations button/menu to initiate certain actions on one or more units.  
Hiding units from view - see Showing and hiding units on page 98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Units View Windows  
103  
Push or pull names to/from the appliance - see Manual name push on page 118 and Manual  
Wall power on, off or cycle - see Power Device Sockets on page 150  
Change unit properties - see Unit Properties on page 125  
Custom operations defined in plug-ins may also be listed in the Operations menu.  
A given action will be available only if at least one of the selected units supports the action. If a  
selected unit does not support the operation, it will be reported as such in the results window.  
When one of these multiple unit operations is initiated and confirmed (if needed), a system task is  
created that will perform the operation on each unit. The Multiple Unit Operation window will  
open, indicating the operation has been submitted. This window contains a link that directs the user  
to the Operations Results window for the task.  
To initiate and view results from multiple unit operations from a Units  
View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), initiate the multiple  
unit operation as described in the procedures referenced above. If prompted, confirm  
the operation.  
2. The Multiple Unit Operation window will open, indicating the operation has been submitted.  
If you do not want to view the results of the operation, click Close and skip the rest of  
this procedure.  
To view the results of the operation, click Click here to view results.  
3. The Operations Results window will open, listing all multiple unit operations and any unit  
tasks that have been initiated (see Using Tasks on page 291). The entry for each  
operation includes:  
Name of the operation  
When the operation started  
When the operation finished (blank if not yet complete)  
Status or result of the operation  
You may also access this window at any time by clicking the Units tab, then clicking  
Operation Results in the side navigation bar.  
4. To view the results for an individual operation, click on the name. The Operation Results  
window for that operation type will open, indicating:  
Status - Current status of the task  
Summary - Number of successful/failed/total unit operations (for example, the summary  
of an operation with a status of ‘Rebooting the unit(s)’ might contain a 2/0/3 summary - 2  
successful, 0 failed and 3 total units)  
Name of the operation  
Type of unit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
104  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
When the operation started  
How long the operation took  
Status or result of the operation on the unit  
5. Click Close.  
Unit Overview Windows  
The Unit Overview window contains the following information about an individual unit:  
Target Devices - Name, type and icon associated with the target device. You may also use this  
window to connect to the target device. The available connection methods are determined by  
the type of target device.  
Power information appears only if the target device is a power device and the user has power  
control rights. In this case, the user may power up, power down or cycle the power of the  
target device.  
Managed appliances - Name and type of managed appliances and the tools that may be used to:  
Reboot  
Upgrade firmware  
Resynchronize  
Save or restore the configuration (valid only for supported KVM switches and serial  
console appliances)  
Save or restore the user database (valid only for supported KVM switches and serial  
console appliances)  
The available tasks depend on the type of managed appliance and the user’s access rights on  
the managed appliance. (Custom tools defined by a plug-in may also be available.)  
EVR1500 environmental monitor or generic appliance - Name and type of EVR1500  
environmental monitor or generic appliance and links for establishing a connection to it.  
You may change the overview information for one target device from a Unit Overview window.  
From a Units View window, you can change the type or icon for several target devices in one  
operation. This may be helpful when you want to assign the same values to several units. See Unit  
Other types of Unit Overview windows may be supported by plug-ins; see the plug-in  
documentation for more information.  
To change overview information for a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of a target device. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Enter a name for the target device.  
3. Enter a type for the target device.  
4. Select a new icon for the target device using the arrows.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Units View Windows  
105  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open. If you added a type that  
was not previously defined, it will appear under Target Devices in the side navigation bar.  
To initiate a session with a target device from the Unit Overview window:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of a target device. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Click on the icon or name of the session type you wish to start.  
To change the power state of a target device from the Unit Overview window:  
NOTE: A user must have power control access rights and the target device must be connected to and powered  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of a target device. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the power device outlet(s). To select all device outlets on the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of Connection at the top of the list.  
3. Click On, Off or Cycle to power up, power down, or power cycle (power down and then power  
up) the power device outlets.  
To change the name of a managed appliance from the Unit Overview window:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of an appliance. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Type a name for the managed appliance. (You cannot change the type.)  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Unit Status Window  
The Unit Status window displays all units in a grid with a color-coded status.  
NOTE: To view the Unit Status window, Adobe Flash Player version 9.0 or later must be installed on your client  
workstation. The DSView 3 software will prompt you to install Flash Player if needed; or you can visit  
www.adobe.com to download and install the player.  
To use the Unit Status window:  
1. Click the Units tab, then click Unit Status in the side navigation bar.  
2. The Unit Status window opens.  
3. You can filter what units are displayed by selecting a status from the Filter menu. Each unit  
status is color-coded. The default filtered status is Active Status which displays only currently  
active units.  
4. You can select how often the Unit Status is updated by selecting a time from the Interval menu.  
5. You can view the Unit Overview window by double-clicking the unit name, or right-clicking  
the unit name and selecting Show Unit Overview.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
106  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
107  
CHAPTER  
Adding and Deleting Units  
8
This chapter describes how to add and delete units in the DSView 3 software.  
Adding Units  
You may add:  
A single managed appliance  
A single embedded appliance  
Multiple managed appliances based on a range of IP addresses  
A generic appliance or an EVR1500 environmental monitor  
A single target device that is not attached to a managed appliance  
When a managed appliance is added, DSView 3 software administrator, user administrator and  
appliance administrator privileges are automatically assigned to the managed appliance. A user  
with any of these privileges may:  
Reboot a managed appliance and disconnect sessions  
Administer local user accounts on the managed appliance  
Control target device power  
Establish sessions with target devices from KVM switches, serial console appliances or other  
supported units.  
Appliance administrators and DSView 3 software administrators may also Flash upgrade a  
managed appliance and configure settings for a managed appliance.  
Managed appliance rights may be changed. See About Access Rights on page 129.  
When you add a KVM switch or serial console appliance, attached target devices are also added.  
If you add a KVM switch or serial console appliance that has an attached power device, the power  
device is automatically added to the DSView 3 software database. Any target devices plugged into  
the power device outlets (sockets) are also added, based on the options selected.  
The applicable X.509 certificate is automatically copied from the DSView 3 software to the unit  
being added. A certificate is a unique identifier of an individual managed appliance. (EVR1500  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
108  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
environmental monitors and generic appliances do not support certificates and may be added to  
multiple DSView 3 software systems.)  
Wizards that add units  
In a Units View window, clicking Add invokes a wizard that guides you through the process of  
adding managed appliances and target devices to the DSView 3 software system. The units that are  
visible in the current Units View window determines which wizard will be invoked when you  
click Add.  
If you are in the Appliances - All window, you can add managed appliances of any type. You  
cannot add target devices from that window.  
If you are in the Units View window for a specific appliance type (such as Appliances -  
DSR4030), you can only add more appliances of that type (DSR4030 appliances). You cannot  
add appliances of any other type or any target devices.  
If you are in the Target Devices - All window or any of the target device type windows (such as  
Target Devices - Linux Servers), you can add target devices. You cannot add appliances from  
that window.  
If you are in any other Units View window (see Types of Units View windows on page 95), you  
can add a managed appliance or a target device.  
When a unit is added to the DSView 3 software database, it is also added to the current Units View.  
For example, if you are viewing units in the department named Accounting and click Add, the  
newly added unit will automatically be added to the Accounting department.  
Adding a single managed appliance  
This procedure is valid for supported KVM switches and serial console appliances. It may also be  
valid for appliances supported by a plug-in; see the appropriate documentation.  
To add a single managed appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing managed appliances (see Accessing Units View windows  
on page 98), click Add. The Add Appliance Wizard will open. Click Next.  
2. The Select Add Unit Procedure window will open. Click Add a single appliance, then  
click Next.  
3. If you were not in an appliance type Units View window when you clicked Add in the first  
step, the Select Appliance Type window will open. Select a managed appliance from the  
product list, then click Next.  
If you were in an appliance type Units View window when you clicked Add in the first step, go  
to the next step.  
4. A Select Address Configuration of Appliance window will open, including the type of the  
managed appliance.  
If the managed appliance does not have an address, click No, the <Managed Appliance  
Type> does not have an address. Go to the next step.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 8: Adding and Deleting Units  
109  
If the managed appliance has an address, click Yes, the <Managed Appliance Type> does  
have an address and either type the address or the fully qualified domain name for the  
managed appliance. Go to step 7.  
5. The Configure Appliance Network Settings window will open.  
a. Type the IP address and subnet mask, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), for the  
managed appliance.  
b. Optionally, type a gateway in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
c. Click Next.  
6. The Select Appliance to Add window will open. Select the entry, then click Next.  
7. The Select Options window will open. (For more information about the options that affect  
adding target devices connected to the appliance, see Topology Synchronization on page 120.)  
For appliances supported by plug-ins, the content of this window may differ; see the  
appropriate documentation.  
a. Enable the Enable secure mode checkbox if you want the managed appliance to only be  
accessible by this DSView 3 software system. In non-secure mode, the managed appliance  
may be added to multiple DSView 3 software systems.  
This checkbox will not appear when adding a DSI5100 appliance, which may only be  
added in Secure mode.  
b. Enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single target  
device checkbox if you wish to merge a target device that has multiple connections into a  
single target device.  
c. Under Allow target devices that contain default names to be added for these type of  
connections, you may enable the checkboxes for one or more connection types. Any target  
devices that contain default names in the managed appliance and support the enabled  
connection type in the managed appliance will be added to the DSView 3  
software database.  
This option has no effect when adding a DSI5100 appliance, since default target device  
names are not supported. A target device is named when it is added as a BMC port using  
the Add IPMI BMC Wizard.  
d. Click Next.  
8. If one or more cascade switches are connected to the managed appliance, the Configure  
Cascade Switches window will open.  
a. Select the type of cascade switch for each row from the menu in the Cascade Switch  
Type column.  
b. Optionally, type a name for each row in the Name column.  
c. If two or more rows of a multiuser cascade switch are discovered, you can merge the rows  
by selecting the checkboxes of those rows and clicking Merge. To undo the merge, click  
the row of the merged switch and click Split. For information about other methods for  
merging cascade switches, see Topology Synchronization on page 120.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
110  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
d. Click Next.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open.  
10. Click Finish.  
Adding a single embedded appliance  
This procedure is valid only for IBM ASM RSA II, DRAC 4, HP iLO and NEC IPF  
embedded appliances.  
To add a single embedded appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing managed appliances (see Accessing Units View windows  
on page 98), click Add. The Add Appliance Wizard will open. Click Next.  
2. The Select Add Unit Procedure window will open. Click Add a single appliance, then  
click Next.  
3. If you were not in an appliance type Units View window when you clicked Add in the first  
step, the Select Appliance Type window will open. Select an embedded appliance from the  
product list, then click Next.  
For an IBM ASM RSA II embedded appliance, go to step 4.  
For a DRAC 4 embedded appliance, go to step 5.  
For an HP iLO embedded appliance, go to step 6.  
For an NEC IPF embedded appliance, go to step 7.  
4. For IBM ASM RSA II embedded appliances:  
a. The Configure IBM ASM RSA II Settings window will open.  
b. In the Appliance Name field, type a 1-64 character appliance name. The name is not  
case sensitive.  
c. In the Address field, type a 1-256 character IP address in dot notation form or a DNS  
name. The address is not case sensitive.  
d. In the Username field, type a 1-64 character username to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Usernames are case sensitive.  
e. In the Password field, type a 1-64 character password to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Passwords are case sensitive.  
f. Click Next.  
g. The embedded device discovery will verify that a web server exists at the specified IP  
address. If successful, the Select Option window will open.  
h. Enable or disable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single  
target device checkbox.  
i. Click Next. Go to step 8.  
5. For DRAC 4 embedded appliances:  
a. The Configure DELL DRAC4 Settings window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 8: Adding and Deleting Units  
111  
b. In the Appliance Name field, type a 1-64 character appliance name. The name is not  
case sensitive.  
c. In the Address field, type a 1-256 character IP address in dot notation form or a DNS  
name. The address is not case sensitive.  
d. In the Port field, type a TCP port number in the range 0-65535 where the appliance  
will listen.  
e. In the Username field, type a 1-64 character username to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Usernames are case sensitive.  
f. In the Password field, type a 1-64 character password to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Passwords are case sensitive.  
g. Click Next.  
h. The embedded device discovery will verify that a web server exists at the specified IP  
address. If successful, the Select Option window will open.  
i. Enable or disable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single  
target device checkbox.  
j. Click Next. Go to step 8.  
6. For HP iLO embedded appliances:  
a. The Configure HP iLO Settings window will open.  
b. In the Appliance Name field, type a 1-64 character appliance name. The name is not  
case sensitive.  
c. In the Address field, type a 1-256 character IP address in dot notation form or a DNS  
name. The address is not case sensitive.  
d. Click Next. Go to step 8.  
7. For NEC IPF embedded appliances:  
a. The Configure NEC IPF Settings window will open.  
b. In the Address field, type a 1-256 character IP address in dot notation form or a DNS  
name. The address is not case sensitive.  
c. In the Username field, type a 1-64 character username to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Usernames are case sensitive.  
d. In the Password field, type a 1-64 character password to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Passwords are case sensitive.  
e. Click Next.  
f. The embedded device discovery will verify that the embedded appliance’s product ID  
matches the appliance type. If successful, the Select Options window will open.  
g. The Appliance Name field contains the name stored in the embedded appliance. You may  
change this to a 1-256 character unique name. Names are not case sensitive.  
h. Enable or disable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single  
target device checkbox.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
112  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
i. Click Next.  
8. The Completed Successful window will open.  
9. Click Finish.  
Adding managed appliances from a range of IP addresses  
This procedure is valid for supported KVM switches and serial console appliances. It may also be  
valid for appliances supported by a plug-in; see the appropriate documentation.  
To add a managed appliance from a range of IP addresses:  
1. In a Units View window containing managed appliances (see Accessing Units View windows  
on page 98), click Add. The Add Appliance Wizard will open. Click Next.  
2. The Select Add Unit Procedure window will open. Click Discover appliances on the network  
from an IP address range, then click Next.  
3. The Type in Discover IP Address Range window will open.  
a. Type the IP address in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), from which to begin  
the search.  
b. Type the IP address in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), at which to end  
the search.  
c. Click Next.  
4. The DSView 3 software will search for managed appliances within the IP address range. When  
the search is completed, the Select Appliances to Add window will open, listing the results.  
5. Add or remove appliances.  
To add one or more managed appliances, select the managed appliances in the Appliances  
found list, then click Add. The managed appliances will be moved to the Appliances to  
Add list.  
To remove one or more managed appliances, select the managed appliances in the  
Appliances to Add list, then click Remove. The managed appliances will be moved to the  
Appliances found list.  
Click Next.  
6. The Select Options window will open. (For more information about the options that affect  
adding target devices connected to the appliance, see Topology Synchronization on page 120.)  
For appliances that are supported by plug-ins, the content of this window may differ; see the  
appropriate documentation.  
a. Click Enable secure mode if you want the managed appliance to only be accessible by this  
DSView 3 software system. In non-secure mode, the managed appliance may be added to  
multiple DSView 3 software systems.  
NOTE: For appliances that require Secure mode, this checkbox will not be visible and the appliance will enable  
Secure mode automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 8: Adding and Deleting Units  
113  
b. Click Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single target device if  
you wish to merge a target device that has multiple connections into a single target device.  
c. Under Allow target devices that contain default names to be added for these type of  
connections, you may enable one or more connection types. Any target devices that  
contain default names in the managed appliance and support the enabled connection type  
in the managed appliance will be added to the DSView 3 software database.  
This option has no effect when adding a DSI5100 appliance, since default target device  
names are not supported. A target device is named when it is added as a BMC port using  
the Add IPMI BMC Wizard.  
d. Click Next.  
7. The Adding Appliances window will open while the selected managed appliances are added to  
the DSView 3 software system.  
8. The Completed Successful window will open.  
9. Click Finish.  
Adding a generic appliance or an EVR1500 environmental monitor  
To add a single EVR1500 environmental monitor or generic appliance:  
1. Click Add in a Units View window. The Add Unit Wizard will open. Click Next.  
2. The Select Add Unit Procedure window will open. Click Add a single appliance, then  
click Next.  
3. The Select Appliance Type window will open. Select EVR1500 or Generic from the product  
list, then click Next.  
4. A Configure Generic Appliance Settings window will open.  
a. Type the name.  
b. Type either the address or the fully qualified domain name.  
c. Type the Telnet port.  
d. Type the web browser URL.  
e. Click Next.  
5. The Completed Successful window will open.  
6. Click Finish.  
Adding a target device  
You may add a target device using the Add Target Device Wizard, which is described in this  
section. You may also add a target device using the Attach Target Device Wizard, which is  
available from a Units View window that has the topology view enabled. See Topology view on  
To add a power device, see Power Devices on page 147. To add BMCs, see the DSI5100  
Operations for the DSView 3 Software Technical Bulletin, available on the Avocent web site.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
114  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To add a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click Add. If you are in a target device view window, the Add Target Device Wizard  
will open. If you are in a mixed view window, the Add Unit Wizard will open. Click Next.  
2. If you were in a mixed view window when you clicked Add, the Select Add Unit Procedure  
window will open. Click Add a single target device. Click Next.  
If you were in a target device view window when you clicked Add, go to the next step.  
3. The Type in Device Settings window will open, where you may enter optional information:  
name, address or fully qualified domain name, Telnet port and web browser URL.  
4. Click Next. The Completed Successful window will open.  
5. Click Finish.  
Deleting Units  
When you delete a unit, it is removed from the DSView 3 software database, and all associated  
connections will also be deleted.  
You may also choose to delete target devices that are no longer connected when you run the Resync  
To delete a power device, see Power Devices on page 147.  
To delete a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit name. To delete all units on the page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at  
the top of the list.  
2. Click Delete. You are prompted to confirm the deletion.  
3. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
115  
CHAPTER  
Synchronizing the DSView 3  
Software Database  
9
This chapter describes how to synchronize the DSView 3 software database with changes that  
occur on units.  
Name Synchronization  
Units and connections in the DSView 3 software system have a “Name in DSView”, which is the  
name stored in the DSView 3 software database. Some units (appliance serial ports, cascade  
switches, target devices, power devices and power device sockets) may also have a “Name in  
Appliance,” which is the name stored in the managed appliance.  
The DSView 3 software name synchronization feature will “push” and/or “pull” names. You may  
enable the name push and name pull operations to run automatically. You may also push and pull  
names manually.  
Name push  
When the name of a target device or cascade device is changed in the DSView 3 software database,  
a push operation will update the target device, cascade device, serial port and power device socket  
names in the appliance.  
You may also rename units associated with a single connection to a target device in the DSView 3  
software database. The name push operation will then push the new unit names to the appliance.  
Name pull  
When the name of a target device, cascade device, serial port or power device socket is changed in  
a managed appliance, a pull operation will update the target device and cascade device names in the  
DSView 3 software database.  
You may enable/disable automatic name push and automatic name pull. You may also manually  
initiate a push or pull operation at any time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
116  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Automatic name push  
When automatic name push is enabled, the name push operation occurs automatically when a name  
is changed in the DSView 3 software.  
Table 9.1: Automatic Name Push Operation Effects  
Unit  
Effect  
If the target device for the serial port in the DSView 3 software database has a single  
appliance connection, the target device name will be pushed to the appliance.  
If the target device for the serial port in the DSView 3 software database has multiple  
appliance connections, the target device name will be pushed to the appliance for  
each appliance connection (for connection type(s) enabled in the Automatic Name  
Push Properties window).  
Appliance serial ports  
The power device name in the DSView 3 software database will be pushed to  
the appliance.  
Power devices  
If the target device for the power device socket in the DSView 3 software database  
has a single appliance connection, the target device name will be pushed to  
the appliance.  
Power device sockets  
If the target device for the power device socket in the DSView 3 software database  
has multiple appliance connections, the target device name will be pushed to each  
appliance for each appliance connection (for connection type(s) enabled in the  
Automatic Name Push Properties window).  
If the target device in the DSView 3 software database has a single appliance  
connection, the target device name will be pushed to the appliance.  
If the target device in the DSView 3 software database has multiple appliance  
connections, the target device name will be pushed to the appliance for each  
appliance connection (for connection type(s) enabled in the Automatic Name Push  
Properties window).  
Target devices  
If the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database has a single appliance  
connection, the name will be pulled from the appliance to update the cascade switch  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
If the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database has multiple appliance  
connections to the same appliance (a multiuser cascade switch), the cascade switch  
name will be pulled from the appliance connection with the lowest port number to  
update the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database. (Multiuser cascade  
switches are treated as separate cascade switches by the appliance.)  
Cascade switches  
To enable or disable automatic name push:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Unit Synchronization in the side navigation bar, then click Auto Name Push.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 9: Synchronizing the DSView 3 Software Database  
117  
4. The Automatic Name Push Properties window will open. To enable automatic name push,  
enable the Push Names from DSView to appliances automatically checkbox.  
To disable automatic name push, disable the Push Names from DSView to appliances  
automatically checkbox and go to the last step.  
5. Enable the checkboxes for one or more appliance connection types. The name in the DSView 3  
software will be pushed to the appliance if the target device has a connection that matches the  
selected type.  
6. Click Save.  
Automatic name pull  
When automatic name pull is enabled, the name pull operation occurs automatically when an  
appliance name is changed.  
Table 9.2: Automatic Name Pull Operation Effects  
Unit  
Effect  
If the target device for the serial port in the DSView 3 software database has a  
single appliance connection, the target device name will be pulled from the  
appliance to update the target device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Appliance serial ports  
If the target device for the serial port in the DSView 3 software database has  
multiple appliance connections, the target device name will be pulled from one of  
the appliance connections (based on the configured connection type priority) to  
update the target device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
The power device name will be pulled from the appliance to update the power  
device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Power devices  
If the target device for the power device socket in the DSView 3 software database  
has a single appliance connection, the target device name will be pulled from the  
appliance to update the target device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Power device sockets  
If the target device for the power device socket in the DSView 3 software database  
has multiple appliance connections, the target device name will be pulled from one  
of the appliance connections (based on the configured connection type priority) to  
update the target device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
If the target device in the DSView 3 software database has a single appliance  
connection, the name will be pulled from the appliance to update the target device  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Target devices  
If the target device in the DSView 3 software database has multiple appliance  
connections, the target device name will be pulled from one of the appliance  
connections (based on the configured connection type priority) to update the target  
device name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
118  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 9.2: Automatic Name Pull Operation Effects (Continued)  
Unit  
Effect  
If the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database has a single appliance  
connection, the name will be pulled from the appliance to update the cascade  
switch name in the DSView 3 software database.  
If the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database has multiple appliance  
connections to the same appliance (a multiuser cascade switch), the cascade  
switch name will be pulled from the appliance connection with the lowest port  
number to update the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database.  
(Multiuser cascade switches are treated as separate cascade switches by the  
appliance.)  
Cascade switches  
The following sections describe how to change a unit’s Name in Appliance:  
Power device - see Power Devices on page 147  
Power device socket - see Power Device Sockets on page 150  
To enable or disable automatic name pull:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Unit Synchronization in the side navigation bar, then click Auto Name Pull.  
4. The Automatic Name Pull Properties window will open. To enable automatic name pull,  
enable the Pull Names from appliances to DSView automatically checkbox.  
To disable automatic name pull, disable the Pull Names from appliances to DSView  
automatically checkbox and go to the last step.  
5. For target devices that have multiple connections, you may set the connection type priority by  
using the arrows to re-order the available types. This order determines which target device  
name will be pulled from one or more appliances to update the DSView 3 software database.  
The name will be pulled from only one appliance.  
6. Click Save.  
Manual name push  
You may initiate a manual name push from a Units View window (see below) and from the  
following windows:  
Target Devices window - see Target Device Settings on page 135  
Power Device window - see Power Devices on page 147  
Power Device Sockets window - see Power Device Sockets on page 150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9: Synchronizing the DSView 3 Software Database  
119  
Appliance cascade switches window - see KVM Switch and Cascade Switch Settings on  
To initiate a name push operation from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkboxes  
next to one or more units. To select all units on the page, click the checkbox to the left of the  
heading at the top of the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Push Names to Appliance from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Operations window will open, containing a link to the Operation Results  
Manual name pull  
Table 9.3 describes what occurs when a name pull operation is initiated.  
Table 9.3: Manual Name Pull Operation Effects  
When pull is initiated  
The effect is  
for one or more:  
The target device name will be pulled from the appliance to update the target device  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Appliance serial ports  
Power devices  
The power device name will be pulled from the appliance to update the power device  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
The target device name will be pulled from the appliance to update the target device  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
Power device sockets  
Target devices  
The target device name will be pulled from the appliance to update the target device  
name in the DSView 3 software database.  
The cascade switch name will be pulled from the appliance to update the cascade  
switch name in the DSView 3 software database.  
If the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database has multiple appliance  
connections to the same appliance (a multiuser cascade switch), the cascade switch  
name will be pulled from the appliance connection with the lowest port number to  
update the cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database. Multiuser cascade  
switches are treated as separate cascade switches by the managed appliance.  
Cascade switches  
You may initiate a manual name pull from a Units View window and from the following windows:  
Target Devices window - see Target Device Settings on page 135  
Power Device window - see Power Devices on page 147  
Power Device Sockets window - see Power Device Sockets on page 150  
Appliance cascade switches window - see KVM Switch and Cascade Switch Settings on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
120  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To initiate a name pull operation from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkboxes  
next to one or more units. To select all units on the page, click the checkbox to the left of the  
heading at the top of the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Pull Names from Appliance from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Operations window will open, containing a link to the Operation Results  
Topology Synchronization  
The topology synchronization operation updates the DSView 3 software database when a change  
occurs in a managed appliance. Examples of changes are the adding/removing of an IQ adaptor,  
cascade switch or power device.  
Synchronization options include:  
Merge target device names - A target device that has connections to more than one appliance  
managed by the DSView 3 software can appear as two different devices when the appliances  
are added to the DSView 3 software database. For example, a server may have a serial console  
port connected to a serial console appliance, which is used during the boot process. The same  
server may also have a KVM connection to a KVM switch that is accessible after the server is  
up and running. You may configure that target device to appear only once, and the DSView 3  
software will provide the valid Action choices for accessing the device.  
Default target device names allowed for connection types - If a target device has a default  
name, you may indicate that it can be added to the DSView 3 software database only if it  
supports specific connection type(s) in the appliance - for example, KVM, serial or power.  
You may enable/disable deleting target devices that no longer have connections from the  
DSView 3 software database.  
You may enable or disable automatic topology synchronization. You may also control topology  
synchronization manually by:  
Enabling or disabling options when the Add Unit Wizard runs.  
Enabling or disabling options when the Resync Wizard runs.  
Initiating a target device or cascade switch merge operation from a Unit Overview window.  
Initiate a target device merge operation from the Unit Tools window (see Merging target  
Initiating a cascade switch merge operation on two multiuser cascade switches in the same  
appliance from a Units View window.  
Scheduling or manually running the update topology task (see Task: Update topology for  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9: Synchronizing the DSView 3 Software Database  
121  
Automatic topology synchronization  
NOTE: Automatic topology synchronization is not supported on some managed appliances, including the  
®
LANDesk Server Manager. Alternatively, you may schedule the update topology task to keep these appliances  
synchronized with the DSView 3 software. See Task: Update topology for selected units on page 304.  
To enable or disable automatic topology synchronization:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Unit Synchronization in the side navigation bar, then click Auto Topology.  
4. The Automatic Topology Properties window will open. To enable automatic topology  
synchronization, enable the Update DSView with topology changes from appliances  
automatically checkbox.  
To disable automatic topology synchronization, disable the Update DSView with topology  
changes from appliances automatically checkbox and go to the last step.  
5. If you enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single target  
device checkbox, the connection to a target device in the appliance will be merged with the  
connection(s) to an existing target device in the DSView 3 software database.  
6. If you enable the Delete Target Devices that no longer have connections checkbox, target  
devices that no longer have connections will be permanently deleted from the DSView 3  
software database.  
7. If you enable the Add a target device to new connections checkbox, a target device in the  
appliance will be added to a new unit (appliance, power device or cascade switch) connection  
in the DSView 3 software database.  
If you disable this checkbox, the target device in the appliance will not be added automatically  
to a new unit connection in the DSView 3 software database. However, you can add it  
8. If you enable the Allow target devices that contain default names to be added for these type of  
connections checkbox, you may then enable one or more connection type checkboxes. Any  
target devices that contain default names in the appliance will be added to the DSView 3  
software database only if the connection type in the appliance matches an enabled connection  
type in this window.  
9. Click Save.  
Topology synchronization options in the Add Unit Wizard  
The Select Options window in the Add Unit Wizard allows you to specify the access mode and  
certain topology synchronization options.  
Enable/disable secure mode  
Merge target device names  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
122  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Default target names allowed for connection types  
This window is described in Adding Units on page 107.  
Each of these options has a default value, which you may change.  
To change the default values of the options in the Add Unit Wizard:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Wizard Defaults in the side navigation bar, then click Add Unit Wizard.  
4. The Add Unit Wizard Default Options window will open.  
5. If you enable the Enable secure mode checkbox, by default, the unit will only be accessible by  
this DSView 3 software system. In non-secure mode, the unit may be added to multiple  
DSView 3 software systems.  
6. If you enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single target  
device checkbox, by default, the connection to a target device in the appliance will be merged  
with the connection(s) to an existing target device in the DSView 3 software database.  
7. If a target device has a default name, you may indicate that, by default, it can be added to the  
DSView 3 software database only if it supports specific connection type(s) in the appliance.  
Enable the checkboxes for the specific connection types.  
8. Click Save.  
Topology synchronization options in the Resync Wizard  
The Select Resync Options window in the Resync Wizard allows you to specify certain topology  
synchronization options.  
Remove offline connections  
Delete target devices that no longer have connections  
Merge target device names  
Default target names allowed for connection types  
This window is described in Resynchronizing units on page 286.  
Each of these options has a default value, which you may change.  
To change the default values of the options in the Resync Wizard:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Wizard Defaults in the side navigation bar, then click Resync Wizard.  
4. The Resync Wizard Default Options window will open.  
If you enable the Remove offline connections checkbox, by default, any appliance  
connections that are reported as offline in the appliance will be deleted from the DSView 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9: Synchronizing the DSView 3 Software Database  
123  
software database. The Resync Wizard does not add offline connections to the DSView 3  
software database.  
If you enable the Delete target devices that no longer have connections checkbox, by  
default, any target devices that no longer have connections are permanently deleted from  
the DSView 3 software database.  
If you enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single  
target device checkbox, by default, the connection to a target device in the appliance will  
be merged with the connection(s) to an existing target device in the DSView 3  
software database.  
If a target device has a default name, you may indicate that, by default, it can be added to  
the DSView 3 software database only if it supports specific connection type(s) in the  
appliance. Enable the checkboxes for the specific connection types.  
5. Click Save.  
Merging target devices  
You may also merge target devices from a Unit Tools window, see Merging target devices on  
To merge target devices:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the target device name. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Click the Merge Target Devices icon or link. The Merge Target Devices Wizard will appear.  
Click Next.  
3. The Select Target Devices to Merge window will open. The selected target device will be listed  
in the Target Devices to Merge list.  
To add one or more target devices to the merge list, select the target device(s) in the  
Available Target Devices list, then click Add. The target devices will be moved to the  
Target Devices to Merge list.  
To remove one or more target devices from the merge list, select the target device(s) from  
the Target Devices to Merge list, then click Remove. The target devices will be moved to  
the Available Target Devices list.  
To merge target devices in a particular order, select one or more target devices in the  
Target Devices to Merge list and use the up and down arrows to move the selected target  
devices up or down in the listing. Once the order has been specified, select Merge missing  
properties to the target device based on the order of the devices in the “Target Devices to  
Merge” list.  
The merged target devices will contain the name of the first target device in the Target  
Device to Merge list. For example, if you are merging two target devices named TD1 and  
TD2, and TD2 is listed before TD1, the merged target device will be named TD2.  
Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
124  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4. The Confirm Target Device Merge window will open. Click Next to confirm merging the  
connection paths into the specified destination target device. See Connections to Units on  
5. The Completed Successful window will open.  
6. Click Finish.  
Merging or splitting cascade switches  
You may use the Merge Cascade Switch wizard to modify the name/type of one or more cascade  
switches that belong to the same appliance in the DSView 3 software database. You may also  
merge or split two or more multi-user cascade switches from the same appliance.  
To merge or split cascade switches:  
1. In a Units View window containing cascade switches (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the cascade switch name. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Click the Merge Target Devices icon or link. The Merge Cascade Switches Wizard will appear.  
Click Next.  
3. The Cascade Switch Configuration window will open. The Appliance Port column lists the  
ports in the appliance that are connected to cascade switches.  
4. You may change the cascade switch type by selecting from the drop-down menu. If you change  
the cascade switch name, it must contain 1-64 characters and must not exist in the DSView 3  
software database unless it is associated with a multi-user cascade switch.  
5. To merge cascade switches, click the checkboxes to the left of the entries, then click Merge.  
6. To split a previously merged set of cascade switches, click the checkbox to the left of the entry,  
then click Split.  
7. Click Next. The Operation in Progress window will open, followed by the Completed  
Successful window.  
8. Click Finish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
125  
CHAPTER  
Managing Units  
10  
This chapter describes how to manage unit properties and settings, access rights and local account  
settings, and how to view unit asset and usage reports.  
Unit Properties  
A user with access rights may change the following properties for a unit:  
Overview - Specify the type and icon for a target device.  
Identity - May be helpful for quickly identifying information about a unit.  
Location (site, department and location) - May be helpful for identifying where a unit is. See  
Contacts - Identify the primary and secondary contacts may be helpful for quickly identifying  
the people to notify if an issue or question arises about a particular unit.  
Custom fields - Three custom fields are available, in which you may specify any information  
you wish. For example, you may wish to define custom fields such as Program Manager,  
Building Number and so on. See Custom Fields on page 189.  
Notes.  
Network.  
You may specify which properties display in a Units View window by using the Customize link.  
You may change the overview, location, contacts, custom fields, notes and the DSView 3 server for  
one or more units in one operation. This may be helpful when you want to assign the same  
properties to several units.  
To change overview information for one or more target devices:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the checkbox next to one or more target devices. To change overview  
information for all target devices in the page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top  
of the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
126  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Unit Overview.  
4. Enter a new type for the target devices.  
5. Select a new icon for the target devices using the arrows.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open. If you added a type that  
was not previously defined, it will appear under Target Devices in the side navigation bar.  
To change the identity properties for a unit:  
NOTE: Identity properties are visual representations only. Defining incorrect information may cause confusion  
(for example, mistyping a serial number).  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on the  
appliance or target device name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar. The Unit Identification Properties window will  
open. To change information, type a part number, serial number, model number and/or asset  
tag number.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the location properties for a unit:  
NOTE: Location properties are visual representations only. Defining incorrect information may cause confusion  
(for example, a mistyped room number).  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on the  
appliance or target device name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Location in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Location Properties window will open.  
3. Type or use the menus to select the site, department and/or location for the unit.  
4. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the location properties for one or more units from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit(s). To change location properties for all units in the page, click the checkbox to  
the left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page contains units that do not support location  
properties, they will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Location.  
4. Type or use the menus to specify the site, department and/or location for the units.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the contact properties for a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on the  
appliance or target device name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
127  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Contacts in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Contacts window will open. Type the names and phone numbers of the primary and  
secondary contacts.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the contact properties for one or more units from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit(s). To change contact properties for all units in the page, click the checkbox to  
the left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page contains units that do not support contact  
properties, they will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open.  
To change the primary contact information, click Primary Contact. Type names and phone  
numbers for the primary contact.  
To change the secondary contact information, click Secondary Contact. Type names and  
phone numbers for the secondary contact.  
4. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the custom fields for a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on the  
appliance or target device name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, then click Custom Fields in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Custom Fields window will open. To change information, type the information in  
each of the three custom fields.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the custom fields for one or more units from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit(s). To change custom fields for all units in the page, click the checkbox to the  
left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page contains units that do not support custom fields,  
they will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Custom Fields.  
4. Type the information in each of the three custom fields.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the note properties for a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on the  
appliance or target device name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
128  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Notes in the side navigation bar. The  
Unit Notes window will open. Type description, accounting and comment information.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the note properties for one or more units from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit(s). To change note properties for all units in the page, click the checkbox to the  
left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page contains units that do not support note properties,  
they will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Notes.  
4. Type description, accounting and comment information.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the network properties for a target device:  
NOTE: Defining incorrect information for these properties may cause network connection errors.  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the target device name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Network in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Network Properties window will open.  
Type the address or the fully qualified domain name for the target device.  
Type the Telnet port number to use for Telnet connections to the target device. If this field  
is left blank, Telnet will not be enabled for the target device.  
Type the URL for a web browser connection to the target device.  
Select the DSView 3 server that is in charge of the target device.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the network properties for a managed appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98)  
click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Network in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Network Properties window will open.  
Type the address or the fully qualified domain name.  
If you are changing the appliance IP address, you should first change it in the Appliance  
Network Settings window before changing it in the Unit Network Properties window. See  
Select the DSView 3 server in charge of the managed appliance.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
129  
To change the DSView 3 server network property for one or more units from a Units  
View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the unit(s). To change the DSView 3 server property for all units in the page, click the  
checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page contains units that do not support  
note properties, they will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Network. Select the DSView 3 server in  
charge of the units.  
4. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the network properties for an EVR1500 environmental monitor or  
generic appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Network in the side navigation bar.  
The Unit Network Properties window will open.  
Type the address or the fully qualified domain name.  
Type a Telnet port number.  
Type a web browser address.  
Select the DSView 3 server in charge of the EVR1500 environmental monitor or  
generic appliance.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
About Access Rights  
Access rights indicate which users and user groups may access units in the DSView 3 software  
system. Access rights also indicate which actions are allowed.  
For target devices, you may specify whether a user or members of a user group are allowed to:  
View the unit in a Units View window (this right is enabled automatically if any other access  
right for the target device is enabled)  
Establish viewer sessions (Video Viewer or serial, as supported on the device)  
Control target device power  
Establish virtual media sessions to target devices (since virtual media sessions are launched  
from a Video Viewer session, if you select this option, you should also select Establish  
Viewer Sessions)  
Establish reserved virtual media sessions to target devices (since virtual media sessions are  
launched from a Video Viewer session, if you select this option, you should also select  
Establish Viewer Sessions)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
130  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Configure unit settings - see Target Device Settings on page 135  
View data logging - this access right can be set only for target devices connected to appliances  
that support data logging; see Data Logging beginning on page 167  
For certain managed appliances, you may specify whether a user or members of a user group are  
allowed to:  
View the appliance in Units View windows (this right is enabled automatically if any other  
access right for the managed appliance is enabled)  
Reboot appliance and disconnect sessions - see Rebooting on page 285 and Active Sessions on  
Flash upgrade appliance - see Upgrading firmware on page 285  
Configure appliance local user accounts - see Local Account Settings on page 140 (this option  
will not appear for managed appliances that do not support local user accounts)  
View data logging - this access right can be set only for appliances that support data logging;  
For example, you may allow users to configure settings on a managed appliance, but not allow  
them to reboot and disconnect sessions on it. Instead, you may allow a user who has appliance  
administrator privileges on the target devices to establish a Video Viewer session, but not allow  
that user to perform power control operations. Access rights may also be specified for all units in  
the DSView 3 software system or for a specific unit.  
By default, supported embedded units have the same access rights as generic units.  
About target device access rights  
When you assign access rights to a target device, any available session types may be selected, even  
if the target device does not support them. For example, you may enable Video Viewer and virtual  
media sessions to a target device that is attached to a serial console appliance, which does not  
support virtual media. The target device access rights are not based on the valid type of connection  
to that target device - the ability to establish a particular session type exists only when the target  
device (through its managed appliance) supports it. Using the above example, if the target device  
that was attached to the serial console appliance was later moved to a managed appliance that  
supported virtual media sessions, the target device could then be accessed by that method.  
Each access right is independent of other access rights. For example, you may enable virtual media  
session access to a target device that supports it, but not enable KVM (Video Viewer) session  
access to that target device. Since a virtual media session is launched from a KVM session, that  
user would, in fact, not be able to open a virtual media session with that target device. The access  
right only indicates that the user is allowed to perform the operation; it does not mean that the  
operation can actually be performed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
131  
How access rights can be assigned  
There are several ways you may assign access rights.  
You may assign access control rights from a unit perspective. From this perspective, you select  
one or more units, specify the users/user groups for which rights will be assigned, then allow/  
deny the permission to perform the action for each user/user group. See Unit Access Rights on  
You may also assign access control rights from a unit group perspective. This is similar to  
assigning access control rights for a unit, except all units that belong to the selected unit group  
You may also assign access control rights from a user perspective. You select a user account,  
specify the units for which rights will be assigned, then indicate the permission to perform the  
action (none, allow, deny or inherit) for each unit. See User Access Rights on page 211.  
You may assign access control rights from a user group perspective. This is similar to  
assigning access control rights for a user, except all users who are members of the selected user  
group will be affected. See User Group Access Rights on page 220.  
Unit Access Rights  
DSView 3 software administrators may assign unit access rights.  
To add or remove access rights from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98):  
To add/remove access to one or more units, click the checkboxes next to the units, and  
then click Rights.  
To add/remove access to all units on the page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the  
top of the list, and then click Rights.  
2. The Unit Access Rights window will open. To add or remove a user or user group from the  
Access Rights Assignment list, click Edit List. The Unit Access Rights User Selection window  
will open.  
To add one or more users or user groups, select the users or user groups from the Available  
list, then click Add. The users and/or user groups will be moved to the List to Update list.  
To remove one or more users or user groups, select the users or user groups from the List  
to Update list, then click Remove. The users and user groups will be moved to the  
Available list.  
Click OK. The Unit Access Rights window will contain the current list of users/user groups.  
When a user/user group is added to the list, default access rights will be displayed.  
3. To set access rights, select a user or user group from the User and User Groups list, then enable  
or disable a checkbox in the Access Rights table for each access right.  
Allow - the access right is allowed for the user/group.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
132  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Deny - the access right is denied for the user/group.  
Inherit - the access right is inherited from the unit group(s) to which the selected user/  
group belongs. When Inherit is selected, the Allow and Deny checkboxes will become  
gray and unchangeable, and indicate the inherited value. If the inherited settings indicated  
both Allow and Deny, the inherited value is Deny, which takes precedence.  
To disable the inherit functionality, uncheck the Inherit checkbox.  
If none of the checkboxes are checked, the access right is neither allowed nor denied.  
4. Repeat the preceding step to change access rights for other users/user groups.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Managed Appliance Network, Authentication Server and  
Version Settings  
To change the network settings of a managed appliance:  
NOTE: The MAC address cannot be changed.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Network. The Appliance  
Network Settings window will open. To change information:  
Type an IP address, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
If you change the appliance IP address in the Appliance Network Settings window, you  
must then also change the address in the Unit Network Properties window. See Unit  
Properties on page 125. (When changing an IP address, always change it in the Appliance  
Network Settings window before changing it in the Unit Network Properties window.)  
Type a subnet, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
Type a gateway, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).  
Specify a LAN speed. This network setting will not appear for CPS appliances.  
Enable or disable DHCP or BootP (KVM switches).  
Enable or disable ICMP ping reply.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the IP addresses of DSView 3 servers used for managed  
appliance authentication:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Authentication Servers. The  
Appliance Authentication Servers Settings window will open. To change information, type an  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
133  
IP address, in standard dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), for up to four DSView 3 servers the  
managed appliance will use for authentication.  
3. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To display version information for one or more managed appliances from a Units  
View window:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the checkbox next to the unit(s). To display information about all units in the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Show Versions from the drop-down menu.  
3. A Multiple Unit Operation window will open, containing a link to view results; see Multiple  
The results window includes the unit name, type and when the version information  
retrieval began.  
The Appliance Version field will contain the main firmware version; if a unit did not or cannot  
report a firmware version, dashes are displayed.  
The Boot Version field contains the boot firmware version. If a unit does not support a boot  
version but has an appliance version, N/A will be displayed. Dashes will be displayed if a unit  
does not support either appliance or boot firmware.  
The Status field indicates the result of the display (for example, Show Versions complete or  
Show Versions not supported).  
To display version information for a managed appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on an appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then Versions. The Appliance Version  
Information window will open, containing the following information:  
For KVM switches - application, boot and video FPGA  
May also include application, boot, video FPGA, matrix FPGA, UART FPGA, digital/  
application, digital/digitizer, digital/FPGA and OSCAR FPGA  
For serial console appliances - bootstrap and application versions  
3. Click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Managed Appliance SNMP Settings  
This procedure is valid for supported KVM switches and serial console appliances. It may also be  
valid for appliances supported by a plug-in; see the appropriate documentation.  
The SNMP protocol is used to communicate management information between network  
management applications and DSView 3 software managed appliances using TCP/IP and IPX  
®
protocols. Other external SNMP managers (such as Tivoli and HP OpenView) may communicate  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
134  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
with your managed appliances by accessing MIB-II (Management Information Base) and the  
public portion of the enterprise MIB. MIB-II is a standard MIB that many SNMP target devices  
support. The managed appliances will send their traps directly to the external SNMP manager in  
addition to sending it to the server.  
The following settings appear under SNMP in the side navigation bar:  
System - Enables/disables SNMP. When you enable SNMP, the managed appliance will log  
SNMP received messages over UDP (User Datagram Protocol) port 161. UDP port 162 is used  
to listen for incoming traps.  
Managers - Stations that can manage the managed appliance.  
Community - Communities to which the traps belong.  
Destinations - Stations that can receive SNMP traps.  
Traps - Available traps and enabled/disabled traps.  
The traps must be also configured on each managed appliance using the Command Line Interface  
(CLI). The address of the server running the DSView 3 software must be configured as a trap  
recipient, the proper community must be set and each desired trap must be enabled.  
SNMP traps are logged in the event log file. See Displaying the Event Log on page 313. SNMP  
traps may also be configured from a system task. See Task: Configure SNMP trap settings on a  
To change SNMP settings for a managed appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click SNMP in the side navigation  
bar. The Appliance SNMP System Settings window will open.  
3. To enable SNMP, select Enabled in the Enable SNMP menu. If desired, change the name and  
description of the managed appliance and type a contact. Then, click Save.  
4. To enable SNMP manager settings, click Managers in the side navigation bar. The Appliance  
SNMP Manager Settings window will open. Type the IP addresses, in standard dot notation  
(xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), for up to four SNMP managers. Then, click Save.  
5. To specify SNMP community settings, click Community in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance SNMP Community Settings window will open. Type the SNMP community names  
for reading, writing and SNMP traps. Then, click Save.  
6. To specify SNMP destination settings, click Destinations in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance SNMP Destination Settings window will open. Type the IP addresses, in standard  
dot notation (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx), for up to four SNMP destinations. Then, click Save.  
7. To enable or disable SNMP traps, click Traps in the side navigation bar. The Appliance SNMP  
Trap Settings window will open. Select one of the following:  
Enabled turns a trap on; Disabled turns a trap off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
135  
Enable All turns all traps on; Disable All turns all traps off.  
8. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Target Device Settings  
For information about power device settings, see Power Devices on page 147.  
To display a list of target devices that are attached to a managed appliance or  
initiate a push/pull name operation:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of an appliance.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, then click Target Devices.  
3. The Target Devices window will open.  
4. To initiate a pull or push name operation (see Name Synchronization on page 115), click the  
checkboxes to the left of one or more device names. To select all names on the page, click the  
box to the left of Appliance Name at the top of the list.  
For a pull operation, click Pull Name.  
For a push operation, click Push Name.  
Customizing the Target Devices window  
The following fields may be displayed in the Target Devices window. Use the Customize link to  
add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Name in Appliance - Name of the target device in the appliance.  
Name in DSView - Name of the target device in the DSView 3 software database.  
Connection - Connection path to the target device in the appliance.  
To change the appliance name for a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances, click on the name of an appliance.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, then click Target Devices.  
3. The Target Devices window will open. Click on a target device name.  
4. Change the appliance name for the target device. If the automatic name pull feature is enabled,  
Target Device Services  
You may add or remove support on a target device for third party services such as Terminal  
Services and VNC. Before adding support for a service, the service must be properly installed and  
configured on the target device.  
Once support for a service has been added, you can launch a session for that service using  
several methods:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
136  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Clicking the name or icon for the service in the target device’s Unit Overview window.  
Selecting the session link for that service in the Action field’s Alternate Action menu in Units  
View windows that list that target device.  
Clicking the Action field in the Unit Services window for that service.  
Service options may include actions to be performed if a problem is detected with the service. This  
may include automatically launching a KVM session, prompting the user or no action.  
To add support for services on a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on a target device name.  
2. In the side navigation bar, click Properties, then click Services. The Unit Services window will  
open, listing the services that are supported.  
3. Click Add. The Add Service Wizard will appear.  
4. If the target device does not have an address in the DSView 3 software database, you will be  
prompted to enter it. After you enter the name, click Next.  
5. The Select the Procedure window will open. You may add support for the service either by  
discovery of services running on the target device or by selecting from all available services.  
Enable the radio button for adding with discovery or without discovery, then click Next.  
If you chose to add a service by discovery, a Request in Progress display will appear before the  
next window opens.  
6. The Select Service window will open. Select the services from the Available Services (or  
Services Found) list, then click Add. The selected services will be moved to the Services to  
Assign list.  
To remove services from the Services to Assign list, select the services, then click Remove.  
The selected services will be moved to the Available Services (or Services Found) list.  
Click Next.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Close.  
To change service options:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on a target device name.  
2. In the side navigation bar, click Properties, then click Services. The Unit Services window  
will open.  
3. Click on a service name.  
4. Enable the radio buttons to enable options, then click Save.  
To remove support for a service on a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on a target device name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
137  
2. In the side navigation bar, click Properties, then click Services. The Unit Services window will  
open, listing the services that are supported.  
3. Click the checkbox next to the services to be removed. To remove all services on the page,  
click the checkbox to the left of Service at the top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
IQ Module Settings  
IQ modules are connected to supported KVM switches.  
To display IQ module information:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then click IQ Modules in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance IQ Modules window will open. This window lists all modules with their EID,  
status, port number, application version, hardware version, interface type and USB speed.  
3. To display an individual module’s settings, click on an IQ module. The Appliance IQ Module  
Settings window will open.  
To delete offline IQ modules:  
NOTE: Any offline module will have a red circle and an “X” to the left of its EID. An online module will have a  
green circle to the left of its EID.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then click IQ Modules in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance IQ Modules window will open.  
3. Click Delete Offline. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
To upgrade IQ modules:  
NOTE: Offline IQ modules may not be selected for upgrading.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances, click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then click IQ Modules in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance IQ Modules window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the IQ modules you wish to upgrade. To select all IQ modules  
on the page, click the checkbox to the left of EID at the top of the list.  
4. Click Upgrade. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the upgrade.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
138  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If the upgrade is confirmed, a yellow LED icon will appear to the left of the upgrading modules.  
You may click on the name of an IQ module in the EID column to display its upgrade status in the  
Appliance Settings - Ports - IQ Modules - Settings window. When the upgrade is completed, a  
green circle will appear next to the modules and they may once again be selected.  
To set the USB speed for IQ modules:  
NOTE: The USB speed may only be set for supported USB2 and PS2M IQ modules.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances, click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then click IQ Modules in the side navigation bar. The  
Appliance IQ Modules window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the IQ modules you wish to modify. To select all IQ modules  
on the page, click the checkbox to the left of EID at the top of the list.  
NOTE: If any IQ module in the list is not supported, the set USB speed buttons will be disabled.  
4. Click Set USB 1.1 Speed or Set USB 2.0 Speed. The USB speed for the selected IQ modules  
will be set.  
KVM Switch and Cascade Switch Settings  
For information about the SPC ports and managing power devices, see Power Devices on  
To merge or split multi-user cascade switches from the same appliance, see Merging or  
To display cascade switch port settings and initiate a push/pull name operation:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar. Click Ports and then click Cascade  
Switches. The Appliance Cascade Switches window will open.  
3. To initiate a pull or push name operation (see Name Synchronization on page 115), click the  
checkboxes to the left of one or more device name(s). To select all names on the page, click the  
box to the left of Appliance Name at the top of the list.  
For a pull operation, click Pull Name.  
For a push operation, click Push Name.  
To change the name in appliance for a cascade switch:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar. Click Ports and then click Cascade  
Switches. The Appliance Cascade Switches window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
139  
3. Click on a cascade switch name. The Cascade Switch Settings window will open.  
4. Change the name in the appliance. If the automatic name pull feature is enabled, see Automatic  
name pull on page 117 for the effect.  
5. If you changed the appliance name, click Save.  
6. Click Close when you are finished.  
To change the Name in DSView for a cascade switch:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances and using the topology feature (see Accessing  
Units View windows on page 98 and Topology view on page 96), click on the name of a cascade  
switch. The Unit Overview window will open.  
2. In the Name field, change the name that will be used in the DSView 3 software.  
3. If the cascade switch is uniquely identified (for example, a power device or an AutoView 2000  
switch), that type will automatically be entered in the Type field and cannot be changed.  
If the appliance cannot uniquely identify the cascade switch type, the Type field will include a  
list of compatible units from which you may choose. A compatible unit will have at least as  
many inputs and outputs as the DSView 3 software indicates in its database for the  
cascade switch.  
For example, if the DSView 3 software database indicates the cascade switch has more than  
one connection to the same appliance, only switches with two or more inputs will be included  
in the list. The target side ports are also checked; if a cascade switch has a target device on port  
14, only types that support 14 or more ports will be displayed.  
4. Click Save and then click Close.  
You may also change the name of a cascade switch in the DSView 3 software database by using the  
Merge Cascade Switch wizard; see Merging or splitting cascade switches on page 124.  
You may also change cascade device properties (identity, location, contacts, custom fields and  
notes) by clicking the property in the side navigation bar. These windows operate identically to  
To change local OSCAR interface authentication settings:  
NOTE: This procedure is valid for the following managed appliances: all DSR switches except the DSR800,  
1161, 2161 and 4160 switches.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the DSR switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, then click Ports and then click OSCAR.  
The Appliance OSCAR Settings window will open.  
3. Click Disable OSCAR Authentication to prevent the supported DSR switch from performing  
internal or external authentication. If the Disable OSCAR Authentication checkbox is not  
selected, the supported DSR switch will attempt external authentication using the list of  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
140  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
authentication servers that reside in the switch. If the authentication fails, the supported DSR  
switch will use its internal user tables.  
4. Specify a preemption level for the DSR switch (1-4).  
5. The Long Name Display Mode is used when cascade switch or target device names contain  
more than 15 characters. Select the radio button to specify whether the OSCAR interface will  
display the first 15 characters or the last 15 characters.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change modem port settings:  
NOTE: This procedure is valid for the following managed appliances: DSR1020, 1021, 1022, 1024, 1030, 2020,  
2030, 2035, 4020, 4030, 8020, 8030 and 8035 switches.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the DSR switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Ports and then click  
Modems. The Appliance Modem Settings window will open.  
3. Select Modem sessions can preempt digital sessions to enable a modem session to disconnect  
an existing Ethernet connection to the DSR switch.  
4. Type an authentication time-out for the modem in the range of 30-300 seconds.  
5. Type an inactivity time-out for the modem connection in the range of 1-60 minutes.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Local Account Settings  
This procedure is valid on KVM switches and serial console appliances that support local accounts.  
Local accounts allow a user to log in to a managed appliance locally if it has a server configured as  
an authentication server. You may assign the user administrator, appliance administrator or user  
level to a local user. See Built-in User Groups on page 37.  
You must have Configure Local Accounts rights to add, modify or delete local user accounts. See  
To display the Appliance Local User Accounts window:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Local Accounts. The  
Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
To change access control method for local user accounts:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
141  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, click Local Accounts and then Settings.  
The Appliance Local User Access Method window will open.  
3. Enable the Port or Port group radio button.  
4. Click Save.  
Customizing the Appliance Local User Accounts window  
The preemption level and access level fields may be displayed in the Appliance Local User  
Accounts window. Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the display. See Using the  
To add a local user account:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, click Local Accounts and then Users. The  
Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Local User Account Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Type in Local User Credentials window will open.  
a. Type the name of the local user account.  
b. Type a password for the local user account.  
c. Confirm the password for the local user account.  
d. Click Next.  
5. The Select Preemption Level window will open. Select a preemption level (1-4) for the local  
user. This will be used for KVM, serial and virtual media sessions. (See Preemption Levels on  
page 38.) Click Next.  
6. The Select Access Level window will open. Select an access level from the menu: Appliance  
Administrator, User or User Administrator. (DSR1010, DSR2010 and DSR4010 switches  
support local accounts, but the Appliance Administrator access level cannot be changed, so  
this menu will not appear for these switches.)  
7. Click Next.  
If you selected User, go to step 8.  
If you selected Appliance Administrator or User Administrator, go to step 9.  
8. The Assign target devices window will open. Add or remove user access rights to a  
target device:  
a. To add user access rights to one or more target devices, select the target device(s) in the  
Available Target Devices list, then click Add. The target devices will be moved to the  
Assigned Target Devices list.  
b. To delete user access rights to one or more target devices, select the target device(s) in the  
Assigned Target Devices list, then click Remove. The target devices will be moved to the  
Available Target Devices list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
142  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
9. Click Next. The Completed Successful window will open.  
10. Click Finish. The Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
To delete a local user account:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Local Accounts. The  
Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the local usernames to be deleted. To delete all local user  
accounts, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
To change the settings of a local user account:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Local Accounts. The  
Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a local user account. The Appliance Local User Account Settings  
window will open.  
4. Type a new name for the local user.  
5. Select a preemption level (1-4) for the local user. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
6. If available, select an access level: User Administrator, Appliance Administrator or User.  
7. Type a new password for the local account and then confirm the password.  
8. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliances window will open.  
To change target device access rights to a local account:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Local Accounts. The  
Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a local account. The Appliance Local User Account Settings window will  
open. (If the local user has Configure Local Accounts rights, a message will indicate that the  
local user may access all target devices in the system.)  
4. For all managed appliances except CCM appliances: click Access Rights in the side navigation  
bar. The Appliance Local User Account Access Rights window will open.  
To add local user account access to one or more target devices, select the target device(s)  
in the Available Target Devices list. Click Add. The target devices will be moved to the  
Assigned Target Devices list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
143  
To remove local user account access to one or more target devices, select the target  
device(s) in the Assigned Target Devices list. Click Remove. The target devices will be  
moved to the Available Target Devices list.  
5. For CCM appliances:  
To change local user account access by port, click Access Rights in the side navigation bar  
and then Port. Select the ports in the Available list and then click Add. The selected ports  
will be moved to the Assigned list.  
To change local user account access by group, click Access Rights in the side navigation  
bar and then Group. Select the groups in the Available list and then click Add. The  
selected groups will be moved to the Assigned list.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance Local User Accounts window will open.  
Embedded Units  
The IBM ASM RSA II and the DRAC 4 embedded units have one target port and one appliance for  
each embedded appliance.  
The NEC IPF embedded unit has nine target ports and one appliance for each embedded appliance.  
Port names default to “Blade” plus the port number.  
The HP iLO embedded unit has one target device.  
In the DSView 3 software, each of these appliance types will contain specific information about the  
target as well as the embedded appliance itself. All KVM connections are initiated through the  
target port/device.  
After an embedded appliance type is added to the DSView 3 software, an appliance type is added  
under the Appliances link in the side navigation bar.  
Updating firmware, changing device settings and rebooting embedded units must be done  
manually. See the embedded unit documentation for further information.  
Launching embedded unit sessions  
From the Target Devices window, users may launch a KVM or browser session to the embedded  
devices. Each session is handled by the embedded unit and is launched in a separate window  
browser. HP iLO, NEC IPF, IBM ASM RSA II and DRAC 4 viewers are proprietary to their  
owners, and the DSView 3 software has little control of their look, feel and configuration.  
There is no status polling for these sessions (status is idle by default); nor are there connection  
types. All embedded KVM browsers have their own certificate authentication. Users must accept  
certificate authentication to launch embedded unit video sessions.  
Users must manually close the window to close a session. In all cases, exiting or logging out of the  
DSView 3 software will not shut the KVM/browser session.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
144  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The DRAC 4 KVM session launches a standalone launch browser which in turn launches a  
KVM applet. To leave the session, the user must exit the KVM session applet and the  
standalone launch browser.  
The IBM ASM RSA II KVM session launches a KVM session applet within a browser. To  
leave the session, users must exit the KVM browser session.  
The NEC IPF KVM session launches a standalone KVM session applet. To leave the session,  
users must exit the standalone KVM session.  
The HP iLO session will launch a browser session to the login page of the embedded device  
server. Users must log in to the web server to access the target device’s KVM session. To leave  
the session, users must exit the KVM browser session.  
See the embedded units’ documentation for further information.  
Changing embedded unit credentials  
You may change the login credentials for the IBM ASM RSA II, DRAC 4 and NEC IPF  
embedded units.  
To change login credentials for an IBM ASM RSA II embedded appliance:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Appliances in the side navigation bar, and then click on the appliance type in the side  
navigation bar.  
3. Click on the embedded appliance name.  
4. Click the Credentials link in the side navigation bar and then click Credentials in the side  
   
Chapter 10: Managing Units  
145  
5. The DELL DRAC4 Settings window will open. To change information:  
In the Appliance Name field, type a 1-64 character appliance name. The name is not  
case sensitive.  
In the Port field, type a TCP port number in the range 0-65535 where the appliance  
will listen.  
In the Username field, type a 1-64 character username to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Usernames are case sensitive.  
In the Password field, type a 1-64 character password to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Passwords are case sensitive.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
To change login credentials for an NEC IPF embedded appliance:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Appliances in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click the embedded appliance name.  
4. Click the Credentials link in the side navigation bar and then click Credentials in the side  
navigation bar.  
5. The NEC IPF Settings window will open. To change information:  
In the Name field, type a 1-64 character appliance name. The name is not case sensitive.  
In the Username field, type a 1-64 character username to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Usernames are case sensitive.  
In the Password field, type a 1-64 character password to be used to log in to the embedded  
appliance. Passwords are case sensitive.  
Click Save and then click Close.  
Asset and Usage Reports  
NOTE: To view Asset and Usage Reports, Adobe® Flash Player version 9.0 or later must be installed on your  
client workstation. The DSView 3 software will prompt you to install Flash Player if needed; or you can visit  
www.adobe.com to download and install the player.  
You can view Asset and Usage reports as a pie chart, bar chart or table by clicking the appropriate  
button. If multiple charts are tiled on the screen, you can change the size of the charts by dragging  
the triangle on the Size bar to the right or left.  
Asset  
To view Asset reports:  
1. Click the Reports tab, then click Asset in the top navigation bar.  
2. Select one of the following reports in the side navigation bar:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
146  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Appliance Models - Displays the number of units for each appliance model the user has  
added to the DSView 3 software.  
Port Types - Displays the number of ports for each type of port connected to the DSView 3  
software. Port types include KVM (Keyboard Video Mouse), Serial, Power, SPC (an  
Avocent power control device), SoL (Serial over LAN) and LDSM (LANDesk  
Server Manager).  
Appliance Versions - Displays the firmware version(s) for each appliance model managed  
by the DSView 3 software.  
Usage  
To view Usage reports:  
1. Click the Reports tab, then click Usage in the top navigation bar.  
2. Select one of the following reports in the side navigation bar:  
Sessions Per Day - Displays the number of sessions opened to a target device from the  
DSView 3 software each day during the last seven days.  
Frequently Accessed Targets - Displays the number of sessions opened from the DSView  
3 software for each target device during the last seven days.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
147  
CHAPTER  
Power Devices and Power  
Device Sockets  
11  
See Power devices on page 7 for information about the power device types and models that are  
supported on Avocent appliances. See Licenses on page 50 for information about third party power  
device licenses.  
Power Devices  
To display a list of power devices attached to an appliance or initiate a push/pull  
name operation:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Ports and then click Power  
device. The Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open. (For DSR switches that  
have two SPC ports, one row will appear for each power device.)  
3. To initiate a pull or push name operation (see Name Synchronization on page 115), click the  
checkboxes to the left of one or more device name(s). To select all names on the page, click the  
box to the left of Appliance Name at the top of the list.  
For a pull operation, click Pull Name.  
For a push operation, click Push Name.  
Customizing the Power Devices Attached to Appliance window  
The display fields and content of the Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will differ  
according to the power device type and models. For details, see the product documentation. Use the  
Customize link to add or remove fields in the display; see Using the Customize link in windows on  
The following fields are always displayed, regardless of the power device type and model.  
Name in Appliance - Name of the power device in the appliance  
Name in DSView - Name of the power device in the DSView 3 software database  
Status  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
148  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
     
Chapter 11: Power Devices and Power Device Sockets  
149  
5. Click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Upgrading the firmware of a Cyclades power device  
You may upgrade the firmware of a Cyclades power device attached to a DSR switch. There are  
two ways to do this:  
In the Select Task to Add window, select Upgrade firmware of selected units.  
In the Select Unit Type window, you may select by product family (Cyclades Power  
Devices) or unit type (specific power device types)  
If multiple power devices are installed in a daisy chain configuration, the most remote power  
device will be upgraded first.  
Power Device Input Feed  
The ability to display and change power device input feed information is currently supported on  
Avocent SPC power control devices, Server Technology power devices and Cyclades PM  
Intelligent Power Distribution Units (IPDU).  
To display power device input feed information:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, click Ports and then Power device in the  
side navigation bar. The Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open. (For DSR  
switches that have two SPC ports, one row will appear for each power device.)  
3. Click on the name of a power device.  
4. Click Input Feeds in the side navigation bar. The Power Device Input Feeds window will open.  
Customizing the Power Device Input Feeds window  
The following fields may be displayed in the Power Device Input Feeds window. For detailed field  
descriptions, see the product documentation. Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the  
Input Feed Name  
Status - Unknown, on, off, cycling, pending off, pending on, pending cycle or no status  
Load  
Alarm Threshold - a trap will be sent if the Load value reaches the Alarm Threshold value  
Load Max - a trap will be sent if the Load value is greater than the Load Max value  
Load Min - a trap will be sent if the Load value is less than the Load Min value  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
150  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To change power device input feed information:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then Power devices in the side navigation bar. The  
Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a power device.  
4. Click Input Feeds in the side navigation bar. The Power Device Input Feeds window will open.  
5. Click on an input feed name. The Power Device Input Feed Settings window will open. Some  
fields are read-only. For fields that can be modified, enter or select new values.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Power Device Sockets window will open.  
7. Click Close. The Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open.  
8. Click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Power Device Sockets  
To display information about power device sockets or initiate a push/  
pull operation:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then Power devices in the side navigation bar. The  
Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a power device.  
4. Click Sockets in the side navigation bar. The Power Device Sockets window will open.  
If you change the IP address of a managed appliance that is attached to a power device, the  
appliance may need rebooting. In this case, a Reboot Required icon will be displayed in the top  
left corner of the Power Device Sockets window. Click the icon to reboot the  
managed appliance.  
5. To initiate a pull or push name operation (see Name Synchronization on page 115):  
a. Click the checkboxes to the left of one or more device name(s). To select all names on the  
page, click the box to the left of Appliance Name at the top of the list.  
b. For a pull operation, click Pull Name.  
c. For a push operation, click Push Name.  
Customizing the Power Device Sockets window  
The display fields and content of the Power Device Sockets window will differ according to the  
power device type and models. For details, see the product documentation. Use the Customize link  
to add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
The following fields are always displayed, regardless of the power device type and model.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 11: Power Devices and Power Device Sockets  
151  
Socket - Socket (outlet) number.  
Appliance Name - Name of the power device socket in the appliance.  
Unit Name - Name of the power device socket in the DSView 3 software database.  
To change power device socket settings:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, click Ports and then Power device in the  
side navigation bar. The Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a power device.  
4. Click Sockets in the side navigation bar. The Power Device Sockets window will open.  
5. Click on a power device socket. The Power Device Socket Settings window will open.  
Some fields are read-only. For fields that can be modified, enter or select new values. (If you  
change the appliance name and the automatic name pull feature is enabled, see Automatic  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Power Device Sockets window will open.  
7. Click Close. The Power Devices Attached to Appliance window will open.  
8. Click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Power Control of Devices Attached to Power Devices  
There are several ways to power up, power down or power cycle a target device that is attached to a  
power device socket.  
From a Power Device Sockets window - see the procedure in this section  
From a Units View window containing power devices - see the procedure in this section  
From the DSR Remote Operations software - see Power control of devices attached to power  
To control power from a Power Device Sockets window:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar, click Ports and then Power device in the  
     
152  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
5. Click the checkbox to the left of the power device socket(s). To select all sockets on the page,  
click the checkbox to the left of Socket at the top of the list.  
6. Click On, Off or Cycle to power up, power down or power cycle (off and then on) the selected  
power device sockets. The Power field for the selected sockets will reflect the state.  
7. For certain power device types and models, administrators may also lock or unlock a socket’s  
current state by clicking Lock or Unlock. This sets the control field of the selected socket(s) to  
the specified value; users other than administrators cannot change the state. The default value  
is Unlock.  
To control power from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window containing power devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the checkbox next to the power device(s). To select all power devices in the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list. (If any of the selected units  
are not power devices, the operation will be ignored for them.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Wall Power On, Wall Power Off or Wall Power Cycle from the  
drop-down menu.  
3. A Multiple Unit Operation window will open, containing a link to view results; see Multiple  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
153  
CHAPTER  
Unit Sessions and Connections  
12  
This chapter describes how to view and manage unit sessions and connections.  
Managed Appliance Session Settings  
From the Appliance Sessions window, you may display session information and change appliance  
session settings.  
Exit macros may be used by and reside on certain switches.  
Customizing the Appliance Sessions window  
The following fields may be displayed in the Appliance Sessions window for managed appliances.  
Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in  
Duration - Length of the DSView 3 software session.  
User - Name of user who initiated the DSView 3 software session.  
(KVM switches that support virtual media) Type - Session type: KVM or Virtual Media.  
(KVM switches that support virtual media) Lock Status - When there is a KVM and a virtual  
media session to the same target device and the appliance setting Virtual Media Locked to  
KVM Session is enabled, Locked will be displayed in this field.  
(KVM switches) Channel - Channel being used by the managed appliance to connect to the  
DSView 3 software session.  
(KVM switches) Client - Proxy address if the proxy is enabled.  
(KVM switches) IQ Module - EID of the target device IQ module.  
(KVM switches) Mode - Mode of the session, which may change during the session. Available  
modes are:  
Normal - An interactive session that may be shared with other users. When two or more  
users are sharing the session, the mode will change to Sharing Interactive.  
Exclusive - A private session that does not allow sharing by other users.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
154  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Sharing Interactive - A session that is being shared by two or more users. Interactive users  
have full control of the video, mouse and keyboard. Passive users may also share the  
session, but may only display the session and have a mode of Sharing Passive.  
A user may display the usernames of other users sharing the session if View identity of  
shared connections is checked in the Video Viewer Session Properties dialog box or if the  
user is a member of the administrators user group. Users viewing the session in Stealth  
mode will not be listed. If users disconnect from the session and a single user remains  
connected, the mode will change to Normal.  
Sharing Passive - A session that is being shared by two or more users. Passive users may  
only display the DSView 3 software session. Interactive users may also share the session,  
but have full control of the video, mouse and keyboard and have a state of  
Sharing Interactive.  
A user may display the usernames of other users sharing the software session if View  
identity of shared connections is checked in the Video Viewer Session Properties dialog  
box or if the user is a member of the built-in administrators user group. Users viewing the  
session in Stealth mode will not be listed. If other users disconnect from the session and a  
single user remains connected, the mode will change to Normal.  
Scan - A temporary non-exclusive DSView 3 software session that displays connected  
target devices in a thumbnail viewer.  
(KVM switches) Owner - Username of the logged in user that owns the session connected to  
the managed appliance.  
(KVM switches) Port - Managed appliance port number connected to the session.  
Preemption Level - Effective user preemption level for the user that is connected to the  
appliance port. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
(serial console appliances) Client - IP address of the DSView 3 software client computer  
connected to the appliance in a non-proxied connection. The IP address of the DSView 3 proxy  
will display in this column if the client is connected to the appliance using a proxy connection.  
(serial console appliances) Interface - Interface to which to the session is connected, which is  
either a serial port or the network CLI.  
To display session information:  
This procedure is valid for supported KVM switches and serial console appliances. It may also be  
valid for appliances supported by a plug-in; see the appropriate documentation.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Sessions. The Appliance  
Sessions window will open.  
3. To display information about a specific session, click on the name of the KVM, virtual media  
or serial session. The Active Session Information window will open, including information  
about the active session.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
155  
4. Click Close. The Appliance Sessions window will open.  
5. Click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To display or change the session settings for a serial console appliance:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the serial console appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Sessions. The Appliance  
Sessions window will open.  
3. Click Settings in the side navigation bar. The Appliance Settings - Sessions - Settings window  
will open. The display includes SSH settings for the appliance.  
4. Specify how the most recent 64K bytes of online and offline data (history) from a serial port  
will be controlled:  
Auto - Displays the history buffer content to a Telnet window.  
Hold - Saves the buffer contents. To display the contents, you must access the appliance  
CLI and issue a Port History command.  
5. Click Enable Inactivity Timeout and use the arrows to specify a value (from 1-90 minutes) that  
the managed appliance will wait during inactive intervals until the session is closed and the  
user must log back into the managed appliance.  
6. (CCM appliances only) In the Serial Session Share Mode area, enable one of the radio buttons:  
Disable, Auto or Query.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the KVM session settings for a supported KVM switch:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Sessions. The Appliance  
Sessions window will open.  
3. Click Settings in the side navigation bar and then click KVM. The Appliance KVM Session  
Settings window will open.  
4. In the Inactivity Timeout area, click Enable Inactivity Timeout and use the arrows to specify a  
time-out value (from 1-90 minutes) that the managed appliance will wait during inactive  
intervals until the session is closed and the user must log back into the managed appliance.  
5. To enable video noise compensation, click the Enable Video Noise Compensation checkbox.  
6. In the Encryption Level area, specify an encryption level for the keyboard and mouse and also  
for the video:  
DES - SSL Single DES encryption  
3DES - SSL Triple DES encryption  
®
128-Bit SSL - 128-bit encryption which used an ARCFOUR (RC4 ) SSL cipher  
AES - AES encryption  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
156  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
At least one encryption level must be specified for the keyboard and mouse. When you specify  
more than one SSL encryption type, the switch negotiates the strongest algorithm that is  
supported by both sides. The strongest algorithm is AES, followed by 128 bit, 3DES and DES.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
To change the virtual media session settings on a KVM switch:  
This procedure is valid for KVM switches that support virtual media.  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the KVM switch name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Sessions. The Appliance  
Sessions window will open.  
3. Click Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Virtual Media. The Appliance Virtual  
Media Session Settings window will open.  
4. In the Session Lock area, enable the Virtual Media locked to KVM session checkbox if you  
wish to close the virtual media session when the associated KVM session is closed. When this  
feature is disabled an active virtual media session will remain active when the associated KVM  
session is closed.  
5. In the Drive Mappings area, choose an access mode from the Virtual Media Access Mode  
menu: read-only or read-write.  
When the access mode is read-only, the user will not be able to write data to the mapped drive  
on the client machine. When the access mode is read-write, the user will be able to read and  
write data to the mapped drive.  
If the drive is a read-only drive (for example, CD/DVD drives or ISO images), the access mode  
setting will be ignored. If the drive on the client machine is read-write (for example, a mass  
storage device or USB removal media), setting read-only access mode will prevent the user  
from writing data to the client machine.  
6. In the Encryption Level area, enable one or more encryption levels for the virtual media  
session: DES, 3DES, 128-Bit SSL or AES. Any combination of selections (or no selection)  
is valid.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Defining exit macros  
Since clients are running remotely on PCs, certain commands must be sent to the controlled target  
device using keyboard macros. For example, pressing Ctrl+Alt+Delete on your keyboard resets the  
PC running the client rather than resetting the target device. To reset the target device, a macro is  
needed. The DSView 3 management software provides numerous sequences pre-configured for  
ease of operation.  
Three kinds of macros are available: personal, global and exit. Personal macros and global macros  
are created using the Video Viewer window. See Macros on page 247.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
157  
Exit macros are supported on DS1800 digital switches and the following DSR switches: DSR1010,  
1021, 1022, 1024, 1030, 1031, 2010, 2020, 2030, 2035, 4010, 4020, 4030, 8020, 8030 and  
8035 switches.  
Exit macros allow software administrators to create a macro that returns a target device to a known  
state. They reside on the managed appliances and are executed whenever a DSView 3 software  
session is terminated. For example, if a user is connected to a target device and the user closes the  
Video Viewer session, an exit macro may be executed that resets the target device to a known state  
by logging the user out of the target device session.  
Exit macros may be created and maintained by any user with Configure Unit Settings access rights.  
Different groups of exit macros may be created for each managed appliance in your system.  
To define exit macros:  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar and then click Sessions. The Appliance  
Sessions window will open.  
3. Click Exit Macros in the side navigation bar. The Appliance Exit Macros window will open.  
4. Click the number of a macro. The Appliance Exit Macro Settings window will open.  
5. Enter a unique description for the global macro in the Name field.  
6. In the Select Keyboard field, select the country configuration of your keyboard. The keyboard  
graphic in the window will update to reflect your selection.  
7. Click on the buttons in the keyboard graphic to create the macro. As a button is clicked, it will  
appear in the list box to the left of the keyboard graphic.  
You may type or use the arrow buttons to specify a delay between buttons you selected from  
the keyboard graphic. First, click the button in the list box after which you want to insert a  
delay. Then, click Delay to insert the delay in the list box.  
8. To specify one or more target devices on which you wish to use the macro, select the device(s)  
in the Available list, then click Add. The target devices will be moved to the Assigned list.  
9. To remove one or more target devices on which you wish to use the macro, select the device(s)  
from the Assigned list, then click Remove. The target devices will be moved to the  
Available list.  
10. Click Save and then click Close. The Units View window will open.  
Example: Creating a macro  
The following example creates an exit macro where the Ctrl key is held while F1-F2-F3 are typed:  
1. Type ControlF1-F2-F3 in the Name field. This is the name of the macro that will appear in the  
Appliance Exit Macros window.  
2. Click the left or right Ctrl key in the keyboard graphic in the window. Ctrl Left - PRESS or Ctrl  
Right - PRESS will appear in the list box to the left of the keyboard graphic.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
158  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. Click F1, F2 and F3 in the keyboard graphic in the window. The keystrokes will appear in the  
list box to the left of the keyboard graphic.  
4. Click the same left or right Ctrl key in the graphic that you pressed in step 2. Ctrl Left -  
RELEASE or Ctrl Right - RELEASE will appear in the list box to the left of the  
keyboard graphic.  
5. In the Assigned to Macro area, select the target devices to which you want to assign the macro.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
Active Sessions  
There are two types of active session displays: all active sessions in your system and active session  
information for each target device.  
All active sessions  
To display information about all active sessions:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Active Sessions in the side navigation bar. The Active Sessions window will open.  
3. To display information about a session, click on the name in the Start-Date-Time column. The  
Active Session Information window will open.  
4. Click Close to close the window and return to the Active Sessions window.  
Customizing the Active Sessions window for all sessions  
The Start-Date-Time field, which indicates when the target device session was started, is always  
displayed in the Active Sessions window:  
The following fields may be displayed in the Active Sessions window. Use the Customize link to  
add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Duration - Length of the DSView 3 software session.  
User - User who initiated the session, which may be a user, a local port user or a user with a  
local user account.  
Target Device - Name of the target device being used for the session.  
Type - Session type, which may be KVM, virtual media or serial.  
Client - IP address of the client computer connected to the session for a non-proxy connection.  
For a proxy connection, the IP address of the DSView 3 proxy will appear in this field.  
Connection - Connection path from the target device to the managed appliance. See  
Mode - Session mode, which may change during the session. See Customizing the Appliance  
Sessions window on page 153 for a description of the available modes.  
Owner - Name of the user who launched the session, which may be a user, a local port user or  
a user with a local user account.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
159  
Preemption Level - Effective user preemption level for the user that is connected to the target  
device session. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
To remove an active session from the (all) Active Sessions window:  
NOTE: Removing an active session from the Active Sessions window does not disconnect the session.  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Active Sessions in the side navigation bar. The Active Sessions window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the session. To remove all active sessions on the page, click  
the checkbox to the left of Start-Date-Time at the top of the list.  
4. Click Remove. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the removal.  
To disconnect an active session from an appliance window:  
This procedure is valid for supported KVM switches and serial console appliances. It may also be  
valid for appliances supported by a plug-in; see the appropriate documentation. You must have the  
Reboot Appliance and Disconnect Sessions unit access right. See About Access Rights on page 129.  
Additionally, your preemption level must be higher than the preemption level of the active session  
1. In a Units View window containing appliances (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings in the side navigation bar. Then click Sessions in the side navigation  
bar, then Active. The Appliance Sessions window will open.  
3. To disconnect one or more sessions, click the checkbox to the left of the sessions. To  
disconnect all sessions on the page, click the checkbox to the left of Start-Date-Time at the top  
of the list.  
4. Click Disconnect. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
For virtual media sessions on supported KVM switches - If you attempt to disconnect an active  
virtual media session or a KVM session that is locked to a virtual media session, a  
confirmation message is displayed, indicating that any virtual media mappings will be  
disconnected. Confirm or cancel. See Using Virtual Media on page 252.  
5. Confirm or cancel the disconnect.  
Active sessions on a target device  
To display information about active sessions on a target device:  
In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98),  
click on a target device Status field. The Active Sessions window for that target device will open.  
You may also display active session information for a target device by clicking on a target device  
name in a Units View window, which will open the Unit Overview window. Then, click Active  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
160  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Sessions in the side navigation bar, and the Active Sessions window for that target device will  
open. The first method above saves a step.  
Customizing a target device Active Sessions window  
The following fields are always displayed in the Active Sessions window.  
Duration - Elapsed time since the session started, in hours:minutes:seconds.  
User - Name of current user. This field will be blank for users who do not have Appliance  
Administrator or User Administrator access rights when the Video Viewer session property  
“view identity of shared connections” is not set. See Video Viewer session properties on  
Type - Session type, which may be KVM, virtual media or serial.  
Connection - Connection path from the managed appliance to the target device. See  
The following fields may be displayed in the Active Sessions window. Use the Customize link to  
add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Owner - Owner of the session, when it is shared. This field will be blank for users who do not  
have Appliance Administrator or User Administrator access rights when the Video Viewer  
session property “view identity of shared connections” is not set. See Video Viewer session  
Preemption Level - Effective user preemption level for the session user. See Preemption Levels  
Channel - Channel number when connection includes a cascade switch (valid only for KVM or  
virtual media sessions).  
Client - IP address of client who is connected to this session (valid only for KVM or virtual  
media sessions).  
IQ Module - IQ module ID associated with the session (valid only for KVM or virtual  
media sessions).  
Lock Status - Whether KVM and virtual media sessions are locked. See Virtual media session  
Mode - Session mode, which may change during the session. See Customizing the Appliance  
Sessions window on page 153 for a description of the available modes.  
Port - Port associated with the session.  
To disconnect one or more target device active sessions:  
NOTE: To disconnect a session, a user must have unit view access rights and a preemption level that is greater  
than or equal to the session user.  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on a target device Status field. The Active Sessions window for that target  
device will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
161  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the sessions. To disconnect all sessions, click the checkbox to  
the left of Duration at the top of the list. (If you do not have permission to disconnect an active  
session, you will not be able to select its checkbox or the checkbox at the top of the list.)  
3. Click Disconnect. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
For virtual media sessions on supported KVM switches - If you attempt to disconnect an active  
virtual media session or a KVM session that is locked to a virtual media session, a  
confirmation message is displayed, indicating that any virtual media mappings will be  
disconnected. Confirm or cancel. See Using Virtual Media on page 252.  
4. Confirm or cancel the disconnect.  
Active modem sessions  
In the event the primary network fails, you may establish a session to an ACS console server  
through a modem/ISDN dial-up connection method. This connection may be established using the  
SSH Passthrough client or the ACS console server plug-in. To configure the SSH Passthrough  
settings, see Enabling SSH Passthrough on page 177. To configure the ACS console server plug-in  
settings, see the ACS console server plug-in online help.  
Secure connections  
During the initial dial-up connection attempt, the DSView 3 DialUp service will authenticate the  
ACS console server and establish a connection using a Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP). Password  
Authentication Protocol (PAP) and Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (CHAP) are  
supported. In addition to the PAP and CHAP methods, a One Time Password (OTP) authentication  
may also be used for analog modem dial-up connections. (OTP is not supported on ISDN modems.)  
A secret password will be generated for every dial-up request, and each password will only be valid  
for a single attempt. Once authenticated, a secure connection will be established.  
For added security, the ACS console server plug-in may also be configured for dial-back  
connections. Once authenticated, the dial-up connection will be dropped, and the ACS console  
server will dial-back to the DSView 3 server to establish a secure connection. This method does not  
support OTP. To configure dial-back settings on the DSView 3 server, see DSView 3 software  
Only DSView 3 software administrators may access the Active Modem Sessions window.  
Supported modems  
The following modems and serial PCI cards are supported by the DSView 3 software, provided the  
modems are supported on the DSView 3 server operating system.  
Perle PCI-RAS 4 and PCI-RAS 8, which are backwards compatible with Perle V90 Modem  
Equinox SST MM 4p Modem  
Equinox SST 4p Serial  
Eicon DS series ISDN BRI-2M  
Eicon DS series ISDN 4BRI-8M  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
162  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The DSView 3 software also supports the USR3453B - Courier 56k external modem.  
NOTE: The modems listed are not supported on Sun Solaris SPARC operating systems.  
Customizing the Active Modem Sessions window for all sessions  
The Start-Date-Time field, which indicates when the target device session was started, is always  
displayed in the Active Modem Sessions window.  
The Unit field, which indicates the units that are connected by dial-up, is always displayed in the  
Active Modem Sessions window.  
The following fields may be displayed in the Active Modem Sessions window. Use the Customize  
link to add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Duration - Length of the DSView 3 software dial-up connection to the unit.  
IP Address - IP address of the dial-up connection to the unit.  
Status - Status of the dial-up connection. Status values include Established, indicating that a  
dial-up connection is established; or Establish/Primary, indicating that a dial-up connection is  
established but the primary network connection is also available; or Disconnecting, which  
indicates that a DSView 3 software administrator is closing the session.  
Dial-back - Identifies if the connection used a dial-back connection.  
Unit Phone Number - Phone number dialed to connect the unit.  
To disconnect one or more target device active modem sessions:  
NOTE: Only DSView 3 software administrators may disconnect active modem sessions.  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click Active Modem Sessions in the side navigation bar. The Active Modem Sessions  
window will open.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the sessions. To disconnect all sessions, click the checkbox to  
the left of Duration at the top of the list. (If you do not have permission to disconnect an active  
session, you will not be able to select its checkbox or the checkbox at the top of the list.)  
3. Click Disconnect. A confirmation dialog box will appear. Confirm or cancel the disconnect.  
Connections to Units  
The Connections link displays either target device or managed appliance connections.  
The Target Device Connections window lists all connections to the target device. You may also  
use this window to add or delete a connection to or from the target device.  
The Appliance Connections window lists all connections from the managed appliance to  
cascade switches or target devices. You may rename the units which are part of the connection  
path through this window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
163  
NOTE: Connections of EVR1500 environmental monitors and generic appliances may not be viewed.  
Connection display format  
Connections typically appear in a format similar to the following for connections to target devices,  
cascade switches and power devices:  
<Managed appliance name>(<Port>) <EID Number> <target device>  
<Managed appliance name>(<Port>) <EID Number> switch one  
<Port><target device>  
<Managed appliance name>(<Port>) <Power Device> (<Port>) <target device>  
<DSI5100 Appliance Name>(<Port>)<target device>  
The following examples illustrate typical connections that may appear in your DSView 3 software.  
Example: Target device connections  
In the following example, there are three target devices connected to ports 3, 4 and 8 of a DSR1021  
switch named dsr-1021-huntsville. The DSR1021 switch ports are connected to the three target  
devices using IQ modules. The IQ module with an EID of 520255-044F6F is connected to target  
device td-john, while 520255-03F757 is connected to td-mary and 520255-016BE0 is connected  
to td-tim.  
dsr-1021-huntsville(3)520255-044F6Ftd-john  
dsr-1021-huntsville(4)520255-03F757td-mary  
dsr-1021-huntsville(8)520255-016BE0td-tim  
Example: Cascade switch connection  
In the following example, an AutoView 200 1 x 8 switch is connected to port one of a DSR1021  
switch named dsr-1021-huntsville, using an IQ module with an EID of 520255-023FB7. Each port  
of the AutoView 200 switch is connected to a different target device (520255-023FB701  
through 520255-023FB708).  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (1)520255-023FB701  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (2)520255-023FB702  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (3)520255-023FB703  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (4)520255-023FB704  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (5)520255-023FB705  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (6)520255-023FB706  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (7)520255-023FB707  
dsr-1021-huntsville(1)520255-023FB7switch one (8)520255-023FB708  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 12: Unit Sessions and Connections  
165  
7. Select a managed appliance, then click Next.  
8. The Select Available Connection window will open. Select a connection, then click Next.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Target Device Connections  
window will open.  
To delete a target device connection:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the name of a target device.  
2. Click Connections in the side navigation bar. The Target Device Connections window  
will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the target device connection(s) to delete. To delete all target  
device connections on the page, click the checkbox to the left of Connection at the top of  
the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
166  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
167  
CHAPTER  
Data Logging  
13  
The DSView 3 software supports logging of serial session console data from certain appliances and  
their target devices, using the Syslog protocol.  
NOTE: Navigation links, configuration pages and display pages for data logging will only be visible for appliances  
and target devices that support Syslog messaging.  
The DSView 3 software has an SSH server that supports SSH2; this server must be enabled in the  
DSView 3 software to use the data logging feature. An appliance establishes an SSH connection to  
the DSView 3 server (using its X.509 appliance certificate) on demand when it has Syslog  
messages to send. The SSH server then forwards valid messages to the Syslog server; this server  
must be enabled in the DSView 3 software to use the data logging feature.  
There are two types of Syslog messages:  
Data log messages - Contain serial console data that will be stored in files on the DSView 3  
server. The files may then be viewed.  
Events - When a defined event occurs on the appliance, a Syslog message is sent to the  
appliance, and then to the DSView 3 software system event database (for information about  
events, see Events and Event Logs on page 309). Also, when the appliance detects a port alert  
string on a serial port, it can send a syslog event message.  
Data session logging is enabled per connection on the appliance, subject to license availability (see  
Data log licenses on page 168). The DSView 3 server supports up to 2048 enabled data logging  
sessions on each DSView 3 server (assuming sufficient licenses are available).  
Data log files  
Syslog messages that contain data log session information are stored in individual ASCII files.  
Syslog data messages that contain appliance and port values are linked with a target device; those  
with only appliance values are linked with an appliance. The maximum number of data log files  
that can be written simultaneously is determined by the number of data log session  
licenses available.  
A data log filename includes the name of the appliance and/or target device, plus the system data  
and time when the file was created. Current files have a .txt file name extension. If a port supports  
session sharing, concurrent sessions on that port will be written to a single log file.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
168  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Data log files are not backed up by the DSView 3 software backup utility.  
When a data log file is created, a companion signature file with the same name is created, but with  
a .sig file name extension. This file is digitally signed using the DSView 3 software private key.  
When a user wants to display the content of a data log file, the DSView 3 software will first verify  
the digital signature to ensure the file has not been altered.  
You may also export the DSView 3 system X.509 certificate and use its public key to validate the  
signature of files, using external tools. See System certificate on page 43.  
Data log licenses  
A data log license is used for each enabled data log port connection. A direct SSH/Telnet session to  
an appliance will not require or use a data log license for the DSView 3 software to capture data  
logs for that appliance session. Only sessions related to appliance ports require a data log license.  
A data log license is used when data logging is enabled on a port connection. When data logging is  
disabled on a port connection, that license is freed and returned to the available pool.  
The DSView 3 software ships with 32 available data log licenses - that is, 32 data logging sessions  
may be enabled on appliance connections that support data logging. An add-on license key may be  
obtained to support a certain number of additional data logging sessions or an unlimited number of  
data logging sessions (site license). See Licenses on page 50 for more information.  
Configuring Data Logging  
Complete the following steps to configure DSView 3 software data logging.  
Make sure you have sufficient data log licenses - one per port connection for which you want  
to log session data; see Data log licenses on page 168.  
Enable data logging on appliance and/or target device connections; see Enabling and disabling  
Verify the data logging settings for each connection; see Verifying the data logging settings for  
Customize the SSH server settings; see Viewing and customizing the SSH server settings on  
Configure the notification mode for buffer warning events as SNMP; see Configuring the  
Specify where the data log files will be stored; see Specifying where data log files will be  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Data Logging  
169  
Only DSView 3 software administrators may enable the SSH and Syslog servers, specify where the  
data log files will be stored and specify archiving properties. You must have the Configure Unit  
Settings access right to enable/disable data logging.  
Enabling and disabling the SSH server  
The SSH server must be enabled in the DSView 3 software to use the data logging and SSH  
Passthrough features.  
To enable or disable the SSH server:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click SSH Server in the side navigation bar. The SSH Properties window will open.  
4. To enable the SSH server:  
a. Click the Enable SSH Server checkbox.  
b. The default TCP port is 4122. If you wish to change the port, enter a port value in the  
range 1-65535 in the Port field.  
5. To disable the SSH server, uncheck the Enable SSH Server checkbox.  
6. Click Save.  
7. If you changed the port value, you are prompted to confirm the change. Confirm or cancel  
the change.  
Enabling or disabling the SSH server will generate a DSView 3 software system event.  
Enabling and disabling the Syslog server  
The Syslog server must be enabled in the DSView 3 software to use the data logging feature. You  
may change the TCP port where the DSView 3 software will listen for Syslog messages forwarded  
by the SSH server.  
To enable or disable Syslog server port:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. In the side navigation bar, click Data Logging, then Server Settings. The Syslog Properties  
window will open.  
4. To enable the Syslog server:  
a. Click the Enable Syslog Server checkbox.  
b. The default TCP port is 4514. If you wish to change the port, enter a port value in the  
range 1-65535 in the Port field.  
5. To disable the Syslog server, uncheck the Enable Syslog Server checkbox.  
6. Click Save. You are prompted to confirm the change. Confirm or cancel the change.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
170  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
7. If you have not already done so, click the SSH server page link and enable the SSH server. See  
Enabling or disabling the Syslog server will generate a DSView 3 software system event.  
Enabling and disabling data logging on units  
Data logging is enabled and disabled per connection. Depending on the appliance type, you may  
enable or disable data logging on target device connections, appliance connections or both.  
You must have the Configure Unit Settings access right to enable/disable data logging.  
To enable or disable data logging on a unit:  
NOTE: The exact name and content of configuration pages are specific to the appliance type; see the  
appropriate documentation.  
1. In a Units View window containing the appliance or target device (see Accessing Units View  
windows on page 98), click on the unit name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Data Logging and then Configure in the side navigation bar.  
The Data Logging Configuration window for that unit will open. The display lists all  
connections. The Status field may contain the following values:  
Enabled - Data logging is enabled in the appliance for the corresponding port connection  
and a data log license has been allocated for it (data logging for a direct session to an  
appliance does not require or use a license).  
Disabled - Data logging is disabled in the appliance for the corresponding port.  
Unlicensed - Data logging is enabled in the appliance for the corresponding port  
connection, but there is no data log license allocated for it.  
3. To enable data logging on one or more connections:  
a. Click the checkbox next to the connection name(s). To select all connections on the page,  
click the checkbox at the top of the list.  
b. Click Enable. If sufficient data log licenses are available, logging will be enabled on the  
selected connections and the Status field will indicate Enabled. If insufficient licenses are  
available, a warning will be displayed, and the Status field will indicate either Enabled or  
Unlicensed.  
4. To disable data logging on one or more connections:  
a. Click the checkbox next to the connection name(s). To select all connections on the page,  
click the checkbox at the top of the list.  
a. Click Disable. Data logging will be stopped on the selected connections, and the data log  
licenses used by those connections will be returned to the available pool.  
Verifying the data logging settings for each connection  
After enabling data logging on the appliance, verify that DSView Data Log is enabled for  
each connection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Data Logging  
171  
To check the data logging settings for connections:  
1. In a Units View window, click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Ports and then Serial in the side navigation bar. The Serial  
window will open.  
3. Click on the appropriate port.  
NOTE: If the Status is Disabled, you will not be able to click on the connection. To change the status to Enabled,  
4. In the side navigation bar, click Data Logging.  
5. If not already selected, click the radio button next to Enable DSView Data Log. Any previous  
data logging settings will be lost.  
6. If available, click the Flash Required button to ensure that these settings remain even if power  
is interrupted. If the Flash Required button is not displayed, the settings have been saved to  
non-volatile Flash memory on the appliance.  
Viewing and customizing the SSH server settings  
To view and customize the SSH server settings:  
1. In a Units View window, click on the appliance name.  
2. Click Appliance Settings, click Data Logging and then Syslog SSH Server in the side  
navigation bar.  
3. In the DSView Server IP field, enter the IP address for the DSView 3 server that will receive  
data logs. This may be either the hub or a spoke server.  
4. In the Syslog Server Port field, enter the Syslog port that you set in Enabling and disabling the  
5. In the SSH Server Port field, enter the SSH port that you set in Enabling and disabling the SSH  
NOTE: It is recommended that no more than 2048 data logging and SSH Passthrough sessions be  
open concurrently.  
6. The Appliance Configuration Section contains several fields for managing the SSH sessions  
and buffer warning events. Each field contains the Avocent recommended value, but you may  
change these values if needed.  
SSH Idle Timeout (seconds): If the SSH session is inactive for the specified amount of  
time, it will be closed. The default time-out is 15 seconds.  
SSH Start Threshold (bytes): The appliance will log data in its local memory. Once it  
meets the threshold specified in this field, it will attempt to open an SSH session to the  
DSView 3 server. The default threshold is 10 KB.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
172  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
SSH Tunnel Buffer Size (bytes): If the SSH session cannot be opened, the appliance will  
continue to store data logs in its local memory until it reaches the size specified in this  
field. The default buffer size is 1 MB.  
NOTE: The appliance may be prevented from opening an SSH session if a firewall is blocking traffic, the DSView  
SSH service is disabled or the IP address and TCP port settings are incorrect.  
Buffer Full First Warning (bytes): If an SSH session cannot be opened, a first warning will  
be sent once the appliance local memory reaches the size specified in this field. The  
recommended first warning size is 500KB.  
Buffer Full Second Warning (bytes): If an SSH session cannot be opened, a second  
warning will be sent once the appliance local memory reaches the size specified in this  
field. The recommended second warning size is 700 KB.  
Configuring the buffer warnings events as SNMP  
If the appliance fails to open an SSH connection to the DSView 3 server, the appliance will  
continue to store data logs in local memory. To ensure that the administrator receives buffer  
warnings events if the SSH connection fails, change the notification mode from Syslog to SNMP.  
To configure the buffer warnings as SNMP:  
1. In a Units View window, click on the appliance name.  
2. Select Appliance Settings - Events - Traps/Syslog.  
3. Click the checkbox next to the following events: Appliance Data Log Buffer Full First  
Warning, Appliance Data Log Buffer Full Second Warning and Appliance Data Log Loss.  
4. Click the Enable SNMP Trap button.  
5. The Notification Mode for the events changes from Syslog Enabled to SNMP Trap Enabled.  
If available, click the Flash Required button to ensure that these settings remain even if power  
is interrupted. If the Flash Required button is not displayed, the settings have been saved to  
non-volatile Flash memory on the appliance.  
To begin receiving buffer warning events, configure the DSView 3 software for email notifications.  
See Email Notifications in the DSView 3 software online help for more information.  
Specifying where data log files will be stored  
To specify where data log files will be stored:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. In the side navigation bar, click Data Logging, then Location. The Data Logging Location  
Properties window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Data Logging  
173  
4. In the Location field, enter a local or network shared location, using a UNC (Universal Naming  
Convention) path of up to 256 characters. You cannot specify a mapped network drive. If the  
operating system supports case sensitive file names, use case sensitive text.  
The default location is %<DSView 3 software installation directory>%\datalogs.  
If you change the location at a later time, any data log files in the previous location will no  
longer be viewable or accessible through the DSView 3 software.  
Data log files are not backed up by the DSView 3 software backup utility.  
5. If a login will not be required to access the file location, disable the Login required to access  
shared drive location checkbox.  
If a login will be required to access the file location:  
a. Enable the Login required to access shared drive location checkbox.  
b. In the Username field, enter the username (up to 256 characters) to access the file location.  
c. In the Password field, enter the password (up to 64 characters).  
d. Repeat the password in the Confirm Password field.  
6. Click Save.  
Archiving and deleting data log files  
Data log files are archived at specified intervals or when a file reaches a specified size. You may  
also archive files dynamically. Archived files retain the same name with a .zip file name extension.  
Each time a file is archived, it is considered a version for that particular connection/port. You may  
indicate the number of versions that will be retained in the file system - when this value is exceeded  
for a connection/port, the oldest archived file version will automatically be deleted. You may also  
delete archived files dynamically.  
If an appliance or target device name is changed, any current log files associated with the original  
name will be closed and archived with their original name. Those files will be viewable only from  
the Reports - Data Log Session Files window. Subsequent incoming data log messages will be  
written to a new file that has the new unit name.  
Similarly, if a target device or appliance is deleted from the DSView 3 software system, any current  
log files associated with the unit (and its target devices if the deleted unit is an appliance) will be  
closed and archived. These files will be viewable only from the Reports - Data Log Session  
Files window.  
To specify archiving properties:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. In the side navigation bar, click Data Logging, then Archiving. The Data Logging Archiving  
Properties window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
174  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4. In the Archive by frequency field, select the interval for archiving current data log files: daily  
(every day at midnight local time), weekly (every Sunday at midnight) or monthly (the first  
day of each month at midnight).  
5. In the Archive by size field, enter a size from 1-2000 MB. When a current file reaches this size,  
it will be closed and archived.  
6. In the Number of archived versions field, select a value (1-10). This specifies the maximum  
number of archived versions of a file (based on the file name) that will be retained. When this  
number is exceeded, the oldest archived file will be deleted.  
For example, if a value of 5 is specified, up to five archived versions of each file will be  
retained. When a subsequent archive operation occurs for that log file (triggered either by the  
archive frequency or size value being reached), the oldest archived version will be deleted.  
Changing this value affects all archived files.  
7. Click Save.  
Dynamically archiving and deleting data log files  
Data log files are automatically archived and deleted according to the properties specified in the  
preceding procedure. You may also archive current files or delete archived files at any time.  
To archive data log files dynamically:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Data Log Session Files in the top navigation bar. The Data Log Session Files window  
will open.  
3. Click the checkboxes to the left of current log files to be archived. To select all files on the  
page, click the checkbox at the top of the list. (The status for all selected files must be Current.)  
4. Click Archive Now. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the archiving.  
To delete data log files dynamically:  
NOTE: Always use this procedure to delete data log files dynamically, rather than using other methods to  
delete files.  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Data Log Session Files in the top navigation bar. The Data Log Session Files window  
will open.  
3. Click the checkboxes to the left of log files to be deleted. To select all files on the page, click  
the checkbox at the top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 13: Data Logging  
175  
Viewing Data Log Files  
Displaying lists of data log files  
Each row in the display table contains the following information about a single log file:  
Log file name  
Name of the DSView 3 server where the file was created and stored  
When the file was created  
When the file was last modified  
File size in megabytes  
Status - Archived, Current, File not Found or Pending  
The Size and Last Modified fields are optional; use the Customize link to add or remove them from  
To display information about log files for a single unit, you must have View Data Logging access  
rights. To display information about all data log files in the DSView 3 software system, you must  
be a member of the DSView 3 software administrators or auditor user group.  
To display a list of data log files for a single unit:  
1. In a Units View window containing the appliance/target device (see Accessing Units View  
windows on page 98), click on the unit name.  
2. In the side navigation bar, click Data Logging, then click Session Files. The Data Logging  
Session Files window for that unit will open.  
3. To view a file’s content, click on the file name. See Displaying data log file content.  
To display a list of all data log files in the DSView 3 software system:  
NOTE: This is the only procedure that will include log files for units that have been renamed or deleted from the  
DSView 3 software system.  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Data Log Session Files in the top navigation bar. The Data Log Session Files window  
will open.  
You may dynamically archive or delete data log files from this window; see Dynamically  
archiving and deleting data log files on page 174.  
3. To view a file’s content, click on the file name. See Displaying data log file content below.  
Displaying data log file content  
When you click on a file name in a Data Log Session Files window, the file is transferred to the  
browser. It will be opened as a text file, using the default text viewer on the DSView 3 software  
client’s computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
176  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Before the file is transferred to the browser, the DSView 3 software will verify the file’s digital  
signature. If the computed digital signature does not match the actual file’s digital signature, the  
content of the file will be preceded with a warning, indicating that digital signature verification  
failed and the file content may have been altered.  
If you select a log file that does not reside on the DSView 3 server to which you’re logged in, the  
log file is transferred from the appropriate server.  
You may also validate the signature of data log files by exporting the system certificate; see System  
certificate on page 43 and Verifying data log file digital signatures.  
Verifying data log file digital signatures  
The DSView 3 software computes hashes for data log files using the SHA1 digest algorithm. After  
a hash is computed for a file, it is signed using the RSA public key algorithm and the DSView 3  
software X.509 system certificate private key.  
To verify the signature, you may use standard tools (such as OpenSSL) and the DSView 3 software  
system X.509 certificate public key. (To view or export the system certificate, see System  
For example, assume the following:  
A data log file is created with the name cisco-router-session-2006-04-02-12:12:01.txt.  
The DSView 3 software signs the data log file and creates a signature file with the name  
cisco-router-session-2006-04-02-12:12:01.sig.  
The DSView 3 software system certificate has been exported with the name sun-jdoe.p10.  
The OpenSSL command to verify the signature (and a successful response) is:  
c:\>openssl dgst -sha1 -verify sun-jdoe.p10 -signature cisco-router-  
session-2006-04-02-12:12:01.sig cisco-router-session-2006-04-02-  
12:12:01.txt  
c:\>Verification OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
177  
CHAPTER  
SSH Passthrough Sessions  
14  
An SSH Passthrough session is a serial session opened to a unit without the use of a web browser.  
From an SSH client, a user with access rights can establish a connection to any serial unit managed  
by the DSView 3 software that supports Secure Shell 2 (SSH2) and Avocent DS Authentication 2  
Protocol (ADSAP2) protocol.  
The DSView 3 server provides user authentication and, if events are enabled, logs SSH  
Passthrough session events. You can also share SSH Passthrough sessions with multiple users  
across multiple DSView 3 servers. Serial sessions initiated from the DSView 3 client software may  
also be shared if the Avocent Session Viewer is preconfigured as the serial viewer.  
Shared serial sessions provide server redundancy. If a DSView 3 server is no longer available, a  
user may establish an SSH Passthrough session to a different DSView 3 server.  
Client licenses  
A client license is required for each user operating SSH Passthrough sessions. However, a user can  
open any number of SSH Passthrough sessions without increasing the license counter, provided the  
username is identical, and resides on the same DSView 3 server and network source address for  
each SSH Passthrough session. Once the user closes all SSH Passthrough sessions, the client  
session license is freed. If the available number of client session licenses is exceeded three times,  
users will be prevented from establishing a new SSH Passthrough session. See Licenses on page 50  
for more information.  
Configuring SSH Passthrough  
Enable SSH Passthrough; see Enabling SSH Passthrough on page 177.  
(Optional) Enable SSH port sharing; see SSH port sharing on page 178.  
Only DSView 3 software administrators may enable the SSH servers, SSH Passthrough and SSH  
port sharing.  
Enabling SSH Passthrough  
To enable or disable SSH Passthrough:  
1. Click the System tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
178  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click SSH Passthrough in the side navigation bar. The SSH Passthrough Properties  
window opens.  
4. To enable SSH Passthrough, select the Enable SSH Passthrough checkbox.  
-or-  
To disable SSH Passthrough, uncheck the Enable SSH Passthrough checkbox.  
5. In the event of a network failure, you may establish an SSH Passthrough session to the target  
device through Modem Dial-Up. To allow this capability, select the Enable Modem Dial-Up  
Connections checkbox. If the main network connection is unavailable when trying to open an  
SSH Passthrough session, you will be notified that the network is unreachable and a  
connection over modem dial-up is being established.  
-or-  
To prevent connections through Modem Dial-Up, uncheck the Enable Modem Dial-Up  
Connections checkbox. If the main network connection fails, the SSH Passthrough connection  
will fail without attempting an alternate connection.  
NOTE: Modem dial-up connections are only available on supported ACS console servers.  
6. Click Save.  
7. If you have not already done so, click the SSH Server page link and enable the SSH server. See  
Enabling or disabling SSH Passthrough will generate a DSView 3 software system event.  
SSH port sharing  
SSH Passthrough sessions and/or Avocent Session Viewer sessions can be shared to allow other  
users to view the session data. You can also enable hub/spoke forwarding to allow sessions from  
multiple DSView 3 servers to be shared simultaneously. The first user to open an SSH Passthrough  
or Avocent Session Viewer session has read/write access; all subsequent users who share the  
session have read-only access. Users can enter a command to obtain read/write access, but only one  
user at a time can possess read/write access.  
To configure SSH Passthrough port sharing:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click SSH Passthrough in the side navigation bar. The SSH Passthrough Properties  
window opens.  
4. To enable shared SSH Passthrough sessions, select the Enable Port Sharing checkbox.  
5. To allow simultaneous shared SSH Passthrough sessions from multiple DSView 3 servers,  
select the Enable Hub/Spoke Forwarding checkbox.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 14: SSH Passthrough Sessions  
179  
If hub/spoke forwarding is enabled, shared SSH Passthrough sessions are centralized to the  
DSView 3 server that owns the appliance to which the session is opened.  
NOTE: The appliance is owned by the DSView 3 server to which it was first added. To determine which DSView  
3 server owns an appliance, go the appliance Unit Overview Page and click Properties - Network. The DSView  
Server menu displays the name of the server that owns the appliance. See Unit Properties on page 125 for  
more information.  
6. To allow sharing among SSH Passthrough sessions and Avocent Session Viewer sessions,  
select the Enable DSView Client Serial Sessions checkbox.  
7. Click Save.  
Configuring the Avocent Session Viewer  
To allow sharing among sessions initiated from the DSView 3 client software, you must  
preconfigure the Avocent Session Viewer as the serial viewer.  
To configure the Avocent Session Viewer:  
1. Click the Profile tab.  
2. Click Applications in the side navigation bar.  
3. Select the Avocent Session Viewer checkbox.  
4. Click Save.  
For more information about serial session applications, see Choosing the serial session application  
SSH Passthrough Sessions  
You may establish an SSH connection to a target device or an appliance console by specifying the  
appropriate name in the SSH command. You may also establish an SSH session to a target device  
with multiple connections, but the appliance name and port number must be entered in place of the  
target device name.  
NOTE: It is recommended that no more than 2048 concurrent data logging and SSH Passthrough sessions  
be open.  
Preemption  
Your SSH session may be interrupted or disconnected based on the appliance preemption levels. If  
the appliance supports DSView 3 software preemption levels, then user preemption rights will be  
determined based on the preemption levels set in the DSView 3 software. For more information,  
Logging in with a User SSH key  
A user SSH key may be used instead of a password to authenticate the user before establishing an  
SSH Passthrough session. See User SSH key on page 207 to configure the key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
180  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Establishing an SSH Passthrough connection to a unit  
To establish an SSH Passthrough connection to a target device or  
appliance console:  
NOTE: If you are using the Linux or Unix SSH command, you will need to specify the port by entering -p and the  
port number. The default port number is 4122. For more information or to change the port number, see Enabling  
1. To connect to a target device or appliance console, open your SSH client and enter the  
following values in the provided text fields:  
<username>:  
<targetdevicename>@ (to connect to a target device)  
-or-  
<appliancename>:@ (to connect to an appliance console)  
host name or IP address of the DSView 3 server  
To connect to a target device using the Linux or Unix SSH command, enter a command in the  
following format:  
<username>:<target device name>@<host name or IP address of DSView 3 server>  
For example, a command to open an SSH session to a target device may look like this:  
ssh -p 4122 jsmith:[email protected]  
To connect to an appliance console using the Linux or Unix SSH command, enter a command  
in the following format:  
<username>:<appliance name:>@<host name or IP address of DSView 3 server>  
For example, a command to open an SSH session to an appliance console may look like this:  
ssh -p 4122 jsmith:ACS_Lab:@172.30.19.101  
NOTE: The colon is used to delimit different arguments; however, if a colon is contained within the name, then a  
double backslash may be used as an escape sequence to include the colon in the name.  
For example, if the username is “sanders:”, a command to open an SSH session to a target device may look  
like this:  
ssh -p 4122 sanders\\::Boston:[email protected]  
2. If a user SSH key has been configured, the session is automatically authenticated based on the  
key. The user SSH key must be stored on the DSView 3 server specified in step 1.  
-or-  
When prompted, enter the password for the username. If you enter an incorrect password three  
times, the login failed event will be generated and the SSH session will be closed.  
The user credentials for the target device are validated by the DSView 3 server. If the user is  
valid, the DSView 3 software database determines the IP address of the appliance and the  
X.509 certificate for establishing the connection. If the user is invalid, the session  
closes immediately.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: SSH Passthrough Sessions  
181  
3. If more than one connection exists to the target device, the SSH connection attempt fails and  
the DSView 3 software informs the user of the failure reason. To connect to a target device  
with multiple connections, specify the appliance name and port instead of the target device  
name. The appliance name must be identical to the appliance name in the DSView 3 software  
database, and the port must be the exact port number that appears in the Units view in the  
DSView 3 software.  
To connect to a target device with multiple connections, open your SSH client and enter the  
following values in the provided text fields:  
<username>:  
<appliancename>:port@  
host name or IP address of the DSView 3 server  
To connect to a target device with multiple connections using the Linux or Unix SSH  
command, enter a command in the following format:  
<username>:<appliance name:port>@<host name or IP address of DSView 3 server>  
4. The SSH client attempts to establish an SSH connection to the appliance or target device. If a  
successful connection is established, the DSView 3 server acts as a proxy between the user and  
target device.  
If an SSH Passthrough session to the same appliance or target device is already open, your  
session is shared with the previously connected users. You have read-only access to the  
session, but you may enter a command to obtain read/write access. See Transferring read/write  
5. If the console port on the target device requires additional authentication, the user is prompted  
to log in.  
Escape key sequence  
An escape key sequence is a combination of characters that can be sent to the DSView 3 server to  
affect an SSH Passthrough or Avocent Session Viewer session. The default escape sequence is  
^Ec, which can be followed by an escape key to send a command to a target device. Some escape  
key sequences are limited to only the user with read/write access.  
In this chapter, the preset escape Sequence ^Ec is used in all examples to indicate the configured  
escape sequence.  
Table 14.1: DSView 3 Software - Supported SSH Passthrough Session Escape Keys  
Escape  
Keys  
Escape  
Keys  
Description  
Description  
.
Disconnect  
?
Print this message  
Change escape sequence [the preset  
value is ^Ec]  
a
l?  
Attach read/write rights  
Displays break sequence list*  
e
0-9  
Send specific break sequence*  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
182  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 14.1: DSView 3 Software - Supported SSH Passthrough Session Escape Keys (Continued)  
Escape  
Keys  
Escape  
Keys  
Description  
Description  
r
Replay last 30 lines of log  
<cr>  
Ignore/abort command  
*Only users with read/write access can send these escape key sequences.  
To modify the escape sequence:  
From an SSH Passthrough session, enter the following command:  
^Ece[new escape sequence]  
For example: ^Ece^Acchanges the escape sequence from ^Ec to ^Ac.  
To enter an escape key sequence:  
From an SSH Passthrough session, enter a command in the following format:  
^Ec[escape key]  
For example: ^Ecl?displays the break sequence list.  
After entering an escape key sequence, the SSH client displays a message indicating success  
or failure.  
Break sequences  
NOTE: SSH port sharing must be enabled before you can configure break sequences.  
A break sequence is a user-defined combination of characters that can be sent as a command to a  
target device during an SSH Passthrough or Avocent Session Viewer session. A break sequence is  
sent when the corresponding escape key sequence is typed by the user. The DSView 3 software  
supports ASCII and UTF-8 characters and special break keys. Only the user with read/write access  
to the SSH session can send a break sequence to a target device.  
You can configure up to 10 break sequences to be used in SSH Passthrough sessions.  
The following special break keys are supported:  
Table 14.2: DSView 3 Software - Supported SSH Passthrough Session Break Keys  
Break  
Character  
Break  
Character  
Description  
Description  
Serial break [defined as Telnet break:  
IAC(\337), BREAK(\363)]  
\a  
Alert  
\z  
\\  
\b  
\d  
Backspace  
Backslash  
Circumflex  
Delay [preset value is 250 milliseconds] \^  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: SSH Passthrough Sessions  
183  
Table 14.2: DSView 3 Software - Supported SSH Passthrough Session Break Keys (Continued)  
Break  
Character  
Break  
Character  
Description  
Description  
Octal representation of a character (where  
ooo is one to three octal digits)  
\f  
Form-feed  
\ooo  
\n  
\r  
New line  
\c  
Character c  
Carriage return  
Tab  
^?  
Delete  
\t  
^c  
Control character (c is “and”ed with 0x1f)  
Any utf8 character  
\v  
Vertical tab  
[UTF-8]  
To configure break sequences:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click DSView Server in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click SSH Passthrough in the side navigation bar. The SSH Passthrough Properties  
window opens.  
4. In the Delay field, you may enter the number of milliseconds to delay a command if \d  
is entered.  
5. Enter the break sequence description in the Description field, then enter the break sequence in  
the Break Sequence field. Descriptions and break sequences are limited to 64 characters. Field  
numbers 0-9 are available for up to 10 break sequences.  
To send a break sequence:  
1. From an SSH Passthrough session, enter the escape sequence for the break sequence definition  
in the following format:  
^Ecl[break sequence number 0-9]  
For example: ^Ecl5  
2. The break sequence is sent to the target device and a confirmation message appears.  
-or-  
The SSH client indicates that the break sequence is invalid or contains a syntax error. You can  
correct the error and resend the break sequence.  
Transferring read/write access  
Only one user at a time can have read/write access to a shared SSH Passthrough or Avocent Session  
Viewer session. The first user who opens the session has read/write access. If that user exits a  
shared session, read/write access is granted to a randomly selected user who is sharing the session.  
A user with read-only access can enter a command to obtain read/write access.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
184  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To obtain read/write access:  
1. From a shared SSH Passthrough or Avocent Session Viewer session where you have read-only  
access, enter the following command:  
^Eca  
2. The user with read/write access receives a message that read/write access has been transferred  
to the specified user.  
3. You receive a message that the user has lost read/write access.  
You now have sole read/write privileges to the SSH Passthrough or Avocent Session Viewer  
session. Transferring read/write access generates DSView 3 software system events.  
Disconnecting a session  
To disconnect an SSH session:  
1. From an SSH Passthrough session, enter the following command:  
^Ec.  
2. Your session is closed. If you had read/write access to the session, read/write access is granted  
to a randomly selected user who is sharing the session.  
Displaying session output  
If a data log was created for the SSH Passthrough session, you can enter a command to display the  
last 30 lines (limited to 16384 characters) of the data log on the SSH client. The last 30 lines may  
include previous SSH sessions, but will only display target device output, not user actions.  
NOTE: To display session output, data logging must be enabled and the user must have access rights to unit.  
To display session output:  
1. From an SSH Passthrough session, enter the following command:  
^Ecr  
2. The client displays the last 30 lines of the data log.  
-or-  
If you do not have access rights or if a data log was not created, an error message is displayed.  
Supported service processor commands  
NOTE: SSH Passthrough port sharing is not supported if a server processor command is included at the end of  
the SSH command.  
When opening an SSH Passthrough session to a target device connected to a supported MergePoint  
52xx manager, you may include a service processor (SP) command at the end of the SSH  
command. If the SP command is not present at the end of the SSH command, the appliance may  
provide the user with a menu of SP commands to choose from.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 14: SSH Passthrough Sessions  
185  
To include an SP command, open your SSH client and enter a command in the following format:  
<username>:<target device name>@<host name or IP address of the DSView 3 server>  
[spcommand]  
NOTE: Enter a space between <host name or IP address of the DSView 3 server> and [spcommand].  
The first part of the command will establish an SSH session to the MergePoint 52xx SP manager. If  
a supported SP command is present at the end of the SSH command, the SP command will be  
passed through to the service processor on the appliance. The appliance will validate and execute  
the command.  
For example, a command to open an SSH session to a MergePoint 52xx SP manager and execute an  
SP command may look like this:  
ssh -p 4122 jsmith:[email protected] poweron  
For more information and a list of supported SP commands, see the documentation included with  
the MergePoint 52xx SP manager.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
186  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
187  
CHAPTER  
Grouping Units  
15  
The DSView 3 Explorer automatically groups managed appliances by the type of appliance (DSR  
switch, ACS console server and so on). Target devices are automatically grouped based on the type  
to which they are assigned.  
You may also add and change the following types of groups:  
Sites  
Departments  
Locations  
Custom fields - Custom fields allow a user to create groupings of units which are accessed by  
all DSView 3 software users  
Personal and global unit groups - Global unit groups may be seen by all users; personal unit  
groups are visible only to the user who created the group  
Site, Department and Location Groups  
You may create one or more site, department and location names and then associate units with  
them. For example, you could create sites names such as Austin and Sunrise, department names  
such as Software Development and Human Resources or location names such as Lab Room 101  
and System Administrator’s Office.  
Site, Department and/or Location columns may be included in a Units View window display, using  
To group units by site, department or location, you first create a site/department/location, then  
associate units with it. Sites/departments/locations that contain units to which a user does not have  
access rights will not appear in the side navigation bar. The site/department/location must also have  
at least one unit associated with it to be displayed in the side navigation bar.  
To add a site, department or location:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. To add a site, click Sites in the top navigation bar. The Sites window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
188  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To add a department, click Departments in the top navigation bar. The Departments window  
will open.  
To add a location, click Locations in the top navigation bar. The Locations window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Site, Add Department or Add Location window will open.  
4. Type a name, then click Add. The Sites, Departments or Locations window will open.  
A site, department or location will not be listed in the side navigation bar until a unit has been  
associated with it.  
To delete a site, department or location:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. To delete a site click Sites in the top navigation bar. The Sites window will open.  
To delete a department, click Departments in the top navigation bar. The Departments window  
will open.  
To delete a location, click Locations in the top navigation bar. The Locations window  
will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of one or more sites/departments/locations. To delete all sites/  
departments/locations in the page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
To change the name of a site, department or location:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. To change the name of a site, click Sites in the top navigation bar. The Sites window will open.  
To change the name of a department, click Departments in the top navigation bar. The  
Departments window will open.  
To change the name of a location, click Locations in the top navigation bar. The Locations  
window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a site/department/location. The Site/Department/Location Name window  
will open.  
4. Type a new 1-64 character name.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Sites, Departments or Locations window will open.  
To associate or change the association of an existing unit to a site, department or  
location:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click one of the links listed in Table 15.1 in the side navigation bar to display the  
corresponding window for the units you wish to associate, change or remove the association.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
189  
Table 15.1: Links for Managing Sites, Departments or Location Associations  
Link  
Window  
Changes Site Associations For  
A link under Target Devices  
A link under Appliances  
Sites  
Target Devices  
Appliances  
Target devices only  
Managed appliances only  
Units in Site  
Units  
Units  
Units  
Units  
Groups  
Units in Group  
Units in Custom Fields  
Recently Accessed Units  
A link under Custom Field  
Recently Accessed  
3. Click on the name of a unit. The Unit Overview window will open.  
4. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, then click Location.  
5. From the menus, select the site, department and/or location to associate with the unit. If you do  
not wish to associate the unit with any site, department or location choose the top (empty) item  
from the menu.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
To display the units associated with a site, department or location:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. To display units associated with a site, click Sites in the side navigation bar. The Units in Site  
window will open, with a list of units associated with the first alphabetically-listed site.  
To display units associated with a department, click Departments in the side navigation bar.  
The Units in Departments window will open, with a list of units associated with the first  
alphabetically-listed department.  
To display units associated with a location, click Locations in the side navigation bar. The  
Units in Location window will open, with a list of units associated with the first  
alphabetically-listed location.  
3. Click on a site, department, location link in the side navigation bar to display another entry in  
the unit list.  
Custom Fields  
Three custom fields are available. To use the custom fields, you first change the default labels on  
the fields (Custom Field 1, Custom Field 2 and Custom Field 3) and then associate a custom label  
with a unit. The custom fields may be displayed in Units View windows using the Customize link.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
190  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To define custom fields:  
NOTE: You must have Software Administrator or Appliance Administrator access to define custom fields.  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Custom Field Labels in the side navigation bar. The Unit Custom Field Labels window  
will open.  
3. In Label 1, type the 1-64 character name for the first custom field label. All first-level custom  
fields for units will appear under this heading in the side navigation bar.  
4. In Label 2, type the 1-64 character name for the second custom field label. All second-level  
custom fields for units will appear under this heading in the side navigation bar.  
5. In Label 3, type the 1-64 character name for the third custom field label. This custom field will  
not appear in the side navigation bar, but may be displayed in the content area by clicking  
Customize and adding the field.  
6. Click Save.  
The Custom Field Labels name will continue to appear in the side navigation bar until you  
associate the custom label with a unit.  
To associate a custom label with a unit:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click on a unit. The  
Unit Overview window will open.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Custom Fields. The Unit Custom  
Fields window will open.  
3. In the first field, type the 1-64 character name to associate with the first label. You may also  
leave the field blank.  
4. In the second field, type the 1-64 character name to associate with the second label. You may  
also leave the field blank.  
5. In the third field, type the 1-64 character name to associate with the third label. You may also  
leave the field blank.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance - All window will open. The side navigation  
bar will include the names of the defined and associated custom fields.  
Example: Custom fields  
In the following example, a DSView 3 software administrator wants to examine a unit test  
configuration. The units will be placed in one of two categories: an initial configuration or a final  
configuration category. The administrator also wants to identify the unit’s managers. At the present  
time, the DSView 3 software administrator has one DSR1021 switch and one EVR1500  
environmental monitor to add to the test configuration category and one generic appliance to add to  
the final configuration category.  
1. First, the DSView 3 software administrator will define the custom fields.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
191  
a. Click the Units tab.  
b. Click Custom Field Labels in the side navigation bar. The Unit Custom Field Labels  
window will open.  
c. In Label 1, type Test Configuration. All first-level custom fields for units will appear  
under this heading in the side navigation bar.  
d. In Label 2, type Appliances and target devices. All second-level custom fields for units  
will appear under this heading in the side navigation bar.  
e. In Label 3, type Manager. This custom field will not appear in the side navigation bar, but  
may be displayed in the content area by using the Customize link.  
f. Click Save to save the changes.  
Custom Field Labels will still appear in the side navigation bar because the administrator  
has not yet defined any custom fields for the units.  
2. A DSR1021 switch has been added to the system, but will need to go into a category named  
Initial Configuration, since it has not yet been verified for the final configuration. The  
administrator will associate the DSR1021 switch managed by John Smith to the custom fields  
as follows:  
a. Click Appliances in the side navigation bar. The Appliances - All window will open.  
b. Click on the DSR1021 switch. The Unit Overview window will open.  
c. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Custom Fields. The Unit Custom  
Fields window will open, including the custom field names defined in step 1.  
d. In the Test Configuration field, type Initial Configuration.  
e. In the Appliances and target devices field, type DSR1021 Switches.  
f. In the Manager field, type John Smith.  
g. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance - All window will open. The side  
navigation bar will now include Test Configuration instead of Custom Field Labels.  
3. The test configuration will also include an EVR1500 environmental monitor that is managed  
by Mary Jones. The EVR1500 environmental monitor has also not been verified for the final  
configuration, so the administrator will include it in the Initial Configuration category.  
a. In the Appliances - All window, click on the EVR1500 environmental monitor. The Unit  
Overview window will open.  
b. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Custom Fields. The Unit Custom  
Fields window will open, including the custom field names defined in step 1.  
c. In the Test Configuration field, type Initial Configuration.  
d. In the Appliances and target devices field, type EVR1500 Environmental Monitors.  
e. In the Manager field, type Mary Jones.  
f. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance - All window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
192  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4. The configuration of a generic appliance has been verified, so the administrator wants to create  
a category named Final Configuration that will contain the final test units. The category will  
contain one generic appliance managed by Tim Brown.  
a. In the Appliances - All window, click on the generic appliance. The Unit Overview  
window will open.  
b. Click Properties in the side navigation bar and then click Custom Fields. The Unit Custom  
Fields window will open, including the custom field names you defined in step 1.  
c. In the Test Configuration field, type Final Configuration.  
d. In the Appliances and target devices field, type Generic Appliances.  
e. In the Manager field, type Tim Brown.  
f. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance - All window will open.  
Figure 15.1 indicates how the side navigation bar will appear after the example procedure. Clicking  
on a custom field link displays the units associated with that custom field.  
1
2
3
Figure 15.1: Custom Fields Example: Side Navigation Bar  
Table 15.2: Custom Fields Example: Side Navigation Bar Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
1
2
3
System-wide first-level custom field label  
Unit first-level custom field labels  
Unit second-level custom field labels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
193  
Unit Groups  
Unit groups may be used to organize units. You may create nested unit groups (unit groups within  
unit groups) to organize units hierarchically. Units may belong to multiple groups. For example,  
you may have a DSR switch that belongs to two global groups and three personal groups.  
There are two types of unit groups: global and personal. A global unit group can be viewed by any  
user logged into the DSView 3 software. A personal unit group may only be viewed by the person  
who created it. Up to 32 personal unit groups may be created by a user.  
There are two top-level system-defined unit group containers: global root and personal root. These  
group containers cannot be deleted. They can contain other unit groups, but not individual units. All  
global unit groups are descendents of global root. All personal unit groups are descendents of  
personal root.  
There is also a system-defined unit group named Unassigned, which is a descendent of the global  
root. This unit group automatically contains all units that are not assigned to any other global unit  
groups. This group cannot be deleted, and you cannot add subgroups (children) to the Unassigned  
unit group.  
Global unit groups may only be created, modified or deleted by users with DSView 3 software  
administrator, user administrator or appliance administrator privileges. The global root, personal  
root and unassigned unit groups cannot be deleted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
194  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Personal Root  
System Defined  
Global Root  
System Defined  
• No rights associated with  
personal groups  
• Can create subgroups  
• Can add groups as children, but  
not units  
• Can change rights  
• Can create subgroups  
• Can add groups as children,  
but not units  
User Defined  
Personal Groups  
Unassigned  
System Defined  
User Defined  
Global Groups  
• No rights associated with  
personal groups  
• Can create subgroups  
• Can add units as members  
• Can change rights  
• Can change rights  
• Can create subgroups  
• Can add units as members  
• Cannot create subgroups  
• Cannot add units as members  
• If a unit is not assigned to any  
other global group, it  
automatically becomes a  
member of this group  
Figure 15.2: Unit Groups Structure  
Table 15.3: Unit Groups Features  
Group Type  
Can change rights? Can have subgroups? Can add units as members?  
System Defined  
Global Root  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
No, can only add groups  
No  
Unassigned  
Personal Root  
User Defined  
Global Groups  
Personal Groups  
Yes  
No, can only add groups  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Unit group hierarchy  
There are two primary ways to view unit groups:  
Unit Groups window - clicking the Units tab and then Groups in the top navigation bar  
Units View Groups window - clicking the Units tab and then Groups in the side navigation bar  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
195  
Global groups that contain units the user cannot access will not be displayed, unless there are  
descendent groups containing units the user is allowed to access.  
All personal unit groups are displayed in the Unit Groups window, even if they do not contain any  
units. In Units View Groups windows, groups will not be listed unless they have assigned units.  
Global Root  
1
Alpha  
Beta  
Delta  
Gamma  
Lab  
2
3
}
Operations  
Unassigned  
4
Personal Root  
ProjectA  
5
6
ProjectB  
ProjectC  
Figure 15.3: Unit Group Hierarchy Example  
Table 15.4: Unit Group Hierarchy Example Descriptions  
Number Description  
Number Description  
Global unit group Unassigned has all units  
that are not assigned to a group; it cannot  
have subgroups  
Global unit group Alpha has one or  
more subgroups  
1
2
4
5
Global Unit group Gamma has two  
subgroups  
Personal unit group ProjectB has no  
subgroups  
These unit groups do not have  
subgroups (in a Units view Group  
window, a document icon will appear  
to the left)  
Personal unit group ProjectC has one or  
more subgroups  
3
6
In the example, four unit groups have been created in the global root group, and each of those four  
unit groups contain groups. The unit group Gamma has been selected, and indicates it has two  
subgroups, Lab and Operations. The Unassigned global group will contain any units that are not  
assigned to another global unit group.  
Three personal unit groups have been created. The ProjectA and ProjectB unit groups do not have  
subgroups. The ProjectC unit group has one or more subgroups.  
To display a list of unit groups in the Unit Groups window:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
196  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open. If a unit group has  
subgroups (children), an arrow will be displayed next to its name.  
To display a list of groups in the global root group, click Global Root. The first global unit  
group listed will automatically be selected. Click on the arrow next to a group to expand it  
and display subgroup names.  
To display a list of groups in the personal root group, click Personal Root. The first  
personal unit group listed will automatically be selected. Click on the arrow next to a  
group to expand it and display subgroup names.  
You may customize the number of items per page that appear in this window; see Using the  
To display a list of unit groups in a Units View window:  
NOTE: When you create a unit group, you may indicate whether it (and any of its child unit groups) will be  
displayed in the side navigation bar.  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the side navigation bar. The Groups - Global Root window will open.  
If a unit group has subgroups (children), an arrow will be displayed next to its name.  
When a selected group has subgroups, the window will display either the immediate  
children of the unit group or all descendents of the unit group, depending on the Show  
group descendants setting.  
If a unit group does not have subgroups, a document icon will be displayed next to its  
name in the side navigation bar.  
When you click on a unit group in the side navigation bar that has a document icon (that is, it has no  
subgroups), a window will open, listing the units in the group. This window can include the same  
fields as other Units View windows; see Units View windows fields on page 99. You may enable or  
disable a field display using the Customize link. See Using the Customize link in windows on  
When you customize this window, you may also enable/disable the display of descendants. When  
enabled and a unit group is selected in a side navigation bar, the window will display all  
descendants of the group. When disabled, only the immediate children of the selected group will  
be displayed.  
To display information about a unit group:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click the group container or the parent group of the unit group you want to display  
information about.  
4. Click on the unit group name.  
5. The side navigation bar will contain information links about the selected unit group.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
197  
Click Name in the side navigation bar to display the unit group name.  
Click Members in the side navigation bar to display the unit group members.  
Click Groups to display a list of groups that are members of the unit group.  
Click Units to display a list of units that are members of the unit group.  
Click Access Rights in the side navigation bar to display the unit group access rights.  
6. Click Close.  
Adding or deleting a unit group  
To add a unit group:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox next to the group container (Global Root or Personal Root) or the group  
name that you want to be the parent of the new unit group.  
4. Click Add. The Add Unit Group window will open.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the unit group. The name must be unique within the parent  
group. For example, two groups can be named “development” but they cannot both be  
members of the unit group “Huntsville.” (This unique name restriction does not apply to  
personal unit groups that are owned by different users.)  
6. If you do not want the unit group (or any of its child unit groups) to appear in the side  
navigation bar, enable the Do not display this unit group nor any child unit groups as unit  
views checkbox.  
7. Click Save.  
To delete a unit group:  
NOTE: Deleting a unit group deletes the group only; the units still exist in the DSView 3 software system. You  
cannot delete any system-defined unit groups (global root, personal root and unassigned.)  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox next to the unit group to be deleted.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Changing the name, members or access rights of a unit group  
Access rights indicate which users and user groups may access units in the DSView 3 software  
system. Access rights also indicate which actions are allowed. See About Access Rights on  
page 129. You can assign access rights from a unit group perspective, as described in this section.  
Using this method, selected users and members of selected user groups are allowed or prohibited  
from initiating certain actions on all units in the unit group.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
198  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Access rights for a unit group default to inherit if they are not explicitly granted to a user or user  
group. For example, if you create unit group A and subgroup B, by default any access rights you  
assign to group A will be propagated to group B.  
There are other ways to assign access rights; see How access rights can be assigned on page 131.  
To change the name or display of a unit group:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open.  
3. Click on the name of a unit group. The Unit Group Name window will open.  
4. Type a new 1-64 character name in the Group field. The name must be unique within the  
parent group. For example, two groups can be named “development” but they cannot both be  
members of the unit group “Huntsville.” (This unique name restriction does not apply to  
personal unit groups that are owned by different users.)  
5. If you do not want the unit group (or any of its child unit groups) to appear in the side  
navigation bar, enable the Do not display this unit group nor any child unit groups as unit  
views checkbox.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
To add or remove members in a unit group:  
NOTE: Removing a unit group or unit member from a unit group does not delete the group/unit from the DSView  
3 software system or any other group to which it belongs.  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open.  
3. To add or remove a group member of the unit group, click Members in the side navigation bar  
and then click Groups.  
To add or remove a unit member of the unit group, click Members in the side navigation bar,  
and then click Units.  
NOTE: If you select a group container (Global Root or Personal Root), you can only add unit groups as members  
- you cannot add units; therefore, when you click Members in the side navigation bar, Groups is the only choice.  
You cannot add units or groups to the global unassigned unit group.  
4. The Unit Group Members (Units) or Unit Group Members (Groups) window will open.  
Click Assign.  
5. The Assign Units to Unit Group window will open.  
To add one or more units to the unit group, select the unit(s) from the Available Units list,  
then click Add. The units will be moved to the Units to Assign list.  
To remove one or more units already assigned to the unit group, select the unit(s) from the  
Units to Assign list, then click Remove. The units will be moved to the Available  
Units list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 15: Grouping Units  
199  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Unit Group Members window will open.  
7. Click Close. The Unit Groups window will open.  
To add or remove access rights for one or more unit groups:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. The Unit Groups window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of one or more unit groups, then click Rights. The Unit Group  
Access Rights window will open.  
If you are setting access rights for one unit group, you may click on the unit group name, then  
click Access Rights in the side navigation bar to access the Unit Group Access Rights window.  
4. To add or remove a user or user group from the User and User Groups list:  
a. Click Edit List. The Unit Access Rights User Selection window will open.  
To add one or more users or user groups, select the user(s) or user group(s) from the  
Available list, then click Add. The users and/or user groups will be moved to the List  
to Update list.  
To remove one or more users or user groups, select the user(s) or user group(s) from  
the List to Update list, then click Remove. The users and user groups will be moved to  
the Available list. (Inherited users and user groups can only be removed from the first  
unit group that specified any access rights other than inherit.)  
b. Click OK. The Unit Access Rights window will display the current list of users and/or user  
groups. When a user or user group is added to the list, the default access rights will  
be displayed.  
5. To set access rights, select a user or user group from the User and User Groups list, then enable  
or disable a checkbox in the Access Rights table for each access right.  
Allow - the access right is allowed for the user/user group.  
Deny - the access right is denied for the user/user group.  
Inherit - the access right is inherited from the unit group(s) to which the selected user/user  
group belongs. When Inherit is selected, the Allow and Deny checkboxes will become  
gray and unchangeable, and indicate the inherited value. If the inherited settings indicated  
both Allow and Deny, the inherited value is Deny, which takes precedence.  
To disable the inherit functionality, uncheck the Inherit checkbox.  
If none of the checkboxes are checked, the access right is neither allowed nor denied.  
If the unit group contains both appliances and target devices, all rights will be displayed and  
may be enabled, even though they may not necessarily be valid for the unit.  
6. Repeat the preceding steps to change access rights for other users or user groups.  
7. Click Save and then click Close. If a connection or power control action is enabled, the  
appropriate link will appear in the Action column of Units Views windows containing that  
group or units in that group.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
200  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
201  
CHAPTER  
Managing User Accounts  
16  
The DSView 3 software allows you to:  
Add, change and delete user accounts  
Unlock user accounts  
Specify user account restrictions  
Change user group membership  
Display user and user group access rights to target devices and managed appliances  
Add and delete user-defined user groups  
Display, assign and remove user group members from built-in or user-defined user groups  
User Accounts Windows  
User accounts are displayed and managed through User Accounts windows.  
To display the User Accounts window:  
1. Click the Users tab. The User Accounts - All window will open.  
2. To display the names of users in a built-in or user-defined user group, click the group name  
link under User Accounts in the side navigation bar. The User Accounts window for that group  
will open, listing all the users in the group.  
3. To select a user, click on a username in a User Accounts window.  
Customizing the User Accounts window  
The User Name field is usually displayed in the User Accounts window. One of the icons in  
Table 16.1 will appear to the left of the usernames and represent the status of each DSView 3  
software user.  
Table 16.1: User Status Icons  
Authentication  
Method  
Icon  
Status  
Face  
All  
Enabled - The user can log in and use the DSView 3 software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
202  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 16.1: User Status Icons (Continued)  
Authentication  
Icon  
Status  
Method  
Face with a  
red X  
Disabled - The user cannot log in to the DSView 3 software. See User  
Internal  
Locked - The user account has been locked; the user cannot log in to the  
DSView 3 software because the maximum number of log in failures has been  
Padlock  
Internal  
Question  
mark  
Suspicious - The user account exists, but the external authentication server  
no longer contains the account.  
External  
All  
Expired - The user account is configured with an expiration date, which has  
passed. Expired user accounts remain in the system until deleted. See User  
Face with  
a clock  
The following fields may be displayed in the User Accounts window. Use the Customize link to  
add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Full Name - Another name for a user. For example, a user may have a username of Sunrise1  
and a full name defined as Mary Jones. See Username on page 206.  
Status - User account status: Enabled, Disabled, Locked, Suspicious or Expired. One of the  
user status icons in Table 16.1 will appear to the left of the username.  
Preemption Level - Effective preemption level of a user. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
When a User Accounts window contains this column or a Group Preemption Level column,  
values are not displayed for external users (users validated with external authentication  
services). To display an external user’s effective and group preemption level, select the user’s  
name and then click Preemption Levels in the side navigation bar.  
Authentication Server - Name of the internal or external authentication server. See  
Business Address - Business address defined in the user’s properties. See Address on page 210.  
Business Mobile - Business mobile phone number defined in the user’s properties. See Phone  
Business Phone - Business phone number defined in the user’s properties. See Phone contact  
Default E-Mail - Default email account defined in the user’s properties. See Email contact on  
E-Mail 1-E-Mail 5 - Up to five additional email accounts defined in the user’s properties. See  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
203  
Custom Field 1- Custom Field 6 - Custom fields for the user. If you have specified text for a  
custom field, that text will display when you display the field. See Custom field properties on  
Group Preemption Level - Highest preemption level of all groups to which the user belongs.  
For example, if a user belongs to appliance administrators (with a group preemption level of 3)  
and auditors (with a group preemption level of 1), this field will display 3. See Preemption  
When a User Accounts window contains this column or a Preemption Level column, values  
are not displayed for external users (users validated with external authentication services). You  
may display an external user’s effective and group preemption level by selecting the user’s  
name and then clicking Preemption Levels in the side navigation bar.  
Home Address - Home address defined in the user’s properties. See Address on page 210.  
Home Phone - Home phone number defined in the user’s properties. See Phone contact on  
Mobile Phone - Mobile phone number defined in the user’s properties. See Phone contact on  
Pager - Pager number defined in the user’s properties. See Phone contact on page 210.  
User Preemption Level - User preemption level defined in the user’s properties. See  
Adding User Accounts  
The following information is configured when a user account is created:  
Whether the user will be authenticated using the DSView 3 software internal authentication or  
an external authentication server. See Authentication Services on page 73.  
The user groups in which the user will be included. Each user group contains specific access  
rights that allow a user to perform specific actions. See User Groups on page 215.  
The preemption level for interrupting or disconnecting serial or KVM sessions. See  
You must have DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator rights to add a user.  
To add a user account:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Add. The Add User Account Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
3. The Select Authentication Service window will open. This window lists the DSView 3  
software internal service and all the external authentication services that have been added,  
which may be used to authenticate users when they log in. See Authentication Services on  
Select an authentication service and then click Next.  
If you selected DSView Internal, go to step 4.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
204  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If you selected any other authentication service, go to step 5.  
4. The Type in User Credentials window will open.  
a. Type a username, password and confirm the password of the user you are adding.  
Usernames may contain up to 256 non-case sensitive characters (if a RADIUS external  
authentication service will be used, the limit is 253 characters). Usernames are  
case-preserving. For example, if an account named JDoe is created, it will be saved as  
JDoe in the DSView 3 server, but a user may log in as JDoe, jdoe, JDOe and so on.  
Passwords may contain 3-64 characters. Passwords will never expire unless User must  
change password at next login is selected in the Unit Password window, or Passwords  
Expire information is specified in the Authentication Service User Account Policies  
window. A DSView 3 software administrator may specify a different minimum character  
length and change expiration criteria. See Authentication Services on page 73.  
b. To enable users to set their own passwords when they log in to the DSView 3 software,  
click User must change password at next login.  
c. To designate the account as a service account, select the Service Account checkbox. A  
service account cannot be used to log in to the DSView 3 software. A service account can  
be used to impersonate another user over the Web Services API or GUI Access API. For  
more information, see the DSView 3 software SDK online help.  
NOTE: A service account may only be created if you selected the DSView 3 software internal authentication  
service in step 3.  
d. Click Next. Go to step 6.  
5. The Specify User Name window will open.  
If you selected RADIUS, TACACS+ or RSA SecurID in step 3:  
a. Enable the Specify user on external authentication service radio button.  
b. Type the username that is configured on the RADIUS, TACACS+ or RSA  
SecurID server.  
c. Click Next.  
If you selected any other type of external authentication service in step 3, you may either  
specify the username or find the user on the external authentication service.  
To specify the user, enable the Specify user on external authentication service radio button  
and type the name of the user. Then click Next.  
Usernames may contain up to 256 characters. Usernames may or may not be case  
sensitive, depending on the requirements of the external authentication server.  
To find the user, enable the Find user on external authentication service radio button. The  
Select User from External Authentication Service window will open.  
If the list of users contains more than 5000 entries, a message will indicate that not all  
items are displayed. You may filter the list by using the Filter button and the adjacent text  
field. Specifying a username in the text field will return all valid matches. If filtering on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
205  
another item (such as full name), you must include a wildcard. See Filtering information  
Select one or more users from the list, then click Next.  
6. The Assign User to User Groups window will open. This window lists all built-in and  
user-defined groups. Select one or more groups in the Available Groups list and click Add. The  
group names will move to the Member Of list, and the new user(s) will be added to those  
groups. Then click Next.  
7. The Select User Preemption Level window will open. Type a preemption level from 1-4 or  
select it from the menu, then click Next. (The higher the number, the higher the preemption  
8. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The user(s) have been added.  
The DSView 3 software obtains external group membership and external user information when a  
user logs in. If a user’s group membership changes or the user is deleted externally, the DSView 3  
software will not see those changes until the next time that user logs in.  
Deleting User Accounts  
To delete one or more user accounts:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the username(s). To delete all users on the page, click the  
checkbox to the left of User Name at the top of the list.  
3. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Unlocking User Accounts  
If lock-out settings have been specified for the DSView 3 internal authentication service and a user  
exceeds these settings, the user will not be allowed to attempt another log in until a certain amount  
of time has passed. Users that have been locked out will appear with a lock next to their name in the  
User Accounts window and Locked will appear in the Status column.  
User administrators or administrators may manually unlock the user accounts.  
To unlock one or more user accounts:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. In a User Accounts window, click the checkbox to the left of the username(s).  
3. Click Unlock.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
206  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Resetting a User Account Password  
A DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator may reset a user’s password. When a  
password is reset, the user will be required to login by typing password as their password, then  
enter and verify a new password for their account the next time they start a new DSView 3  
software session.  
To reset a user account password:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the user(s) to reset the password.  
3. Click Reset Password. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
4. Confirm or cancel the reset.  
Changing User Account Properties  
If you have DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator privileges, you may change the  
following account properties for a user:  
The user (login) name and full name  
The certificate associated with the user  
The SSH key associated with the user  
Login password  
Account login restrictions and expiration settings  
The user groups to which the user is assigned  
User preemption levels  
Home and business addresses  
Home, business, mobile and pager phone numbers  
Primary email address and up to five additional email addresses  
Notes you wish to add about the user  
Up to six custom fields  
Some properties may be changed only if the user account will be using the DSView 3 software  
internal authentication service. See Authentication Services on page 73.  
Username  
The username information that you may specify for a user includes:  
User Name - The name that the DSView 3 software uses to log in and identify the user.  
Full Name - The actual name of the user.  
For example, you may use Engr10 as the username and Jonathan Z. Smith as the full name to  
identify the person associated with the username.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
207  
To change the name of a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Type the username for the user.  
4. Type the full name of the user.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
User certificates  
Certificates may be changed only for internal authentication users. If the system certificate policy is  
enabled for user certificates (see System certificate policy and trust store on page 44), the user  
certificate used at login must meet the policy requirements.  
As an alternative to using this method, the user may change the certificate in the profile settings,  
but only if the administrator has enabled a global setting to allow it. See Specifying a user  
To change the certificate associated with a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Credentials in the side navigation bar and then click Certificate. The User Certificate  
window will open. If a certificate has failed a test required in the system certificate policy, the  
failure information is displayed.  
4. Type the path and name of the certificate or browse to the certificate location.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
User SSH key  
A configurable SSH key may be used by a serial console appliance to authenticate a DSView 3  
software user who is using an out of band client (for example, someone using a PuTTY SSH client  
that was not started by the DSView 3 software). The user supplies the public/private SSH key when  
connecting to the serial console appliance (only RSA keys with a maximum length of 1024 bits are  
allowed).The appliance then verifies the public key against the one stored for the user in the  
DSView 3 software.  
As an alternative to using this method, the user may specify the SSH key in the profile settings, but  
only if the administrator has enabled a global setting to allow it. See Specifying an SSH key on  
To specify a user SSH key:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
208  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. Click Credentials in the side navigation bar and then click SSH Key. The User SSH Key  
window will open.  
4. Type the 1-256 character name of the file containing the public SSH key that was generated by  
a third party key generator or browse to the file location.  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The SSH key file will be uploaded to the DSView 3 server for  
use in authenticating the user.  
User password  
A user’s password may be changed or you may specify that a user must enter a new password  
during the next login.The password may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To change a user password or force a new password:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. In a User Accounts window, click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Password in the side navigation bar. The User Password window will open.  
4. Type the new password for the user and verify the new password.  
5. To force a user to define a new password during the next login, enable the User must change  
password at next login checkbox.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
User account restrictions and expiration settings  
Account restriction and expiration settings may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To change user account restrictions and expiration settings:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Restrictions in the side navigation bar. The User Account Restrictions window will open.  
4. To change account restrictions:  
To prevent the user from logging into the DSView 3 software, enable the Disable user  
account checkbox. (Users with open sessions will remain logged in.) To re-enable the user  
account, uncheck the Disable user account checkbox.  
To force a user to define a new password during the next login, enable the User must  
change password at next login checkbox.  
To prevent the user from changing the password, enable the User cannot change  
password checkbox.  
To prevent a user’s password from expiring, enable the Click Password never  
expires checkbox.  
To designate the account as a service account, enable the Service Account checkbox. A  
service account cannot be used to log in to the DSView 3 software. A service account can  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
209  
be used to impersonate another user over the Web Services API or GUI Access API. For  
more information, see the DSView 3 software SDK online help.  
NOTE: A service account may only be created if you are using the DSView 3 software internal  
authentication service.  
5. To change account expiration settings:  
To indicate no expiration date, enable the Never radio button.  
To specify an expiration date, enable the End of radio button. Then click the button to the  
right of the adjacent field, and a calendar will be displayed. Select the date when the user  
account will expire.  
When a user account expires, it remains in the DSView 3 software system until the account  
is deleted.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
User group membership  
To change the group membership of a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click User Groups in the side navigation bar. The User Group Membership window will open.  
4. To add a user to one or more groups, select the group(s) in the Available Groups list, then click  
Add. The columns will be moved to the Member Of list.  
5. To remove the user from one or more groups, select the group(s) in the Member Of list, then  
click Remove. The groups will be moved to the Available Groups list.  
6. Click Save and then click Close.  
The DSView 3 software obtains external group membership and external user information when a  
user logs in. If a user’s group membership changes or the user is deleted externally, the DSView 3  
software will not see those changes until the next time that user logs in.  
Preemption level  
To change the preemption level of a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Preemption Levels in the side navigation bar. The User Preemption Level window  
will open.  
4. Select a preemption level (1-4) from the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
210  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Address  
The user address may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To specify address information for a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Addresses in the side navigation bar. The User Address Properties window will open.  
4. Type the home address and business address of the user.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Phone contact  
The phone contact may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To specify phone contact information for a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Telephones in the side navigation bar. The User Telephone Properties window will open.  
4. Type the home phone number, business phone number, mobile phone number, mobile business  
phone number and/or pager number of the user.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Email contact  
Email contacts may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To specify email contact information for user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. In a User Accounts window, click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click E-Mail Addresses in the side navigation bar. The User E-Mail Properties window  
will open.  
4. Type the primary email address of the user and up to five additional email addresses.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
User notes  
User notes may be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To specify notes about a user:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
211  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Notes in the side navigation bar. The User Notes window will open.  
4. Type any information you wish.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Custom field properties  
You may specify any information you wish in the six custom fields. Custom field properties may  
be changed only for internal authentication users.  
To change the custom fields:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username.  
3. Click Custom Fields in the side navigation bar. The User Custom Fields window will open.  
4. Type information in the fields.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
User Access Rights  
Access rights indicate whether a user is allowed to perform certain actions on a unit in the DSView  
3 software system. See About Access Rights on page 129 for detailed information and a list of  
actions that can be enabled/disabled for target devices and managed appliances.  
You may assign access control rights from a user perspective. You select a user account, specify  
the units for which rights will be assigned, then indicate the permission to perform the action (none,  
allow, deny or inherit) for each unit. That procedure is described in this section.  
There are other ways to assign access rights:  
From a user group perspective - see User Group Access Rights on page 220  
From a unit perspective - see Unit Access Rights on page 131  
To display a user’s access rights:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username. The User Name window will open.  
3. Click Effective Rights in the side navigation bar and then click All Units, Target Devices or  
Appliances. The Target Device Effective Rights or Appliance Effective Rights window will  
open. Columns indicate the available actions for the unit.  
Black check mark - The user has been granted access for this right.  
Gray check mark - A group to which the user belongs has been granted access for  
this right.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
212  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Black X - The user has been denied access for this right.  
Gray X - A group to which the user belongs has been denied access for this right.  
No check mark - No access has been granted or denied for this right.  
The access rights display for a target device may contain information that appears invalid. For  
example, virtual media access can be enabled to a target device that does not support it.  
Similarly, virtual media access to a target device could be enabled but KVM (Video Viewer)  
access may be disabled. See About target device access rights on page 130 for  
more information.  
4. Click Close when you are finished reviewing the access rights. The User Accounts window  
will open.  
Customizing Appliance and Target Device Access Rights windows  
The Name field is always displayed in the Target Device Access Rights and Appliance Access  
Rights windows. The action fields may also be displayed (see About Access Rights on page 129).  
Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in  
To add or remove access rights through a user account:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click on a username.  
3. Click Access Rights in the side navigation bar. The User Access Rights window will open.  
4. To add or remove a unit or unit group from the Unit and Unit Groups list, click Edit List. The  
User Access Rights Unit Selection window will open.  
To add one or more units/unit groups, select the units/groups in the Available list, then  
click Add. The units/unit groups will be moved to the List to Update list.  
To remove one or more units/unit groups, select the units/groups in the List to Update list,  
then click Remove. The units/unit groups will be moved to the Available list. (Inherited  
users and user groups can only be removed from the first unit group that specified any  
access rights other than inherit.)  
5. Click OK. The User Access Rights window will display the current list of units/unit groups.  
6. To add/remove access rights for a unit/unit group, select a unit or unit group from the Unit and  
Unit Groups list, then enable or disable a checkbox in the Access Rights table for each  
access right.  
Allow - the access right is allowed for the user.  
Deny - the access right is denied for the user.  
Inherit - the access right is inherited from the unit group(s) to which the selected unit/unit  
group belongs. When Inherit is selected, the Allow and Deny checkboxes will become  
gray and unchangeable, and indicate the inherited value. If the inherited settings indicated  
both Allow and Deny, the inherited value is Deny, which takes precedence.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 16: Managing User Accounts  
213  
To disable the inherit functionality, uncheck the Inherit checkbox.  
If none of the checkboxes are checked, the access right is neither allowed nor denied.  
7. Repeat the preceding step for other units/unit groups.  
8. Click Save and then click Close.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
214  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
215  
CHAPTER  
User Groups  
17  
Users that have been added to the DSView 3 software system may be added to the following two  
types of user groups:  
Built-In - The DSView 3 management software is delivered with six predefined user groups:  
Appliance Administrators, Auditors, DSView 3 software administrators, Everyone, User  
Administrators and Users. All users are automatically included in the Everyone user group  
when they are added to the DSView 3 software system. Users may be added to any of the other  
user groups. The privileges that a user has to perform tasks on the DSView 3 software system  
is dependent on the built-in user group to which the user is a member. See Built-in User  
User-defined - You may also define custom groups, based on any criteria you wish. For  
example, you may want to define groups based on user administrators with read-only access,  
software developers at a specific location, global network infrastructure personnel based on  
job title and so on.  
Built-in user groups appear in the User Groups - Built-in window and user-defined user groups  
appear in the User Groups - User Defined window. The Preemption Level column will indicate the  
preemption level of each user group. The windows may also display the following fields. Use the  
Customize link to add or remove fields in the display: See Using the Customize link in windows on  
Authentication Server - Name of the authentication server assigned to the user. See  
Role - Role of a user-defined user group, which may be None, User, Auditor, Appliance  
Administrator, User Administrator or DSView Administrator. The role column for a built-in  
user group or a user-defined user group with a role of None will be empty.  
Type - Type of user group, which will be built-in or user-defined.  
To display user groups:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Built-In will automatically be selected in the side  
navigation bar and the User Groups - Built-in window will open. To display the user-defined  
groups, click User-Defined in the side navigation bar. The User Groups - User Defined  
window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
216  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Group naming in external authentication services  
Groups in Active Directory (AD) external authentication services are specified using a combination  
of their Active Directory folder and group name, minus the group container specified in the  
DSView 3 software.  
The group container defaults to the AD domain root if it is unspecified.  
For example, if you have an AD external authentication service for the “sw.eng.mydomain.com”  
domain with no group container specified, the “Domain Users” group in the  
“sw.eng.mydomain.com/Users” folder will have a DSView 3 software equivalent of “Users/  
Domain Users”.  
Using the same example, but with a group container of “Users”, the DSView 3 software equivalent  
is “Domain Users”.  
Using the same example, but with a group container of “mydomain.com”, the DSView 3 software  
equivalent is “eng/sw/Users/Domain Users”.  
Groups in LDAP external authentication services are specified using a modified  
distinguishedName of their LDAP object, minus the group base DN specified in the DSView  
3 software.  
For example, if you have an LDAP external authentication service with a group base DN of  
“ou=myldap,c=US”, the “cn=Admin Users,ou=Users,o=myldap,c=US” group will have a DSView  
3 software equivalent of “Admin Users”.  
Using the same example, but with the “cn=Admin Users,c=Sunrise,ou=Users,o=myldap,c=US”  
group, the DSView 3 software equivalent is “Sunrise/Admin Users”.  
Adding User-defined User Groups  
If you are using DSView 3 software internal authentication, you may add your own custom  
user-defined user groups and then add other users that use DSView 3 internal authentication  
as members.  
External user-defined user groups (on external authentication servers) may be added, but their  
membership is not controlled by the DSView 3 software.  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator rights to add user-defined  
user groups.  
DSView 3 software internal, RADIUS, LDAP, Windows NT or Active Directory  
authentication services  
To add a user-defined user group:  
1. Click the Users tab. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Click User-Defined in the side  
navigation bar. The User Groups - User Defined window will open.  
2. Click Add. The Add User Group wizard will appear. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 17: User Groups  
217  
3. The Select Authentication Service window will open. This window lists all authentication  
services that may be used to authenticate the user group when the user logs in. See  
Click on the name of an authentication service and then click Next.  
If you selected DSView Internal as the authentication service, go to step 4.  
If you selected any other type of authentication service, go to step 5.  
NOTE: If you are adding a group to the TACACS+ authentication service, see TACACS+ external authentication  
services on page 217 for more information.  
4. The Type in Internal Group Name window will open. Type the name for the new user group  
you wish to create, and then click Next. User-defined user group names may contain up to 256  
characters. User-defined user group names are case-preserving. Go to step 7.  
5. The Specify External Group Name window will open.  
Click Import Everyone to consider any user on the external authentication server as a  
member of this user group. Then click Next and go to step 7.  
Click Specify a group on external authentication service and type the name of the group in  
the field. Then click Next and go to step 7.  
User group names may contain up to 256 non-case sensitive characters. User group names  
are case-preserving if the user group on the external authentication server is case sensitive.  
Click Find a group on external authentication service to browse a list of groups on the  
external authentication service. Then click Next and go to step 6.  
6. The Select Group from External Authentication Service window will open. If the list of groups  
contains more than 5000 entries, a message will indicate that not all items are displayed.  
You may filter the list by using the Filter button and the adjacent text field. See Filtering  
Select one or more groups from the list, then click Next.  
7. The Select Role window will open. Select a role for the user group(s), then click Next. See  
Built-in User Groups on page 37 for information about user roles.  
8. The Select User Group Preemption Level window will open. Type a preemption level (from  
1-4; the higher the number, the higher the preemption level) or select a value from the menu,  
and then click Next. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
TACACS+ external authentication services  
To add a TACACS+ user group:  
1. Click the Users tab. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Click User-Defined in the side  
navigation bar. The User Groups - User Defined window will open.  
2. Click Add. The Add User Group wizard will appear. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
218  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. The Select Authentication Service window will open. This window lists all authentication  
services that may be used to authenticate the user group when the user logs in. Select an  
appropriate TACACS+ authentication service from the list. Click Next.  
4. If the TACACS+ service you selected is configured to use the privilege level attribute method,  
the Specify External Group Name window will open and display a list of privilege levels 0-15  
(the higher the number, the higher the level of access).  
Select a privilege level from the list. The DSView 3 server will assign a group name based on  
the privilege level you select. For example, if you choose level 7, the group name will be  
Privilege Level 7.  
Click Next.  
-or-  
If the TACACS+ service you selected is configured to use the group name custom attribute  
method, the Specify External Group Name window will open and display a Name field. Type  
the name for the external user group on the external authentication service. The group name  
must correspond to one of the values configured in the TACACS+ service.  
Click Next.  
5. The Select Role window will open. Select a role for the user group(s), then click Next. See  
Built-in User Groups on page 37 for information about user roles.  
6. The Select User Group Preemption Level window will open. Type a preemption level (from  
1-4; the higher the number, the higher the preemption level) or select a value from the menu,  
and then click Next. See Preemption Levels on page 38.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
Deleting User-defined User Groups  
You may delete any user-defined user groups that have been created in the DSView 3 software  
system. You must have DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator rights to delete  
user-defined user groups.  
To delete a user-defined user group:  
1. Click the Users tab. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Click User-Defined in the side  
navigation bar. The User Groups - User Defined window will open.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the user group(s) to be deleted. To delete all user groups listed  
in the window, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
3. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 17: User Groups  
219  
User Group Properties  
To display the properties of a built-in user group:  
1. Click the Users tab. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Built-In will automatically be  
selected in the side navigation bar and the User Groups - Built-in window will open.  
2. Click on a user group name. The User Group Properties window will open. The display  
includes read-only properties for each group: name, type and preemption level.  
3. Click Close when you are finished. The User Groups - Built-in window will open.  
To display or change the properties of a user-defined user group:  
1. Click the Users tab. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Click User-Defined in the side  
navigation bar. The User Groups - User Defined window will open.  
2. Click on a user group name. The User Group Properties window will open.  
3. To change the name of the user group, type a new 1-256 character name in the Name field.  
NOTE: If the user group belongs to a TACACS+ service that uses the privilege level attribute method, the Name  
field will be disabled.  
4. To change the preemption level, type a number (from 1-4; the higher the number, the higher the  
preemption level) in the Preemption Level field or select a value from the menu. See  
5. To change the role of the user group, select a role from the menu. If you do not wish to assign  
a role to the user group, select None.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The User Groups - User Defined window will open.  
Changing User Group Members  
When users are created, they may be assigned to one or more built-in or user-defined user groups.  
You may add or remove users to or from the built-in and user-defined user groups.  
To add or remove user group members:  
NOTE: Members may only be assigned to or removed from user groups defined on the internal DSView 3  
authentication service.  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Built-In will automatically be selected in the side  
navigation bar and the User Groups - Built-in window will open. To display the User Groups -  
User Defined window, click User-Defined in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click on a user group name. The User Group Properties window will open.  
4. Click Members in the side navigation bar. The User Group Members window will open.  
5. Click Assign. The Assign Users to User Group window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
220  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
6. To add one or more users to the user group, select the user(s) in the Available Users list, then  
click Add. The users will be moved to the Members list.  
7. To remove one or more users from the user group, select the user(s) in the Members list, then  
click Remove. The users will be moved to the Available Users list.  
8. Click Save and then click Close. The User Group Members window will open.  
9. Click Close. The User Groups - Built-In or User Groups - User Defined window will open  
(depending on which groups you were working with).  
You may also add or remove a user from a built-in or user-defined user group by clicking on a  
username in a User Accounts window and changing its user group membership. See Changing  
User Group Access Rights  
Access rights indicate whether a user is allowed to perform certain actions on a unit in the DSView  
3 software system. See About Access Rights on page 129 for detailed information and a list of  
actions that are available for target devices and managed appliances.  
You may assign access control rights from a user group perspective. You select a user group,  
specify the units for which rights will be assigned, then indicate the permission to perform the  
action (none, allow, deny or inherit) for each unit. That procedure is described in this section.  
There are other ways to assign access rights:  
From a user perspective - see User Access Rights on page 211  
From a unit perspective - see Unit Access Rights on page 131  
To display user group access rights:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar. Built-In will automatically be selected in the side  
navigation bar and the User Groups - Built-in window will open. To display the User Groups -  
User Defined window, click User-Defined in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click on a user group name. The User Group Properties window will open.  
4. Click Effective Rights in the side navigation bar and then click All Units, Target Devices or  
Appliances. The Target Devices Effective Rights window or Appliance Effective Rights  
window will open. Columns indicate the available actions for the unit.  
Black check mark - the user has been granted access for this right  
Gray check mark - a group to which the user belongs has been granted access for this right  
Black X - the user has been denied access for this right  
Gray X - a group to which the user belongs has been denied access for this right  
No check mark - no access has been granted or denied for this right  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 17: User Groups  
221  
The access rights display may contain information that appears invalid. For example, virtual  
media access can be enabled to a target device that does not support it. Similarly, virtual media  
access could be enabled but KVM (Video Viewer) access may be disabled. See About target  
5. Click Close when you are finished. The User Accounts - All window will open.  
To add or remove user group access rights:  
1. Click the Users tab.  
2. Click Groups in the top navigation bar.  
3. Built-In will automatically be selected in the side navigation bar and the User Groups - Built-in  
window will open. To display the User Groups - User Defined window, click User-Defined in  
the side navigation bar.  
4. Click on a user group name.  
5. Click Access Rights in the side navigation bar. The User Group Access Rights window  
will open.  
6. To add or remove a unit or unit group from the Unit and Unit Groups list, click Edit List. The  
User Group Access Rights Unit Selection window will open.  
To add one or more units/unit groups, select the units/groups in the Available list, then  
click Add. The units/unit groups will be moved to the List to Update list.  
To remove one or more units/unit groups, select the units/groups in the List to Update list,  
then click Remove. The units/unit groups will be moved to the Available list.  
7. Click OK. The User Group Access Rights window will display the current list of units/  
unit groups.  
8. To add/remove access rights for a unit/unit group, select a unit or unit group from the Unit and  
Unit Groups list, then enable or disable a checkbox in the Access Rights table for each  
access right.  
Allow - the access right is allowed for members of the user group.  
Deny - the access right is denied for members of the user group.  
Inherit - the access right is inherited from the unit group(s) to which the selected unit/unit  
group belongs. When Inherit is selected, the Allow and Deny checkboxes will become  
gray and unchangeable, and indicate the inherited value. If the inherited settings indicated  
both Allow and Deny, the inherited value is Deny, which takes precedence.  
To disable the inherit functionality, uncheck the Inherit checkbox.  
If none of the checkboxes are checked, the access right is neither allowed nor denied.  
9. Repeat the preceding step for other units/unit groups.  
10. Click Save and then click Close.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
222  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
223  
CHAPTER  
Using the Video Viewer  
18  
The Video Viewer is used to conduct a KVM session with one or more target devices attached to  
one or more KVM switches. You may optionally use KVM session profiles to control session  
behavior on target devices. When you connect to a device using the Video Viewer, the target device  
desktop appears in a separate window. The Video Viewer window supports either a 3 or 5  
button mouse.  
Virtual media sessions, which are supported on certain KVM switches, are opened from the  
Video Viewer.  
About the Video Viewer  
The DSView 3 management software uses either a Java-based program or an ActiveX applet to  
display the Video Viewer window. The Java-based Video Viewer is launched from the Mozilla,  
Firefox and Netscape based clients when a KVM session is requested. The ActiveX Video Viewer  
is launched from Internet Explorer on Windows.  
KVM sessions may be launched to devices from any supported KVM switch. Each KVM session  
will be established using the configured encryption level. See Managed Appliance Session Settings  
To launch a KVM session, a user must have been assigned rights or belong to a user group which  
has been assigned rights to establish a KVM session. See About Access Rights on page 129.  
The DSView 3 software uses system memory to store and display images within Video Viewer  
windows. Each opened Video Viewer window requires additional system memory. An 8-bit color  
setting on the client PC requires 1.4 MB of memory per Video Viewer window, a 16-bit color  
setting requires 2.4 MB and a 32-bit color setting requires 6.8 MB. Opening more than four  
simultaneous Video Viewer windows may affect system performance and is not recommended. If  
you attempt to open more Video Viewer windows than your system memory allows, you will  
receive an out of memory error and the requested Video Viewer window will not open.  
When using a non-proxied connection, video performance over a slower network connection may  
be less than optimal. Since certain color settings use less network bandwidth than others, changing  
the color settings may increase video performance. For optimal video performance over a slower  
network connection, a color setting such as Grayscale/Best Compression or Low Color/High  
Compression is recommended. See Color depth on page 232.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
224  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The Video Viewer client requires Java when launched from Mozilla, Netscape or Firefox browsers.  
The supported Java version is 1.5.0_02. The Video Viewer requires this version. The DSView 3  
software client automatically downloads and installs the JRE (Java Runtime Environment) the first  
time the Video Viewer or Telnet Viewer is launched. See Java Installation on page 18.  
See the DSR Installer/User Guide for information about how the keys on a standard Type 5 Sun  
keyboard are emulated on a PS/2 keyboard.  
Window Features  
3
5
2
4
6
7
1
8
9
Figure 18.1: Video Viewer Window (Normal Windows Mode) (Windows OS Shown)  
Table 18.1: Video Viewer Window Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
Title Bar: Displays the name of the server being viewed. When in Full Screen mode, the title bar  
disappears and the server name appears between the menu and toolbar.  
1
2
Thumbtack: Locks the display of the menu and toolbar so that it is visible at all times.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
225  
Table 18.1: Video Viewer Window Descriptions (Continued)  
Number Description  
Menu and toolbar: Allows you to access many of the features in the Video Viewer window. The  
menu and toolbar will be in a show/hide state if the thumbtack has not been used. Place your  
cursor over the toolbar to display the menu and toolbar.  
Up to ten commands and/or macro group buttons may be displayed on the toolbar. By default,  
the Single Cursor Mode, Refresh, Automatic Video Adjust and Align Local Cursor buttons  
3
Macro button: Displays when a user specifies icons for macros and indicates that the icons  
should appear on the toolbar. See Macros on page 247.  
4
5
Minimize button: Minimizes the display of the Video Viewer window into the task bar at the  
bottom of the local computer.  
Maximize button: Changes the window to Full Screen mode, which expands the accessed  
device desktop to fill the entire screen. When you expand the window, the following occurs:  
The title bar disappears.  
6
7
The server name appears between the menu and toolbar.  
The Maximize button is changed to a Normal Window Mode button and it appears on the  
toolbar. Clicking the button will toggle the Video Viewer window to Normal Window mode.  
The Close button appears on the toolbar.  
Close button: Closes the Video Viewer window. This button may not be present on all  
operating systems.  
8
9
Accessed device desktop: Interacts with your device through this window.  
Frame: Resizes the Video Viewer window by clicking and holding on the frame.  
NOTE: On supported Macintosh system clients, the placement of some buttons is different. The Minimize,  
Maximize and Close buttons are located on the left side of the screen, and the frame can be resized by clicking  
in the lower right corner.  
NOTE: On supported Macintosh system clients, the Video Viewer opens in a self-contained window and is not  
included in the Macintosh Application Menu.  
Opening a KVM Session  
See Connecting to an existing session on page 226 for information about what occurs if the device  
you are attempting to access is currently being viewed by another user.  
To open a KVM session from the DSView 3 Explorer:  
In a Units View window containing the target device you want to access (see Accessing Units View  
windows on page 98), click the KVM Session link in the Action column of the target device you  
wish to view.  
The Video Viewer launches in a new window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
226  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To open a KVM session using the Unit Overview window:  
1. In a Units View window containing the target device you want to access (see Accessing Units  
View windows on page 98), click on the name of the target device. The Unit Overview window  
will open.  
2. Click on the KVM Session name or icon.  
The Video Viewer launches in a new window.  
Opening an exclusive KVM session  
An exclusive KVM connection is used when you need to access a port while excluding all other  
users. When a port is selected with the Exclusive KVM connection setting enabled, no other user in  
the system may switch to that port.  
To open an exclusive (non-shared) KVM session from the DSView 3 Explorer:  
1. In a Units View window containing the target device you want to access (see Accessing Units  
View windows on page 98), click the alternate actions arrow in the Action column of the target  
device. A list of actions will appear.  
2. Click the Exclusive KVM Session link.  
The Video Viewer launches in a new window. A yellow dot will appear next to the icon of the  
target device in the Units View windows to indicate an Exclusive KVM connection. Other  
users may not share that session.  
To open an exclusive (non-shared) KVM session in the Unit Overview window:  
1. In a Units View window containing the target device you want to access (see Accessing Units  
View windows on page 98), click on the name of the target device. The Unit Overview window  
will open.  
2. Click Exclusive KVM Session.  
3. Click the KVM Session icon or link in the Unit Overview window.  
The Video Viewer launches in a new window. A yellow dot will appear next to the icon of the  
target device in the Units View windows to indicate an Exclusive KVM connection. Other  
users may not share the session.  
Connecting to an existing session  
When you attempt to connect to a port already in use by another user, the Cannot connect to the  
server dialog box displays and states that the port is in use along with the name of the current  
user(s). At this point, you may request to share access to the port with the current user(s).  
You may be presented with one or more of the following options:  
Actively share a connection - When you are prompted to share a connection and you click  
Share with the other user but do not click Passive Share, an active connection will be  
established. When sharing access to a port actively, all users may monitor the port and take  
control if no other user is currently active.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
227  
When you click OK, the primary user who is currently active will receive a request to allow  
sharing unless Allow shared connections automatically has been enabled (see Video Viewer  
session properties on page 227). If the user confirms, then you will be given active access to  
the port.  
Passively share a connection - When you are prompted to share a connection and you click  
Share with the other user and also click Passive Share, a passive connection will be  
established. When sharing access to a port passively, you may only view what occurs on the  
target device, without controlling the keyboard or mouse.  
When you click OK, the primary user who is currently active will receive a request to allow  
sharing unless Allow shared connections automatically has been enabled (see Video Viewer  
session properties on page 227). If the user confirms, then you will be given passive access to  
the port.  
Preempt a user’s connection (DSView 3 software administrators and user administrators only)  
- When you are prompted to preempt the user’s session and you click Preempt the other user,  
the user requesting access to the target device will be connected and existing user(s) will lose  
their connection to the target device. The existing user(s) will be notified that their sessions  
have been preempted.  
You cannot preempt a local user who is in broadcast mode. See the DSR Installer/User Guide  
for more information.  
Make a stealth connection (DSView 3 software administrators and user administrators only) -  
When you are prompted to connect using Stealth mode and you click Stealth mode, a Video  
Viewer window session will be started but you will only be able to view what occurs on the  
target device, without controlling the keyboard or mouse. The user who is currently active will  
not be notified that access is being shared and no request to authorize sharing will be made.  
Up to 12 users may share a single port at one time. If a 13th user attempts to connect, an error  
message will inform the user that no sessions are available.  
To display a list of users sharing their port or channel, select View - List of Shared Users in the  
Video Viewer window. Users in stealth mode are excluded from this display.  
Video Viewer session properties  
Session properties specify whether users may share Video Viewer sessions automatically and  
whether shared connections may be viewed with the Video Viewer View - Connected  
Users command.  
To change Video Viewer session properties:  
You must have DSView 3 software administrator or user administrator privileges to configure  
Video Viewer session properties.  
1. Click the System tab in the DSView 3 Explorer.  
2. Click Global Properties in the top navigation bar. The Video Viewer Session Properties  
window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
228  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. To allow other users to share a Video Viewer session automatically, enable the Allow shared  
connections automatically checkbox. You will not be notified that they wish to connect to the  
session and will not be able to accept or reject the connection.  
Disable the checkbox if you want to be notified when other users want to share the Video  
Viewer session. When a user attempts to connect to the session, you will be notified and  
prompted to accept or reject the connection request.  
4. To display a list of shared connections using the View - Connected Users command in the  
Video Viewer window, enable the View identity of shared connections checkbox. See  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Session time-out  
A remote session may time-out if there has been no activity in a session window for a specified  
time. The session time-out value is configured by the DSView 3 software administrator at the  
You may override this value within the DSView 3 Explorer. If you specify a new time-out value, it  
will be used the next time the DSView 3 software is started.  
Closing a Video Viewer Session  
To close a Video Viewer session:  
Select File - Exit from the Video Viewer menu.  
KVM Session Profiles  
KVM session profiles provide a convenient method of controlling KVM session behavior on a  
target device. DSView 3 software appliance administrators may add, change and delete KVM  
session profiles. A profile is then assigned to a target device. Appliance administrators or users  
with unit configure or unit edit rights may assign a profile to one or more target devices.  
There is always one KVM session profile, named the Default KVM Session Profile. (This profile is  
called the “default profile” for the remainder of this section.) Its configuration may be changed, but  
the default profile cannot be deleted. The default profile is used when the profile assigned to a  
target device is deleted. It is also used when a target device is added to the DSView 3 software  
system and no other profile is assigned.  
NOTE: For DSView 3 software systems that are upgraded to version 3.2 or later from an earlier version, existing  
target devices will not be assigned a profile.  
You may create any number of additional KVM session profiles and then assign them to target  
devices. When a new profile is created, it has all settings configured to Inherit Default Settings; that  
is, it uses all the settings from the default profile. The appliance administrator may then change  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
229  
only those settings that differ from the default profile. For example, a new profile may be identical  
to the default profile, except with different toolbar settings.  
Some settings have a profile override option, which indicates whether users may override the  
profile information by using Video Viewer menu commands (see Using Menu Commands to  
Manage Session Settings on page 236). If the override option is disabled for a setting in the profile,  
the Video Viewer menu selection for that setting will be disabled for the target device using that  
profile. If a target device is not assigned a profile, a user with a Video Viewer connection to that  
target device may use the Video Viewer menu commands to control their session.  
In addition to the profile override option, the c5(ione)-6(rt)(h ind) vdeo Vsal ng -6( )6(tetti-5(iog -6( )4(ihave-6(e  
   
230  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Ctrl-Alt-Del. For Macintosh operating systems, the following table lists keystrokes and keystroke  
combinations that are not supported.  
Table 18.2: Macintosh Keys and Keystrokes Not Supported in Keyboard Pass Through  
Keystrokes and Keystroke Combinations  
Description  
F13  
F14  
F15  
F16  
Function Key  
Brightness Up  
Brightness Down  
Function Key  
Volume Down  
Volume Up  
Mute  
Eject  
Command-Option-Eject  
Command-Control-Eject  
Command-Option-Control-Eject  
Option-Command-D  
Sleep Immediately  
Restart  
Shut Down  
Display/Hide Dock  
When the local desktop is active, keystrokes and keystroke combinations entered by the user affect  
the local computer.  
In full-screen mode, keystrokes are always passed to the target device, regardless of the keyboard  
pass through mode setting.  
The Ctrl-Alt-Delete keyboard combination can only be sent to a remote server by using a macro.  
The Japanese keyboard ALT-Han/Zen keystroke combination is always sent to a remote server,  
regardless of the screen mode or keyboard pass through setting.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may enable/disable pass through mode using Video Viewer menu commands. You may also  
enable/disable full screen mode. See General commands on page 237.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
231  
Menu activation keystroke  
The menu activation keystroke setting specifies the keystroke that can be used to activate the Video  
Viewer menu. When the menu and toolbar display are hidden, pressing this key re-enables  
the display.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the menu activation keystroke using Video Viewer menu commands. See  
Cursor profile settings  
To prevent potential mouse conflicts, you may configure certain settings on each server connected  
to a managed appliance. For details, see the Mouse and Pointer Settings Technical Brief, which is  
available on the DSView 3 software DVD and on the Avocent web site.  
Local cursor  
The local cursor setting specifies the appearance of the local mouse cursor. There are five  
appearance choices. You may also choose no cursor or the default cursor.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the local cursor setting using Video Viewer menu commands. See Cursor  
Single cursor mode - session startup  
NOTE: Single cursor mode is available only on supported Windows system clients.  
The single cursor mode - session startup setting indicates whether the Video Viewer starts up in  
single cursor mode.  
In single cursor mode, the display of the local (second) cursor in the Video Viewer window is  
turned off and only the target device mouse pointer will be visible. The only mouse movements that  
will appear are those of the target device remote cursor. Single cursor mode is used when there is  
no need for a local cursor.  
The cursor mode status of the Video Viewer window displays in the title bar, including the  
keystroke that can be used to exit single cursor mode.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may enter and exit single cursor mode using Video Viewer menu commands. See Cursor  
Single cursor mode - release keystroke  
The single cursor mode - release keystroke setting indicates the keystroke that can be used to  
release the Video Viewer single cursor mode.  
When using a device that captures keystrokes before they reach the client, you should avoid using  
those keys to restore the mouse pointer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
232  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the cursor release keystroke using Video Viewer menu commands. See Cursor  
Toolbar profile settings  
Hide delay  
The hide delay setting indicates the number of seconds before the toolbar hides in the Video  
Viewer window when it is in show/hide state (that is, not locked in place by the thumbtack).  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the hide delay using Video Viewer menu commands. See Toolbar commands on  
Available/enabled items lists  
The Available items and Enabled items columns indicate which toolbar functions and macros can  
and will be displayed in the Video Viewer window.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the items to display using Video Viewer menu commands. See Toolbar  
Video profile settings  
Color depth  
The color depth setting indicates the color depth the Video Viewer will use.  
The Dambrackas Video Compression™ (DVC) algorithm allows you to display more colors for the  
best fidelity, or fewer colors to reduce the volume of data transferred on the network.  
The choices are (in descending color quantity): Best Color, Medium Color/Medium Compression,  
Low Color/High Compression or Gray Scale/Best Compression.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, you may also control whether they may select a  
value higher than the profile setting. For example, when this control is enabled, if the color depth  
setting in the profile is Low Color/High Compression, users on a target device using that profile  
will not be able to select Best Color. However, they could select a lower color depth such as Gray  
Scale/Best Compression.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the color depth using Video Viewer menu commands. See Video commands on  
Video scaling  
The video scaling setting indicates the Video Viewer window resolution. You may choose absolute  
values, auto scale or full scale.  
When autoscaling is enabled, the DSView 3 software will automatically adjust the display if the  
window size changes during a session. When a user accesses a channel using sharing, the display  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
233  
will be adjusted to match the input resolution selected by the primary user of that channel. This will  
prevent the primary user’s display from being affected. If the target device resolution changes any  
time during a session, the display will be adjusted automatically.  
When full scaling is enabled, the display window is sized to match the resolution of the server  
being viewed.  
If users are allowed to override this profile setting, you may also control whether they may select a  
value higher than the profile setting. For example, when this control is enabled, if the video scaling  
setting in the profile is 768 x 576, users on a target device using that profile will not be able to  
select 1024 x 768. However, they could select a lower resolution such as 640 x 480.  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may specify the video scaling using Video Viewer menu commands. See Video commands on  
Background refresh  
The background refresh setting enables or disables background refresh.  
When background refresh is enabled, a small portion of video data is constantly sent by the KVM  
switch to background refresh the Video Viewer window. When background refresh is disabled, the  
Video Viewer window is updated by the switch only when it determines that the target device video  
image has changed.  
NOTE: This option is not available if the switch does not support background refresh or if the DSR Remote  
Operations software is being used to connect to the DSR switch viewing the target device. See DSR Remote  
If you enable Allow users to override this setting, or if no profile is assigned to the target device,  
users may enable/disable background refresh using Video Viewer menu commands. Users may  
also use the Refresh Image command. See Video commands on page 239.  
Managing KVM session profiles  
Only appliance administrators may display, add, change or delete a KVM session profile. To assign  
a profile to a target device, the user must either be an appliance administrator or have unit configure  
or edit rights. These operations are all performed in the DSView 3 Explorer.  
To display KVM session profile names and settings:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Profiles in the top navigation bar. The KVM Session Profiles window will open, listing  
the profile names.  
3. To view a profile’s settings, click the profile name, then click General, Cursor, Toolbar or  
Video in the side navigation bar to view the settings.  
4. Click Close.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
234  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To add a KVM session profile:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Profiles in the top navigation bar. The KVM Session Profiles window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add KVM Session Profile window will open.  
4. Enter a 1-64 character name for the new profile. The name cannot be the same as the name of  
an existing KVM session profile.  
5. Click Add. The new profile will be created with all values set to Inherit Default Settings.  
To change a KVM session profile:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Profiles in the top navigation bar. The KVM Session Profiles window will open.  
3. Click the profile name.  
4. Change the desired settings.  
For many settings, the choices will include Inherit Default Settings, if you are changing  
any profile other than the default profile. When you select Inherit Default Settings, the  
fields for that setting will automatically be filled with values from the Default KVM  
Session Profile; these values cannot be changed.  
Several settings also allow you to enable/disable an Allow users to override these settings  
checkbox. When enabled, users may override that profile setting using a Video Viewer  
menu command or button. When disabled, users cannot override the setting.  
For all profiles other than the default profile, if a setting is configured with Inherit Default  
Settings, the Allow users to override these settings checkbox for that setting will not be  
available (it will be disabled).  
5. To change general settings (see General profile settings on page 229):  
a. Click General in the side navigation bar. The General Settings window will open.  
b. In the Name field, enter a 1-64 character name. This cannot be the same name as an  
existing KVM session profile.  
c. In the Default Macro Group field, select the macro group that will appear in the Video  
Viewer Macros menu. Enable or disable the Allow users to override this setting checkbox.  
d. In the Keyboard Pass Through Mode field, enable or disable keyboard pass through.  
Enable or disable the Allow users to override this setting checkbox. As noted in the  
window, in full screen mode, keystrokes are always passed to the target device, regardless  
of this setting.  
e. In the Menu Activation Keystroke field, select the keystroke that will activate the Video  
Viewer menu. Enable or disable the Allow users to override this setting checkbox.  
f. If you changed any settings, click Save.  
6. To change cursor settings (see Cursor profile settings on page 231):  
a. Click Cursor in the side navigation bar. The Cursor Settings window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
235  
b. In the Local Cursor field, if you do not check the Inherit Default Settings checkbox,  
enable the radio button for the desired cursor type. Check or uncheck the Allow users to  
override this setting checkbox.  
c. In the Single Cursor Mode - Session Startup field, indicate whether the Video Viewer will  
start up in single cursor mode. In the Single Cursor Mode - Release Keystroke field, select  
the keystroke that will release the Video Viewer single cursor mode. Enable or disable the  
Allow users to override these settings checkbox.  
d. If you changed any settings, click Save.  
7. To change toolbar settings (see Toolbar profile settings on page 232):  
a. Click Toolbar in the side navigation bar. The Toolbar Settings window will open.  
b. If this is not the default profile, the Inherit Default Settings checkbox may be enabled or  
disabled. When enabled, no other settings in this window may be changed.  
c. In the Hide Delay field, select the number of seconds for the toolbar hide delay.  
d. To add functions to be displayed in the toolbar, select one or more functions from the  
Available Functions column, then click Add. The selected items will move to the Enabled  
Functions column.  
To add macros to be displayed in the toolbar, select one or more macros from the  
Available Macros column, then click Add. The selected items will move to the Enabled  
Macros column.  
To remove functions or macros from display in the toolbar, select one or more items from  
the Enabled Functions or Enabled Macros column, then click Remove. The selected items  
will move to the Available Functions or Available Macros column.  
e. Enable or disable the Allow users to override these settings checkbox.  
f. If you changed any settings, click Save. The enabled functions will be displayed first in  
the toolbar, followed by the enabled macros.  
8. To change video settings (see Video profile settings on page 232):  
a. Click Video in the side navigation bar. The Video Settings window will open.  
b. In the Color Depth field, choose the desired value. Enable or disable the Allow users to  
override these settings checkbox.  
If users are allowed to override this setting, you may also enable or disable the Prohibit  
users from selecting a higher value checkbox. When enabled, users may select a higher  
color depth value than the current setting. When disabled, users may not select a higher  
value, but they may select a lower value.  
c. In the Video Scaling field, choose the desired value. Enable or disable the Allow users to  
override these settings checkbox.  
If users are allowed to override this setting, you may also enable or disable the Prohibit  
users from selecting a higher value checkbox. When enabled, users may select a higher  
video scaling value than the current setting. When disabled, users may not select a higher  
value, but they may select a lower value.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
236  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
d. In the Background Refresh field, enable or disable background refresh. Enable or disable  
the Allow users to override these settings checkbox.  
e. If you changed any settings, click Save.  
9. Click Close.  
To delete one or more KVM session profiles:  
NOTE: The default KVM Session Profile cannot be deleted.  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Profiles in the top navigation bar.  
3. To delete one or more profiles, click the checkbox to the left of the profile name. To delete all  
profiles except the Default KVM Session Profile, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the  
top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
To assign a KVM session profile to a target device:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click on the target device name.  
2. Click Properties in the side navigation bar, then click Profiles in the side navigation bar. The  
Profiles window will open.  
3. Select the desired profile.  
4. Click Save and then click Close.  
To assign a KVM session profile to multiple target devices:  
1. In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on  
page 98), click the checkbox next to one or more target devices. To change the KVM session  
profile for all target devices in the page, click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of  
the list.  
2. Click Operations, then select Properties from the drop-down menu.  
3. The Multiple Unit Properties window will open. Click Profile.  
4. Select a KVM session profile from the menu.  
5. Click Save and then click Close.  
Using Menu Commands to Manage Session Settings  
KVM session profiles contain settings for the many following operations. In a profile, if the Allow  
users to override this setting checkbox is enabled for a setting, or if a profile has not been assigned  
to a target device, Video Viewer users connected to that target device may use the Video Viewer  
menu commands/buttons described in this section.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
237  
General commands  
All of the following commands except enabling/disabling full screen mode may also be specified in  
a KVM session profile; see General profile settings on page 229.  
To specify a key for toggling activation of the menu and toolbar:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the General tab.  
3. In the Menu Activation Keystroke field, select a keystroke from the menu.  
4. Click OK. When you disable the menu and toolbar display, pressing the specified key  
reenables the display.  
To enable keyboard pass through:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the General tab.  
3. Select Pass-through all keystrokes in regular window mode.  
4. Click OK.  
To enable or disable full screen mode:  
NOTE: The View - Full Screen command may only be used by the primary user. The command is not available to  
non-primary users who are sharing the session.  
1. To enable full screen mode, click the Maximize button or select View - Full Screen from the  
Video Viewer menu. The desktop window will disappear and only the accessed device desktop  
will be visible. The screen will be resized up to a maximum of 1024 x 768. If the desktop has a  
higher resolution, then a black background will surround the full screen image. The floating  
toolbar will appear.  
2. To disable full screen mode, click the Full Screen Mode button on the floating toolbar to return  
to the desktop window.  
Cursor commands  
The mouse cursor and key for exiting single cursor mode commands may also be specified in a  
The commands to enter and exit single cursor mode and the command to align the mouse cursors  
cannot be set in a KVM session profile.  
NOTE: If the target device does not support the ability to disconnect and reconnect the mouse (almost all newer  
PCs do), then the mouse will become disabled and the device will have to be rebooted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
238  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To prevent potential mouse conflicts, you may configure certain settings on each server connected  
to a managed appliance. For details, see the Mouse and Pointer Settings Technical Brief, which is  
available on the DSView 3 software DVD and on the Avocent web site.  
To change the mouse cursor setting:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the Mouse tab.  
3. In the Local Cursor panel, select a mouse cursor type.  
4. Click OK.  
To enter single cursor mode:  
Select Tools - Single Cursor Mode from the Video Viewer menu or click the Single Cursor Mode  
button. The local cursor will not appear and all movements will be relative to the target device.  
NOTE: Single cursor mode is only available on supported Windows system clients.  
To specify a key for exiting single cursor mode:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the Mouse tab.  
3. In the Single Cursor mode field, select a key from the menu.  
4. Click OK. The key will be displayed in the title bar. When single cursor mode is enabled,  
pressing the specified key returns the session to regular desktop mode.  
To exit single cursor mode:  
Press the key identified in the title bar.  
To align the mouse cursors:  
NOTE: The DSView 3 software cannot get constant feedback from the mouse, so occasionally the mouse on the  
switch may lose sync with the mouse on the host system. If your mouse or keyboard no longer responds  
properly, align the mouse to re-establish proper tracking. Alignment causes the local cursor to be aligned with the  
cursor on the remote server. Resetting causes the appliance to simulate a mouse and keyboard reconnect at the  
device as if you had disconnected and then reconnected them.  
Click the Align Local Cursor button in the Video Viewer toolbar. The local cursor will align with  
the cursor on the remote device.  
If cursors drift out of alignment, turn off mouse acceleration in the device.  
Toolbar commands  
These commands may also be specified in a KVM session profile; see Toolbar profile settings on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
239  
To specify a toolbar hide time:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the Toolbar tab.  
3. Use the arrow keys to specify the number of seconds to delay the hiding of the toolbar.  
4. Click OK to save the changes and close the dialog box.  
To add or remove items in the toolbar:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the Toolbar tab.  
3. Enable the checkboxes for the items to display in the toolbar. Disable the checkboxes for the  
items to remove from the toolbar.  
4. Click OK to save the changes and close the dialog box.  
Video commands  
The color depth, scaling and background refresh commands may also be specified in a KVM  
session profile; see Video profile settings on page 232. The refresh image button/command cannot  
be set in a KVM session profile.  
To adjust the color depth:  
Select View - Color Depth from the Video Viewer menu, then.select the desired depth.  
To change the Video Viewer window resolution:  
NOTE: The View - Scaling command is not available if the Video Viewer window is in full screen mode or to  
non-primary users of a shared session.  
Select the View - Scaling command, then select the desired resolution. The default is 1024 x 768.  
To enable or disable background refresh:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the General tab.  
3. Enable or disable the Background Refresh checkbox.  
4. Click OK.  
You may also use the Refresh Image command.  
To refresh the screen:  
Click the Refresh Image button in the Video Viewer toolbar or select View - Refresh from the Video  
Viewer menu. The digitized video image will be completely regenerated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
240  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Mouse scaling command  
Mouse scaling cannot be specified in a KVM session profile.  
To prevent potential mouse conflicts, you may configure certain settings on each server connected  
to a managed appliance. For details, see the Mouse and Pointer Settings Technical Brief, which is  
available on the DSView 3 software DVD and on the Avocent web site.  
To set mouse scaling:  
1. Select Tools - Session Options from the Video Viewer menu or click the Session Options  
button. The Session Options dialog box appears.  
2. Click the Mouse tab.  
3. To use one of the preconfigured settings, enable a radio button.  
In the Default 1:1 scaling ratio, every mouse movement on the desktop window will send  
an equivalent mouse movement to the server.  
In the High 2:1 scaling ratio, the same mouse movement will send a 2X mouse movement.  
In the Low 1:2 scaling ratio, the value will be 1/2X.  
4. To set custom scaling, click the Custom radio button. The X and Y fields become enabled. Type  
a mouse scaling value in the X and Y fields. For every mouse input, the mouse movements are  
multiplied by the respective X and Y scaling factors. Valid input ranges are 0.25-3.00.  
Manual Video Adjustment  
Generally, the Video Viewer window automatic adjustment features will optimize the video for the  
best possible view. However, users may fine tune the video with the help of Avocent Technical  
Support by using the Tools - Manual Video Adjust command in the Video Viewer menu or clicking  
the Manual Video Adjust button. This displays the Manual Video Adjust dialog box.  
Video adjustment is a per target setting and applies to each target device you access.  
Modified video settings are written to the KVM switch. Settings are also stored per port/channel  
session on a system when they are made and saved so they may be used during a non-shared  
session as follows:  
If sharing is not enabled, the video settings made on the local KVM switch during the session  
are used.  
If sharing is enabled for the non-primary user, video settings are read from the KVM switch.  
See Connecting to an existing session on page 226 for information about session sharing.  
Users may verify the level of packets per second required to support a static screen by observing  
the packet rate which is located in the lower left-hand corner of the dialog box.  
To manually adjust the video quality of the window:  
NOTE: The following video adjustments should be made only on the advice and with the help of Avocent  
Technical Support.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
241  
1. Select Tools - Manual Video Adjust from the Video Viewer menu or click the Manual Video  
Adjust button. The Manual Video Adjust dialog box appears.  
2. Click the icon for the feature you wish to adjust.  
3. Move the slider bar and then fine tune the setting by clicking the Min (-) or Max (+) buttons to  
adjust the parameter for each icon pressed. The adjustments will display immediately in the  
Video Viewer window.  
4. When finished, click Close.  
Figure 18.2: Manual Video Adjust Dialog Box  
Table 18.3: Manual Video Adjust Dialog Box Descriptions  
Number Description  
Number Description  
A
B
C
D
E
F
Image Capture Width  
H
I
Pixel Noise Threshold  
Pixel Sampling/Fine Adjust  
Image Capture Horizontal Position  
Image Capture Vertical Position  
Contrast  
Automatic Video Adjustment  
Refresh Image  
J
K
L
M
N
Adjustment bar  
Video Test Pattern  
Performance Monitor  
Close button  
Brightness  
G
Block Noise Threshold  
   
242  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Image capture width, pixel sampling/fine adjust, image capture horizontal position  
and image capture vertical position  
The Image Capture Width, Pixel Sampling/Fine Adjust, Image Capture Horizontal Position and  
Image Capture Vertical Position adjustments affect how the target video is captured and digitized  
and are seldom changed.  
The image capture parameters are automatically changed by the Automatic Adjustment function. A  
special image is required on the target in order to make accurate adjustments independently.  
Contrast and brightness  
If the image in the Video Viewer window is too dark or too light, select Tools - Automatic Video  
Adjust or click the Automatic Video Adjust button. This command is also available in the Video  
Adjustments dialog box. In most cases, this will correct video problems. In those cases where  
clicking on Auto Adjust several times does not set the contrast and brightness as desired, adjusting  
the contrast and brightness manually may help.  
First, increase the brightness. Do not go more than 10 increments before moving the contrast.  
Generally, the contrast should be moved very little.  
Detection thresholds  
In some cases, noise in the video transmission keeps the packets/sec count up. This may be seen  
when little dots change in the area of the cursor when it is moved. Varying the threshold values  
may result in “quieter” screens and improved cursor tracking.  
Noise Threshold and Priority Threshold values may be modified if you are using standard video  
compression. Block Noise Threshold and Pixel Noise Threshold values may be modified if you are  
using the KVM switch DVC algorithm upgrade. Default threshold values can be restored by  
clicking Auto Adjust Video.  
Block noise threshold and pixel noise threshold  
The Block Noise Threshold and Pixel Noise Threshold values set the minimum color levels in  
terms of changed video blocks and pixels per thousand that are allowed.  
The Block Noise Threshold sets the minimum color change that will occur in a single video  
block. Increasing the value will reduce the network bandwidth. Decreasing the value will make  
the size of these artifacts smaller.  
The Pixel Noise Threshold sets the minimum color change in a single pixel. Decreasing the  
value will reduce the number of low-contrast artifacts, but will increase network bandwidth.  
Automatic video adjustment  
NOTE: You may also select Tools - Automatic Video Adjust from the Video Viewer menu or click the Automatic  
Video Adjust toolbar icon to automatically adjust the video.  
In most cases, you will not need to alter the Video Settings from the default. The system will  
automatically adjust and use the optimal video parameters. The DSView 3 management software  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
243  
performs best when the video parameters are set such that no (0) video packets are transmitted for a  
static screen.  
You may easily adjust your video parameters by clicking on the Auto Adjust Video button in the  
Manual Video Adjust dialog box, which instructs the KVM switch to optimize the video to  
ideal settings.  
A green screen with yellow lettering may appear during auto-adjustment.  
Refresh image  
Clicking the Refresh Image button in the Manual Video Adjust dialog box will completely  
regenerate the digitized video image.  
You may also select View - Refresh from the Video Viewer menu to refresh the image.  
Video test pattern  
Clicking the Video Test Pattern button in the Manual Video Adjust dialog box will toggle a display  
of a video test pattern. Click the Video Test Pattern button again to toggle back to a normal  
video image.  
Saving the View  
The display of a Video Viewer window may be saved to a file or to the clipboard for pasting into  
another program.  
NOTE: Saving the view is only supported on Windows clients. The Capture to File menu option and link are  
disabled on non-Windows clients.  
To capture the Video Viewer window to a file:  
1. Select File - Capture to File from the Video Viewer menu or click the Capture to File button.  
The Save As dialog box appears.  
2. Enter a filename and choose a location to save the file.  
3. Click Save.  
To capture the Video Viewer window to your clipboard:  
Select File - Capture to Clipboard from the Video Viewer menu or click the Capture to Clipboard  
button. The image data is saved to the clipboard.  
Displaying Video Viewer Users  
NOTE: This procedure is not available if the DSR Remote Operations software is being used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
244  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To display current Video Viewer users:  
1. Select View - Connected Users from the Video Viewer menu or click the Connected Users  
button. The Users Connected to <device - Video Session number> dialog box appears,  
containing a list of all users connected to the Video Viewer window session.  
2. Click OK to close the dialog box.  
To display a list of users sharing a port or channel:  
Select View - List of Shared Users in the Video Viewer menu. Users in stealth mode are excluded  
from this display.  
Scan Mode  
To start scan mode:  
In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), select two or more target  
devices that support KVM connections, then click Scan.  
Scan mode will start and the Video Viewer windows will appear in the Thumbnail Viewer. A series  
of thumbnail frames appear in the Thumbnail Viewer, each containing a small, scaled,  
non-interactive version of a target device screen image.  
About scan mode  
Scan mode moves from one thumbnail image to the next, logging into a device and displaying an  
updated device image for a specified length of time (View Time Per Server), before logging out of  
that device and moving on to the next thumbnail image. You may specify a scan delay between  
thumbnails (Time Between Servers). During the delay, you will see the last thumbnail image for all  
devices in the scan sequence, though you won’t be logged into any devices.  
When you first launch the Thumbnail Viewer, each frame will be filled with a white background  
until a device image is displayed. An indicator light at the bottom of each frame displays the device  
status. The default thumbnail size is based on the number of devices in the scan list.  
Scan mode has a lower priority than an active connection. If you or another user are connected to a  
device, that device will be skipped in the scan sequence, and scan mode will proceed to the next  
device unless the Shared Connections Automatically option has been selected, in which case target  
devices may be shared and will not be skipped in the scan sequence. No login error messages will  
appear. After your interactive session is closed, the thumbnail will be included in the scan  
sequence again.  
You may disable a device thumbnail from the scan sequence. The thumbnail image remains, but it  
is not updated until it is once again enabled.  
When running scan mode, it is recommended that logging of the following events (enabled by  
default) be disabled in the DSView 3 software system. Each thumbnail scan will result in the  
logging of these events. The event log could grow to a huge size if the following events are enabled  
and scan mode is run continuously for a lengthy amount of time:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
245  
Appliance Change Of State  
Viewer Session Started  
Viewer Session Stopped  
Appliance Viewer Session Stopped  
Appliance Viewer Session Started  
Thumbnail Viewer features  
Figure 18.3 shows the Thumbnail Viewer areas, and descriptions follow in Table 18.4.  
1
2
4
3
5
6
Figure 18.3: Thumbnail Viewer  
Table 18.4: Thumbnail Viewer Descriptions  
Number  
1
Description  
Thumbtack: Locks the display of the menu so that it is visible at all times.  
Menu: Allows access to Thumbnail Viewer features. The menu will be in a show/hide state if the  
thumbtack has not been used. Place your cursor over the toolbar to display the menu.  
2
3
Minimize button: Minimizes the display of the Thumbnail Viewer window into the toolbar at the  
bottom of the local computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
246  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 18.4: Thumbnail Viewer Descriptions (Continued)  
Number  
4
Description  
Close button: Closes the Thumbnail Viewer and all thumbnails being viewed. The Close button  
may not be present on all operating systems.  
Status indicator: The device name and status indicator appear below each thumbnail:  
A green LED indicates that a device is currently being scanned.  
5
6
A red X indicates that the last scan of the device was not successful. The scan may have  
failed due to a credential or path failure (for example, the device path on the appliance was  
not available). The tool tip for the LED indicates the reason for the failure.  
Thumbnail image: Interacts with your device through this window.  
Performing Thumbnail Viewer tasks  
To set scan preferences:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the Thumbnail Viewer menu. The Scan Mode Preferences  
dialog box appears.  
2. In the View Time Per Server field, enter the time each thumbnail will be active during the scan,  
in the range 10-60 seconds.  
3. In the Time Between Server field, enter the time the scan will stop between each device, in the  
range 5-60 seconds.  
4. Click OK.  
To pause or restart a scan sequence:  
Select Options - Pause Scan from the Thumbnail Viewer menu. The scan sequence will pause at  
the current thumbnail if the Thumbnail Viewer has a scan in progress or will restart the scan if  
currently paused.  
To change the thumbnail size:  
Select Options - Thumbnail Size from the Thumbnail Viewer menu. Choose the desired thumbnail  
size from the cascade menu.  
To disable a device thumbnail in the scan sequence:  
Select a device thumbnail. Select Thumbnail - <device name> - Disable from the Thumbnail  
Viewer menu or right-click on a device thumbnail and select Disable from the pop-up menu.  
Updating of the thumbnail image will stop until it is enabled.  
To enable a device thumbnail in the scan sequence:  
Select a device thumbnail. Select Thumbnail - <device name> - Enable from the Thumbnail  
Viewer menu or right-click on a device thumbnail and select Enable from the pop-up menu.  
Updating of that thumbnail image will resume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
247  
To launch a session to a device from the Thumbnail Viewer:  
Select a device thumbnail. Select Thumbnail - <device name> - View Interactive Session from the  
Thumbnail Viewer menu.  
-or-  
Right-click on a device thumbnail and select View Interactive Session from the Thumbnail Viewer  
menu. That target device desktop will appear in a Video Viewer window.  
-or-  
Dou9017et-clicue bnail  
Toexite he Taumbnaiaer  
Select  
from the(Thumbnail Vbieuwer )-6(menk )-6(r -click )-6 the  
   
248  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Send a macro from a predefined macro group. Macro groups for Windows, Novell and Sun are  
already defined.  
Create, edit and delete your own macros. When you create or edit a macro, you may type the  
desired keystrokes or you may select from among several available categories of keystrokes.  
Each category contains a set of keystroke combinations. Selecting from the available  
categories and keystrokes saves time and eliminates the risk of typographical errors.  
Since the DSView 3 software may be used to access different computer platforms, you may find it  
helpful to assign distinct macro groups to Global Macros or Personal Macros on individual  
systems. You may specify the macro group to display in the Macro Groups dialog box. The Macro  
Groups dialog box may also be used to switch between using Global and Personal Macros at any  
time during a session.  
The Video Viewer window contains grouping commands that allow you to create, edit and delete  
your own macro groups. A user with software administrator or user administrator privileges may  
also change the predefined macro groups.  
Macro group settings are device-specific; that is, they may be set differently for each device.  
To send a macro:  
1. Select Macros - <desired macro> from the Video Viewer menu.  
-or-  
Select Macros - Configure - Macros (this menu item is not available if you are using the DSR  
Remote Operations software.)  
-or-  
Click the Macros button.  
The Macros dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macros, Personal - displays  
only personal macros or Global - displays only global macros.  
3. Select the desired macro from the Defined Macros list and then click Run.  
4. Click Close.  
To create or edit a macro:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macros button.  
The Macros dialog box appears.  
2. To create a macro, click Create. The Create Macro dialog box appears.  
To edit a macro, click Edit. The Edit Macro dialog box appears.  
3. If you are creating a macro, type a 1-32 character name in the Macro Name field.  
4. Select whether you wish to edit or create a personal or global macro from the Macro Type area.  
5. Select the type of keyboard to create or edit the macro from the Keyboard Type menu.  
Available keyboard types are: U.S. English, Dutch, Danish, German, French, Italian, Spanish  
and Japanese.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
249  
6. Select an icon to associate with the macro from the Macro Icon menu.  
7. To build the macro, click the keys on the virtual keyboard in the dialog box. The keys of the  
virtual keyboard operate like a physical keyboard. As a key is clicked, it will appear in the  
Keystrokes list box to the left of the virtual keyboard.  
You may type or press the arrow keys to specify a delay between keys. First, click the key in  
the list box after which you wish to place a delay. Next, click Delay to insert the delay in the  
list box.  
Keystrokes unique to Sun keyboards may be added to the macro by selecting the key type from  
the menu to the right of the Sun Key button and clicking the button.  
8. If necessary, use the following keys to change the entries in the Keystrokes list box.  
Click Reset to remove all entries from the list box.  
Click on an entry and then click Remove to remove it from the list box.  
Click on an entry and then click Move Up to promote the entry in the list box.  
Click on an entry and then click Move Down to demote the entry in the list box.  
9. Click OK to accept the changes and return to the Macros dialog box.  
To delete a macro:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macros button.  
The Macros dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macros, Personal - displays  
only personal macros or Global - displays only global macros.  
3. Select the desired macro from the Defined Macros list and then click Delete. You are prompted  
to confirm the deletion.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
5. Click Close.  
To copy a macro:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macros button.  
The Macros dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macros, Personal - displays  
only personal macros or Global - displays only global macros.  
3. Select the desired macro from the Defined Macros list and then click Copy. The Copy Macro  
dialog box will appear.  
4. Type a 1-32 character name in the Name of copied macro field.  
5. Select whether you wish to make the copied macro a personal or global macro from the Macro  
Type area.  
6. Click OK to copy the macro. The Copy Macro dialog box is closed and the copied macro will  
appear in the Macros dialog box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
250  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
7. Click Close.  
Macro groups  
Macro groups may not be displayed, created, edited, renamed, copied or deleted if you are using the  
DSR Remote Operations software.  
To create a macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macro Groups dialog box appears.  
2. Click Create. The Create/Edit Macro Group dialog box will appear.  
3. In the Macro Group Name field, enter a 1-32 character unique macro group name.  
4. In the Group Type area, click Global if you wish to create a global macro group or click  
Personal if you wish to create a personal macro group.  
5. Click OK to save the name and return to the Macro Groups dialog box.  
6. Click Close.  
To add or delete macros in an existing macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macros Groups dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macro groups, Personal -  
displays only personal macro groups or Global - displays only global macro groups.  
3. Select the macro group to be altered from the Defined Groups list box. Windows and Sun are  
the default macro groups. If you have created new groups, they will also be displayed.  
4. Click Edit. The Create/Edit Macro Groups dialog box will appear.  
5. If you are editing a Personal Macro group, select one of the following from the View area: All-  
displays both personal and global macros, Personal - displays only personal macros or Global  
- displays only global macros.  
6. To add macros to the group, select the macro from the Macros Available list. Click the Add  
button. The macro moves to the Macros in Group list. Use the Move Up and Move Down  
buttons to move the macro up or down in relation to the other macros.  
7. To remove macros from the group, select the macro from the Macros in Group list. Click the  
Remove button. The macro moves to the Macros Available list.  
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 until the Macros in Group list contains all the desired macros.  
9. Click OK to accept the macro group and return to the Macro Groups dialog box.  
10. Click Close.  
To rename a macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macro Groups dialog box appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
251  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macro groups, Personal -  
displays only personal macro groups or Global - displays only global macro groups.  
3. Select the macro group to be altered from the Defined Groups list box. Windows and Sun are  
the default macro groups. If you have created new groups, they will also be displayed.  
4. Click Edit. The Create/Edit Macro Groups dialog box will appear.  
5. In the Macro Group Name field, enter a 1-32 character unique macro group name.  
6. Click OK to save the name and return to the Macro Groups dialog box.  
7. Click Close.  
To delete a macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macro Groups dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macro groups, Personal -  
displays only personal macro groups or Global - displays only global macro groups.  
3. Select the macro group to be deleted from the Defined Groups list box.  
4. Click the Delete button. You are prompted to confirm the deletion.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
6. Click Close.  
To copy a macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macro Groups dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macros, Personal - displays  
only personal macros or Global - displays only global macros.  
3. Select the desired macro group from the Defined Groups list and then click Copy. The Copy  
Macro Group dialog box will appear.  
4. Type a 1-32 character name in the Name of copied macro group field.  
5. Select whether you wish to make the copied macro group a personal or global macro from the  
Macro Type area.  
6. Click OK to copy the macro group. The Copy Macro Group dialog box is closed and the  
copied macro group will appear in the Macro Groups dialog box.  
7. Click Close.  
To change the macro group to be displayed in the Macros menu:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macro Groups from the Video Viewer menu or click the Macro  
Groups button. The Macro Groups dialog box appears.  
2. Select one of the following: All - displays both personal and global macro groups, Personal -  
displays only personal macro groups or Global - displays only global macro groups.  
3. Select the macro group to be displayed from the Defined Groups list box.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
252  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4. Select Display on Menu.  
5. Click Close to exit the Macro Groups dialog box.  
Macros in the selected group will appear in the Video Viewer window Macros menu.  
To display a predefined macro group:  
Select Macros - Display on Menu and then select one of the macro groups Sun or Windows.  
Power Control of Devices Attached to Power Devices  
NOTE: You must have Appliance Administrator privileges to issue a power control command.  
If a target device is connected to a power device outlet (socket), you may power up, power down or  
cycle (power up and then power down) the target device using the Power Control dialog box.  
To power up, power down or power cycle a target device:  
1. Select Tools - Power Control from the Video Viewer menu. The Power Control dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Click the Power On the Server, Power Off the Server or Power Cycle the Server button.  
3. A warning dialog box will appear. Confirm or cancel the operation.  
4. Click Close to close the dialog box.  
Using Virtual Media  
The virtual media feature allows the user on the client workstation to map a physical drive on that  
machine as a virtual drive on a target device. The client may also add and map an ISO or floppy  
image file as a virtual drive on the target device.  
You may have one CD drive and one mass storage device mapped concurrently.  
A CD/DVD drive, disk image file (such as an ISO or floppy image file) is mapped as a virtual  
CD drive.  
A floppy drive, USB memory device or other media type is mapped as a virtual mass  
storage device.  
For additional information, see Understanding and Using Virtual Media, which is available on the  
DSView 3 software DVD and on the Avocent web site.  
Requirements  
The target device must be connected to the KVM switch that supports virtual media with an IQ  
module that supports virtual media.  
The target device must be intrinsically able to use the types of USB2-compatible media that you  
virtually map. In other words, if the target device does not support a portable USB memory device,  
you cannot map that on the client machine as a virtual media drive on the target device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
253  
The user (or user group to which the user belongs) must have permission to establish virtual media  
sessions and/or reserved virtual media sessions to the target device. See About Access Rights on  
Only one virtual media session may be active to a target device at one time.  
You may not use the virtual media feature with the DSR Remote Operations software.  
Sharing and preemption considerations  
The KVM and virtual media sessions are separate; therefore, there are many options for sharing,  
reserving or preempting sessions. The DSView 3 software has the flexibility to accommodate the  
system needs.  
For example, the KVM and virtual media sessions may be locked together. In this mode, when a  
KVM session is disconnected, so is the associated virtual media session. If the sessions are not  
locked together, the KVM session can be closed but the virtual media session will remain active.  
This could be desirable if a user is performing a time-intensive task using the virtual media session  
(such as an operating system load), and wants to establish a KVM session with a different target  
device to perform other functions while the operating system load progresses.  
Once a target device has an active virtual media session without an associated active KVM session,  
two situations can occur - the original user (User A) can reconnect or a different user (User B) can  
connect to that channel. You may set an option in the Virtual Media dialog box (Reserved) that  
allows only the User A to access that channel with a KVM session.  
If User B is allowed to access that session (the Reserved option is not enabled), User B could  
control the media that is being used in the virtual media session. In some environments, this may  
not be desirable.  
By using the Reserved option in a tiered environment, only User A could access the lower switch  
and the KVM channel between the upper switch and lower switch would be reserved for User A.  
Preemption levels offer additional flexibility of combinations. See Opening an exclusive KVM  
described in those sections also apply to virtual media session.  
Virtual Media dialog box  
The Virtual Media dialog box is a program that manages the mapping and unmapping of virtual  
media. The dialog box displays all the physical drives on the client’s workstation that can be  
mapped as virtual drives. You may also add ISO and floppy image files and then map them using  
the Virtual Media dialog box.  
After a device is mapped, the Virtual Media dialog box Details View displays information about  
the amount of data transferred and the time elapsed since the device was mapped.  
You may specify that the virtual media session is reserved. When a session is reserved, and the  
associated KVM session is closed, another user cannot launch a KVM session to that target device.  
If a session is not reserved, another KVM session may be launched.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
254  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
You may also reset the USB2 IQ module from the Virtual Media dialog box. This action will reset  
every form of USB media on the target device, and should therefore be used with caution, and only  
when the target device is not responding.  
Virtual media session settings  
Virtual media session settings include locking, mapped drives access mode and encryption level.  
Table 18.5 describes the virtual media session settings on the supported KVM switch.  
Table 18.5: Virtual Media Session Settings  
Setting  
Description  
The locking option specifies whether a virtual media session is locked to the KVM  
session on the target device. When locking is enabled (which is the default) and the  
KVM session is closed, the virtual media session will also be closed. When locking is  
disabled and the KVM session is closed, the virtual media session will remain active.  
Locking  
You may set the access mode for mapped drives to read-only or read-write. When  
the access mode is read-only, the user will not be able to write data to the mapped  
drive on the client workstation. When the access mode is read-write, the user will be  
able to read and write data from/to the mapped drive.  
If the mapped drive is read-only by design (for example, certain CD/DVD drives or  
ISO images), the configured read-write access mode will be ignored.  
Setting the read-only mode can be helpful when a read-write drive such as a mass  
storage device or a USB removable media is mapped, and you wish to prevent the  
user from writing data to it.  
Mapped drives access  
mode  
You may configure up to three encryption levels (or none) for virtual media sessions.  
Any combination is valid. The choices are: DES, 3DES, 128-bit SSL and AES. The  
default is no encryption (no encryption levels selected).  
Encryption level  
Opening a virtual media session  
To launch a virtual media session:  
Select Tools - Virtual Media from the Video Viewer menu. The Virtual Media dialog box  
will appear.  
To make this a reserved session, click Details, then enable the Reserved checkbox.  
To map a virtual media drives:  
1. Open a virtual media session from the Video Viewer menu by selecting Tools - Virtual Media.  
2. To map a physical drive as a virtual media drive:  
a. In the Virtual Media dialog box, click the Mapped checkbox next to the drive(s) you wish  
to map.  
b. If you wish to limit the mapped drive to read-only access, click the Read Only checkbox  
next to the drive. If the virtual media session settings were previously configured so that  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
255  
all mapped drives must be read only, this checkbox will already be enabled and cannot  
be changed.  
You might wish to enable the Read Only checkbox if the session settings enabled read and  
write access, but you wished to limit a particular drive’s access to read only.  
3. To add and map an ISO or floppy image as a virtual media drive:  
a. In the Virtual Media dialog box, click Add Image.  
b. The common file dialog box will appear, with the directory containing disk image files  
(that is, those ending in .iso or .img) displayed. Select the desired ISO or floppy image file  
and click Open.  
-or-  
If the client workstation’s operating system supports drag-and-drop, select the desired ISO  
or floppy image file from the common file dialog box and drag it onto the Virtual Media  
dialog box.  
c. The file’s header is checked to ensure it is correct. If it is, the common file dialog box will  
close and the chosen image file will appear in the Virtual Media dialog box, where it can  
be mapped by clicking the Mapped checkbox.  
d. Repeat steps a through c for any additional ISO or floppy images you wish to add. You  
may add any number of image files (up to the limits imposed by memory), but you may  
only have one virtual CD or virtual mass storage mapped concurrently.  
If you attempt to map too many drives (one CD and one mass storage device) or too many  
drives of a particular type (more than one CD or mass storage device), a message will be  
displayed. If you still wish to map a new drive, you must first unmap an existing mapped drive,  
then map the new drive.  
After a physical drive or image is mapped, it may be used on the target device.  
To unmap a virtual media drive:  
1. In the Virtual Media dialog box, uncheck the Mapped checkbox next to the drive you wish  
to unmap.  
2. You will be prompted to confirm. Confirm or cancel the unmapping.  
3. Repeat for any additional virtual media drives you wish to unmap.  
To display virtual media drive details:  
In the Virtual Media dialog box, click Details. The dialog box expands to display the Details table.  
Each row indicates:  
Target Drive - Name used for the mapped drive, such as Virtual CD 1 or Virtual CD 2.  
Mapped to - Identical to Drive information that appears in the Client View Drive column.  
Read Bytes and Write Bytes - Amount of data transferred since the mapping.  
Duration - Elapsed time since the drive was mapped.  
To close the Details view, click Details again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
256  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To reset all USB devices on the target device:  
NOTE: The USB reset feature resets every USB device on the target device, including the mouse and keyboard.  
It should only be used when the target device is not responding.  
1. In the Virtual Media dialog box, click Details.  
2. The Details View will appear. Click USB Reset.  
3. A warning message will appear, indicating the possible effects of the reset. Confirm or cancel  
the reset.  
4. To close the Details view, click Details again.  
Closing a virtual media session  
To close the Virtual Media dialog box:  
1. Click Exit.  
2. If you have any mapped drives, a message is displayed, indicating that the drives will be  
unmapped. Confirm or cancel the operation.  
If a user attempts to disconnect a virtual media session or an active KVM session that has an  
associated locked virtual media session, a confirmation message is displayed, indicating that any  
virtual media mappings will be lost.  
information about other factors that may affect virtual media session closings.  
Video Viewer Troubleshooting  
If the Video Viewer or the Virtual Media dialog box does not start, the local Java cache may be  
corrupted. You can easily clear the cache without losing any data.  
To clear the local Java cache:  
1. Start the Java Control panel.  
On supported Windows and Macintosh systems, this will be an item in the Control Panel.  
On supported Linux systems, from a shell prompt, change directory to the bin directory where  
Java is installed. Then type ./ControlPanel.  
For example:  
cd /usr/java/avocent/jrel.5.0_02/bin  
./ControlPanel  
2. Select the General tab.  
3. Click the Settings button.  
4. Click the View Applications button.  
5. Select any DSView Video Viewer Application items.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 18: Using the Video Viewer  
257  
6. Click the Remove Selected Entries button (this button may also be named Remove  
Selected Application).  
If this does not solve the problem, repeat step 1, then click the Delete Files button.  
NOTE: Clicking the Delete Files button will remove all applications installed with Java Web Start.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
258  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
259  
CHAPTER  
Using the Telnet Viewer  
19  
The DSView 3 management software ships bundled with a built-in proprietary Telnet Viewer that  
provides features unavailable in many other Telnet programs. These features include configurable  
session properties tailored for each device, configurable user preferences for all sessions, a  
scripting function for automatic device login, a macro function and a logging function.  
About the Telnet Viewer  
DSView 3 software clients may use the DSView 3 management software Telnet Viewer to access  
CPS810 and 1610 appliances and their ports, CCM 850, 1650 and 4850 appliances and their ports,  
or any generic appliance that supports Telnet Viewer connections.  
NOTE: Throughout this chapter, the term “appliance” or “managed appliance” will be used to indicate a  
supported CPS appliance, CCM appliance or generic appliance that supports Telnet Viewer connections.  
When a session is established with a supported appliance, the Telnet client switches to SSH (Secure  
Shell) mode and opens an SSH shell to/through the appliance. The SSH shell can use any of the  
Telnet client’s terminal emulations. See Security Property on page 261.  
The Telnet Viewer uses the credentials provided by the DSView 3 software to establish a session  
and will automatically accept the appliance server key. The username and password provided by  
the users when they log in are authenticated by the authentication service configured in the  
DSView 3 software.  
Requirements  
The Telnet Viewer is actually an applet that runs within the Java 1.5.0_02 plug-in (JRE). The  
Telnet Viewer may also work with other Java versions. The DSView 3 software client  
automatically downloads and installs the JRE (Java Runtime Environment) the first time the Video  
Viewer or the Telnet Viewer is launched. See Java Installation on page 18 for information about  
user interaction with the JRE installer.  
Telnet Viewer Window Features  
A new Telnet Viewer window will open for each new Telnet session established by a user. The  
Telnet Viewer window contains menus, a toolbar and a window that provides virtual  
terminal emulation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
260  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
1
2
3
4
5
Figure 19.1: Telnet Viewer Window  
Table 19.1: Telnet Viewer Window Descriptions  
Number  
1
Description  
Title Bar: Displays the name of the target device being viewed.  
Toolbar: Allows you to access many of the features in the Telnet Viewer. See Table 19.2 for a  
description of the toolbar icons.  
2
3
4
Virtual Terminal window: Interacts with your target device through this window. By default the  
window size is 80 characters x 24 lines.  
Viewer window: Resizes the window when you click and hold on the frame. Although the window  
may be resized, the Virtual Terminal window will remain the same size.  
Status Bar: Displays one of the following:  
Connected - Displays during normal terminal emulation in a Telnet Viewer session.  
Logging - Displays when logging is enabled.  
5
Logging Paused - Displays when logging is paused.  
NOTE: The Close button may not be present on all operating systems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
261  
NOTE: On supported Macintosh system clients, the Telnet Viewer opens in a self-contained window and is not  
included in the Application Menu.  
Telnet Viewer window toolbar  
Table 19.2 describes the Telnet Viewer window’s toolbar icons.  
Table 19.2: Telnet Viewer Window Toolbar Icons  
Icon  
Description  
Session Settings - Displays the Session Properties dialog box  
Help - Displays the DSView 3 software help  
Copy Screen - Copies a screen of Telnet Viewer session data to the system clipboard  
Copy Buffer - Copies the contents of the Telnet Viewer session buffer to the system clipboard  
Copy Text - Copies highlighted text in a Telnet Viewer session screen to the system clipboard  
Restore - Restores the ability to highlight screen text when autoscaling is enabled and the  
virtual terminal window has been scaled  
Paste - Pastes the contents of the system clipboard into a Telnet Viewer session  
Prints a screen of Telnet Viewer session data  
Security Property  
A fully functional SSH2 (Secure Shell Version 2) Client is built into the Telnet Viewer. The SSH2  
Client is Java-based and provides a secure method for accessing target devices.  
The Telnet Viewer provides the following security features:  
Strict host key checking  
Support ciphers for AES (128-, 192-, 256-bit), Blowfish, Twofish, Cast, 3DES and Arcfour  
Diffie-Hellman key exchange support  
SSH-RSA key types  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
262  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Supported for hmac-md5, hmac-sha1, hmac-sha1-96, hmac-md5-96 and hmac-ripemd160  
The DSView 3 software will determine whether to create a Telnet or SSH2 connection when you  
start a session with an appliance. A serial connection provides SSH2 serial access to the target  
device from the appliance. Terminal emulation options are supported using both types  
of connections.  
The SSH2 client is started when you initiate a session with an appliance port from the DSView 3  
Explorer. The DSView 3 server is contacted, which in turn contacts the target device connected to  
the appliance port and exchanges X.509 certificates with the target device. The target device also  
supplies a session certificate, private key and appliance certificate.  
These certificates are then passed back to the SSH2 client, which uses them to determine the SSH2  
host key and the user SSH2 key. The Telnet Viewer will then establish a session with the target  
device (or through the proxy server if there is a proxy server connection). The Telnet Viewer then  
passes the RSA public key from the session certificate when establishing the SSH connection.  
Finally, the virtual terminal window will open using an SSH2 shell over SSH connection.  
SSH2 settings may be viewed by clicking on an appliance name in the DSView 3 Explorer and  
selecting Appliance Settings - Sessions - Settings in the side navigation bar to display the Properties  
- Sessions - Settings window.  
Opening a Session  
A DSView 3 management software Telnet Viewer session is opened using the DSView 3 Explorer  
by clicking on Telnet Session or Serial Session in the Action column of the target device. If the  
target device is attached to an appliance port, Telnet Session will appear. If the target device is  
attached to an appliance that is also attached to a serial device, Serial Session will appear.  
NOTE: If multiple connection methods are available, an alternate actions arrow will appear to the right of the  
action. Clicking the alternate action arrow will display a list of other actions, in descending order of priority, which  
may be selected to launch the corresponding window type.  
To open a Telnet Viewer session:  
In a Units View window containing target devices (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98),  
click Telnet Session or Serial Session in the Action field or the Alternate Action menu. Alternative,  
you can click the Telnet Session or Serial Session icon in the Unit Overview window for the target  
The Telnet Viewer window will open.  
NOTE: You can share a Telnet Viewer session with an SSH serial session. See SSH Passthrough Sessions on  
Customizing the Telnet Viewer  
You may specify preferences that will be used for every Telnet Viewer session, regardless of the  
device to which you connect. These application preferences are entered from the Telnet Viewer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
263  
window when you are connected to a device or port. After the preferences are entered, they are  
applied to devices/ports during subsequent sessions.  
To change the window background and/or text color:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the menu. The Preferences dialog box will appear.  
2. To change the background color, click the Background/Normal Mode box in the Colors section  
and select a color. The default color is blue.  
3. To change the text color, click the Text/Normal Mode box in the Colors section and select a  
color. The default color is white.  
To change the cursor appearance:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the menu. The Preferences dialog box will appear.  
2. In the Caret list, choose Block to display the cursor as a block or choose Underline to display  
the cursor as an underline. The default value is Underline.  
To enable/disable an exit warning prompt for Telnet Viewer sessions:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the menu. The Preferences dialog box will appear.  
2. Enable or disable the Prompt on Exit checkbox. When the exit warning prompt is enabled, a  
message appears when you select Telnet - Exit. You may then choose to exit or continue the  
session. When disabled, the session closes without further prompting. The default value  
is enabled.  
To enable/disable autoscaling:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the menu. The Preferences dialog box will appear.  
2. Enable or disable the Auto Scale checkbox. When autoscaling is enabled, the user may reduce  
or expand the virtual terminal window by dragging a corner of the window. When autoscaling  
is disabled, the virtual terminal window will not scale when the view is changed; instead, scroll  
bars will appear around the window. The default value is enabled.  
Customizing Session Properties  
When you are connected to an appliance or port using the DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer, you  
may specify session properties that will be stored and reused every time you connect to the selected  
appliance or port. When you select Options - Session Properties in the DSView 3 software Telnet  
Viewer, the Session Properties dialog box will appear containing Terminal, Login Scripts and  
Logging tabs.  
To change the terminal window size:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. In the Rows list, choose a value of 24 or 48. The default value is 24.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
264  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
4. In the Columns list, choose a value of 80 or 132. The default value is 80.  
To change the terminal emulation mode:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. From the Terminal Emulation list, choose one option. The default value is VT100. Terminal  
Emulation on page 343 contains encoding and decoding information for each of the terminal  
emulation types.  
NOTE: When connecting to an appliance, the terminal type setting must match the terminal emulation type.  
To change the Telnet Viewer Arrow key sequences:  
When the Terminal Emulation mode is VT100, VT100+, VT102, VT52, VT220 or VT320, you  
may specify either VT100 or ANSI Arrow key sequences.  
Table 19.3: Arrow Key Sequences  
Key  
VT100  
ANSI  
VT52  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
<Esc> [A  
<Esc> [B  
<Esc> [C  
<Esc> [D  
<Esc> OA  
<Esc> OB  
<Esc> OC  
<Esc> OD  
<Esc> A  
<Esc> B  
<Esc> C  
<Esc> D  
NOTE: When the Terminal Emulation mode is VT52, the Arrow keys are interpreted as indicated in this  
column, regardless of the value in the Arrow Keys list.  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. In the Arrow Keys list, choose either VT100 or ANSI. The default value is VT100.  
To change the terminal type:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. In the Terminal Type box, enter a value of up to 40 characters, beginning with a letter and  
ending with a letter or digit. Valid characters are the letters A-Z, digits 0-9, forward slash, dash,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
265  
left parenthesis and right parenthesis. The terminal type must be entered in the Terminal Type  
field exactly as shown in Table 19.4.  
Table 19.4: Terminal Emulation and Type  
Terminal Emulation  
VT52  
Terminal Type  
DEC-VT52  
VT100  
DEC-VT100  
DEC-VT100  
DEC-VT102  
DEC-VT220  
DEC-VT320  
VT100+  
VT102  
VT220  
VT320  
To change the linefeed settings:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. When connecting to devices that do not insert a carriage return in incoming or outgoing data,  
automatically inserting a line after each line of data can prevent overwriting data when a new  
line is received.  
If the New Line Mode - Inbound box is checked, an inbound carriage return from the device  
will be treated as if both a carriage return and a linefeed were received. If not checked, a  
linefeed is not added to an inbound carriage return.  
If the New Line Mode - Outbound box is checked, an outbound carriage return to the device  
will always be followed by a linefeed character. If not checked, a linefeed is not sent with a  
carriage return. The default value is disabled for inbound and outbound.  
To enable/disable line wrap:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. Enable or disable the Auto wrap line checkbox. When line wrap is enabled, characters wrap  
onto the next line when a new character is received and the cursor is at the end of the line.  
When disabled, new characters will overwrite the last character on the current line when the  
cursor is at the end of the line. The default value is enabled.  
To enable/disable local echo:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
266  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. When you are connected to a device that does not repeat or echo the data that you type, you  
may enable Local Echo mode. Otherwise, the Telnet Viewer will not display the text you type.  
However, if you are connected to a device that echoes data, and you are in Local Echo mode,  
all of the data you type will appear on your terminal twice.  
Enable or disable the Local echo checkbox. The default value is disabled.  
To enable/disable 7-bit ASCII:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. Enable or disable the Strip 8th bit checkbox. The default value is disabled.  
Login scripts  
The Telnet Viewer has a login scripting function that enables you to automatically log in to a  
device. A login script is built with a sequence of expect and send strings, and initial transmission  
characters that work with them. To use a login script, you must enable automatic login in  
a checkbox.  
The first Initial character (that is, the first entry in the Initial character column) specifies what is  
sent to the device as soon as the Telnet Viewer session is established. This is selected from a list  
containing the choices: None, CR (carriage return), CR+LF (carriage return and linefeed), ESC  
(Escape) and CTRL+P (Control and P).  
The first Expect string indicates what the device will send as its first prompt.  
The first Send string indicates what the login script will send to the device after it receives the first  
Expect string.  
You may then build additional Expect and Send strings according to what the particular device will  
prompt for and what will be sent in response.  
To build a login script and enable/disable automatic login:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Login Scripts tab.  
3. Enable or disable the Automate login checkbox. The default value is disabled.  
4. In the Initial Character list, select one option: CR (carriage return), CR+LF (carriage return and  
linefeed), ESC (Escape), CTRL+P (Control+P sequence, 0X10 in hex) or None (no initial  
transmission character).  
5. In the Expect box, type the 1-32 alphanumeric character string that you expect from the device.  
Spaces are allowed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
267  
6. In the Send box, type the 0-32 alphanumeric character string that you wish to send in response  
to the Expect string. Spaces are allowed, and a blank field is valid. A CR or CR+LF is  
appended to the string, based on the New Line Mode - Outbound setting.  
7. Repeat the Expect and Send entries as needed, to a maximum of four each.  
Reviewing Session Data  
During a Telnet Viewer session, you may review the accumulated screen contents by using the  
scroll bar or the Arrow keys. To return to the current session location, press Enter. The size of the  
buffer containing session data that can be reviewed is configurable.  
You may optionally choose to change the color of the text and/or the background when you are  
reviewing session data. When you return to the current session location, the colors will return to  
those specified in the Telnet Viewer’s configuration (see Customizing the Telnet Viewer on  
While you are reviewing collected data, new incoming data is buffered, but it will not be displayed  
until you return to the current session location. You may not enter outgoing data.  
To change the maximum number of lines in the session buffer:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Terminal tab.  
3. In the History Buffer Size box, type a value from 1-1000. The default value is 256.  
To change the background and/or text color when reviewing session data:  
1. Select Options - Preferences from the menu. The Preferences dialog box will appear.  
2. To change the background color, click the Background/History Mode box in the Colors section  
and select a color. The default color is blue.  
3. To change the text color, click the Text/History Mode box in the Colors section and select a  
color. The default color is white.  
Macros  
NOTE: Three additional types of macros are available in the DSView 3 management software. Exit macros,  
created within the DSView 3 Explorer, reside on DS1800 digital switches and DSR switches and are used by  
these switches. Global macros and personal macros are created using the Video Viewer window and are used  
with KVM sessions with target devices attached to DS1800 digital switches and DSR switches. None of these  
macros may be used or are compatible with a Telnet Viewer.  
The DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer has a macro function that allows you to create and use  
macros during Telnet Viewer sessions. A macro comprises a series of keystrokes that you define.  
Additionally, you may specify a hotkey in the macro’s definition. When you define a macro and  
enable its inclusion in the Macros menu, you may execute the macro during a Telnet Viewer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
268  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
session either by selecting it from the Macros menu or by pressing the defined hotkey on  
your keyboard.  
You may also define one or more global macro or personal macro groups, then add macros to the  
groups. Personal macro groups may be created by any user and are only available for use on the  
target device on which they are created. Global macros may only be created by a DSView 3  
software administrator and are available for use by any user on the DSView 3 software system.  
A macro may belong to more than one macro group or belong to both personal and global macro  
groups; however, a macro does not have to belong to a macro group. Selecting Macros - Configure  
- Groups takes you to the Configure Macro Groups dialog box which contains a list of defined  
macro groups from which you may select one group or all defined groups. The macros in the  
selected group(s) are then available for use during subsequent Telnet Viewer sessions with  
that device/port.  
After defining a macro or a macro group, you may edit or delete it at any time. When you delete a  
macro or macro group, you are prompted for confirmation. When you change a macro group name,  
each macro belonging to the changed macro group is updated, but the change is not visible until the  
next Telnet Viewer session is established. When you delete a macro group, you delete only its  
name - the individual macros in the group are not affected.  
To create a macro:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the menu. The Configure Macros dialog  
box appears.  
2. Click Create. The Configure Macros dialog box expands to display an Edit Macro area.  
3. In the Macro Name field, Type a 1-64 character name for the macro.  
4. To define a hotkey for the macro, choose one from the Key list. To add a modifier to the  
hotkey, check the Control, Shift or Alt boxes. (A macro’s hotkey is accessible only when the  
macro belongs to the active macro group.)  
5. By default, the Include in Menu box is checked, indicating the macro will appear in the Macros  
menu. If you do not wish to include the macro in the Macros menu, uncheck this box. In this  
case, if the macro definition includes a hotkey, you will still be able to use the hotkey to run the  
macro, even if the macro’s name does not appear in the Macros menu.  
6. Type the macro string in the Keystrokes box. For non-printing and special character code  
sequences, use the following escape sequences:  
New line: \n  
Carriage return: \r  
Form feed: \f  
Horizontal tab: \t  
Backspace: \b  
Delay character (500 ms): \d  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
269  
Hexadecimal code sequence: \0x<NN>, where <NN> is the hexadecimal byte. For example,  
the Ctrl+D character sequence may be sent by using 0x04.  
Octal code sequence: \0<NNN>, where <NNN> is the octal byte. For example, the Ctrl+D  
character sequence may be sent by using 0004.  
7. From the Control Code menu, select the sequence to invoke with the selected characters.  
8. In the Access Rights area, specify whether you wish for the macro to be a global macro  
(available to all users) or a personal macro (available only to the current user).  
You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to use the Access Rights area.  
9. Click OK. The Configure Macros dialog box returns to its abbreviated display and the macro  
appears in the Macros area.  
10. Click OK to close the Configure Macros dialog box.  
To edit an existing macro:  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to edit Global Macros.  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the menu. The Configure Macros dialog  
box appears.  
2. In the Macros table, select the macro you wish to edit.  
3. Click Edit. The Configure Macros dialog box expands to display an Edit Macro area  
containing the information defined for the macro.  
4. Edit the macro properties as needed.  
5. Click OK. The changes are saved and the Configure Macros dialog box returns to its  
abbreviated view.  
6. Repeat steps 2-5 to edit additional macros.  
7. Click OK to close the Configure Macros dialog box.  
To delete a macro:  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to delete Global Macros.  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Macros from the menu. The Configure Macros dialog  
box appears.  
2. Select the macro in the Macros table that you wish to delete.  
3. Click Delete. A dialog box appears, prompting you to confirm the deletion.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
To use a macro:  
1. Select the macro from the Macros menu (if the macro’s definition includes a hotkey, press the  
hotkey or hotkey sequence. A macro’s hotkey is accessible only when the macro belongs to the  
active macro group) or select Macros - Configure - Macros from the menu. The Configure  
Macros dialog box appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
270  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. Select the macro in the Macros table that you wish to run.  
3. Click Run.  
Macro groups  
To create a macro group:  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Groups from the menu. The Configure Macro Groups dialog  
box appears.  
2. Click the Create button. The Configure Macros dialog box expands to display a Create  
Group area.  
3. In the Group Name field, type a 1-64 character name for the macro group.  
4. To add one or more macros to the macro group, select the macro(s) from the Macros Available  
list, then click Add. The macros will be moved to the Macros In Group list.  
5. To remove one or more macros from the macro group, select the macro(s) from the Macros In  
Group list, then click Remove. The macros will be moved to the Macros Available list.  
6. In the Access Rights area, specify whether you want the macro group to be a Global Macro  
group (available to all users) or a Personal Macro group (available only to the current user).  
You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to assign access rights.  
7. Click OK. The Configure Macro Groups dialog box returns to its abbreviated view.  
8. Click OK to close the Configure Macro Groups dialog box.  
To enable a macro group for use during Telnet Viewer sessions:  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to enable a macro group.  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Groups from the menu. The Configure Macro Groups dialog  
box appears.  
2. In the Macro Groups table, select the macro group you wish to enable.  
3. Click the Edit button. The Configure Macro Groups dialog box expands to display an Edit  
Group area containing the information defined for the macro.  
4. Enable the Active Group checkbox.  
5. Click OK. The changes are saved and the Configure Macro Groups dialog box returns to its  
abbreviated view.  
To edit an existing macro group:  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to edit global macro groups.  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Groups from the menu. The Configure Macro Groups dialog  
box appears.  
2. In the Macro Groups table, select the macro group you wish to edit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
271  
3. Click the Edit button. The Configure Macro Groups dialog box expands to display an Edit  
Group area containing the information defined for the macro.  
4. Edit the macro group properties as needed.  
5. Click OK. The changes are saved and the Configure Macro Groups dialog box returns to its  
abbreviated view.  
6. Repeat steps 2-5 to edit additional macro groups.  
7. Click OK to close the Configure Macro Groups dialog box.  
To delete a macro group:  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to delete global macro groups.  
1. Select Macros - Configure - Groups from the menu. The Configure Macro Groups dialog  
box appears.  
2. Select the macro group in the Macro Groups table that you wish to delete.  
3. Click the Delete button. A dialog box appears, prompting you to confirm the deletion.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Logging  
The Telnet Viewer has a logging function that saves the contents of a Telnet Viewer session to a  
file. You may enable automatic logging or dynamically start logging at any time. Additionally, you  
may pause, resume and stop logging, regardless of whether it was started automatically  
or dynamically.  
While logging is occurring or when it is paused, a Logging Status label appears in the status panel  
at the bottom of the DSView 3 management software Telnet Viewer window.  
NOTE: When you enable or disable automatic logging, the logging will begin or end at the start of the next  
DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer session to that device. If you change the default log file directory used for  
automatic logging, the change does not take effect until the next session to that device.  
Log files  
The format of log filenames is shown below, where <mmddyy> represents the month, day and  
year, and <hhmmss> represents the current hour, minute and second in military time:  
scvTelnet<mmddyy>_<hhmmss>.log  
The default log directory is session-specific, that is, each Telnet Viewer session may have its own  
location for storing logfiles. You may change the name of the file and the location of the directory  
that stores the logfiles. If you do not change the default directory, logfiles are stored in your  
home directory.  
You may display a log file at any time, using a standard text editor. The screen buffer is written to  
the log file when the buffer is full, or when logging is paused or stopped. To ensure the log file is  
up-to-date, either pause or stop the logging.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
272  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To change the default log file directory:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Logging tab. The Default Directory field displays the current default location  
for logfiles.  
3. Click the Browse button. The Set Directory dialog box appears.  
4. Select a directory from the Look in list or create a new directory. To create a new directory:  
a. Click the Create New Folder button. A new directory named New Folder appears in the  
directory list.  
b. Click the New Folder entry in the directory list to highlight it. Then, click the entry again  
to edit its name. Type in a new name. Press Enter. The directory appears in alphabetical  
order in the directory list.  
c. Select the newly-created directory in the directory list. The Filename field will now  
contain the name of the new directory.  
5. Click the Set Directory button to select the newly-created or selected directory as the default  
log file directory. The Set Directory dialog box will close.  
6. The Default Directory field now contains the name of the newly-created or selected directory.  
Click OK to save the new information.  
To enable automatic logging:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Logging tab.  
3. Enable the Logging checkbox.  
4. The Default Directory field displays the current default location for logfiles. If that is the  
desired directory, click OK. (You may change the default directory.)  
Automatic logging will begin when you initiate the next Telnet Viewer session to that device. At  
that time, the Logging Status label will indicate Logging.  
To disable automatic logging:  
1. Select Options - Session Properties from the menu or click the Session Settings icon in the  
toolbar. The Session Properties dialog box will appear.  
2. Click the Logging tab.  
3. Disable the Logging checkbox.  
4. Click OK.  
Automatic logging will stop when you close the Telnet Viewer session. When logging stops, the  
Logging Status label disappears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
273  
To start dynamic logging:  
1. Select Options - Logging - Start from the menu. The Log dialog box appears.  
2. The Look in list contains the default log file directory and the Filename field contains the  
default log filename. Using this filename format is recommended; however, you may change it  
for the duration of this Telnet Viewer session. If you choose to use the default log filename,  
skip to step 4.  
3. To change the default log filename for the duration of the dynamic logging session, you may  
select a directory from the Look in list. The directory list may contain directories and files. To  
create a new directory:  
a. Click the Create New Folder button. A new directory named New Folder appears in the  
directory list.  
b. Click the New Folder entry in the directory list to highlight it. Then click the entry again to  
edit its name. Type in a new name. Press Enter. The directory appears in alphabetical  
order in the directory list.  
c. Double-click the newly-created directory in the directory list. The Filename field will now  
contain the name of the new directory.  
d. Type a new filename in the Filename field. If you enter a filename that already exists, the  
new file will overwrite the old file.  
4. You are prompted to confirm the directory selection and begin logging. Confirm or cancel the  
logging start.  
When logging begins, the Logging Status label will indicate Logging.  
To pause logging:  
Select Options - Logging - Pause from the menu. The Logging Status label will change to  
Logging Paused.  
To resume logging:  
Select Options - Logging - Resume from the menu. The Logging Status label will change  
to Logging.  
To stop logging:  
Select Options - Logging - Stop from the menu. The Logging Status label will disappear.  
Copying, Pasting and Printing Session Data  
In the Telnet Viewer you may:  
Copy a screen of Telnet Viewer session data to the system clipboard  
Copy all of the Telnet Viewer session buffer contents to the system clipboard  
Copy a highlighted portion of the Telnet Viewer session data to the system clipboard  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
274  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Paste the contents of the system clipboard into a Telnet Viewer session or into  
another application  
Print a screen of the Telnet Viewer session data  
Information that is copied from a DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer session may be pasted into  
other applications. Similarly, information copied from other applications may be pasted into a  
Telnet Viewer session.  
NOTE: Only textual data may be copied and pasted in the DSView 3 software Telnet Viewer.  
To copy a Telnet Viewer session window screen:  
Select Options - Copy Screen from the menu or click the Copy Screen icon in the toolbar.  
The screen contents will be saved to the system clipboard. You may then paste the clipboard  
contents into a Telnet Viewer session or into another application.  
To copy all of the Telnet Viewer session buffer contents:  
Select Options - Copy Buffer from the menu or click the Copy Buffer icon in the toolbar.  
The entire buffer will be copied to the system clipboard (regardless of the amount of data in it. You  
may then paste the clipboard contents into a Telnet Viewer session or into another application.  
To highlight and copy a portion of a Telnet Viewer window screen:  
NOTE: When autoscaling has been enabled and the window has been scaled, you will not be able to highlight  
text until you click the Restore icon in the toolbar.  
1. Use the mouse to drag-select the portion of the screen text you wish to copy.  
2. Select Options - Copy Text from the menu.  
-or-  
Click the Copy Text icon in the toolbar.  
-or-  
Right-click and select Copy Text from the pop-up menu.  
The highlighted text will be copied to the system clipboard. You may then paste the clipboard  
contents into a Telnet Viewer session or into another application.  
To paste system clipboard contents:  
1. Place textual data on the system clipboard, using a text editor or other application.  
2. Initiate a Telnet Viewer session.  
3. At the point where you wish to paste the clipboard contents, select Options - Paste from the  
menu or click the Paste icon in the toolbar.  
To print a Telnet Viewer window screen:  
1. Select Options - Print Screen from the menu or click the Print Screen icon in the toolbar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 19: Using the Telnet Viewer  
275  
2. The operating system’s print dialog box appears. Make the appropriate settings. The screen  
contents will then be sent to the printer.  
Power Control of Devices Attached to Power Devices  
NOTE: A user must have DSView 3 software administrator privileges to control the power of a target device.  
If a target device attached to an appliance port is connected to a power device outlet and the target  
device has been accessed in a serial session, you may power up, power down or cycle (power down  
and then power up) the target device using the Power Control dialog box.  
NOTE: This operation is valid only during serial sessions.  
The Options - Power menu option will not be available if the target device cannot be power  
controlled using the DSView 3 software, or if the user does not have power control access rights.  
The current state of the power device outlet appears in the Current Power Status area of the dialog  
box. As you change the power state, the information is updated in real time.  
Depending on the configuration of a power device outlet, it may not immediately respond to a  
power change request (for example, it may be configured to remain off for a specific period  
of time).  
To power up, power down, or power cycle a target device:  
1. Select Options - Power from the Telnet Viewer main window. The Power Control dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Click On, Off or Cycle.  
3. Click Close to close the dialog box.  
Closing a Telnet Viewer Session  
To close a Telnet Viewer session:  
Select File - Exit from the Telnet Viewer window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
276  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
277  
CHAPTER  
Using Tools  
20  
The DSView 3 management software contains tools that may be used to perform various actions on  
units. This chapter describes the available tools and how to use them.  
Using Unit Tools  
The Unit Tools window contains tools that allow a user to:  
Export unit information to a .csv (comma separated value) file  
Export unit access rights information to a .csv file  
Merge two or more target devices into a single target device  
Import a DSView 2.x software database into the DSView 3 management software (valid only  
when the DSView 3 software is installed on supported Windows systems)  
Import data in an XML format into the DSView 3 software database  
To display the Units Tools window:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Unit Tools window will open.  
Exporting units  
The Export Units tool will export information about units into a .csv file. Unit names are always  
exported. The following unit properties may be selected for export:  
Action (default action)  
Browser URL  
Custom field 1-3  
Department  
Primary contact phone  
Secondary contact  
Secondary contact phone  
Serial number  
DSView server name  
IP address  
Location  
Site  
Status (at time of export)  
Telnet port  
Model number  
Part number  
Type  
Visibility (show or hide)  
Primary contact  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
278  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
You may also export a topology report, regardless of any properties selected for export. A topology  
report contains the following columns:  
Port - (target devices or cascade switches only) Port number on the appliance to which the  
target device or cascade switch is connected.  
Type - (managed appliances only) Appliance type, if known.  
Level - Level of connection from the appliance. A managed appliance is level 0. A target  
device attached to a managed appliance is 1, and so on.  
The output .csv file may be viewed in a text editor or spreadsheet application, such as  
Microsoft Excel.  
To export units:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Unit Tools window will open.  
3. Click the Export Units icon or link. The Export Units Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Unit Properties to Export window will open.  
5. To add one or more properties to be exported, select the properties in the Available Properties  
list, then click Add. The properties will be moved to the Properties to Export list.  
6. To remove one or more properties to be exported, select the properties from the Properties to  
Export list, then click Remove. The properties will be moved to the Available Properties list.  
7. To change the order in which properties are listed in the output .csv file, select one or more  
properties in the Properties to Export list and use the up and down arrows to move the selected  
properties up or down in the listing.  
8. To create a topology report, enable the Export Topology checkbox. If any properties are also  
being exported, they will be listed after the topology information in the report.  
9. Click Next.  
10. The Save Process window will open. Click Next.  
11. The Completed Successful window will open, along with a File Download dialog box.  
12. Click Open. The file will download and open. By default, .csv files are configured to open in  
Microsoft Excel. If Microsoft Excel is not installed on your computer, you will be prompted to  
select a text editor to use for opening the .csv file.  
The default filename of the .csv file is unitproperties.csv. Subsequent files that you export will  
be incremented (unitproperties[1].csv, unitproperties[2].csv and so on).  
-or-  
Click Save. The Save As dialog box will appear. Select a directory and filename and click Save  
to save the .csv file.  
13. Click Finish. The Units Tools window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
279  
Exporting access rights  
The Export Access Rights tool will export permission information about units from the DSView 3  
management software host. The unit name and the user/user group to which the unit has access  
rights will be exported. Additionally, the unit access right settings will be exported; see About  
The output .csv file may be viewed in a text editor or spreadsheet application, such as  
Microsoft Excel.  
To export access rights:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Unit Tools window will open.  
3. Click the Export Access Rights icon or link. The Export Access Rights Wizard will appear.  
Click Next.  
4. The Select Type window will open. Select either All Units, Appliances, Target Devices or Unit  
Groups, click Next.  
5. The Save Process window will open. Read the text, then click Next.  
6. When prompted, enter the location and filename where the exported access rights will  
be saved.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open, along with a File Download dialog box.  
8. Click Open. The file will download and open. By default, .csv files are configured to open in  
Microsoft Excel. If Microsoft Excel is not installed on your computer, you will be prompted to  
select a text editor to use for opening the .csv file.  
The default filename of the .csv file is appliance_rights.csv if you are exporting managed  
appliance rights or target_device_rights.csv if you are exporting target device rights.  
Subsequent files that you export will be incremented (target_device_rights[1].csv,  
target_device_rights[2].csv and so on).  
-or-  
Click Save. The Save As dialog box will appear. Select a directory and filename and click Save  
to save the .csv file.  
9. Click Finish. The Units Tools window will open.  
Merging target devices  
Using the Merge Target Devices tool may be necessary if a target device is connected to one or  
more managed appliances. For example, if a target device is connected to both a DSR switch and an  
ACS console server, this tool will merge the target devices (that were created when the managed  
appliances were added) into a single target device that contains all of the target actions.  
You may also merge one or more target devices from a Unit Overview window; see Merging target  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
280  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To merge target devices:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Unit Tools window will open.  
3. Click the Merge Target Devices icon or link. The Merge Target Devices Wizard will appear.  
Click Next.  
4. The Select Target Devices to Merge window will open.  
To add one or more target devices to the merge list, select the target device(s) in the  
Available Target Devices list, then click Add. The target devices will be moved to the  
Target Devices to Merge list.  
To remove one or more target devices from the merge list, select the target device(s) from  
the Target Devices to Merge list, then click Remove. The target devices will be moved to  
the Available Target Devices list.  
To merge target devices in a particular order, select one or more target devices in the  
Target Devices to Merge list and use the up and down arrows to move the selected target  
devices up or down in the listing. Once the order has been specified, select Merge missing  
properties to the target device based on the order of the devices in the “Target Devices to  
Merge” list.  
The merged target devices will contain the name of the first target device in the Target  
Device to Merge list. For example, if you are merging two target devices named TD1 and  
TD2, and TD2 is listed before TD1, the merged target device will be named TD2.  
Click Next.  
5. The Confirm Target Device Merge window will open. Click Next to confirm merging the  
connection paths into the specified destination target device. See Connections to Units on  
6. The Completed Successful window will open.  
7. Click Finish. The Units Tools window will open.  
Importing DSView 2.x software databases  
NOTE: This procedure is available only when the DSView 3 software is installed on a supported  
Windows system.  
The Import DSView 2.x software database tool allows you to import an existing DSView 2.x  
software database into the DSView 3 software system. When a database is imported, the following  
items will be imported:  
Units, including attached cascade switches, power devices and target devices  
Users and user groups with unit access rights  
Authentication services, including Windows NT domains, LDAP and local accounts  
System settings, including the ability to display connected users, connection sharing, status  
polling and delay rates and when the event log is deleted  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
281  
The following actions occur when a DSView 2.x software database is imported into the DSView 3  
management software system:  
A global unit group is created in the system for each group found in the DSView 2.x software  
database. The DSView 3 software does not provide DSView 2.x software Topology unit group  
nesting. Unit group names added to the system are a concatenation of the hierarchical names  
found in the DSView 2.x software, including the truncation of names when necessary.  
If a user had Admin rights in the DSView 2.x software for all nodes in the tree (including the  
Topology node), the user will be added as a member and inherit the access rights of a DSView  
administrator user group member in the DSView 3 software.  
If a user had Admin rights in the DSView 2.x software for all nodes in the tree except for the  
Topology node, the user will be added as a member and inherit the access rights of an  
appliance administrator user group member in the DSView 3 software.  
If a user had any other type rights in the DSView 2.x software, the user will be added as a  
member of the user group in the DSView 3 software. Access rights are set for units to which  
the user has access as follows:  
A user with User rights to a target device in the DSView 2.x software will be assigned the  
Establish Viewer Sessions access right in the DSView 3 software.  
A user with Admin rights to a target device in the DSView 2.x software will be assigned  
the Configure Unit Settings, Establish Viewer Sessions and Control Target Device Power  
access rights in the DSView 3 software.  
A user with User rights to a DS1800 digital switch, CPS appliance or DSR switch in the  
DSView 2.x software will not be assigned any access rights in the DSView 3 software.  
A user with Admin rights to a DS1800 digital switch, CPS appliance or DSR switch in the  
DSView 2.x software will be assigned the Reboot Appliance, Flash Upgrade Appliance  
and Configure Appliance Settings access rights in the DSView 3 software.  
Cascade switch types in the DSView 2.x software database cannot be determined during the  
import process and are added as Generic 1 x <n> switches, based on the number of found  
switch channels. After importing the DSView 2.x software database and running the Migrate  
DSView 2.X Units task, you may run the Resync Wizard on individual CPS appliances,  
DS1800 digital switches and DSR switches to specify switch types and merge multiuser  
Internal users and built-in user groups with DSView 2.x software permissions residing on the  
computer that ran the DSAuth server will be imported into the DSView 3 software system. An  
external NT authentication service with the same name as the DSAuth server will be added to  
the DSView 3 software system. The DSView 2.x software users and user groups will be  
associated with the authentication service added to the DSView 3 software system.  
The DSView 2.x software Everyone user group cannot be imported into DSView 3  
software systems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
282  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Before using the Import DSView 2.x Software Database tool  
To use the Import DSView 2.x Software Database tool, you must create a backup of the database  
using the DSAuth Migration Utility. The database is saved as a .zip file which may then be  
imported into the DSView 3 software system using the Import DSView 2.x Database tool.  
The DSAuth Migration Utility will shut down the DSView 2.x DSAuth service as it runs and will  
restart the service upon completion.  
To backup the database:  
1. On the computer containing the DSView 2.x software database (that is, the DSAuth Server)  
that you wish to migrate, insert the DSView 3 software DVD. An autorun file will display the  
DSView 3 management software screen.  
2. Click Run DSView 2.x Migration.  
-or-  
If autorun is not enabled, type <drive:>\Migration Utility\DSMigration.exe, where <drive:> is  
the letter of your DVD drive. The DSAuth Migration Utility dialog box will appear.  
3. Click Backup. The Save As dialog box will appear.  
4. Select a directory and filename and click Save. The Status area of the DSAuth Migration  
Utility dialog box will contain messages as the backup is created. A Finished message box will  
appear when the backup is completed.  
5. Click OK.  
To import DSView 2.x software databases:  
1. In the Units Tools window, click the Import DSView 2.x Database icon or link. The Import  
DSView 2.x Database Wizard will appear.  
2. Use the Browse button to locate the .zip backup file of the DSView 2.x software database you  
created, then click Next.  
3. The Select Import Options window will open.  
a. Select Import DSView 2.x system settings and apply them to this system to allow the  
following settings to be imported from the DSView 2.x software database migration file  
into your DSView 3 software system:  
Whether connected users may be viewed. See Video Viewer session properties on  
Whether connections are automatically shared when a KVM session is started. See  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
283  
b. Select Allow Target Devices to be added for nodes that have a default name to allow  
target devices to be added to your DSView 3 software system for nodes in the DSView 2.x  
software migration file that have default names. In DSView 2.x software, a default name  
is considered to be a name such as Port 1, Channel 1 and Socket 1.  
All default names are adjusted when they are imported to include the name of each CPS  
appliance, DS1800 digital switch and DSR switch.  
c. Select Allow nodes with the same name to be merged into the same target device if you  
wish to merge a target device that has multiple connections into a single target device. For  
example, a target device may be connected to a both a DSR switch and a power device.  
d. Select Add Active Directory authentication services instead of NT authentication services  
when Active Directory is detected to add an Active Directory service when an Active  
Directory domain is detected in the DSView 2.x software database migration file. If this  
option is not selected, the service will be added to the DSView 3 software system as a  
Windows NT Domain service.  
e. Type the case-insensitive names of any DSView 2.x software database nodes that you do  
not wish to import, separated by commas (,), in the Node Names to Ignore field. Any  
children within the parent nodes listed in the field are also ignored (that is, not imported).  
You may import a node containing a comma on its name by enclosing the node name in  
quotation marks. For example, to import a node named node, two (containing a comma)  
and a node named nodeone, type “node,two”,nodeone in the Node Names to  
Ignore field.  
f. Click Next.  
4. The Import in Progress window will open, displaying the current step being performed, as the  
DSView 2.x software database is importing. When the import completes, the Completed  
Successful window will open with a summary of the import, including the number of  
authentication services, users, user groups, units and unit groups added.  
5. Click Finish. The Units Tools window will open.  
After running the Import DSView 2.x Database tool  
Units requiring migration will contain Migration Needed in the Migration Status field of Units  
View windows.  
Although the managed appliances have been imported from the DSView 2.x software database into  
the DSView 3 software system, they are not yet compatible with the DSView 3 software. To  
complete the configuration and update the firmware on each type of managed appliance, you must  
use the Migrate Units task. See Task: Migrating units on page 299.  
Importing data  
®
You can use the Import Data Wizard to migrate data from the AlterPath Manager to the DSView  
3 software. First, you will need to export the data from the AlterPath Manager into an XML format  
that is recognized by DSView 3 software. See the AlterPath Manager Data Migration Technical  
Bulletin for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
284  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To import data:  
1. Click the Units tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Unit Tools window will open.  
3. Click the Import Data icon or link. The Import Data Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. In the File field, type the path and name of the import file or browse to the file location. The  
file must be a valid DSView 3 software data import file in an XML format. Click Next.  
5. The Select Import Options window will open. Specify the User Password Options. Select Set  
the users password to the users username or Set the users password to a default value. If you  
choose a default password value, type a 3-64 character password in the Password and Confirm  
Password fields.  
6. Specify the Account Options. Depending on which options you choose, you may select  
multiple checkboxes. Only valid combinations will be enabled. You may choose from the  
following options:  
Disable user account  
User must change password at next login  
User cannot change password  
Password never expires  
7. Click Next. The Import In Progress message will display until the import attempt is complete.  
If the import is successful, the Completed Successful window will open and display a  
summary of the results.  
If the import was not successful, the Completed Unsuccessful window will open and display  
the errors that caused the import to fail. If some items could not be imported, a message will  
direct you to a .csv file with more information. You may attempt to import the data again.  
8. Click Finish.  
Although data has been imported from the AlterPath Manager to the DSView 3 software system,  
the units are not yet compatible with the DSView 3 software. To complete the configuration and  
import process, you must use the Migrate Units task. When creating the Migrate Units task, it is  
recommend that you select Enable Secure Mode for the units. See Task: Migrating units on  
Using the Managed Appliance Tools  
The DSView 3 management software contains tools that allow you to perform the following  
actions on a supported KVM switch or serial console appliance:  
Reboot  
Upgrade the firmware  
Resynchronize the managed appliance so that it reflects the current DSView 3 software  
system configuration  
Save or restore the configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
285  
Save or restore the database of local users  
To access the managed appliance tools:  
1. Click the Units tab. In the side navigation bar, click one of the following:  
Appliances - The Appliances - All window will open. You may also click on a link below  
Appliances to display only specific types of managed appliances in an  
Appliances window.  
Sites and then click on a site link - A Units in Site window will open.  
A custom field label and then the label you specified for the managed appliance - The  
Units in Custom Fields window will open.  
Recently Accessed - The Recently Accessed Units window will open.  
2. Click on the name of a managed appliance. The Unit Overview window will open. The tools  
are listed in the Tools section of the window.  
Rebooting  
To reboot one or more managed appliances from a Units View window:  
1. In a Units View window (see Accessing Units View windows on page 98), click the checkbox  
next to the appliance. To reboot all managed appliances in the page, click the checkbox to the  
left of Name at the top of the list. (If the page lists units other than managed appliances, they  
will not be affected.)  
2. Click Operations, then select Reboot from the menu. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
3. Confirm or cancel the reboot. If confirmed, all active sessions will be disconnected. A Multiple  
Unit Operation window will open, containing a link to another window where results may be  
To reboot a managed appliance from a Unit Overview window:  
NOTE: To reboot a KVM switch or serial console appliance, you must have Reboot Appliance access rights. By  
default, users who are members of the DSView 3 software administrators, user administrators and appliance  
administrators built-in groups have this access right. See About Access Rights on page 129.  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Reboot icon or link. A confirmation dialog box  
will appear.  
2. Confirm or cancel the reboot. If confirmed, all active sessions will be disconnected.  
Upgrading firmware  
To upgrade the firmware on a managed appliance:  
NOTE: A valid Flash file must exist in the DSView 3 server’s firmware repository for the KVM switch or serial  
console appliance to use this command. Optionally, one or more managed appliances may be Flash upgraded  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
286  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Upgrade Firmware icon or link. The Upgrade Appli-  
ance Firmware Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
2. The Select Firmware Files window will open.  
To add one or more Flash files to the update list, select the file(s) in the Available  
Firmware Files list, then click Add. The properties will be moved to the Firmware Files to  
Update list.  
To remove one or more firmware files from the update list, select the file(s) from the  
Firmware Files to Update list, then click Remove. The firmware files will be moved to the  
Available Firmware Files list.  
The firmware on each managed appliance will be upgraded in the order shown in the  
Update list. A reboot will be automatically performed between each firmware update.To  
change the order in which firmware files are installed on the managed appliance, select  
one or more firmware files in the Firmware Files to Update list and use the up and down  
arrows to move the selected firmware files up or down in the listing.  
Click Next.  
3. The Type in Task Name window will open. Type a 1-64 character name for the upgrade  
firmware task, then click Next.  
4. The Completed Successful window will open. To check the progress of the upgrade task, click  
the Click here to view results link. (You may also check the upgrade task progress while the  
task is running by clicking the System tab and then clicking Tasks in the top navigation bar;  
however, the upgrade task will be removed from the task list when it completes.)  
5. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
Resynchronizing units  
When a unit changes its configuration, it may not be properly represented in the DSView 3  
software system. For example, a target device may be added, removed or moved. Resynchronizing  
will update these and other changes made to the unit within the DSView 3 software system.  
Resynchronizing will force a check of the entire DSView 3 software system. The process requires a  
large amount of time and network bandwidth and should only be performed when necessary.  
Alternatively, you may use the automatic topology synchronization feature or synchronize selected  
units manually from a Units View window. See Topology Synchronization on page 120.  
To resynchronize a unit:  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Resync icon or link. The Resync Unit Wizard will  
appear. Click Next.  
2. The Select Resync Options window will open. (For more information about the resync options,  
a. Enable the Remove offline connections checkbox to remove from the DSView 3 software  
database any connections to target devices that are reported as offline in the appliance.  
The Resync Wizard does not add offline connections to the DSView 3 software database.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
287  
b. Enable the Delete target devices that no longer have connections checkbox to delete those  
target devices permanently from the DSView 3 software database.  
c. Enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single target  
device checkbox to allow the DSView 3 software to treat multiple target devices with the  
same name as one unit with multiple access methods.  
d. Enable the Allow target devices that contain default names to be added checkbox to allow  
target devices that have default names in the managed appliances to be added to the  
DSView 3 software database.  
e. Click Next.  
3. If the unit does not require resynchronizing, the Completed Successful window will open.  
If the unit requires resynchronizing, the Changes Detected in Appliance window will open.  
Click Next and go to step 7.  
If one or more cascade switches are attached to the KVM switch, the Cascade Switch  
Configuration window will open. Go to step 4.  
4. Select the type of each detected cascade switch.  
5. Type a name for each cascade switch.  
6. Optionally, combine any multiuser cascade switches. Click the checkboxes of the cascade  
switches that you wish to merge, and then click Merge.  
To unmerge any cascade switches that you have merged, click the checkbox of the merged  
cascade switch and then click Split.  
7. Click Next. The Completed Successful window will open.  
8. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
Saving a managed appliance configuration  
You may save the configuration of a KVM switch or serial console appliance to a file. The  
configuration file will contain information about the managed appliance, including the following:  
Global settings  
Port settings  
SNMP trap settings  
SNMP manager settings  
The names of connected target devices  
For information on restoring a configuration file, see Restoring a managed appliance configuration  
To save a managed appliance configuration to a file:  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Save Configuration icon or link. The Save Appliance  
Configuration Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
288  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. The Type in File Description window will open. Type a description of the configuration that  
will be saved and may be used if you wish to restore the configuration at a later time, and then  
click Next.  
3. The Completed Successful window will open.  
4. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
Restoring a managed appliance configuration  
You may restore the configuration of a KVM switch or serial console appliance. To restore the  
configuration, a previously-saved configuration file must exist. See Saving a managed appliance  
Appliance configuration files are stored in the DSView 3 server appliance files repository. You  
may display the available configuration files by clicking the System tab, clicking Appliance Files in  
the top navigation bar and clicking Configuration in the side navigation bar.  
To restore a managed appliance configuration:  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Restore Configuration icon or link. The Restore Appli-  
ance Configuration Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
2. The Select Configuration to Restore window will open. Click the radio button to the left of the  
file containing the configuration you wish to restore, and then click Next.  
3. The Completed Successful window will open.  
4. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
5. Reboot the managed appliance to enable the restored configuration. See Rebooting on  
Saving a managed appliance user database  
NOTE: You may not save the user database of a DS1800 digital switch or DSR1161, DSR2161, DSR4160,  
DSR800 switch.  
You may save the local user database on a KVM switch or serial console appliance. For  
information on restoring a user database, see Restoring a managed appliance user database on  
To save the user database of a managed appliance:  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Save User Database icon or link. The Save Appliance  
User Database Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
2. The Type in File Description window will open. Type a description of the user database that  
will be saved and can be used if you wish to restore the database, and then click Next.  
3. The Completed Successful window will open.  
4. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 20: Using Tools  
289  
Restoring a managed appliance user database  
NOTE: You may not restore the user database of a DS1800 digital switch or DSR1161, DSR2161, DSR4160 or  
DSR800 switch.  
You may restore the local user database of a KVM switch or serial console appliance. To restore  
the user database, a previously saved user database file must exist. See Saving a managed  
User database files are stored in the DSView 3 server appliance files repository. You may display  
the available database files by clicking the System tab, clicking Appliance Files in the top  
navigation bar and clicking User Database in the side navigation bar.  
To restore the user database of a managed appliance:  
1. In the Unit Overview window, click the Restore User Database icon or link. The Restore  
Appliance User Database Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
2. The Select User Database to Restore window will open. Click the radio button to the left of the  
managed appliance user database you wish to restore, and then click Next.  
3. The Completed Successful window will open.  
4. Click Finish. The Unit Overview window will open.  
5. Reboot the managed appliance to enable the restored user database. See Rebooting on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
290  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
291  
CHAPTER  
Using Tasks  
21  
You may add, delete and change tasks from the Tasks window. The Tasks window lists all tasks  
configured in the DSView 3 management software system and allows you to manually run tasks.  
Using the Tasks Window  
To display the Tasks window:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
Customizing the Tasks window  
The following fields may be displayed in the Tasks window: Use the Customize link to add or  
remove fields in the display. See Using the Customize link in windows on page 26.  
Runs On - Server(s) on which the task will run.  
Next Run - Next date and time on which the task is scheduled to run. This field will be blank  
for a task scheduled on a remote DSView 3 server.  
Last Run - Date and time of the last run of the task. This field will be blank for a task scheduled  
on a remote DSView 3 server.  
Schedule - How often and when the task is scheduled.  
Status - Status of a task. An icon in the Name column also indicates the task status.  
Table 21.1: Task Status Icons  
Icon  
Task  
Idle - Task is not currently running  
Running - Task is currently running  
Stopping - Task has run but has not completely stopped  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
292  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Disabled - Task was prevented from executing  
Adding tasks  
You may use the Add Task Wizard to run the following tasks:  
Backup the DSView 3 software database and system files  
Configure SNMP trap settings on appliance  
Control power of target devices  
Export event log to comma separated values (.csv) file  
Migrate units (configures and upgrades DSView 2.x or AlterPath Manager software units)  
Send IPMI chassis control command to target devices  
Test modem connections to selected units  
Upgrade firmware of selected appliances of the same type  
Validate external authentication server user accounts  
Pull names from selected units  
Update topology for selected units  
Specifying when to run tasks  
You may choose to run tasks at the following times:  
Run task now - Runs the task immediately after you click Finish when adding the task in the  
Add Task Wizard. The Status column will indicate Running and the running icon will appear to  
the left of the task name.  
One time only - Runs the task once at a specific time on a specific date.  
Periodic - Runs the task a certain number of times per hour or day, beginning at a specific time  
on a specific date.  
Daily - Runs the task once every day, once Monday-Friday or regularly for a certain number of  
days (every 2 days, every 3 days and so on), beginning at a specific time on a specific date.  
Weekly - Runs the task once each week or regularly over a certain number of weeks (every 2  
weeks, every 3 weeks and so on), beginning at a specific time on a specific date. You may also  
specify which days you wish for the task to run.  
       
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
293  
Monthly - Runs the task once each month or regularly over a certain number of months (every  
2 months, every 3 months and so on) beginning at a specific time on a specific date. You may  
also specify specific months for the task to run.  
To run a task periodically:  
1. In the Select When to Run the Task window of the Add Task Wizard, click Periodic.  
Click Next.  
2. The Specify Periodic Schedule window will open.  
a. Select the hour, minute and AM or PM to indicate when to begin running the task.  
b. Click Every (minutes) and select a number of minutes or click Every (hours) and select a  
number of hours.  
c. Click on the calendar button or the field to the left of the calendar button and select a date  
to begin running the task. To use the calendar:  
Click on the year and select a year.  
Click on the month name and select a month or use the arrows at the top of the  
calendar to move forward and backward by month.  
Click on a day in the calendar to close the calendar and fill the field to the left of the  
calendar with the date you have selected.  
To run a task daily:  
1. In the Select When to Run the Task window of the Add Task Wizard, click Daily. Click Next.  
2. The Specify Daily Schedule window will open.  
a. Select the hour, minute and AM or PM to indicate when to begin running the task.  
b. Click Every Day to run the task each day of the week (Sunday-Saturday).  
-or-  
Click Weekdays to run the task once each weekday (Monday-Friday).  
-or-  
Click Every (days) and select the number of consecutive days (1-365).  
c. Click on the calendar button or the field to the left of the calendar button and select a date  
to begin running the task. To use the calendar:  
Click on the year and select a year.  
Click on the month name and select a month or use the arrows at the top of the  
calendar to move forward and backward by month.  
Click on a day in the calendar to close the calendar and fill the field to the left of the  
calendar with the date you have selected.  
To run a task weekly:  
1. In the Select When to Run the Task window of the Add Task Wizard, click Weekly. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
294  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
2. The Specify Weekly Schedule window will open.  
a. Select the hour, minute and AM or PM to indicate when to begin running the task.  
b. Click Every (weeks) and select the number of consecutive weeks (1-52).  
c. Select the day of week to run the task from the list box. Multiple weeks may be selected by  
pressing Ctrl while clicking on the weeks.  
d. Click on the calendar button or the field to the left of the calendar button and select a date  
to begin running the task. To use the calendar:  
Click on the year and select a year.  
Click on the month name and select a month or use the arrows at the top of the  
calendar to move forward and backward by month.  
Click on a day in the calendar. The calendar will close and fill the field to the left of  
the calendar with the selected date.  
To run a task monthly:  
1. In the Select When to Run the Task window of the Add Task Wizard, click Monthly.  
Click Next.  
2. The Specify Monthly Schedule window will open.  
a. Select the hour, minute and AM or PM to indicate when to begin running the task.  
b. Click Day and select the day of the month to run the task.  
-or-  
Click The and select a week and a day of the week to run the task. For example, if you  
wish to run the task each second Tuesday of the month, select second from the first menu  
and Tuesday from the second menu.  
c. Select the month to run the task from the list box. Multiple months may be selected by  
pressing Ctrl while clicking on the months.  
d. Click on the calendar button or the field to the left of the calendar button and select a date  
to begin running the task. To use the calendar:  
Click on the year and select a year.  
Click on the month name and select a month or use the arrows at the top of the  
calendar to move forward and backward by month.  
Click on a day in the calendar. The calendar will close and fill the field to the left of  
the calendar with the selected date.  
Adding tasks using the Add Task Wizard  
Tasks may be added only by DSView 3 software administrators.  
Task: Backup DSView 3 software database and system files  
This task creates a compressed .zip file containing a backup of your DSView 3 software system.  
The backup file contains everything necessary to fully restore the DSView 3 software hub server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
295  
The backup file is named dsviewBackup.zip by default, but you may also append the date and time  
to the end of the backup filename.  
If a backup is restored to a server with a different IP address, managed appliances may not be able  
to authenticate until the new DSView 3 server IP address has been programmed into the  
managed appliances.  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
page 305. You may also create a backup manually; see Backing up and Restoring Hub Servers  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open.  
a. Select Backup DSView database and system files from the drop-down menu.  
b. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task, then click  
6. The Specify DSView System Backup Properties dialog box will appear.  
a. Type the directory location in which to create the system backup, which may be a physical  
local drive on the DSView 3 server or a shared network location specified by a UNC  
(Universal Naming Convention) path. The Location field cannot be set to a mapped  
network drive. The directory name must be entered in case sensitive text if your operating  
system supports case sensitive filenames.  
b. If the specified directory location is a network path that requires a login, enable the Login  
required to access shared drive location checkbox. Then type the username and password  
and confirm the password of a user account that has read/write access to the network  
share location.  
c. To encrypt the created system backup file, enable the Encrypt Backup File checkbox, then  
type a password to lock and unlock the encrypted file.  
d. To append the date and time (in military time) to the end of the system backup filename,  
enable the Use date and time for file naming checkbox. For example, if you are creating the  
backup file on October 1, 2005 at 10:04 pm, the file created will be named  
dsviewBackup1001052204.zip.  
If a system backup file already exists in the specified directory and this option is not  
enabled, the existing backup file will be overwritten when the new backup file is created.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
296  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Task: Configure SNMP trap settings on a managed appliance  
This task turns SNMP traps on or off for one or more managed appliances of a particular type. To  
specify SNMP trap settings for other types of managed appliances, you must create  
additional tasks.  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
page 305. You may also configure SNMP trap settings manually; see Managed Appliance SNMP  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open. Select Configure SNMP trap settings on appliance  
from the drop-down menu.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.Then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
7. The Select Unit Group window will open. Select All Appliances or select a unit group, then  
click Next.  
8. The Select Appliance Type window will open. Select the type of managed appliance for which  
to configure SNMP traps, then click Next.  
9. The Select Appliances window will open. Select one or more managed appliances from the  
Available Appliances list, then click Add. The unit(s) will be moved to the Appliances to  
Configure list. Then click Next.  
10. The Configure SNMP Traps window will open. Change the trap state by selecting one of the  
following from each trap menu, then click Next.  
No Change - uses the trap on/off state already configured.  
Enable - turns the trap on.  
Disable - turns the trap off.  
-or-  
Click one of the following buttons:  
No Change All - uses the on/off states already configured.  
Enable All - turns all traps on.  
Disable All - turns all traps off.  
11. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open,  
including the new task.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
297  
Task: Power control a target device  
This task powers up, powers down or cycles the power (powers down and then powers up) of one  
or more target devices.  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
page 305. There are other ways to power control a target device; see Power Control of Devices  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open.  
a. Select Control power of Target Devices from the drop-down menu.  
b. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
6. The Select Unit Group window will open. Select All Target Devices to configure the power  
control settings on all target devices or select a particular unit group to configure. See Unit  
Groups on page 193. Then click Next.  
7. The Select Target Devices window will open. Select one or more target devices in the  
Available Target Devices list, then click Add. The target device(s) will be moved to the Target  
Devices to Control list. Then click Next.  
8. The Select Power Control Function window will open. Select the power control function to be  
performed on the target devices, and then click Next.  
Turn Power On - powers up the specified target devices.  
Turn Power Off - powers down the specified target devices.  
Cycle Power - powers down and then powers up the specified target devices.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open,  
including the new task.  
Task: Exporting an event log .csv file  
This task exports selected fields from the DSView 3 software system event log to a .csv file. The  
exported event log may be stored on a local or network drive. The event log is named eventlog.csv  
by default, but you may also append the date and time to the end of the event log. The output .csv  
file may be viewed in a text editor or spreadsheet application, such as Microsoft Excel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
298  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
page 305. You may also save an event log using the Export Event Log tool. See Creating an Event  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open.  
a. Select Export event log to a comma separated values (.CSV) file from the  
drop-down menu.  
b. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
6. The Specify Export Event Log Properties window will open.  
a. Type the directory in which to create the event log, which may be a physical local drive on  
the DSView 3 server or at a shared network location specified by a UNC path. The  
location cannot be set to a mapped network drive.The directory name must be entered in  
case sensitive text if your operating system supports case sensitive filenames.  
b. If the specified directory location is a network drive that requires a log in, enable the Login  
required to access shared drive location checkbox. Then, type the username and password  
and confirm the password of a user account that has read/write access to the network  
share location.  
c. To append the date and time (in military time) to the end of the event log file, enable the  
Use date and time for file naming checkbox. For example, if you are creating the event log  
file on October 1, 2005 at 10:04 pm, the file created will be named  
eventlog1001052204.csv.  
If an event log exists in the specified directory and you do not enable this option, it will be  
overwritten when the new event log is created.  
d. Click Next.  
7. The Select Event Log Columns to Export window will open.  
8. To add one or more columns to export, select the column(s) from the Available Columns list,  
then click Add. The column(s) will be moved to the Columns to Export list.  
9. To remove one or more columns to export, select the column(s) from the Columns to Export  
list, then click Remove. The column(s) will be moved to the Available Columns list.  
10. To change the order in which exported columns are listed in the output .csv file, select one or  
more columns in the Columns to Export list and use the up and down arrows to move the  
selected columns up or down in the listing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
299  
11. Click Next.  
12. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Task: Migrating units  
NOTE: This task is valid only when the DSView 3 software is installed on a supported Windows system.  
This task may be used to migrate units from a DSView 2.x software database or from the  
AlterPath Manager.  
Migrating DSView 2.x software units  
This task updates DS1800 digital switches, CPS appliances or DSR switches within the unit group,  
or any of those managed appliances using firmware compatible with DSView 2.x software to  
firmware that is compatible with the DSView 3 management software.  
The managed appliances should not be Flash upgraded from DSView 2.x firmware to firmware that  
supports DSView 3 software before using the Migrate Units command. The recommended  
procedure is to first import the DSView 2.x software database to the new DSView 3 software  
system using the Import DSView 2.x Database tool (see Importing DSView 2.x software databases  
on page 280), followed by running the Migrate Units task on each managed appliance.  
A CPS appliance or DSR switch that has been migrated to DSView 3 software compatible  
firmware may be returned to DSView 2.x compatibility.  
Migrating AlterPath Manager software units  
This task updates units that have been imported from the AlterPath Manager to be compatible with  
the DSView 3 management software.  
The recommended procedure is to first export data from the AlterPath Manager into an XML  
format that can be read by DSView 3 software (see the AlterPath Manager Data Migration  
Technical Bulletin). Then, import the AlterPath Manager data to the DSView 3 software system  
using the Import Data Wizard (see Importing data on page 283), followed by running the Migrate  
Units task on each managed appliance. When creating the Migrate Units task, it is recommend that  
you select Enable Secure Mode for the units.  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open. Select Migrate Units from the drop-down menu.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task, then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
7. The Select Unit Group window will open. Select Units Needing Migration or a particular unit  
group from the menu. Then click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
300  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
8. The Select Unit Type window will open. Select the type of managed appliance to migrate, and  
then click Next. You must create a separate task for each model or type of managed appliance  
you wish to migrate.  
9. The Select Appliances window will open. The Available Appliances list will contain only units  
with a status of Migration Needed that match the selected type found in the unit group  
specified in the previous step. Select one or more managed appliance to migrate from the  
Available Appliances list, then Click Add. The switches or appliances will be moved to the  
Appliances to Configure list.  
10. Click Next.  
11. The Select Options for Migration window will open. If you want the managed appliances you  
are migrating to be accessible only by this DSView 3 server, enable the Enable secure mode  
checkbox. If you want the managed appliances you are migrating to be accessible by any  
DSView 3 software system, disable the Enable secure mode checkbox. Click Next.  
NOTE: If you are migrating units from the AlterPath Manager, enabling secure mode is recommended.  
12. If you are migrating DSView 2.x software units, the Select Firmware Files for Migration  
window will open.  
a. Type the host name or the address of the TFTP server, in standard dot notation  
(xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) containing the DS1800 digital switch, CPS appliance or DSR switch  
firmware files required for migration to DSView 3 management software compatibility.  
b. Type the name of each firmware image.  
c. Click Next.  
13. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open. You  
may display the current progress of the migration task by clicking on the name of the task.  
14. Repeat the preceding steps for each type of managed appliance that you wish to migrate.  
Units successfully migrated into the DSView 3 software system will appear in Units View  
windows and the Migration Status field for these units will indicate Migration Completed.  
Task: Sending an IPMI chassis control command to target devices  
This command powers up, powers down, cycles the power (power down and then power up),  
performs a gentle shutdown or resets one or more IPMI target devices.  
You must have Control Target Device Power rights to send an IPMI chassis control command. See  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
301  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open.  
a. Select Send IPMI chassis control command to target devices from the drop-down menu.  
b. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
6. The Select Unit Group window will open. Select All Target Devices or select a particular unit  
group to configure from the menu. See Grouping Units on page 187. Then click Next.  
7. The Select Target Devices window will open. Select one or more IPMI target devices to  
chassis control from the Available Target Devices list, then click Add. The IPMI target devices  
will be moved to the Target Devices to Control list. Click Next.  
8. The Select IPMI Control Function window will open. Select the power control function you  
wish to perform on the IPMI target devices, then click Next.  
Turn Power On - powers up the specified devices.  
Turn Power Off - powers down the specified devices.  
Cycle Power - powers down and then power up the specified devices. *  
Reset - performs a hard reset of the specified devices.  
Graceful Shutdown - performs a graceful shutdown of the specified devices. *  
* The availability of the Cycle Power and Graceful Shutdown options is dependent on the  
BMC implementation. If one of these options is selected for a task but the BMC  
implementation does not support the option, the task will fail when run and be reported in the  
Task Results window.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Task: Test modem connections to selected units  
This task tests modem connections to ACS console servers that have been configured to support  
modem dial-up or modem dial-back.  
For more information about modem connections, see Active modem sessions on page 161.  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open. Select Test modem connections to selected units  
from the drop-down menu.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task, then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
302  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
7. The Select Unit Type window will open.  
Click Select by Product Family and select ACS Firmware from the drop-down menu.  
-or-  
Click Select Unit Type and choose a specific ACS console server model from the  
drop-down menu.  
Then click Next.  
8. The Select Unit window will open. Select the units that you wish to test and click Add, then  
click Next.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Task: Updating the firmware of an appliance type  
This task upgrades the firmware of selected DS1800 digital switches, DSI5100, CPS or CCM  
appliances or DSR switches. To upgrade other types of managed appliances, you must create  
additional tasks.  
Firmware must be available before using this command. See Firmware Management on page 307.  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open. Select Upgrade firmware of selected appliances of  
the same type from the drop-down menu.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task, then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
7. The Select Unit Group window will open. Select All Appliances or select a particular unit  
group to upgrade from the menu. See Unit Groups on page 193. Then click Next.  
8. The Select Appliance Type window will open. Select the type of managed appliance that you  
wish to upgrade, then click Next.  
9. The Select Appliances window will open. Select one or more managed appliance to be  
upgraded from the Available Appliances list, then click Add. The appliances will be moved to  
the Appliances to Configure list.  
10. Click Next.  
11. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
303  
Task: Validating user accounts on an external authentication server  
This task may be used to ensure that LDAP, Active Directory and NT external authentication  
services contain accounts for users. Any user accounts not found on the external authentication  
server will be flagged as suspicious (a question mark icon will appear to the left of the user’s  
name). Suspicious accounts are indicated in event log files.  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open.  
a. Select Validate external authentication server user accounts from the drop-down menu.  
b. Type a 1-64 character name for the task.  
c. Click Next.  
5. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
6. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Task: Pull names from selected units  
Automatic name pull (see Automatic name pull on page 117) is not supported on some managed  
appliances, including the LANDesk Server Manager. To keep these appliances synchronized with  
the DSView 3 software, you may instead schedule the pull names task.  
NOTE: For more information about LANDesk Server Manager integration, see the DSView 3 Software Plug-in for  
LANDesk Server Manager online help.  
This task may be used to pull names from a managed appliance and update the DSView 3 software  
database. This task performs the same operations as the Pull Names from Appliance option in the  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window opens.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard appears. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window opens. Select Pull Names from selected units from the drop-  
down menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
304  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task, then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
7. The Select Unit Group window opens. Select All Units or select a unit group, then click Next.  
8. The Select Unit window opens. Select the units to be included in the topology update, click  
Add, then click Next.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Task: Update topology for selected units  
Automatic topology synchronization (see Automatic topology synchronization on page 121) is not  
supported on some units supported by plug-ins. To keep these units synchronized with the DSView  
3 software, you may instead schedule the update topology task.  
This task updates the DSView 3 software database when a change occurs in a units. Examples of  
changes are the adding/removing of an IQ adaptor, cascade switch or power device. This task  
performs the same operations as the Resync Unit Wizard (see Resynchronizing units on page 286).  
Once this task is added, you may run it on demand at any time; see Running tasks manually on  
To add the task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window opens.  
3. Click Add. The Add Task Wizard appears. Click Next.  
4. The Select Task to Add window will open. Select Update Topology for selected units from the  
drop-down menu.  
5. Type a 1-64 character name for the task, then click Next.  
6. The Select When to Run the Task window will open. Select a time to run the task (see  
7. The Select Unit Group window opens. Select All Units or select a unit group, then click Next.  
8. The Select Unit window opens. Select the units to be included in the topology update, click  
Add, then click Next.  
9. The Select Options window opens.  
a. If you enable the Remove offline connections checkbox, any units connections that are  
reported as offline in the unit will be deleted from the DSView 3 software database. The  
Update topology for selected units task does not add offline connections to the DSView 3  
software database  
b. If you enable the Delete target devices that no longer have connections checkbox, target  
devices that no longer have connections will be permanently deleted from the DSView 3  
software database.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
305  
c. If you enable the Allow target devices with the same name to be merged into a single  
target device checkbox, the connection to a target device in the unit will be merged with  
the connection(s) to an existing target device in the DSView 3 software database.  
d. If you enable the Allow target devices that contain default names to be added for these  
type of connections checkbox, you may then enable one or more connection type  
checkboxes. Any target devices that contain default names in the unit will be added to the  
DSView 3 software database only if the connection type in the unit matches an enabled  
connection type in this window.  
e. Click Next.  
10. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish. The Tasks window will open.  
Running tasks manually  
Although tasks are scheduled to run at particular times using the Add Task Wizard, you may run an  
existing task at any time.  
To manually run tasks:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the task(s) you wish to run. To select all tasks on the page,  
click the checkbox to the left of Name at the top of the list.  
Remote tasks that are scheduled on another DSView 3 server may not be run from the DSView  
3 server to which you are logged in. To run a remote task, you must log in to the DSView 3  
server on which the task was created.  
4. Click Run Now. The icon to the left of the task name will change to the running icon and the  
status of the task will change to Running.  
Displaying task results  
The Task Results window displays the status of the most current run of tasks, including successful  
and unsuccessful runs and information on each run.  
The following fields display in the Task Results window for the Configure SNMP trap settings on  
appliance, Control power of target devices, Migrate Units, Send IPMI chassis control command to  
target devices and Upgrade firmware of selected appliances of the same type tasks:  
Name - Names of the unit on which the task is running or has been run  
Start Time - Exact time at which each task run occurred  
Duration - Date and time of the task run  
Status - Result of the task run  
To display the results of a task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
306  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
3. Click the name of the task. The Task Results window will display, containing information  
about the task.  
Deleting tasks  
NOTE: Remote tasks, which are scheduled on another DSView 3 server, may not be deleted from the DSView 3  
server to which you are logged in. To delete a remote task, you must log in to the DSView 3 server on which the  
task was created.  
To delete a task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of the task(s) you wish to delete. To delete all tasks on the page,  
click the checkbox to the left of Name column at the top of the list.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Changing tasks  
NOTE: Remote tasks, which are scheduled on another DSView 3 server, may not be modified from the DSView  
3 server to which you are logged in. To change a remote task, you must log in to the DSView 3 server on which  
the task was created.  
You may change the schedule and properties for existing tasks. (The Validate external  
authentication server user accounts task does not contain properties.)  
To change a task schedule:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click on the name of the task.  
4. Click Schedule in the side navigation bar. The Task Schedule window will open. Select the  
type of task you wish to schedule and complete the information. See Specifying when to run  
To change the properties of a task:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Tasks in the top navigation bar. The Tasks window will open.  
3. Click on the name of the task.  
4. Click Properties in the side navigation bar. The Task Properties window will open.  
5. Change the properties of the task. See the operating sequence for the task type in Adding tasks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 21: Using Tasks  
307  
Firmware Management  
The Flash firmware files for DS1800 digital switches, DSI5100, CPS and CCM appliances and  
DSR switches may be added, viewed and deleted using the Appliance Firmware Files window.  
Once a Flash firmware file(s) has been added, you may use the file(s) to upgrade the  
managed appliance.  
To display the Appliance Firmware Files window:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Appliance Files in the top navigation bar. The Appliance Firmware Files window  
will open.  
Customizing the Appliance Firmware Files window  
The Version, firmware Type, Appliance Type, Creation Date and Time, Description, Language and  
Country fields may appear in the display. Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the  
To add a firmware file:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Appliance Files in the top navigation bar. The Appliance Firmware Files window  
will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Firmware File Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Select Firmware File to Import window will open.  
5. Enter the directory and filename (or browse to the location) of the firmware file you want to  
add to the DSView 3 software appliance files repository.  
6. Type a description of the firmware file in the Description field.  
7. Click Next. The firmware is added and the Completed Successful window appears.  
8. Click Finish. The Appliance Firmware Files window will open.  
NOTE: Once the file is uploaded, it is no longer needed on the DSView 3 software client from which it  
was uploaded.  
To display firmware information:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Appliance Files in the top navigation bar. The Appliance Firmware Files window  
will open.  
3. Click on the version of a firmware file. The Firmware File Properties window will open.  
4. The display includes the firmware version, appliance type, firmware creation date, country and  
language of the firmware. If you wish, you may change the description of the firmware file in  
the Description field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
308  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
5. Click Save and then click Close. The Appliance Firmware - All window will open and contain  
the firmware information if you saved the changes.  
To delete firmware:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Appliance Files in the top navigation bar. The Appliance Firmware Files window  
will open.  
3. Click the checkbox next to the firmware you want to delete.  
4. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
5. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
309  
CHAPTER  
Events and Event Logs  
22  
When an enabled, defined event occurs in the DSView 3software system, it is saved in the  
event log. You may display the event log content, view details about an individual event log entry  
or delete an event log entry. You may have an email notification sent to one or more addresses  
when an event occurs. You may change the event log’s retention period and export the event  
log’s content.  
NOTE: You must be a member of the DSView 3 software administrator or auditor user group to access event  
configuration and display windows.  
Event Severity and Categories  
Events are classified by severity and category.  
Event severity  
Table 22.1 describes the event severity levels. The icon appears in event log displays.  
Table 22.1: Event Severity Levels  
Severity  
Icon  
Description  
Monitor  
Events that are periodic and expected.  
Information  
Events that are neither periodic nor problematic.  
Events that are in a normal or cleared state. This value typically appears at  
event start up or after leaving a previous event state.  
OK  
Non-critical  
Abnormal events that require correcting at a later time.  
Abnormal events of a more serious nature that may require quicker action,  
such as the failure of a scheduled task or loss of communication  
Critical  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
310  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 22.1: Event Severity Levels (Continued)  
Severity  
Icon  
Description  
Severe abnormal events impacting your DSView 3 management software  
session and requires immediate corrective action.  
Non-recoverable  
Severity icons  
For users who are members of the DSView 3 software administrators or auditor user groups, the  
non-critical, critical and non-recoverable icons also appear near the right edge of the top navigation  
bar in the DSView Explorer window when events of that severity occur. Each icon is accompanied  
by a total count of new events of that severity. The counter is decremented when an event of that  
severity is deleted from the event log or when an event’s state is changed from New to  
Acknowledged (see Event states on page 315). The counter is incremented when a new event of  
that severity is added to the log or when an event’s state is changed from Acknowledged to New.  
Event categories  
Defined events can be classified in the following categories:  
Access control  
Appliance  
Authentication  
Data logging  
External  
IPMI  
Modem  
Sessions  
SSH Passthrough  
System  
Tasks  
Units  
Unit status  
Users  
Email Notifications  
The DSView 3 software may be configured to send one or more users an email notification when  
an enabled event occurs.  
You may specify which events will trigger an email notification.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 22: Events and Event Logs  
311  
You may also specify one or more unit groups - an email notification will be sent only when a  
specified unit-related event occurs on a unit that is a member of the specified unit group(s).  
If a specified event that is not tied to a unit occurs (for example, DSView server started), an  
email notification will be sent, regardless of the any specified unit groups.  
NOTE: A mail server that supports Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) must be configured to receive email  
event notifications.  
Customizing the Email Notifications window  
The Email Subject column is always displayed in the Email Notifications window: The display  
may include From Address and To Address fields. Use the Customize link to add or remove fields  
To configure an email notification:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Email Notifications in the side navigation bar. The Email Notifications window  
will open.  
3. Click Add. The Add Email Notification Wizard will appear. Click Next.  
4. The Specify Email Properties window will open.  
a. In the Send To field, type the email addresses of the persons you want to notify. Separate  
multiple addresses with a comma (,). This field has a limit of 1024 characters.  
b. In the From field, type the email address (up to 64 characters) of the person you wish to  
designate as the sender of the notification.  
c. In the Subject field, type a subject heading (up to 64 characters) for the notification.  
d. Click Next.  
5. The Select Events to Trigger Email Notification window will open.  
To add one or more events, select the event(s) from the Available Events list, then click  
Add. The event(s) will be moved to the Events To Notify list.  
To remove one or more events, select the event(s) from the Events To Notify list, then  
click Remove. The event(s) will be moved to the Available Events list.  
Click Next.  
6. The Select Unit Groups to Trigger Email Notification window will open.  
To add one or more unit groups, select the unit group(s) from the Available Unit Groups  
list, then click Add. The unit group(s) will be moved to the Selected Unit Groups list.  
To remove one or more unit groups, select the unit group(s) from the Selected Unit Groups  
list, then click Remove. The unit group(s) will be moved to the Available Unit Groups list.  
Click Next.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
312  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
To change an email notification:  
1. Click Email Notifications in the side navigation bar. The Email Notifications window  
will open.  
2. Click on the email subject of the notification you wish to change. The Email Notification  
Properties window will appear.  
3. To change the notification information:  
a. In the Send To field, enter or remove the email addresses of persons you want to notify.  
Separate multiple addresses with a comma (,). This field has a limit of 1024 characters.  
b. In the From field, change the email address (up to 64 characters) of the person you wish to  
designate as the sender of the notification.  
c. In the Subject field, change the subject heading (up to 64 characters) for the notification  
4. To change the events:  
To add one or more events, select the event(s) from the Available Events list, then click  
Add. The events will be moved to the Events To Notify list.  
To remove one or more events, select the event(s) from the Events To Notify list, then  
click Remove. The events will be moved to the Available Events list.  
5. To change the unit groups:  
To add one or more unit groups, select the unit group(s) from the Available Unit Groups  
list, then click Add. The unit group(s) will be moved to the Selected Unit Groups list.  
To remove one or more unit groups, select the unit group(s) from the Selected Unit Groups  
list, then click Remove. The unit group(s) will be moved to the Available Unit Groups list.  
6. Click Save and then click Close. The Email Notifications window will open.  
To test an email notification:  
Once an email notification has been created, you may send a test message to ensure that the  
notification is delivered to the specified recipients.  
1. Click Email Notifications in the side navigation bar. The Email Notifications window  
will open.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the notification(s) to be tested. To select all notifications on  
the page, click the checkbox to the left of Email Subject at the top of the list.  
3. Click Test. You will be prompted to confirm the test.  
4. Confirm or cancel the test.  
To delete an email notification:  
1. Click Email Notifications in the side navigation bar. The Email Notifications window  
will appear.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the notifications to delete. To select all notifications on the  
page, click the checkbox to the left of Email Subject at the top of the list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 22: Events and Event Logs  
313  
3. Click Delete. You will be prompted to confirm the deletion.  
4. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Enabling and Disabling Event Logging  
The logging of individual events that occur in the DSView 3 software system may be enabled or  
disabled. When an enabled event occurs, it is written to the event log. When an event is disabled, its  
occurrence will not be logged until the event is enabled.  
By default the Enabled Log Events window lists the event name and whether it is enabled or  
disabled. (The enabled/disabled state differs from an event’s state in the event log; see Event states  
on page 315.) You may change which fields and the number of items per page that will be  
displayed in the Enabled Log Events window by clicking the Customize link (see Using the  
Customize link in windows on page 26). This may be helpful if you want to sort the list by a field  
such as category or event ID.  
To enable or disable logging of one or more events:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Enabled Events in the side navigation bar. The Enabled Log Events window will open,  
listing all enabled and disabled log events. If you want to display only the events in a particular  
category, click the category link in the side navigation bar.  
3. Click the checkbox to the left of one or more events. To select all events on the page, click the  
checkbox to the left of Log Event at the top of the list.  
4. Click Enable or Disable. (Events cannot be enabled unless they are already disabled. Similarly,  
events cannot be disabled unless they are already enabled).  
The Enabled Log Events window will refresh with the new information.  
Displaying the Event Log  
There are several ways to customize event log displays.  
You may display all events (or at least the most recent 5000) in the log.  
You may display events of a particular severity or a particular category.  
You may display events that occurred during a specified interval.  
You may display events based on their state; see Event states on page 315.  
Event log display fields  
The following fields are always displayed in the Event Log window:  
Severity - See Event severity on page 309. Clicking this field will display the Event Informa-  
tion window, which contains details about the event.  
Date/Time - Displays the date and time of an event in the client computer’s time zone.  
Description - Short description of an event.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
314  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The following fields may be displayed. Use the Customize link to add or remove fields in the  
State - New or Acknowledged. See Event states on page 315. This field is displayed only when  
the Show All button is enabled. Its display is not affected by customization.  
Category - Category of an event log entry.  
Detailed Description - Detailed information, which may include the name of a target device,  
session type, user and so on. For example, a MIB-II interface link up trap might contain  
Appliance change of state in the Description column, while the Detailed Description column  
contains Generic link up interface 1.  
DSView Server - Name of the DSView 3 server where the event was logged.  
Event ID - Unique event identifier, which can be useful for sorting displays.  
Trap Enterprise - Enterprise object identifier for a received SNMP trap. (The Trap Enterprise  
field in an Event Log window is named Enterprise OID in the Event Information window.)  
Unit - Name of a managed appliance for the event.  
User - User associated with the event. For example, when a Unit Deleted event is detected, this  
field contains the username of the initiator.  
To display the event log:  
Click the Reports tab. The Event Log - All window will open.  
To display event log entries by severity, click Severity Level in the side navigation bar, and then  
click one of the levels. (See the Note below for an alternative way to display the event log by  
certain severity levels.)  
To display event log entries by category, click Event Category in the side navigation bar, and  
then click one of the categories.  
To display event log entries that occurred during a specified interval, see Using the date filter  
By default, the display includes event log entries with a state of New (see Event states on  
page 315) and the State column is not displayed. To view events with an Acknowledged state  
in the display, enable the Show All button. The State column will be added to the display, and  
the list will include events with any state (New or Acknowledged). Acknowledged events will  
be grayed-out to differentiate them from New events, but any event can be selected.  
To remove events with an Acknowledged state from the display, disable the Show All button.  
The State column will be removed from the display, and only unacknowledged (state = New)  
events will appear.  
NOTE: You may also display a list of only the new non-critical, critical or non-recoverable event log entries by  
clicking the appropriate icon in the right portion of the top navigation bar (see Table 22.1 for pictures).  
To display details of an event log entry:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 22: Events and Event Logs  
315  
2. In an Event Log window, click on a link in the Severity column. The Event Information  
window will open.  
See Event log display fields on page 313 for descriptions of information in the Event Details  
section of the display.  
The Event History table contains any state change information. This includes when the state  
was changed, the type of change (for example, Changed from New to Acknowledged), and  
who (username) made the state change.  
3. Click Close. The Event Log window will open.  
To delete one or more event log entries:  
1. In an Event Log window, click the checkbox to the left of the event(s) to delete. To select all  
events on the page, click the checkbox to the left of Severity at the top of the list.  
2. Click Delete. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
3. Confirm or cancel the deletion.  
Event states  
When an event first occurs and is placed in the event log, it is considered to be in a New state, You  
may delete the event, which will remove it from displays and from the event log. However, if you  
wish to prevent an event from being displayed but not delete it from the event log, you may  
acknowledge the event, which will change its state from New to Acknowledged.  
You may also change an event’s state from Acknowledged to New again. This can be useful if you  
mistakenly changed an event’s state to Acknowledged. The Event Information window for each  
event contains an Event History that indicates when that event’s state was changed and by whom.  
When you change a non-recoverable, critical or non-critical event’s state to Acknowledged, the  
counter next to that severity icon in the top navigation bar will be decremented. If you change one  
of these events from Acknowledged to New, the counter is incremented.  
In an event log display, if the Show All button is not enabled, the display will only include events  
with a New state. If the Show All button is enabled, events in any state (New or Acknowledged)  
will be included. Acknowledged events will be grayed-out.  
To change the state of one or more event log entries:  
1. Click the Reports tab. The Event Log - All window will open. You may tailor the display by  
severity, category or date, if desired.  
2. Click the checkbox to the left of the events whose state you wish to change. To select all events  
on the page, click the checkbox in the heading at the top of the list.  
3. Click Set State and then select Acknowledged or New from the drop-down list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
316  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Using the date filter  
The event log retains all events occurring in the DSView 3 software system for the specified  
retention time. By default, the 5000 most recent events are displayed. You may use the date filter to  
display older events or to display events from any interval in the retention time.  
To use the date filter:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. In any Event Log window, click Date Filter. The Date Filter window will open.  
3. In the first drop-down menu in the From line, select Events On to select the start date and time.  
4. Click on the calendar button or the field to the left of the calendar button and select a start date.  
To use the calendar:  
a. Click on the year and select a year from the drop-down menu.  
b. Click on the month name and select a month from the drop-down menu, or use the arrows  
at the top of the calendar to move forward and backward by month.  
c. Click on a day in the calendar to close the calendar and fill the field to the left of the  
calendar with the date you have selected.  
5. Select an hour, minute and which half of the day for the start date.  
6. In the first drop-down menu in the To line, select Events On to select the end date and time.  
7. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to specify the end date.  
8. Click Apply. The previous event log view window will open with the event range specified in  
the Filter Date window.  
The Clear Date Filter button will appear in the event log view window. To clear date filtering,  
click this button.  
Changing the Event Log Retention Period  
By default, an event log is retained for seven days (one week). You may specify a retention period  
of up to 365 days (one year).  
NOTE: Event log information is stored in the DSView 3 software database and is replicated. Increasing the event  
log retention time may impact the performance of the DSView 3 software system. It is recommended that old  
event log entries be archived to .csv files by scheduling tasks; see Task: Exporting an ev  
     
Chapter 22: Events and Event Logs  
317  
Creating an Event Log .csv File  
All or selected columns of the event log can be exported as a comma separated values (.csv) file.  
The output event log file is named eventlog.csv by default, but you may change the name when it is  
saved. The .csv file may be viewed in a text editor or spreadsheet application, such as  
Microsoft Excel.  
NOTE: To create a task to export the event log to a .csv file, see Task: Exporting an event log .csv file on  
To create an event log .csv file:  
1. Click the Reports tab.  
2. Click Tools in the side navigation bar. The Event Log Tools window will open.  
3. Click the Export Event Log icon or text. The Export Event Log Wizard will appear.  
4. Click Next.  
5. The Select Columns to Export window will open.  
To add one or more columns to export, select the column(s) from the Available Columns  
list, then click Add. The columns will be moved to the Columns to Export list.  
To remove one or more columns, select the column(s) from the Columns to Export list,  
then click Remove. The columns will be moved to the Available Columns list.  
To change the order in which exported columns are listed in the output .csv file, select one  
or more columns in the Columns to Export list and use the up and down arrows to move  
the selected columns up or down in the listing.  
Click Next.  
6. The Save Process window will open, explaining how the file will be saved. Click Next.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open, along with a File Download dialog box.  
8. From the File Download dialog box, click Open. The file will be downloaded and will open on  
the DSView 3 software client. By default, .csv files are configured to open in Microsoft Excel.  
If Microsoft Excel is not installed on your computer, you will be prompted to select a text  
editor to open the .csv file.  
-or-  
From the File Download dialog box, click Save. The Save As dialog box will appear. Select a  
directory and filename and click Save to save the .csv file.  
9. Click Finish. The Event Log Tools window will open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
318  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
319  
CHAPTER  
Plug-ins  
23  
A plug-in provides support for a specific appliance type (model) in the DSView 3 software. A  
plug-in is packaged into a single archive file that can be shipped and added independently of the  
DSView 3 software. You may add plug-ins to the DSView 3 software version 3.3 or later.  
Although plug-ins are created independently, a particular DSView 3 software release may include  
one or more plug-ins that have already been added to the software. The release notes will indicate if  
any plug-ins are included. If a plug-in is included, you will not need to add it to the hub or  
spoke servers.  
This chapter describes how to add and manage plug-ins in the DSView 3 software. Once you  
successfully complete the sequence for adding a plug-in, you may add appliances of that type and  
initiate other operations from the DSView 3 software that are supported in that plug-in.  
NOTE: You must have DSView 3 software administrator access rights to view, add and manage plug-ins.  
Plug-ins are created using the Plug-in API in the DSView 3 Software Development Kit (SDK).  
Recommended Sequence for Adding/Upgrading Plug-ins  
To add or upgrade a plug-in:  
1. Ensure that scheduled replication will not occur during the adding or upgrading of plug-ins -  
you may need to change the replication schedule temporarily.  
2. Perform a replication operation on every spoke server. See Replication on page 71.  
3. Perform a backup of the DSView 3 software database. See Backing up and Restoring Hub  
4. Add or upgrade the plug-in on the hub server.  
To add a plug-in, see Adding Plug-ins on page 320.  
To upgrade a plug-in, see Upgrading a plug-in on page 322.  
5. Add or upgrade the plug-in on each spoke server. All spoke servers should have the same  
plug-ins at the same version.  
6. Perform a replication operation on every spoke server.  
7. Perform a backup of the DSView 3 software database.  
8. If you changed the replication schedule in step 1, you may change it back to its original values.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
320  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Adding Plug-ins  
For optimal operation, the hub and all of the spoke servers should have the same version of a  
plug-in installed. Follow the steps described in Recommended Sequence for Adding/Upgrading  
During the add operation on the hub server, new data types defined in the plug-in are registered in  
the DSView 3 software database. After the plug-in is added to the spoke server and a replication  
operation is initiated, the registration information on the hub server is propagated to the  
spoke server.  
On the hub server, a new plug-in becomes active when it is added. On a spoke server, a new plug-in  
becomes active only after the plug-in is added to the hub and then to the spoke and a subsequent  
replication completes successfully.  
For some plug-ins, you may need to add a license key to the DSView 3 software system before  
adding the plug-in to any server. See the documentation included with the plug-in or contact your  
Avocent representative to determine if a key is needed. To add a license, see Licenses on page 50.  
To add a plug-in:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Plug-ins in the top navigation bar.  
3. Click Add. The Add Plug-in Wizard will open. Click Next.  
4. The Select Plug-in window will open. Enter the name or browse to the location of the plug-in  
file, then click Next.  
5. The Overview window will open. This window contains read-only information about the  
plug-in. Click Next.  
6. The Adding Plug-in page will open while the plug-in is added to the DSView 3  
software system.  
7. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
NOTE: If you added a plug-in for a Cyclades appliance, you must disable the Cyclades Web Manager to  
       
Chapter 23: Plug-ins  
321  
3. To display information about one plug-in, click the plug-in name. The Plug-in overview  
window will open.  
Information in the Overview area is read-only.  
The DSView Servers table lists the status of the plug-in on each DSView 3 server. Each row  
includes the name of the server and the plug-in version plus the administrative and operational  
status of the plug-in on that server.  
Table 23.1: Plug-ins Display Information  
Field  
Description  
Name  
Plug-in name, acquired from the plug-in.  
Plug-in version (on this server), acquired from the plug-in when it was added  
or upgraded.  
Version  
Same - The plug-in’s operational status, administrative status and version is the  
same on all DSView 3 servers.  
Overall Status  
Mixed - The plus-in’s operational status, administrative status and version is not  
the same on all DSView 3 servers.  
Administrative status on this server. Valid values are:  
DSView server not responding - (This value is valid only when a single plug-in  
has been selected.) The DSView 3 software could not obtain plug-in status on  
this server.  
To examine server status, click the System tab, then DSView Server in the top  
navigation bar. If you are on a hub server, click Spoke Servers in the side  
navigation bar and then select the appropriate server. If you are on a spoke  
server, click Hub Server in the side navigation bar.  
Administrative Status  
Replication needed - The plug-in has been added, but replication is required  
before the plug-in can be used.  
Active - The plug-in is registered and operational.  
Disabled - The plug-in has been disabled.  
Not installed - The plug-in has not been added to this server. If the DSView 3  
software can obtain information from the status service about this plug-in (from  
other servers where it is installed), the Name field will contain the plug-in’s  
name. If the status service does not provide this information, the Name field will  
contain the plug-in’s domain and ID.  
Operational status on this server. Valid values are:  
Inactive - The plug-in is not running.  
Active - The plug-in is running.  
Operational Status  
Initializing - The plug-in is starting up.  
Shutting down - The plug-in is stopping.  
Upgrading - The plug-in is in the upgrade process.  
Detailed Operational  
Status *  
Detailed status acquired from the plug-in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
322  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table 23.1: Plug-ins Display Information (Continued)  
Field  
Description  
Description *  
Languages *  
Appliance Type *  
Vendor *  
Descriptive information acquired from the plug-in.  
Language information acquired from the plug-in.  
Appliance type information acquired from the plug-in.  
Owning vendor of the plug-in, according to information acquired from the plug-in.  
* By default, these fields are not displayed in the Plug-ins window. Use the Customize link to specify which  
fields you want to display; see Using the Customize link in windows on page 26. These fields are always  
displayed in the individual plug-ins’ overview windows.  
Managing Plug-ins  
After a plug-in has been added, you may upgrade it to another (generally, newer) version. You may  
also disable a plug-in if necessary for troubleshooting, and then (re)activate it.  
You may initiate an action only for plug-ins on the DSView 3 server you are currently  
logged into.  
The plug-in must currently have an administrative status that allows the action (for example,  
you can activate a plug-in only if its current administrative status is disabled).  
Upgrading a plug-in  
When you upgrade the existing version of a plug-in, follow the steps described in Recommended  
To upgrade a plug-in:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Plug-ins in the top navigation bar. The Plug-ins window will open.  
3. Click on the name of plug-in to be upgraded. The plug-in overview window will open.  
4. In the DSView Servers area, click the checkbox next to the DSView 3 server you are currently  
logged into.  
5. Click Upgrade. The Upgrade Plug-in Wizard will open. Click Next.  
6. The Select Plug-in File window will open. Enter the name or browse to the location of the  
plug-in file, then click Next.  
7. The Overview window will open. This window contains read-only information about the  
plug-in. Click Next.  
8. The Upgrading Plug-in page will open while the plug-in is being upgraded.  
9. The Completed Successful window will open. Click Finish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 23: Plug-ins  
323  
Disabling and activating a plug-in  
When a plug-in is disabled, you cannot use any features and operations supported by that plug-in.  
Appliances and target devices that were added to the DSView 3 software system before the plug-in  
was disabled will still appear in Units View windows, but you will not be able to acquire status  
from those units, and links that initiate connections to those units will not be available. You will not  
be able to add more appliances of that type until the plug-in is (re)activated.  
A disabled plug-in will remain disabled if the DSView 3 software is restarted.  
To disable a plug-in:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Plug-ins in the top navigation bar. The Plug-ins window will open.  
3. Click on the name of plug-in to be disabled. The plug-in overview window will open.  
4. In the DSView Servers area, click the checkbox next to the DSView 3 server you are currently  
logged into.  
5. Click Disable. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
6. Confirm or cancel the action.  
To activate a plug-in:  
1. Click the System tab.  
2. Click Plug-ins in the top navigation bar. The Plug-ins window will open.  
3. Click on the name of plug-in to be activated. The plug-in overview window will open.  
4. In the DSView Servers area, click the checkbox next to the DSView 3 server you are currently  
logged into.  
5. Click Activate. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
6. Confirm or cancel the action.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
324  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
325  
APPENDICES  
Appendices  
Appendix A: Technical Support  
Our Technical Support staff is ready to assist you with any installation or operating issues you  
encounter with your Avocent product. If an issue should develop, follow the steps below for the  
fastest possible service:  
To resolve an issue:  
1. Check the pertinent section of the manual to see if the issue can be resolved by following the  
procedures outlined.  
2. Check our web site at www.avocent.com/support to search the knowledge base or use the  
online service request.  
3. Call the Avocent Technical Support location nearest you.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
326  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Appendix B: TCP and UDP Ports  
The DSView 3 software client accesses the server and performs commands using a standard web  
browser. The communication protocol used between the client web browser and the server is the  
HTTPS protocol. By default, TCP/IP port 443 is used for HTTPS connections, but you may change  
the port using the DSView Server Network Properties window.  
NOTE: The port used for the HTTPS connection may be changed using the DSView Server Network Properties  
window. The HTTPS port must be specified in the web browser URL if changed from the default (port 443). See  
DSView 3 software clients may communicate with the DSView 3 server through a standard  
connection or using a proxy server. By default, TCP/IP port 1078 is used for proxied connections.  
If a proxy connection has not been created, TCP ports 22, 2068 and 8192 must be configured as  
open on your firewall.  
When data logging is used, the SSH server port, 4122, and the Syslog server port, 4154, must be  
configured as open on your firewall.  
NOTE: You can change the SSH server port and Syslog server port. See Enabling and disabling the SSH server  
KVM switch ports  
A user may initiate a KVM session with a target device on a KVM switch by clicking KVM Session  
for the appropriate target device or by clicking the KVM Session icon or text from a Unit  
Overview window.  
The client contacts the DSView 3 server, which checks the permissions of the target device. If the  
logged in user has permissions to establish Video Viewer sessions to the selected target device, the  
server will establish a connection to the KVM switch using TCP/IP port 3871 to authorize the  
session. The KVM data is sent to the KVM switch using ports 8192 and 3871. Port 8192 contains  
the video portion of the KVM data. Port 2068 contains the keyboard and mouse portion of the  
KVM data.  
In a non-proxied connection, the video data from port 8192 and the keyboard and mouse data from  
port 2068 are sent directly from the client to the KVM switch. Figure B.1 illustrates the ports used  
with a non-proxied KVM switch connection.  
UDP port 3211 is used by the DSView 3 server to initialize the IP configuration of KVM switches.  
TCP/IP port 3211 is also used by the DSView 3 server to perform management functions on KVM  
switches, such as configuring settings.  
NOTE: When using a non-proxied connection, video performance over a slower network connection may be less  
than optimal. Since certain color settings (such as grayscale) use less network bandwidth than others (such as  
Best Color), changing the color settings may increase video performance. For optimal video performance over a  
slower network connection, a color setting such as grayscale/Best Compression or Low Color/High Compression  
is recommended. See Color depth on page 232.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendices  
327  
DSView 3 Server  
DSView 3 Software Client  
A
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
Port 443  
TCP/IP  
Port 2068  
Keyboard/  
Mouse  
TCP/IP  
Port 8192  
Video  
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
Port 443  
UDP  
Port 3211  
TCP/IP  
Port 3211  
Firewall  
with  
Tunnel  
TCP/IP  
Port 3871  
Router  
TCP/IP  
Port 8192  
KVM Switch  
TCP/IP  
Port 2068  
Figure B.1: Ports Used with a KVM Switch Connection Without Proxy  
In a proxied connection, communication with TCP/IP ports 8192 and 2068 occurs between the  
server and the KVM switch instead of directly between the client and the KVM switch. The client  
receives information by communicating back and forth with the server using port 1078.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
328  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
DSView 3 Server  
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
DSView 3 Software Client  
TCP/IP  
Port 1078  
UDP  
Port 3211  
TCP/IP  
Port 3211  
TCP/IP  
TCP/IP  
Port 1078  
HTTPS  
KVM  
TCP/IP  
Port 3871  
Firewall  
with  
Tunnel  
TCP/IP  
Port 8192  
TCP/IP  
Port 2068  
Router  
KVM Switch  
Figure B.2: Ports Used with a KVM Switch Proxy Server Connection (KVM)  
If the user wishes to establish a session with another port on the KVM switch, the same process  
is used.  
For debugging purposes, connection details may be seen by using the console port to place the  
KVM switch into Debug mode.  
Serial console appliance ports  
Like a KVM switch, a serial console appliance may use a non-proxied or a proxied connection.  
Serial console appliances use a Secure Shell Protocol (SSH).  
The client contacts the server, which checks the permissions of the target device. If the logged in  
user has permissions to establish sessions to the selected target device, the server will establish a  
connection to the appliance using TCP/IP port 3871 to authorize the session.  
In a non-proxied SSH connection, the client communicates directly with the appliance using  
port 22.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendices  
329  
DSView 3 Server  
DSView 3 Software Client  
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
TCP/IP  
TCP/IP  
UDP  
Port 3211  
Port 22  
HTTPS  
SSH  
TCP/IP  
Port 3211  
Firewall  
with  
Tunnel  
TCP/IP  
Port 3871  
Router  
TCP/IP  
Port 22  
Serial Console Appliance  
Figure B.3: Ports Used with a Serial Console Appliance Connection (Serial) Without Proxy  
In a proxied connection, communication between the DSView 3 server and serial console appliance  
occurs over port 22. The SSH connection between the client and the DSView 3 server is tunneled  
over port 1078.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
330  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
DSView 3 Server  
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
DSView 3 Software Client  
TCP/IP  
Port 1078  
UDP  
Port 3211  
TCP/IP  
HTTPS  
TCP/IP  
1078  
TCP/IP  
Port 3211  
Port 443  
Serial  
TCP/IP  
Port 3871  
Firewall  
with  
Tunnel  
TCP/IP  
Port 22  
Router  
Serial Console Appliance  
Figure B.4: Ports Used with a Serial Console Appliance Proxy Server Connection (Serial)  
DSView 3 server ports  
The DSView 3 server uses the HTTPS port for communication with clients and spoke servers.  
Changes made to the browse list through the DSView 3 management software are transmitted back  
to the DSView 3 server host, which refreshes its browse list view over the TCP/IP port 443  
connection. Changes to the DSView 3 software are also copied to and from the DSView 3 software  
hub server over the specified HTTPS port.  
Generic appliance ports  
If you are using a generic appliance in your DSView 3 software system, you may use a Telnet  
connection through TCP/IP port 23, or an HTTP connection through TCP/IP port 80. The  
connection is made directly between the client and the generic appliance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendices  
331  
Figure B.5: Generic Appliance Session Ports  
If Active Directory or LDAP external authentication is being used within your DSView 3 software  
system, TCP/IP ports 389 and 636 are used for connections between the DSView 3 server and the  
external authentication server. Port 389 is typically used for non-SSL connections and port 636 is  
used for SSL connections. You may configure the ports used by an Active Directory or LDAP  
external authentication server using the Authentication Service Connection Settings window. See  
Authentication Services on page 60.  
 
332  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
External authentication ports  
DSView 3 Server  
DSView 3 Software Client  
Figure B.6: External Authentication Server Ports  
SNMP ports  
A supported KVM switch or serial console appliance may be configured to send SNMP traps to the  
DSView 3 server in addition to an external SNMP manager.  
Figure B.7: Ports Used by SNMP (No External SNMP Manager)  
           
Appendices  
333  
If an external SNMP manager has been added to your DSView 3 software system, communication  
occurs between the SNMP manager and the KVM switch or serial console appliance as shown in  
SNMP Manager (Optional)  
TCP/IP  
Port 162  
Figure B.8: Ports Used by SNMP (with External SNMP Manager)  
 
334  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Appendix C: DSR Remote Operations Software  
NOTE: The DSR Remote Operations software is supported only on the following DSR switches: DSR1020,  
1021, 1022, 1024, 1030, 1031, 2020, 2030, 2035, 4020, 4030, 8020, 8030 and 8035 switches.  
The DSR Remote Operations software provides a subset of DSView 3 management software  
functionality that allows access to a supported DSR switch when an Ethernet connection is not  
available. For example, if you are in a branch office and your Ethernet network is down, you may  
still access your remote server network by attaching a v.34, v.90 or v.92-compatible modem to the  
modem port on a supported DSR switch for KVM access, administration and flexible server  
management control from anywhere in the world.  
The following DSView 3 software operations are supported:  
Establishing a KVM session to a target device connected to the switch  
Controlling the power sockets of a power device attached to the DSR switch SPC port  
Rebooting the switch  
Retrieving and displaying the switch version  
All other DSView 3 software options (including using virtual media) are not available when using  
the DSR Remote Operations software.  
The following Video Viewer window commands are not available when using the DSR Remote  
Operations software:  
Displaying connected user information  
Creating, editing, copying and deleting macros  
Only the default Windows and Sun macro groups are available when using the Remote  
Operations software.  
Background refresh  
The DSR Remote Operations software uses an SSL-based connection to the DSR switch to  
authenticate the user.  
NOTE: Users may be managed within the internal database of the DSR switch using the PPP Configuration  
menu. See the installer/user guide for your DSR switch for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendices  
335  
5
1
2
3
4
6
7
10  
9
12  
8
11  
Figure C.1: Using the DSR Remote Operations Software with a DSR Switch  
Table C.1: System Configuration Descriptions  
Number Description  
Number Description  
1
2
3
4
5
6
CAT 5 Connection  
7
Modem  
KVM Connection to Switch  
Remote IP Connection  
AC Power Cord  
8
Analog User (OSCAR Interface)  
Ethernet  
9
10  
11  
12  
Telephone Network  
Power Device  
DSR Remote Operations Client  
DSR Switch  
DSView 3 Software Server (Authentication)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
336  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Before using the DSR Remote Operations software  
The following actions should be performed before using the DSR Remote Operations software:  
Ensure that the switch is configured. See the installer/user guide for the DSR switch for  
more information.  
Ensure that users have been added to the internal database of the DSR switch. If the DSView 3  
server is not available, the appliance database is used for appliance authentication. If neither  
are available, authentication cannot be performed for the switch and an error will be displayed  
by the DSR Remote Operations software. See the installer/user guide for the DSR switch for  
more information.  
An external modem must be attached to the PPP modem interface (modem port) of the DSR  
switch. A modem/PPP dial-up connection must be established before the DSR Remote  
Operations software may be started. The modem port should have auto-answer turned off  
(typically a modem’s default setting). The dial-up connection options should be set to 115200  
baud, 8 bits, 1 stop bit, no parity and enabled hardware flow control. The DSR Remote  
Operations application must be started within the authentication time-out specified in the  
Terminal Applications menu of the DSR switch or the PPP (modem) link will be disconnected.  
Ensure that the PC containing the client interface has dial-up software and that the software is  
configured properly. See the operating system documentation for more information.  
Install the DSR Remote Operations software.  
Installing the DSR Remote Operations software  
In this procedure, the DSR Remote Operations software plus its online help and the JRE (Java  
Runtime Environment will be installed.  
Minimum requirements for the DSR Remote Operations software  
The following are the minimum requirements for installing the DSR Remote Operations software  
as a DSView 3 software client:  
1 GHz Pentium or equivalent processor  
512 MB RAM  
XGA video with graphics accelerator  
Desktop size setting of at least 800 x 600  
Color palette of at least 256 colors  
One of the following operating systems:  
Windows 2000 Workstation or Server with Service Pack 2 or later  
Windows XP Home Edition or Professional  
The DSR Remote Operations software is installed from the DSView 3 software DVD.  
To install the DSR Remote Operations software:  
1. Log on to the host system as Administrator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Appendices  
337  
2. Insert the DSView 3 software DVD. An autorun file will bring up a menu of  
installation options.  
3. Click Install DSR Remote Operations.  
-or-  
If autorun is not enabled, type <drive:>\DSR Remote Operations\win32\setup.exe, where  
<drive:> is the letter of your DVD drive.  
4. An installation preparation dialog box displays and the installation program will verify that the  
client computer meets the minimum requirements for installing the DSR Remote  
Operations Software.  
5. The Introduction window will open. Click Next.  
6. The License Agreement window will open.  
If you accept the terms, click I accept the terms of the License Agreement and then click  
Next. Go to step 7.  
If you do not accept the terms, click I do NOT accept the terms of the License Agreement.  
A License Agreement Warning message box will appear.  
If you click Quit, the installation will exit without installing the DSR Remote Operations  
software.  
If you click Resume, you will be returned to the License Agreement window.  
7. The Choose Destination Location window will open.  
a. Click Choose and use the Browse for Folder dialog box to select a directory in which to  
install the DSR Remote Operations software.  
-or-  
Click Restore Default Folder to restore the installation directory to the default  
(C:\Program Files\Avocent DSView 3\DSR Remote Operations).  
b. Click Next.  
8. The Installing... window will open and displays the progress of the installation. The software  
will be installed in the specified folder and a Start - Programs - Avocent DSView 3 - DSR  
Remote Operations shortcut menu will be created.  
If a previous version of the DSR Remote Operations software already exists on the Client  
computer, message boxes may appear asking if you want to overwrite existing files. Click Yes  
to All.  
9. When the software has finished installing, the DSR Remote Operations Installation window  
will open.  
a. To start the DSR Remote Operations, select Click here to invoke the DSR Remote  
Operations application.  
b. Click Done when you are finished.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
338  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Using the DSR Remote Operations software  
To start the DSR Remote Operations software:  
1. Establish a dial-up connection to the switch from the PC containing the DSR remote  
operations software.  
Windows displays a dialog box that prompts the user for a username and password when a  
dial-up connection is established. It is not necessary to enter a username or password in the  
dialog box. When this dialog box appears, click OK to close the dialog box.  
2. Once the connection has been established, select Start - Programs - Avocent DSView 3 - DSR  
Remote Operations to start the DSR Remote Operations software on the PC. The Login dialog  
box will appear. Log in using a valid username and password to establish a DSR Remote Oper-  
ations software session with the DSR switch over the modem link  
The switch will disconnect the modem connection if a user does not log in within the time  
period specified by the authentication time-out value. The default authentication time-out  
value (120 seconds) may be changed using the Terminal Applications menu. See the installer/  
user guide for the DSR switch for more information.  
The DSR switch will attempt to contact the DSView 3 server to authenticate the user. If the  
DSView 3 server is unavailable, the switch will use its internal database to authenticate  
the user.  
3. Type the username and password to which you wish to connect and then click OK. If authenti-  
cation is successful, the DSR Remote Operations window will open.  
NOTE: The switch will disconnect the modem connection if there is no activity on the modem connection for the  
time period specified by the inactivity time-out value. The default inactivity time-out value (15 minutes) may be  
changed using the Terminal Applications menu. See the installer/user guide for the DSR switch for  
more information.  
To exit the DSR Remote Operations software:  
Select File - Exit from the menu.  
Window features  
When you have launched the software and successfully logged in, the DSR Remote Operations  
window will display the list of DSView 3 servers connected to the DSR switch. Figure C.2 shows  
the DSR Remote Operations window areas, and descriptions follow in Table C.2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendices  
339  
1
2
5
4
3
Figure C.2: DSR Remote Operations Window  
Table C.2: DSR Remote Operations Descriptions  
Number  
Description  
1
2
3
Menu bar: Allows you to access many of the features in the DSR Remote Operations window.  
Toolbar: Provides shortcut buttons for quickly accessing commands in the Tools menu.  
Status Bar: Displays the tips for selected menu items and the progress of operations.  
Content Area: Use this area to display information from the DSR switch and control and start  
DSView 3 software sessions to the DSR switch.  
4
5
Side Navigation Bar: Displays the DSR switching system information you wish to access, which  
displays in the Content Area.  
The items displayed in the content area of the DSR Remote Operations window will vary,  
depending on the link selected in the side navigation bar. You may refresh any view by selecting  
View - Refresh from the menu.  
Servers view  
Selecting Servers in the side navigation bar of the DSR Remote Operations window displays a list  
of servers attached to the switch. The following items for each server will appear in the  
content area:  
Name - The name of the server  
Port - The switch port to which the server is attached  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
340  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
EID - The Electronic ID (EID) number of the IQ module attached to the server.  
Table C.3: DSR Remote Operations Content Area Icons (Servers View)  
Icon  
Description  
A target device that is powered up and has no established KVM Video Viewer sessions  
A target device that has an active KVM Video Viewer session  
A target device that is not powered up  
A target device that is powered up but cannot establish a KVM connection because the path  
to the target device is blocked (for example, a cascade switch has only one user port and that  
port is already connected to another target device)  
Power view  
Selecting Power in the side navigation bar of the DSR Remote Operations window will display a  
list of power device sockets attached to the switch and their status.  
Table C.4: DSR Remote Operations Content Area Icons (Power View)  
Icon  
Description  
The power device socket is powered up  
The power device socket is powered down  
The power device socket is cycling  
The socket is unlocked (supported only on certain power device types)  
The socket is locked (supported only on certain power device types)  
Version view  
Selecting Version in the side navigation bar of the DSR Remote Operations window will display  
version information for the following items:  
Application  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendices  
341  
Boot  
Digital/Application  
Digital/Hardware  
Hardware  
Rebooting a switch  
NOTE: Users with a User level account may not reboot a switch.  
To reboot the switch:  
1. From the menu, select Tools - Reboot Appliance. A confirmation dialog box will appear.  
2. Confirm or cancel the reboot.  
Managing servers  
To connect to a server:  
NOTE: Users with a User level account may connect to a server only when given access to a switch.  
Select View - Servers from the menu or click Servers in the side navigation bar. Select a server and  
select Tools - Connect from the menu.  
-or-  
Select a server and click the Connect toolbar button.  
-or-  
Right-click on a server and select Connect from the shortcut menu.  
A Video Viewer window will open. See Using the Video Viewer on page 223.  
Power control of devices attached to power device sockets  
Users with User level account privileges cannot change the power state of power device sockets.  
Use the Power view to manage power device sockets attached to the switch. See Power view on  
To control the power of a device attached to a power device socket:  
1. Select View - Power from the menu or click Power in the side navigation bar. A list of power  
device sockets attached to the switch will appear in the content area.  
2. To power up a device attached to a power device socket, choose one of the following actions:  
Select a socket that has not been powered up and select Tools - Power On from the  
menu bar.  
Select a socket that has not been powered up and click the Power On toolbar button.  
Right-click on a socket that has not been powered up and select Power On from the  
shortcut menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
342  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
The socket will power up and the icon for the socket in the content area will change.  
3. To power down a device attached to a power device socket, choose one of the  
following actions:  
Select a socket that has not been powered down and select Tools - Power Off from the  
menu bar.  
Select a socket that has not been powered down and click the Power Off toolbar button.  
Right-click on a socket that has not been powered down and select Power Off from the  
shortcut menu.  
The socket will power down and the icon for the socket in the content area will change.  
4. To cycle the power of a device attached to a power device socket, choose one of the  
following actions:  
Select a socket that is powered up and select Tools - Cycle Power from the menu bar.  
Select a socket that is powered up and click the Cycle Power toolbar button.  
Right-click on a socket that is powered up and select Cycle Power from the shortcut menu.  
The socket will power down, then power up and the icon for the socket in the content area will  
change accordingly.  
5. To lock or unlock the current state of a power device socket, choose one of the  
following actions:  
Select a socket and select Tools - Lock or Tools - Unlock from the menu bar.  
Select a socket that and click the Lock or Unlock toolbar button.  
Right-click on a socket and select Lock or Unlock from the shortcut menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
343  
Appendix D: Terminal Emulation  
       
344  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
VT100+ terminal emulation  
       
Appendices  
345  
VT100 terminal emulation  
Table D.4 lists the VT100 special key and control (Ctrl) key combinations and indicates Avocent  
encoding/decoding support, where Yes = supported and No = not supported.  
Table D.4: VT100 Special Keys and Control Keys  
Keys  
Hex Code  
0D  
0A  
08  
Function Mnemonic  
Encode/Decode  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Return  
Linefeed  
Backspace  
Tab  
CR  
LF  
BS  
09  
HT  
Spacebar  
Esc  
20  
(SP)  
Esc  
NUL  
SOH  
STX  
ETX  
EOT  
ENO  
ACK  
BELL  
BS  
1B  
00  
Ctrl+Spacebar  
Ctrl+A  
Ctrl+B  
Ctrl+C  
Ctrl+D  
Ctrl+E  
Ctrl+F  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
Ctrl+G  
Ctrl+H  
Ctrl+I  
07  
08  
09  
HT  
Ctrl+J  
0A  
0B  
0C  
0D  
0E  
0F  
LF  
Ctrl+K  
Ctrl+L  
VT  
FF  
Ctrl+M  
Ctrl+N  
Ctrl+O  
Ctrl+P  
Ctrl+Q  
CR  
SO  
SI  
10  
DLE  
DC1 or XON  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
346  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.4: VT100 Special Keys and Control Keys (Continued)  
Keys  
Hex Code  
12  
Function Mnemonic  
Encode/Decode  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Yes/No  
Ctrl+R  
Ctrl+S  
Ctrl+T  
Ctrl+U  
Ctrl+V  
Ctrl+W  
Ctrl+X  
Ctrl+Y  
Ctrl+Z  
Ctrl+[  
DC2  
DC3 or XOFF  
DO4  
NAK  
SYN  
ETB  
CAN  
EM  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
1A  
SUB  
Esc  
1B  
Ctrl+\  
1C  
1D  
1E  
FS  
Ctrl+]  
GS  
Ctrl+^  
Ctrl+_  
RS  
1F  
US  
Table D.5 lists the VT100 ANSI mode and cursor keys for set and reset modes. Encoding and  
decoding is supported for all the cursor keys listed.  
Table D.5: VT100 ANSI Set and Reset Mode Cursor Keys  
Cursor Key  
Up  
Mode Reset  
Esc [ A  
Mode Set  
Esc O A  
Esc O B  
Esc O C  
Esc O D  
Down  
Right  
Esc [ B  
Esc [ C  
Left  
Esc [ D  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendices  
347  
Table D.6 lists the VT100 PF1-PF4 key definitions. Encoding of each listed key is supported;  
decoding is not applicable.  
Table D.6: VT100 PF1-PF4 Key Definitions  
Key  
F1  
Code Sequence  
Esc [ O P  
F2  
Esc [ O Q  
F3  
Esc [ O R  
F4  
Esc [ O S  
Table D.7 lists the ANSI mode control sequences for VT100 terminal emulation and indicates  
Avocent encoding/decoding support, where Yes = supported and No = not supported.  
Table D.7: VT100 ANSI Mode Control Sequences  
Control Sequence  
Esc [ Pn; Pn R  
Esc [ Pn D  
Esc [ Pn B  
Esc [ Pn C  
Esc [ Pn; Pn H  
Esc [ Pn A  
Esc [ Pn c  
Esc # 8  
Definition  
Encode/Decode  
No/No  
Cursor Position Report  
Cursor Backward  
Cursor Down  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
No/No  
Cursor Forward  
Cursor Position  
Cursor Up  
Device Attributes  
Screen Alignment Display  
Double Height Line - Top Half  
Double Height Line - Bottom Half  
Double Width Line  
Identify Terminal  
No/Yes  
No/No  
Esc # 3  
Esc # 4  
No/No  
Esc # 6  
No/No  
Esc Z  
No/No  
Esc =  
Keypad Application Mode  
Keypad Numeric Mode  
Load LEDs  
No/No  
Esc >  
No/No  
Esc [ Ps q  
Esc 8  
No/No  
Restore Cursor  
No/Yes  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
348  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.7: VT100 ANSI Mode Control Sequences (Continued)  
Control Sequence  
Definition  
Encode/Decode  
Report Terminal Parameters <nbits>; <xspeed>;  
<rspeed>; <clkmul>; <flags>x  
Esc [ <sol>; <par>;  
No/No  
Esc [ <sol> x  
Esc 7  
Request Terminal Parameters  
Save Cursor  
No/No  
No/Yes  
Esc [ Pn; Pn r  
Esc # 5  
Set Top and Bottom Margins  
Single Width Line  
Yes/Yes  
No/No  
Esc [ 2; Ps y  
Esc [ Ps n  
Esc [ Ps J  
Esc [ Ps K  
Esc H  
Invoke Confidence Test  
Device Status Report  
Erase in Display  
No/No  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
Erase in Line  
No/Yes  
Horizontal Tabulation Set  
Horizontal and Vertical Position  
Index  
Yes/Yes  
Esc [ Pn; Pn f  
Esc D  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
Esc E  
Next Line  
No/Yes  
Esc M  
Reverse Index  
No/Yes  
Esc c  
Reset to Initial State  
No/No  
Esc [ Ps; Ps;..;Ps 1  
Esc ( A  
Reset Mode  
No/No  
Select Character Set G0 U.K.  
Select Character Set G1 U.K  
Select Character Set G0 ASCII  
Select Character Set G1 ASCII  
Select Character Set G0 Spec. Graphics  
Select Character Set G1 Spec. Graphics  
No/No  
Esc ) A  
No/No  
Esc ( B  
Yes/Yes  
Esc ) B  
Yes/Yes (limited support)  
Yes/Yes (limited support)  
Yes/Yes (limited support)  
Esc ( 0  
Esc ) 0  
Select Character Set G0 Alt. Character ROM  
Standard Character Set  
Esc ( 1  
Esc ) 1  
Esc ( 2  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
Select Character Set G1 Alt. Character  
ROM Standard Character Set  
Select Character Set G0 Alt. Character ROM  
Special Graphics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
349  
Table D.7: VT100 ANSI Mode Control Sequences (Continued)  
Control Sequence  
Definition  
Encode/Decode  
Select Character Set G1 Alt. Character ROM  
Special Graphics  
Esc ) 2  
No/No  
Esc [ Ps;..; Ps m  
Esc Ps;..;Ps h  
Esc [ Ps g  
Select Graphic Rendition  
Set Mode  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
Tabulation Clear  
Esc [ Ps;Ps;..; Ps m  
Esc [ K or Esc [ 0 K  
Esc [ 1 K  
Character Attributes 7 - Reverse Video On  
Erase from cursor to end of line  
Erase from beginning of line to cursor  
Erase entire line containing cursor  
Erase from cursor to end of screen  
Erase from beginning of screen to cursor  
Erase entire screen  
No/Reverse Video only  
No/Yes  
No/No  
Esc [ 2 K  
No/No  
Esc [ J or Esc [ 0 J  
Esc [ 1 J  
No/Yes  
No/No  
Esc [ 2 J  
No/No  
Esc [ Ps;Ps;..Ps q  
Esc [ Pt; Pb r  
Esc [ g or Esc [ 0 g  
Esc [ 3 g  
Programmable LEDs  
No/No  
Scrolling Region  
No/No  
Clear tab at current column  
Clear all tabs  
Yes/Yes  
Yes/Yes  
Modes to Set - New Line - Only supports Linefeed/  
New Line Column mode wraparound  
Esc [ 2 0 h  
Esc [ 2 0 l  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
Modes to Reset - Linefeed - Only supports Linefeed/  
New Line Column mode wraparound  
Esc [ ? 1 h  
Esc [ ? 1 l  
Esc [ ? 2 l  
Esc [ ? 3 h  
Esc [ ? 3 l  
Esc [ ? 4 h  
Esc [ ? 4 l  
Esc [ ? 5 h  
Modes to Set - Cursor Key Mode Appl.  
Modes to Reset - Cursor Key Mode Cursor  
Modes to Reset VT52  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
No/No  
Modes to Set - 132 columns  
Modes to Reset - 80 columns  
Modes to Set - Smooth Scroll  
Modes to Reset - Jump Scroll  
Modes to Set - Reverse Screen Mode  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
350  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.7: VT100 ANSI Mode Control Sequences (Continued)  
Control Sequence  
Esc [ ? 5 l  
Definition  
Encode/Decode  
No/No  
Modes to Reset - Normal Screen Mode  
Modes to Set - Relative Origin Mode  
Modes to Reset - Absolute Origin Mode  
Modes to Set - Wraparound On  
Modes to Reset - Wraparound Off  
Modes to Set - Auto Repeat On  
Modes to Reset - Auto Repeat Off  
Modes to Set - Interlace On  
Modes to Reset - Interlace Off  
Report Cursor Position - Invoked by  
Report Cursor Position - Response is  
Status Report - Invoked by  
Esc [ ? 6 h  
Esc [ ? 6 l  
No/No  
No/No  
Esc [ ? 7 h  
Esc [ ? 7 l  
No/No  
No/No  
Esc [ ? 8 h  
Esc [ ? 8 l  
No/No  
No/No  
Esc [ ? 9 h  
Esc [ ? 9 l  
No/No  
No/No  
Esc [ 6 n  
No/No  
Esc [ P1; Pc R  
Esc [ 5 n  
No/No  
No/No  
Esc [ 0 n  
Status Report - Response is terminal OK  
Status Report - Response is terminal not OK  
What are you? Invoked by  
No/No  
Esc [ 3 n  
No/No  
Esc [ x or Esc [ 0 c  
Esc [ ? 1; Ps c  
Esc c  
No/Yes  
No/Yes  
No/No  
No/Yes  
No/No  
What are you? Response is  
Reset  
Esc # 8  
Fill screen with Es  
Esc [ 2; Ps y  
Invoke Test(s)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
351  
VT220 terminal emulation  
Table D.8 lists the keystroke mapping (encoding) for VT220 emulation.  
Table D.8: VT220 Encoding  
VT220 Keyboard  
Delete  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Keypad /  
Keypad *  
Keypad -  
Keypad +  
Keypad .  
Keypad 0..9  
F1  
PC Keyboard  
Delete  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Keypad /  
Keypad *  
Keypad -  
Keypad +  
Keypad .  
Keypad 0..9  
F1  
VT220 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
0x7F  
Esc [ D  
Esc [ C  
Esc [ A  
Esc [ B  
/
*
-
+
.
0..9  
Esc O P  
Esc O Q  
Esc O R  
Esc O S  
Esc [ 1 7 ~  
Esc [ 1 8 ~  
Esc [ 1 9 ~  
Esc [ 2 0 ~  
Esc [ 2 1 ~  
Esc [ 2 3 ~  
Esc [ 2 4 ~  
Esc [ 2 5 ~  
Esc [ 2 6 ~  
F2  
F2  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
F6  
F6  
F7  
F7  
F8  
F8  
F9  
F9  
F10  
F10  
F11  
F11  
F12  
F12  
F13  
Ctrl - F5  
Ctrl - F6  
F14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
352  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.8: VT220 Encoding (Continued)  
VT220 Keyboard  
PC Keyboard  
VT220 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc [ 2 8 ~  
F15  
F16  
F17  
F18  
F19  
F20  
Ctrl - F7  
Ctrl - F8  
Ctrl - F9  
Ctrl - F10  
Ctrl - F11  
Ctrl - F12  
Esc [ 2 9 ~  
Esc [ 3 1 ~  
Esc [ 3 2 ~  
Esc [ 3 3 ~  
Esc [ 3 4 ~  
Table D.9 lists the decoding for VT220 terminal emulation.  
Table D.9: VT220 Decoding  
VT220 Keyboard Function  
Index  
VT220 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc D  
Esc E  
New Line  
Reverse Index  
Esc M  
Esc O  
Esc 7  
Escape  
Save cursor and attributes  
Restore cursor and attributes  
Up Arrow  
Esc 8  
Esc [ A  
Esc [ B  
Esc [ C  
Esc [ D  
Esc [ H  
Esc [ f  
Esc [ m  
Esc [ K  
Esc [ j  
Esc [ q  
Esc [ c  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Set cursor to home position  
Set cursor to home position  
Character attributes  
Erase from cursor to end of line  
Erase from cursor to end of screen  
Programmable LEDs  
What are You?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendices  
353  
Table D.9: VT220 Decoding (Continued)  
VT220 Keyboard Function  
Set Mode  
VT220 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc [ ?  
Delete 1 Character  
Insert 1 Line  
Esc [ P  
Esc [ L  
Delete 1 Line  
Esc [ M  
Up Arrow  
Esc [ O A  
Down Arrow  
Esc [ O B  
Right Arrow  
Esc [ O C  
Esc [ O D  
Esc # 8  
Left Arrow  
Fill Screen with Es  
Up Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Down Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Right Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Left Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Erase parts of current line  
Erase parts of current screen  
Direct Cursor Addressing  
Direct Cursor Addressing  
Programmable LEDs  
Scrolling Region  
Esc [ Pn A  
Esc [ Pn B  
Esc [ Pn C  
Esc [ Pn D  
Esc [ Pn K  
Esc [ Pn J  
Esc [ Pn H  
Esc [ Pn f  
Esc [ Pn q  
Esc [ Pn r  
Esc [ Pn g  
Esc [ Pn n  
Esc [ Pn c  
Esc [ Pn h  
Esc [ Pn P  
Esc [ Pn L  
Esc [ Pn M  
Esc [ Pn @  
Clear tabs  
Device status report  
What are you?  
Sat Mode  
Delete Pn Characters  
Insert Pn Characters  
Delete Pn Lines  
Insert Character  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
354  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.9: VT220 Decoding (Continued)  
VT220 Keyboard Function  
VT220 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Erase Pn Characters  
Esc [ Pn X  
VT52 terminal emulation  
Table D.10 lists the keystroke mapping (encoding) for VT52 terminal emulation.  
Table D.10: VT52 Encoding  
VT52 Keyboard  
Delete  
PC Character Sequence  
VT52 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Delete  
0x7F  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Shift-F1  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
PF1  
Esc A  
Esc B  
Esc C  
Esc D  
Esc P  
Esc Q  
Esc R  
Esc S  
Shift-F2  
PF2  
Shift-F3  
PF3  
Shift-F4  
PF4  
Table D.11 lists the decoding for VT52 terminal emulation.  
Table D.11: VT52 Decoding  
VT52 Keyboard Function  
Cursor Up  
VT52 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc A  
Esc B  
Esc C  
Esc D  
Esc H  
Esc I  
Cursor Down  
Cursor Right  
Cursor Left  
Cursor Home  
Reverse Linefeed  
Erase to end of screen  
Esc J  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendices  
355  
Table D.11: VT52 Decoding (Continued)  
VT52 Keyboard Function  
VT52 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Erase to end of line  
Esc K  
Table D.12 lists the VT52 and ANSI auxiliary keypad definitions. Encoding of each listed keypad  
key is supported; decoding is not applicable.  
Table D.12: VT52 ANSI Mode Auxiliary Keypad Definitions  
Keys  
Keypad Numeric Code  
VT52 Keypad  
Esc ? p  
Esc ? q  
Esc ? r  
ANSI Keyboard  
Esc O p  
Esc O q  
Esc O r  
0
0
1
1
2
2
3
3
Esc ? s  
Esc ? t  
Esc O s  
Esc O t  
4
4
5
5
Esc ? u  
Esc ? v  
Esc ? w  
Esc ? x  
Esc ? y  
Esc ? m  
Esc ? l  
Esc O u  
Esc O v  
Esc O w  
Esc O x  
Esc O y  
Esc O m  
Esc O l  
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
- (dash)  
, (comma)  
. (period)  
Enter  
- (dash)  
, (comma)  
. (period)  
Same as Return key  
Esc ? n  
Esc ? m  
Esc O n  
Esc O m  
VT320 terminal emulation  
Table D.13 lists the keystroke mapping (encoding) for VT320 terminal emulation.  
Table D.13: VT320 Encoding  
VT320 Keyboard  
PC Character Sequence  
VT320 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Escape Key (Esc)  
Esc  
F1  
0x1B  
F1  
F2  
Esc O P  
Esc O Q  
F2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
356  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.13: VT320 Encoding (Continued)  
VT320 Keyboard  
PC Character Sequence  
VT320 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc O R  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
Esc O S  
F6  
F6  
Esc [ 1 7 ~  
Esc [ 1 8 ~  
Esc [ 1 9 ~  
Esc [ 2 0 ~  
Esc [ 2 1 ~  
Esc [ 2 3 ~  
Esc [ 2 4 ~  
Esc [ 2 5 ~  
Esc [ 2 6 ~  
Esc [ 2 8 ~  
Esc [ 2 9 ~  
Esc [ 3 1 ~  
Esc [ 3 2 ~  
Esc [ 3 3 ~  
Esc [ 3 4 ~  
Esc [ 1 ~  
F7  
F7  
F8  
F8  
F9  
F9  
F10  
F10  
F11  
F11  
F12  
F12  
F13  
Ctrl - F5  
Ctrl - F6  
Ctrl - F7  
Ctrl - F8  
Ctrl - F9  
Ctrl - F10  
Ctrl - F11  
Ctrl - F12  
Insert  
F14  
F15  
F16  
F17  
F18  
F19  
F20  
Insert  
Home  
Delete  
End  
Home  
Delete  
End  
Esc [ 2 ~  
Hex 7 F  
Esc [ 5 ~  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Esc [ A  
Esc [ B  
Esc [ D  
Esc [ C  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
357  
Table D.14 lists the decoding for VT320 terminal emulation.  
Table D.14: VT320 Decoding  
VT320 Keyboard Function  
Index  
VT320 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc D  
New Line  
Esc E  
Reverse Index  
Esc M  
Escape O  
Esc O  
Save cursor and attributes  
Restore cursor and attributes  
Up Arrow  
Esc 7  
Esc 8  
Esc [ A  
Esc [ B  
Esc [ C  
Esc [ D  
Esc [ H  
Esc [ f  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Set cursor to home position  
Set cursor to home position  
Character Attributes  
Erase from cursor to end of line  
Erase from cursor to end of screen  
Programmable LEDs  
What are You?  
Esc [ m  
Esc [ K  
Esc [ J  
Esc [ q  
Esc [ c  
Esc [ ?  
Esc [ P  
Esc [ L  
Esc [ M  
Esc O A  
Esc O B  
Esc O C  
Esc O D  
Esc # 8  
Set Mode  
Delete 1 Character  
Insert 1 Line  
Delete 1 Line  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Fill Screen with Es  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
358  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Table D.14: VT320 Decoding (Continued)  
VT320 Keyboard Function  
Up Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Down Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Right Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Left Down Arrow amount specified by Pn  
Erase parts of current line  
Erase parts of current screen  
Direct Cursor Addressing  
Direct Cursor Addressing  
Programmable LEDs  
VT320 Keyboard Byte Sequence  
Esc [ Pn A  
Esc [ Pn B  
Esc [ Pn C  
Esc [ Pn D  
Esc [ Pn K  
Esc [ Pn J  
Esc [ Pn H  
Esc [ Pn f  
Esc [ Pn q  
Scrolling Region  
Esc [ Pn r  
Clear tabs  
Esc [ Pn g  
Device status report  
Esc [ Pn n  
What are you?  
Esc [ Pn c  
Sat Mode  
Esc [ Pn h  
Delete Pn Characters  
Insert Pn Lines  
Esc [ Pn P  
Esc [ Pn L  
Delete Pn Lines  
Esc [ Pn M  
Esc [ Pn @  
Esc [ Pn X  
Insert Character  
Erase Pn Characters  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
359  
Appendix E: Regaining Access to the DSView 3 Software  
Access to a DSView 3 software system may be lost due to reasons such as:  
Being locked out by the DSView 3 software  
Deleting the last DSView 3 software administrator  
Forgetting the DSView 3 software administrator password  
To regain access to a DSView 3 software system:  
1. Contact Avocent Technical Support. You will be provided with the resetpassword.zip  
archive file.  
2. Extract the resetpassword.zip archive file into the <DSView Installation Directory>\bin  
directory on the DSView 3 software hub server using a third party product.  
3. From the Control Panel, select Administrative Tools - Services and stop the Avocent DSView 3  
software service.  
4. Open a terminal window, change directories to the <DSView Installation Directory>/bin direc-  
tory and enter resetpassword.bat. A code successfully generated message will appear in the  
terminal window, along with a request code in the same format as the following:  
341D3DAD-E71A15B1-66D77BBD-E655BB6C  
NOTE: Request codes are valid for only four hours.  
5. Contact Avocent Technical Support and provide the generated request code.  
6. Avocent Technical Support will provide you with a reset code.  
7. In a terminal window, enter resetpassword.bat <reset code>. A Message reset performed  
successfully message will appear in the terminal window, along with the Administrator user-  
name and password for the DSView 3 management software.  
8. From the Control Panel, select Administrative Tools - Services and restart the Avocent DSView  
3 software service.  
9. You may now log into the DSView 3 management software.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
360  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Appendix F: Glossary  
Access control  
Access control refers to mechanisms and policies that restrict access to computer resources.  
Active Directory  
Active Directory is the directory service included with Microsoft Windows 2000 and later  
versions of Windows operating systems. It extends the features of previous Windows-based  
directory services and contains new features that ease the navigation and management of large  
amounts of information, which may generate savings for both administrators and end users.  
Active Directory is secure, distributed, partitioned and replicated. It is designed to work well in  
any size installation, from a single server with a few hundred objects to thousands of servers  
and millions of objects.  
ADSAP (Avocent DS Authentication Protocol) or ADSAP2  
The ADSAP or ADSAP2 is a protocol used for authentication and authorization of KVM  
switch and serial console appliance target device sessions in the DSView 3 management  
software. This is an SSL based protocol that uses X.509 certificates.  
AIDP (Avocent Install and Discover Protocol)  
AIDP is a protocol used to install out-of-box appliances that do not have an IP address  
assigned and used to discover existing appliances that have an address assigned. This UDP-  
based protocol is not encrypted and only public information is passed over this link. AIDP uses  
UDP port 3211. Port 3211 is non-configurable.  
Applet  
An applet is a program written in the Java language that runs within a web browser.  
ASMP (Avocent Secure Management Protocol)  
ASMP is a protocol used to securely configure managed appliance settings. This TCP-based  
protocol uses an SSL encrypted communications link. AMSP uses TCP port 3211. Port 3211  
is non-configurable.  
Authentication server  
An authentication server is a network device that provides authentication services.  
Authentication  
Authentication is the validation of user login information. Authentication is used to enforce  
selective permission to access resources or to perform an operation.  
Authorization  
Authorization is the process of granting or denying access to a resource. Most computer  
security systems are based on a two-step process. The first stage is authentication, which  
ensures that users are who they claim to be. The second stage is authorization, which allows  
the user access to various resources based on the user's identity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendices  
361  
AVSP (Avocent Video Session Protocol)  
A protocol used to transfer keyboard, video and mouse information between a KVM switch  
and a remote Video Viewer. AVSP operates over SSL encrypted TCP links. TCP/IP ports 8192  
and 2068 are used by default, but may be configured to different port numbers.  
Browser session  
A type of target device session in which the target device contains a web server. The DSView  
3 software client connects directly to the target device using a web browser, without directing  
the connection through the unit.  
Cascade device  
A device that connects between a KVM switch or serial console appliance and a target device,  
or connects to a KVM switch or serial console appliance and is not, in itself, a target device.  
Examples of cascade devices include a cascade switch and a power device.  
Cascade switch  
A cascade switch is an analog KVM switch connected to a KVM switch port or IQ module. A  
cascade switch expands the number of connections allowed on a KVM switch if the switch  
supports the cascade protocol.  
CCM appliance  
A CCM console management appliance is an Avocent managed appliance that provides a  
Telnet server and an SSH server for accessing serially attached devices over a standard TCP/IP  
connection. Model numbers include the CCM850, CCM1650 and CCM4850 appliances.  
Certificate authentication  
Certificate authentication is the process of authenticating with a digital certificate.  
CPS appliance  
A CPS serial over IP network appliance is an Avocent managed appliance that provides a  
Telnet server and an SSH server for accessing serially attached devices over a standard TCP/IP  
connection. Model numbers include the CPS810 and CPS1610 appliances.  
Database replication  
Database replication is the process of distributing and keeping in sync the same database to all  
DSView 3 servers in a DSView 3 software system. Database replication ensures that all  
database changes made at the hub server or spoke servers are replicated to all DSView 3  
servers in the DSView 3 software system.  
The DSView 3 management software versions of the spoke server and hub server must match  
in order to register the spoke server. For example, you may not register a spoke server running  
DSView 3 software version 3.1 with a hub server running DSView 3 software version 3.2.  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)  
DHCP is an Internet protocol used to automate the configuration of computers using TCP/IP.  
DHCP can be used to do the following:  
Assign IP addresses automatically  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
362  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Deliver TCP/IP stack configuration parameters, such as the subnet mask and default router  
Provide other configuration information, such as printer addresses  
Digital Certificate  
A digital certificate is an attachment to an electronic message used for security purposes. The  
most common use of a digital certificate is to verify that users sending a message are who they  
claim to be, and to provide the receiver with the means to encode a reply.  
An individual wishing to send an encrypted message applies for a digital certificate from a  
Certificate Authority (CA). The CA issues an encrypted digital certificate containing the  
applicant's public key and a variety of other identification information. The CA makes its own  
public key readily available through print publicity or perhaps on the Internet.  
The recipient of an encrypted message uses the CA's public key to decode the digital certificate  
attached to the message, verifies it as issued by the CA and then obtains the sender's public key  
and identification information held within the certificate. With this information, the recipient  
can send an encrypted reply.  
The most widely used standard for digital certificates is X.509.  
DSR switch  
The DSR switch is part of the Avocent digital KVM switch series of products that allows  
KVM signals to be transmitted over a standard TCP/IP connection.  
IQ module  
An IQ smart module uses CAT 5 cabling to attach a target device to a KVM switch.  
The IQ module significantly reduces cable bulk in the rack and is well suited for high-  
density installations. An IQ module is connected to a DSR switch or other supported  
KVM switch.  
DSView 3 management software  
The DSView 3 management software is an Avocent software component installed on a PC.  
The DSView 3 management software provides the IP-based centralized services required for  
management of managed appliances and target devices, including centralized authentication,  
access control, logging events, monitoring, license management and so on. DSView 3 software  
clients interact with the software using the DSView 3 Explorer.  
DSView 3 software client  
The DSView 3 software client is a customer provided PC with an installed web browser. The  
web browser accesses the DSView 3 server and provides the user interface (that is, the  
DSView 3 Explorer) for the DSView 3 software system. The DSView 3 Explorer enables users  
to access and administer the server, managed appliances and target devices.  
DSView 3 software client session  
The DSView 3 software client session is a single HTML session between the client web  
browser and the server. For each DSView 3 software client session, the user must log into the  
DSView 3 server. Multiple DSView 3 software client sessions can exist between a given  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
363  
DSView 3 software client PC and the DSView 3 server. This occurs when the user launches  
another web browser window and connects to the same DSView 3 server.  
A DSView 3 software client session may contain multiple target device sessions.  
DSView 3 software hub server  
A DSView 3 software hub server is responsible for maintaining the master copy of the  
DSView 3 software system database. Only one server in a DSView 3 software system can be  
configured as the hub server. Spoke servers in a DSView 3 software system perform database  
replication with the hub server. The DSView 3 software hub server acts as the traffic cop for  
database replication between itself and all of the other servers in a DSView 3 software system.  
The DSView 3 software hub server and a spoke server offer the same software functionality to  
a user. The distinction of hub or spoke only has to do with the database replication role the  
server plays and not with the software functionality the server offers to the user.  
The DSView 3 management software versions of the spoke server and hub server must match  
in order to register the spoke server. For example, you may not register a spoke server running  
DSView 3 version 3.1 with a hub server running DSView 3 software version 3.2.  
DSView 3 software spoke server  
A DSView 3 software spoke server is responsible for initiating database replication with the  
hub server. A spoke server sends its database changes to the hub server and receives database  
changes from it.  
The DSView 3 software hub server and a spoke server offer the same software functionality to  
a user. The distinction of hub or spoke only has to do with the database replication role the  
server plays and not with the software functionality the server offers to the user.  
The DSView 3 management software versions of the spoke server and hub server must match  
in order to register the spoke server. For example, you may not register a spoke server running  
DSView 3 software version 3.1 with a hub server running DSView 3 software version 3.2.  
DSView 3 server  
A DSView 3 server is a customer provided PC on which the DSView 3 management software  
is installed.  
DSView 3 software system  
A DSView 3 software system includes all the components required to provide DSView 3  
software functionality, including the DSView 3 server, DSView 3 software client, managed  
appliances and target devices.  
An SNMP manager and external authentication servers, which are optional components and  
outside the DSView 3 software system, may also be added to provide additional functionality.  
Encryption  
Encryption is the translation of data into a secret code. Encryption is the most effective way to  
achieve data security. To read an encrypted file, you must have access to a secret key or  
password that enables you to decrypt the file. Unencrypted data is called plain text. Encrypted  
data is referred to as cipher text.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
364  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
There are two main types of encryption: asymmetric (also called public-key encryption)  
and symmetric.  
Embedded appliance  
Embedded appliances include IBM ASM RSA II, DRAC 4, HP iLO and NEC IPF  
embedded appliances.  
External authentication server  
The external authentication server is an optional component(s) outside of the DSView 3  
software system that enables you to select an authentication method. The DSView 3 server  
brokers authentication requests (LDAP, RADIUS and so on).  
Flash  
Flash is a special type of EEPROM that can be erased and reprogrammed in blocks instead of  
one byte at a time. The BIOS and applications of many modern applications are stored on a  
Flash memory chip so that it may easily be updated (if necessary).  
FRU (Field Replaceable Unit)  
An FRU is a module or component which is typically completely replaced as part of a field  
service repair operation.  
Graceful shutdown  
A graceful shutdown is identical to a shutdown performed by selecting Start - Shutdown and  
then selecting Shut down in the Shut Down Window dialog box.  
Hotkey  
A hotkey is a keystroke that may be assigned and used to cause a specific action or set of  
actions to occur within a user interface. By assigning the action(s), the keystroke’s normal  
operation (for example, pressing F1 to open help) is superseded.  
HTML (Hypertext Markup Language)  
HTML is a markup language used to create hypertext documents that are portable from one  
platform to another on the World Wide Web (WWW). HTML files are ASCII text files with  
embedded codes (markup tags) to indicate formatting and hypertext links. Web browsers  
interpret and display HTML documents.  
HTTP (Hypertext Transfer Protocol)  
HTTP is the underlying protocol by which WWW clients and servers communicate. HTTP is  
an application-level, generic, stateless, object-oriented protocol for distributed, collaborative,  
hypermedia information systems. A feature of HTTP is the typing and negotiation of data  
representation, allowing systems to be built independently of the data being transferred.  
HTTPS (Secure Hypertext Transfer Protocol)  
HTTPS is an extension to the HTTP protocol that supports sending data securely over  
the WWW.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
365  
Integrated windows authentication  
Previously known as Windows NT Challenge/Response (NT/CR) or NT LAN Manager  
(NTLM), Integrated Windows Authentication is a secure form of web browser authentication  
using either the Kerberos V5 authentication protocol or its own challenge/response  
authentication protocol.  
This authentication method works best in an intranet environment where the types of web  
browsers that your network users access may be controlled. If you are already logged on to  
Windows, Integrated Windows Authentication uses your logon information for authentication,  
so it will not prompt for a username and password [known as Single Sign-On (SSO)].  
Integrated Windows Authentication only works with Internet Explorer and does not work with  
an HTTP proxy. Integrated Windows Authentication must be explicitly enabled under the  
Advance Internet Options dialog box of Internet Explorer version 6.0 SP1 and above.  
Java  
Java is an environment for developing and deploying distributed, scalable, enterprise-level  
applications designed to run on networks, the Internet, and the WWW. The Java platform  
consists of a set of services, Application Program Interfaces (APIs) and protocols that provide  
functionality for developing multitiered, web-based applications.  
KVM  
KVM is an abbreviation of Keyboard, Video, Mouse.  
KVM session  
A KVM session is a type of target device session in which the target device contains a KVM  
connection (typically a server). KVM sessions are connected through a KVM switch. Tiered  
analog switches may also be part of the connection. A KVM Video Viewer connection exists  
between the DSView 3 software client and the target device.  
KVM session profiles  
KVM session profiles control KVM session behavior on a target device. A profile contains  
Video Viewer settings in general, cursor, toolbar, video and mouse scaling categories. There is  
a default KVM session profile which a target device will use if no other profile is assigned to  
it. Appliance administrators may create and modify profiles. Appliance administrators or users  
with unit configure or unit edit rights may assign a profile to a target device.  
KVM switch  
KVM switch refers to a unit that allows KVM sessions to a target device and is supported by  
the DSView 3 software. KVM switches include the DSR switch and other switches supported  
by plug-ins.  
LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol)  
LDAP is a set of protocols for accessing information directories. LDAP is based on standards  
contained in the X.500 standard, but is significantly simpler. Unlike X.500, LDAP supports  
TCP/IP, which is necessary for Internet access. Because LDAP is a simpler version of X.500, it  
is sometimes called X.500-lite.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
366  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Local port  
The local port is the physical connection through which a KVM switch or serial console  
appliance can be accessed without accessing a network connection.  
For a KVM switch, the local port is typically the KVM connection at which a keyboard, mouse  
and monitor can be connected directly to the switch. An onscreen display may be invoked to  
control the KVM switch and access switched KVM ports.  
For a serial console appliance, the local port is typically the serial connection at which a  
terminal can be connected directly to the appliance (CCM appliances have a dedicated console  
port). A command line interface (CLI) is used to control the appliance and access switched  
serial ports.  
Managed appliance  
Managed appliances include KVM switches, serial console appliances, EVR1500  
environmental monitor and control appliances and generic appliances (such as routers). Other  
managed appliances may be supported by a plug-in.  
MIB (Management Information Base)  
MIB is a database of objects that can be monitored by a network management system (NMS).  
SNMP uses standardized MIB formats that allow any SNMP tools to monitor any device  
defined by an MIB.  
NAT (Network Address Translation)  
NAT is an Internet standard that enables a local-area network (LAN) to use one set of IP  
addresses for internal traffic and a second set of addresses for external traffic. A NAT box  
located between the LAN and Internet makes all necessary IP address translations.  
NAT serves three main purposes:  
Provides a type of firewall by hiding internal IP addresses.  
Enables a company to use more internal IP addresses. Since they're used internally only,  
there's no possibility of conflict with IP addresses used by other companies  
and organizations.  
Allows a company to combine multiple ISDN connections into a single  
Internet connection.  
NAT device  
A NAT device is a network address translation (NAT) device enables the use of more internal  
IP addresses than the number that are assigned. A NAT device provides IP addresses that are  
not exposed outside of the device. The DSView 3 management software will not support  
network configuration where the DSView 3 server and KVM switch or serial console  
appliance are separated by a NAT device.  
Negative hysteresis  
Negative hysteresis is the unsigned number of counts added to the raw threshold value, which  
creates the re-arm point for all sensor thresholds that are less than zero (0). A negative  
hysteresis value of 0 indicates that any thresholds less than zero do not contain hysteresis.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
367  
OSCAR interface  
The OSCAR interface is a tool that is built in to Avocent appliances and allows a user  
connected to the local KVM port to display and change settings in a KVM switch. The  
OSCAR interface also allows a local user to connect to target devices.  
Power device  
An Avocent or supported third party cascade device that allows the remote controlling of target  
device power.  
PPP (Point to Point Protocol)  
PPP is a set of industry-standard framing and authentication protocols included with Windows  
NT Remote Access Service to ensure interoperability with third party remote access software.  
PPP negotiates configuration parameters for multiple layers of the OSI (Open Systems  
Interconnection) model.  
Positive hysteresis  
Positive hysteresis is the unsigned number of counts subtracted from the raw threshold value,  
which creates the re-arm point for all sensor thresholds that are greater than zero (0). A  
positive hysteresis value of 0 indicates that any thresholds greater than zero do not  
contain hysteresis.  
SDR repository device  
An SDR repository device is the logical management device that provides a sensor data  
records (SDR) system interface, which in turn, provides a set of SDR storage and  
retrieval commands.  
Serial console appliance  
Serial console appliance refers to a unit that allows serial sessions to a target device and is  
supported by the DSView 3 software. Serial console appliances include the ACS console  
server, the legacy CCM and CPS appliances and other units supported by plug-ins. The ACS  
console server is supported by a plug-in; for detailed procedures and what DSView 3  
operations the ACS console server supports, see the corresponding plug-in documentation for  
detailed procedures.  
Serial session  
A serial session is a type of target device session in which the target device contains a serial  
connection (typically a Linux server TTY port or a router) and is connected through a serial  
console appliance. A Telnet Viewer connection exists between the DSView 3 software client  
and the serial console appliance. The appliance converts the Telnet information to  
serial information.  
Server  
A server is a computer or device on a network that manages network resources. For example:  
A file server is a computer and storage device dedicated to storing files. Any user on the  
network can store files on the server.  
A print server is a computer that manages one or more printers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
368  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
A network server is a computer that manages network traffic.  
A database server is a computer system that processes database queries.  
Servers are often dedicated, meaning that they perform no other tasks besides their server  
tasks. However, on multiprocessing operating systems, a single computer can execute several  
programs at once. In this case, a server may refer to the program that is managing resources  
rather than the entire computer.  
Session  
When used alone, a session refers to a target device session. See the definition of a target  
device session for details.  
Site  
A site is a location that contains a managed appliance, DSView 3 server or both.  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol)  
SNMP is a set of protocols for managing complex networks. SNMP works by sending  
messages to different parts of a network. SNMP-compliant devices, called agents, store data  
about themselves in MIBs and return this data to the SNMP requesters.  
SNMP manager  
The SNMP manager is an optional component (outside of the DSView 3 software system) that  
enables the monitoring of many cross-platform devices using SNMP information. SNMP  
managers are also called network management systems (NMS).  
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer)  
SSL is a protocol that supplies secure data communication through data encryption and  
decryption. SSL enables private communications over networks by using a combination of  
public key cryptography and bulk data encryption.  
SSH Passthrough session  
An SSH Passthrough session is a serial session opened to a unit by without the use of a web  
browser. From an SSH client, you can enter an SSH Passthrough command to establish a  
connection to any serial unit managed by the DSView 3 software if you have access rights.  
Target device  
A target device includes a wide range of data center components such as servers and routers  
that an administrator is able to virtually manage through the DSView 3 management software.  
Target device session  
A target device session is a connection through a KVM, serial, Telnet or web browser. Target  
device sessions do not include power management functionality.  
TCP/IP (Transmission Control Protocol)  
TCP is one of the main protocols in TCP/IP networks. The IP protocol deals only with packets.  
TCP enables two hosts to establish a connection and exchange streams of data. TCP guarantees  
delivery of data and that packets will be delivered in the same order in which they were sent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
369  
Telnet session  
A Telnet Viewer session is a type of target device session in which the target device supports  
Telnet and the DSView 3 software client connects directly to the target device using Telnet.  
Telnet Viewer  
This applet is a software component that provides the user interface needed to display a remote  
target device through serial over IP sessions.  
Tiered switch  
A tiered switch is also known as a cascade switch. See the definition of cascade switch.  
Unit  
Unit is a generic term that refers to either a target device, managed appliance, blade chassis or  
a component in a VMware environment. For example, the Unit List may contain both target  
devices and managed appliances.  
UDP (User Datagram Protocol)  
UDP is a connectionless protocol that runs on top of IP networks like TCP. Unlike TCP/IP,  
UDP/IP provides very few error recovery services, offering instead a direct way to send and  
receive datagrams over an IP network. UDP is primarily used for broadcasting messages over  
a network.  
Video Viewer  
The Video Viewer is a software component that provides the user interface needed to display a  
remote target device through KVM over IP sessions.  
VPN (Virtual Private Network)  
VPN is a means of implementing a private network on a public network such as the Internet.  
By encrypting data and assigning addresses, the impression is given to networks at each end of  
the VPN that they are connected by a private physical network instead of across a  
public network.  
(WAN) Wide Area Network  
WAN typically refers to a network that is distributed at multiple sites and connected by a  
relatively slow link between the sites. The WAN is frequently implemented using a VPN on  
the Internet.  
(WAS) Web Application Server  
WAS is software that runs on a server that is capable of executing web applications. The WAS  
software typically contains or works with a web (HTTP) server.  
(Webapp) Web Application  
Webapps are groups of server-side Web resources that make up an interactive online  
application. The web resources include Java servlets, JavaServer Pages(JSPs), static  
documents (such as HTML documents), and applets that can be deployed in a DSView 3  
software client web browser. Web applications must run in the context of a web application  
server such as the DSView 3 server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
370  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Web server  
A web server is a computer equipped with server software to respond to HTTP requests, such  
as requests from a web browser. A web server uses the HTTP protocol to communicate with  
clients on a TCP/IP network.  
X.509  
X.509 is the most widely used standard for defining digital certificates. X.509 is an  
International Telecommunications Union (ITU) recommendation, which means that the  
standard has not yet been officially defined or approved. As a result, companies have  
implemented the standard in different ways. For example, both Netscape and Microsoft use  
X.509 certificates to implement SSL in their web servers and web browsers. However, an  
X.509 certificate generated by Netscape may not be readable by Microsoft products, and  
vice versa.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
371  
INDEX  
Index  
A
Access  
B
Backup servers. See Spoke servers  
Access rights  
C
Cascade switches  
AlterPath Manager  
Certificates  
Appliances. See Managed appliances  
Authentication services  
Connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
373  
Groups  
IPMI target devices  
IQ modules  
ISDN  
H
Hub server  
J
K
L
I
Installation  
Local accounts  
M
Macros  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
374  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
Managed appliances  
N
Network properties  
O
Operating systems  
P
Passwords  
Plug-ins  
Modem connections  
Mouse  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
375  
Profiles  
Ports  
Properties  
Power device sockets  
Power devices  
Proxy server  
Push/pull  
R
Requirements  
Preemption  
Resync wizard  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
376  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
S
Security  
Servers  
Spoke servers  
See also Hub server and Spoke servers  
Sessions  
SSH  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
377  
Tasks  
Telnet  
T
See also Telnet Viewer  
Telnet Viewer  
Target devices  
Thumbnail Viewer. See View Viewer - Scan mode  
Topology  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
378  
DSView 3 Software Installer/User Guide  
U
Unit groups  
User accounts  
Units  
See also User groups  
User groups  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For Technical Support:  
www.avocent.com/support  
590-395-501J  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

A4 Tech Mouse BT 630 User Manual
Actron Automobile Parts 9620 User Manual
Adaptec Network Card USB2connect Host Bus Adapter User Manual
American Standard Indoor Furnishings 034782 XXX0A User Manual
American Standard Indoor Furnishings 0451001 User Manual
Ask Proxima Projector C105 DP6155 User Manual
Audiovox Automobile Alarm PRO9801C User Manual
Behringer Music Mixer PMP518M User Manual
Behringer Music Pedal FCV100 User Manual
Beko Hot Beverage Maker BKK 2105 User Manual